[PowerPC] Add support for HTM registers
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1274 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1275 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1276 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3877 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3878 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3879 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3880 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3881 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3882
3883 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3884 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3885 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3886 classes.
3887
3888 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3889 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3890 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3891
3892 @smallexample
3893 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3894 @end smallexample
3895
3896 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3897 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3898 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3899 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3900 every function in a given file:
3901
3902 @smallexample
3903 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3907 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3908
3909 @kindex info breakpoints
3910 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3911 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3912 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3913 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3914 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3915 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3916 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3917
3918 @table @emph
3919 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3920 @item Type
3921 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3922 @item Disposition
3923 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3924 @item Enabled or Disabled
3925 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3926 that are not enabled.
3927 @item Address
3928 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3929 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3930 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3931 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3932 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3933 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3934 @item What
3935 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3936 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3937 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3938 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 @noindent
3942 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3943 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3944 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3945 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3946 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3947 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3948
3949 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3950 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3951 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3952 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3953
3954 @noindent
3955 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3956 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3957 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3958 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3959 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3963 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3964 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3965 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3966 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3967 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3968
3969 @noindent
3970 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3971 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3972
3973 @end table
3974
3975 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3976 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3977 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3978 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3979
3980 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3981 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3982 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3983 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item
3987 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3988
3989 @item
3990 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3991 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3992
3993 @item
3994 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3995 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3996
3997 @item
3998 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3999 several places where that function is inlined.
4000 @end itemize
4001
4002 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4003 the relevant locations.
4004
4005 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4006 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4007 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4008 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4009 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4010 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4011 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4012
4013 For example:
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4017 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4018 stop only if i==1
4019 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4020 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4021 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4025 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4026 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4027 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4028 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4029 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4030 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4031 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4032 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4033 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4034 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4035
4036 @cindex pending breakpoints
4037 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4038 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4039 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4040 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4041 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4042 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4043 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4044 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4045 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4046 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4047 is not yet resolved.
4048
4049 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4050 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4051 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4052 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4053 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4054 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4055
4056 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4057 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4058 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4059 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4060
4061 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4062 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4063 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4066 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4067 address specification to an address:
4068
4069 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4070 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4071 @table @code
4072 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4073 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4074 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4075
4076 @item set breakpoint pending on
4077 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4078 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4079
4080 @item set breakpoint pending off
4081 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4082 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4083 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4084
4085 @item show breakpoint pending
4086 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4087 @end table
4088
4089 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4090 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4091 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4092
4093 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4094 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4095 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4096 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4097 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4098 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4099 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4100 breakpoints.
4101
4102 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4103
4104 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4105 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4106 @table @code
4107 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4108 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4109 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4110 breakpoint must be used.
4111
4112 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4113 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4114 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4115 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4116 @end table
4117
4118 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4119 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4120 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4121 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4122 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4123 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4124 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4125 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4126 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4127
4128 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4129 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4130 @table @code
4131 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4132 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4133 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4134 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4135
4136 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4137 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4138 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4139 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4140 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4141 @end table
4142
4143 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4144 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4145 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4146
4147 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4148 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4149
4150 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4151
4152 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4153 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4154 @table @code
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4157 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4158 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4159 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4160
4161 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4162 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4163 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4164 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4165 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4166 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4167 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4168 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4169 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4170 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4171 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4172 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4173 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4174
4175 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4176 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4177 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4178 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4179 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4180 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4181 @end table
4182
4183
4184 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4185 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4186 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4187 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4188 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4189 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4190 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4191 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4192
4193
4194 @node Set Watchpoints
4195 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4196
4197 @cindex setting watchpoints
4198 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4199 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4200 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4201 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4202 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4203
4204 @itemize @bullet
4205 @item
4206 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4207
4208 @item
4209 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4210 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4211 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4212
4213 @item
4214 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4215 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4216 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4217 @end itemize
4218
4219 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4220 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4221 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4222 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4223 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4224 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4225 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4226 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4227 the expression changes.
4228
4229 @cindex software watchpoints
4230 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4231 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4232 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4233 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4234 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4235 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4236 culprit.)
4237
4238 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4239 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4240 slow down the running of your program.
4241
4242 @table @code
4243 @kindex watch
4244 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4245 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4246 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4247 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4248 to watch the value of a single variable:
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4255 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4256 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4257 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4258 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4259 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4260
4261 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4262 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4263 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4264 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4265 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4266 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4267 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4268 error.
4269
4270 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4271 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4272 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4273 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4274 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4275 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4276 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4277 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4278 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4279 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4280 Examples:
4281
4282 @smallexample
4283 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4284 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4285 @end smallexample
4286
4287 @kindex rwatch
4288 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4289 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4290 by the program.
4291
4292 @kindex awatch
4293 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4294 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4295 or written into by the program.
4296
4297 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4298 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4299 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4300 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4301 @end table
4302
4303 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4304 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4305 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4306 a never-changing value:
4307
4308 @smallexample
4309 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4310 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4311 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4312 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4313 @end smallexample
4314
4315 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4316 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4317 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4318 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4319 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4320 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4321
4322 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4323 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4324 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4325 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4326 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4327 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4328 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4329 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4330
4331 @table @code
4332 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4333 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4334 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4335
4336 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4337 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4338 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4339 @end table
4340
4341 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4342 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4343 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4344
4345 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4346
4347 @smallexample
4348 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4349 @end smallexample
4350
4351 @noindent
4352 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4353
4354 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4355 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4356 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4357 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4358 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4359 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4360 will print a message like this:
4361
4362 @smallexample
4363 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4364 @end smallexample
4365
4366 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4367 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4368 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4369 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4370 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4371 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4372 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4373 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4374
4375 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4376 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4377 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4378 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4379 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4380 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4381
4382 @smallexample
4383 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 @noindent
4387 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4388
4389 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4390 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4391 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4392 expression with separately allocated resources.
4393
4394 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4395 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4396 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4397
4398 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4399 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4400 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4401 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4402 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4403 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4404 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4405 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4406 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4407
4408 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4409 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4410 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4411 watched expression from every thread.
4412
4413 @quotation
4414 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4415 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4416 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4417 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4418 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4419 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4420 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4421 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4422 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4423 @end quotation
4424
4425 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4426
4427 @node Set Catchpoints
4428 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4429 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4430 @cindex exception handlers
4431 @cindex event handling
4432
4433 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4434 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4435 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @kindex catch
4439 @item catch @var{event}
4440 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4444 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4445 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4446 @kindex catch throw
4447 @kindex catch rethrow
4448 @kindex catch catch
4449 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4450 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4451
4452 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4453 regular expression will be caught.
4454
4455 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4456 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4457 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4458 exception being thrown.
4459
4460 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4461 @value{GDBN}:
4462
4463 @itemize @bullet
4464 @item
4465 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4466 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4467 supported.
4468
4469 @item
4470 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4471 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4472 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4473 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4474 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4475 built.
4476
4477 @item
4478 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4479 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4480
4481 @item
4482 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4483 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4484 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4485 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4486
4487 @item
4488 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4489 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4490 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4491 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4492 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4493 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4494 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4495 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4496 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4497
4498 @item
4499 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4500
4501 @item
4502 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4503 @end itemize
4504
4505 @item exception
4506 @kindex catch exception
4507 @cindex Ada exception catching
4508 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4509 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4510 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4511 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4512 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4513
4514 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4515 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4516 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4517 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4518 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4519 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4520 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4521 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4522
4523 @item handlers
4524 @kindex catch handlers
4525 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4526 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4527 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4528 specified at the end of the command
4529 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4530 only when this specific exception is handled.
4531 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4532
4533 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4534 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4535 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4536 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4537 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4538 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4539 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4540 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4541 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4542
4543 @item exception unhandled
4544 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4545 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4546
4547 @item assert
4548 @kindex catch assert
4549 A failed Ada assertion.
4550
4551 @item exec
4552 @kindex catch exec
4553 @cindex break on fork/exec
4554 A call to @code{exec}.
4555
4556 @item syscall
4557 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4558 @kindex catch syscall
4559 @cindex break on a system call.
4560 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4561 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4562 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4563 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4564 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4565 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4566 will be caught.
4567
4568 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4569 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4570 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4571 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4572
4573 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4574 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4575 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4576 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4577
4578 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4579 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4580 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4581 available choices.
4582
4583 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4584 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4585 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4586 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4587 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4588 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4589 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4590 behind the OS upgrades).
4591
4592 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4593 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4594 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4595 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4596 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4597 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4598 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4599 syscall groups available on your environment.
4600
4601 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4602 arguments to it:
4603
4604 @smallexample
4605 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4606 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4607 (@value{GDBP}) r
4608 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4609
4610 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4611 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4612 (@value{GDBP}) c
4613 Continuing.
4614
4615 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4616 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4617 (@value{GDBP})
4618 @end smallexample
4619
4620 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4621
4622 @smallexample
4623 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4624 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4625 (@value{GDBP}) r
4626 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4627
4628 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4629 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4630 (@value{GDBP}) c
4631 Continuing.
4632
4633 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4634 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4635 (@value{GDBP})
4636 @end smallexample
4637
4638 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4639 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4640 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4641
4642 @smallexample
4643 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4644 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4645 (@value{GDBP}) r
4646 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4647
4648 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4649 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4650 (@value{GDBP}) c
4651 Continuing.
4652
4653 Program exited normally.
4654 (@value{GDBP})
4655 @end smallexample
4656
4657 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4661 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4662 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4663 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4664 (@value{GDBP}) r
4665 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4666
4667 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4668 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4669
4670 (@value{GDBP}) c
4671 Continuing.
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4675 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4676 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4677 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4678
4679 @smallexample
4680 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4681 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4682 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4683 (@value{GDBP})
4684 @end smallexample
4685
4686 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4687 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4688 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4689 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4690 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4691 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4695 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4696 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4697 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4698 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4699 (@value{GDBP})
4700 @end smallexample
4701
4702 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4703
4704 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4705 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4709 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4710 @end smallexample
4711
4712 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4713
4714 @item fork
4715 @kindex catch fork
4716 A call to @code{fork}.
4717
4718 @item vfork
4719 @kindex catch vfork
4720 A call to @code{vfork}.
4721
4722 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4723 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4724 @kindex catch load
4725 @kindex catch unload
4726 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4727 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4728 matches one of the affected libraries.
4729
4730 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4731 @kindex catch signal
4732 The delivery of a signal.
4733
4734 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4735 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4736 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4737
4738 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4739 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4740 signal names.
4741
4742 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4743 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4744 will be caught.
4745
4746 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4747 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4748 catchpoint.
4749
4750 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4751 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4752 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4753 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4754 commands.
4755
4756 @end table
4757
4758 @item tcatch @var{event}
4759 @kindex tcatch
4760 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4761 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4762
4763 @end table
4764
4765 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4766
4767
4768 @node Delete Breaks
4769 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4770
4771 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4772 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4773 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4774 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4775 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4776 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4777
4778 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4779 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4780 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4781 their breakpoint numbers.
4782
4783 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4784 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4785 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @kindex clear
4789 @item clear
4790 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4791 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4792 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4793 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4794
4795 @item clear @var{location}
4796 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4797 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4798 most useful ones are listed below:
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @item clear @var{function}
4802 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4803 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4804
4805 @item clear @var{linenum}
4806 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4807 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4808 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex delete breakpoints
4812 @kindex delete
4813 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4814 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4815 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4816 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4817 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4818 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 @node Disabling
4822 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4823
4824 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4825 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4826 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4827 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4828 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4829
4830 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4831 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4832 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4833 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4834 do not know which numbers to use.
4835
4836 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4837 affects all of its locations.
4838
4839 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4840 different states of enablement:
4841
4842 @itemize @bullet
4843 @item
4844 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4845 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4846 @item
4847 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4850 disabled.
4851 @item
4852 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4853 N times, then becomes disabled.
4854 @item
4855 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4856 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4857 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4858 @end itemize
4859
4860 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4861 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4862
4863 @table @code
4864 @kindex disable
4865 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4866 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4867 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4868 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4869 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4870 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4871 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4872
4873 @kindex enable
4874 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4876 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4877
4878 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4879 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4880 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4881
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4884 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4885 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4886 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4887 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4888 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4892 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4893 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4894 @end table
4895
4896 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4897 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4898 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4899 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4900 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4901 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4902 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4903 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4904 Stepping}.)
4905
4906 @node Conditions
4907 @subsection Break Conditions
4908 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4909 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4910
4911 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4912 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4913 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4914 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4915 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4916 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4917 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4918 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4919
4920 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4921 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4922 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4923 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4924 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4925
4926 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4927 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4928 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4929 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4930 one.
4931
4932 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4933 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4934 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4935 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4936 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4937 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4938 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4939 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4940 conditions for the
4941 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4942 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4943
4944 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4945 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4946 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4947 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4948 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4949 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4950
4951 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4952 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4953 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4954 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4955 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4956
4957 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4958 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4959 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4960 with the @code{condition} command.
4961
4962 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4963 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4964 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4965 catchpoint.
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @kindex condition
4969 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4970 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4971 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4972 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4973 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4974 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4975 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4976 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4977 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4978 prints an error message:
4979
4980 @smallexample
4981 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4982 @end smallexample
4983
4984 @noindent
4985 @value{GDBN} does
4986 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4987 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4988 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4989
4990 @item condition @var{bnum}
4991 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4992 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4993 @end table
4994
4995 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4996 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4997 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4998 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4999 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5000 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5001 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5002 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5003 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5004 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5005 your program reaches it.
5006
5007 @table @code
5008 @kindex ignore
5009 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5010 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5011 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5012 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5013 takes no action.
5014
5015 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5016 a count of zero.
5017
5018 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5019 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5020 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5021 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5022
5023 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5024 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5025 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5026
5027 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5028 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5029 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5030 Variables}.
5031 @end table
5032
5033 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5034
5035
5036 @node Break Commands
5037 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5038
5039 @cindex breakpoint commands
5040 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5041 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5042 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5043 enable other breakpoints.
5044
5045 @table @code
5046 @kindex commands
5047 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5048 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5049 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5050 @itemx end
5051 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5052 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5053 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5054
5055 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5056 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5057
5058 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5059 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5060 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5061 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5062 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5063 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5064 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5065 Expressions}).
5066 @end table
5067
5068 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5069 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5070
5071 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5072 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5073 that resumes execution.
5074
5075 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5076 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5077 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5078 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5079 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5080
5081 @kindex silent
5082 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5083 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5084 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5085 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5086 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5087 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5088
5089 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5090 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5091 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5092
5093 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5094 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5095
5096 @smallexample
5097 break foo if x>0
5098 commands
5099 silent
5100 printf "x is %d\n",x
5101 cont
5102 end
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5106 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5107 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5108 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5109 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5110 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5111 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5112
5113 @smallexample
5114 break 403
5115 commands
5116 silent
5117 set x = y + 4
5118 cont
5119 end
5120 @end smallexample
5121
5122 @node Dynamic Printf
5123 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5124
5125 @cindex dynamic printf
5126 @cindex dprintf
5127 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5128 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5129 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5130 having to recompile it.
5131
5132 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5133 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5134 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5135 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5136 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5137 redirects to files and so forth.
5138
5139 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5140 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5141 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5142 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5143 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5144 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5145 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5146
5147 @table @code
5148 @kindex dprintf
5149 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5150 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5151 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5152 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5153
5154 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5155 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5156 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5157 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5158 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5159 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @item gdb
5163 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5164 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5165
5166 @item call
5167 @kindex dprintf-style call
5168 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5169 @code{printf}).
5170
5171 @item agent
5172 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5173 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5174 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5175 support running commands on the target.
5176 @end table
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5179 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5180 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5181 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5182 command.
5183
5184 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5185 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5186 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5187 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5188 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5189 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5190
5191 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5192 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5193 you could do the following:
5194
5195 @example
5196 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5197 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5198 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5199 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5200 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5201 (gdb) info break
5202 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5203 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5204 continue
5205 (gdb)
5206 @end example
5207
5208 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5209 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5210 the variable settings.
5211
5212 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5213 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5215 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5216 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5217 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5218
5219 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5220 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5221 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5222
5223 @end table
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5226 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5227 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5228 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5229 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5230 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5231
5232 @node Save Breakpoints
5233 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5234
5235 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5236 breakpoints}} command.
5237
5238 @table @code
5239 @kindex save breakpoints
5240 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5241 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5242 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5243 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5244 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5245 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5246 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5247 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5248 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5249 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5250 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5251 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5252 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5253 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5254 that can no longer be recreated.
5255 @end table
5256
5257 @node Static Probe Points
5258 @subsection Static Probe Points
5259
5260 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5261 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5262 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5263 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5264 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5265
5266 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5267 ELF-compatible systems:
5268
5269 @itemize @bullet
5270
5271 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5272 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5273 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5274 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5275 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5276 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5277 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5278 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5279
5280 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5281 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5282 C@t{++} languages.
5283 @end itemize
5284
5285 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5286 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5287 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5288 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5289 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5290 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5291 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5292 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5293 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5294
5295 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5296 probes}, with optional arguments:
5297
5298 @table @code
5299 @kindex info probes
5300 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5301 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5302 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5303 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5304
5305 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5306 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5307 probes from all providers are listed.
5308
5309 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5310 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5311 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5312
5313 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5314 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5315 given, all object files are considered.
5316
5317 @item info probes all
5318 List the available static probes, from all types.
5319 @end table
5320
5321 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5322 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5323 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5324 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5325 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5326
5327 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5328 commands, with optional arguments:
5329
5330 @table @code
5331 @kindex enable probes
5332 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5333 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5334 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5335 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5336
5337 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5338 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5339 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5340
5341 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5342 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5343 given, all object files are considered.
5344
5345 @kindex disable probes
5346 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5347 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5348 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5349 @end table
5350
5351 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5352 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5353 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5354 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5355 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5356 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5357 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5358 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5359 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5360 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5361 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5362 at the current probe point.
5363
5364 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5365 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5366 an error message.
5367
5368
5369 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5370 @node Error in Breakpoints
5371 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5372
5373 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5374 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5375
5376 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5377 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5378 @smallexample
5379 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5380 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5381 @end smallexample
5382
5383 @noindent
5384 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5385 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5386 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5387
5388 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5389 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5390
5391 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5392 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5393 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5394
5395 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5396 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5397 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5398 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5399
5400 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5401 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5402 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5403 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5404 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5405 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5406 first in the bundle.
5407
5408 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5409 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5410 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5411 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5412 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5413 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5414 is hit.
5415
5416 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5417 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5418
5419 @smallexample
5420 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5424 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5425 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5426 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5427 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5428 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5429 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5430 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5431
5432 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5433 adjusted breakpoints:
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5437 to 0x00010410.
5438 @end smallexample
5439
5440 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5441 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5442 frequently than expected.
5443
5444 @node Continuing and Stepping
5445 @section Continuing and Stepping
5446
5447 @cindex stepping
5448 @cindex continuing
5449 @cindex resuming execution
5450 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5451 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5452 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5453 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5454 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5455 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5456 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5457 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5458 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5459 handlers}).)
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex continue
5463 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5464 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5465 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5466 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5467 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5468 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5469 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5470 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5471 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5472 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5473
5474 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5475 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5476 @code{continue} is ignored.
5477
5478 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5479 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5480 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5481 @code{continue}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5485 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5486 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5487 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5488
5489 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5490 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5491 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5492 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5493 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5494 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex step
5498 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5499 @item step
5500 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5501 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5502 abbreviated @code{s}.
5503
5504 @quotation
5505 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5506 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5507 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5508 @c distinction here.
5509 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5510 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5511 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5512 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5513 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5514 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5515 below.
5516 @end quotation
5517
5518 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5519 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5520 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5521 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5522 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5523 called within the line.
5524
5525 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5526 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5527 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5528 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5529 was any debugging information about the routine.
5530
5531 @item step @var{count}
5532 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5533 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5534 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5535
5536 @kindex next
5537 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5538 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5539 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5540 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5541 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5542 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5543 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5544 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5545
5546 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5547
5548
5549 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5550 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5551 @c
5552 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5553 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5554 @c function are executed without stopping.
5555
5556 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5557 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5558 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5559
5560 @kindex set step-mode
5561 @item set step-mode
5562 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5563 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5564 @itemx set step-mode on
5565 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5566 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5567 information rather than stepping over it.
5568
5569 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5570 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5571 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5572
5573 @item set step-mode off
5574 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5575 debug information. This is the default.
5576
5577 @item show step-mode
5578 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5579 source line debug information.
5580
5581 @kindex finish
5582 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5583 @item finish
5584 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5585 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5586 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5587
5588 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5589 ,Returning from a Function}).
5590
5591 @kindex until
5592 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5593 @cindex run until specified location
5594 @item until
5595 @itemx u
5596 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5597 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5598 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5599 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5600 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5601 than the address of the jump.
5602
5603 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5604 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5605 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5606 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5607 through the next iteration.
5608
5609 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5610 stack frame.
5611
5612 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5613 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5614 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5615 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5616 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (@value{GDBP}) f
5620 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5621 206 expand_input();
5622 (@value{GDBP}) until
5623 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5624 @end smallexample
5625
5626 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5627 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5628 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5629 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5630 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5631 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5632 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5633
5634 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5635 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5636 argument.
5637
5638 @item until @var{location}
5639 @itemx u @var{location}
5640 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5641 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5642 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5643 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5644 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5645 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5646 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5647 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5648 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5649 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5650 invocations have returned.
5651
5652 @smallexample
5653 94 int factorial (int value)
5654 95 @{
5655 96 if (value > 1) @{
5656 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5657 98 @}
5658 99 return (value);
5659 100 @}
5660 @end smallexample
5661
5662
5663 @kindex advance @var{location}
5664 @item advance @var{location}
5665 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5666 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5667 @ref{Specify Location}.
5668 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5669 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5670 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5671 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5672
5673
5674 @kindex stepi
5675 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5676 @item stepi
5677 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5678 @itemx si
5679 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5680
5681 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5682 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5683 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5684 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5685
5686 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5687
5688 @need 750
5689 @kindex nexti
5690 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5691 @item nexti
5692 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5693 @itemx ni
5694 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5695 proceed until the function returns.
5696
5697 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5698
5699 @end table
5700
5701 @anchor{range stepping}
5702 @cindex range stepping
5703 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5704 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5705 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5706 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5707 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5708 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5709 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5710 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5711 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5712 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5713 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5714 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5715 if necessary:
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @kindex set range-stepping
5719 @kindex show range-stepping
5720 @item set range-stepping
5721 @itemx show range-stepping
5722 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5723
5724 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5725 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5726 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5727 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5728 default is @code{on}.
5729
5730 @end table
5731
5732 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5733 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5734 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5735
5736 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5737 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5738 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5739 a particular file when stepping.
5740
5741 For example, consider the following C function:
5742
5743 @smallexample
5744 101 int func()
5745 102 @{
5746 103 foo(boring());
5747 104 bar(boring());
5748 105 @}
5749 @end smallexample
5750
5751 @noindent
5752 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5753 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5754 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5755 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5756
5757 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5758 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5759 is called from many places.
5760
5761 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5762 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5763 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5764 @code{foo}.
5765
5766 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5767 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5768 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5769
5770 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5771 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5772 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5773 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5774 the underlying system.
5775 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5776 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5777
5778 @table @code
5779 @kindex skip
5780 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5781 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5782 that specify what to skip.
5783 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5784
5785 @table @code
5786 @item -file @var{file}
5787 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5788 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5789
5790 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5791 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5792 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5793 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5794 over when stepping.
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @item -function @var{linespec}
5801 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5802 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5803 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804 @xref{Specify Location}.
5805
5806 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5807 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5808 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5809 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5810
5811 This form is useful for complex function names.
5812 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5813 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5814 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5815 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5816 regular expression makes this easier.
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5820 @end smallexample
5821
5822 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5823 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5827 @end smallexample
5828 @end table
5829
5830 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5831 will be skipped.
5832
5833 @kindex skip function
5834 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5835 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5836 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5837 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5838
5839 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5840 will be skipped.
5841
5842 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5843 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5844
5845 @kindex skip file
5846 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5847 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5848 will be skipped over when stepping.
5849
5850 @smallexample
5851 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5852 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5853 @end smallexample
5854
5855 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5856 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5857 @end table
5858
5859 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5860 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5861
5862 @table @code
5863 @kindex info skip
5864 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5865 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5866 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5867 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5868
5869 @table @emph
5870 @item Identifier
5871 A number identifying this skip.
5872 @item Enabled or Disabled
5873 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5874 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5875 @item Glob
5876 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item File
5879 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5880 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @item RE
5882 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5883 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5884 @item Function
5885 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5886 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5887 @end table
5888
5889 @kindex skip delete
5890 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5891 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5892 skips.
5893
5894 @kindex skip enable
5895 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5896 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5897 skips.
5898
5899 @kindex skip disable
5900 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5901 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5902 skips.
5903
5904 @kindex set debug skip
5905 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5906 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5907
5908 @kindex show debug skip
5909 @item show debug skip
5910 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5911
5912 @end table
5913
5914 @node Signals
5915 @section Signals
5916 @cindex signals
5917
5918 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5919 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5920 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5921 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5922 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5923 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5924 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5925 requested an alarm).
5926
5927 @cindex fatal signals
5928 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5929 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5930 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5931 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5932 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5933 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5934
5935 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5936 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5937 signal.
5938
5939 @cindex handling signals
5940 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5941 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5942 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5943 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5944 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @kindex info signals
5948 @kindex info handle
5949 @item info signals
5950 @itemx info handle
5951 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5952 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5953 the defined types of signals.
5954
5955 @item info signals @var{sig}
5956 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5957
5958 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5959
5960 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5961 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5962 for details about this command.
5963
5964 @kindex handle
5965 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5966 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5967 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5968 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5969 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5970 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5971 say what change to make.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 @c @group
5975 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5976 Their full names are:
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @item nostop
5980 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5981 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5982
5983 @item stop
5984 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5985 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5986
5987 @item print
5988 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5989
5990 @item noprint
5991 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5992 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5993
5994 @item pass
5995 @itemx noignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5997 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5998 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5999
6000 @item nopass
6001 @itemx ignore
6002 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6003 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6004 @end table
6005 @c @end group
6006
6007 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6008 program until you
6009 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6010 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6011 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6012 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6013 program sees that signal when you continue.
6014
6015 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6016 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6017 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6018 erroneous signals.
6019
6020 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6021 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6022 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6023 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6024 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6025 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6026 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6027 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6028 Program a Signal}.
6029
6030 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6031 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6032
6033 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6034 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6035 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6036 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6037 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6038 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6039 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6040 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6041 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6042 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6043 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6044 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6045 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6046
6047 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6048
6049 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6050 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6051 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6052 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6053
6054 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6055 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6056 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6057 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6058
6059 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6060 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6061
6062 @smallexample
6063 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6064 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6065 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6066 (@value{GDBP}) c
6067 Continuing.
6068
6069 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6070 main () sigusr1.c:28
6071 28 p = 0;
6072 (@value{GDBP}) si
6073 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6074 9 @{
6075 @end smallexample
6076
6077 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6078 program to receive the signal first:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) n
6082 28 p = 0;
6083 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6084 (@value{GDBP}) si
6085 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6086 9 @{
6087 (@value{GDBP})
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @cindex extra signal information
6091 @anchor{extra signal information}
6092
6093 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6094 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6095 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6096 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6097 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6098 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6099 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6100 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6101 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6102 system header.
6103
6104 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6105 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6106
6107 @smallexample
6108 @group
6109 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6110 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6111 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6112 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6113 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6114 type = struct @{
6115 int si_signo;
6116 int si_errno;
6117 int si_code;
6118 union @{
6119 int _pad[28];
6120 struct @{...@} _kill;
6121 struct @{...@} _timer;
6122 struct @{...@} _rt;
6123 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6124 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6125 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6126 @} _sifields;
6127 @}
6128 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6129 type = struct @{
6130 void *si_addr;
6131 @}
6132 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6133 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6138
6139 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6140 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6141 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6142 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6143 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6144 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6145 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6146 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6147 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6148 information is displayed.
6149
6150 The usual output of a segfault is:
6151 @smallexample
6152 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6153 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6154 68 value = *(p + len);
6155 @end smallexample
6156
6157 While a bound violation is presented as:
6158 @smallexample
6159 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6160 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6161 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6162 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6163 68 value = *(p + len);
6164 @end smallexample
6165
6166 @node Thread Stops
6167 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6168
6169 @cindex stopped threads
6170 @cindex threads, stopped
6171
6172 @cindex continuing threads
6173 @cindex threads, continuing
6174
6175 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6176 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6177 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6178 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6179 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6180 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6181 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6182 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6183 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6184
6185 @menu
6186 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6187 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6188 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6189 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6190 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6191 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6192 @end menu
6193
6194 @node All-Stop Mode
6195 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6196
6197 @cindex all-stop mode
6198
6199 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6200 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6201 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6202 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6203 underfoot.
6204
6205 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6206 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6207 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6208
6209 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6210 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6211 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6212 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6213 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6214 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6215 stops.
6216
6217 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6218 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6219 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6220 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6221
6222 @cindex automatic thread selection
6223 @cindex switching threads automatically
6224 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6225 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6226 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6227 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6228 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6229 thread.
6230
6231 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6232 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6236 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6237 @cindex lock scheduler
6238 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6239 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6240 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6241 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6242 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6243 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6244 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6245 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6246 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6247 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6248 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6249 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6250 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6251 @code{on} in replay mode.
6252
6253 @item show scheduler-locking
6254 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6258 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6259 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6260 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6261 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6262 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6263 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6264 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6265 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6266 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6267 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6268 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6269 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6270 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6274 @item set schedule-multiple
6275 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6276 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6277 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6278 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6279 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6280 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6281
6282 @item show schedule-multiple
6283 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6284 multiple processes.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 @node Non-Stop Mode
6288 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6289
6290 @cindex non-stop mode
6291
6292 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6293 @c with more details.
6294
6295 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6296 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6297 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6298 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6299 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6300 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6301
6302 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6303 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6304 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6305 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6306 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6307 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6308 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6309 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6310 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6311 independently and simultaneously.
6312
6313 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6314 or attach to your program:
6315
6316 @smallexample
6317 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6318 set pagination off
6319
6320 # Finally, turn it on!
6321 set non-stop on
6322 @end smallexample
6323
6324 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6325
6326 @table @code
6327 @kindex set non-stop
6328 @item set non-stop on
6329 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6330 @item set non-stop off
6331 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6332 @kindex show non-stop
6333 @item show non-stop
6334 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6338 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6339 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6340 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6341 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6342 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6343 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6344 default.
6345
6346 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6347 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6348 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6349
6350 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6351 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6352 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6353 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6354 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6355
6356 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6357 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6358 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6359 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6360 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6361
6362 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6363
6364 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6365 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6366 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6367 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6368 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6369 previously current thread.
6370
6371 @node Background Execution
6372 @subsection Background Execution
6373
6374 @cindex foreground execution
6375 @cindex background execution
6376 @cindex asynchronous execution
6377 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6378
6379 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6380 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6381 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6382 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6383 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6384 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6385
6386 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6387 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6388
6389 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6390 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6391 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6392 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6393 are:
6394
6395 @table @code
6396 @kindex run&
6397 @item run
6398 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6399
6400 @item attach
6401 @kindex attach&
6402 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6403
6404 @item step
6405 @kindex step&
6406 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6407
6408 @item stepi
6409 @kindex stepi&
6410 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6411
6412 @item next
6413 @kindex next&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6415
6416 @item nexti
6417 @kindex nexti&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6419
6420 @item continue
6421 @kindex continue&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6423
6424 @item finish
6425 @kindex finish&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6427
6428 @item until
6429 @kindex until&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6431
6432 @end table
6433
6434 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6435 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6436 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6437 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6438 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6439 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6440
6441 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6442 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6443
6444 @table @code
6445 @kindex interrupt
6446 @item interrupt
6447 @itemx interrupt -a
6448
6449 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6450 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6451 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6452 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6453 @end table
6454
6455 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6456 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6457
6458 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6459 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6460 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6461
6462 @table @code
6463 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6464 @cindex thread breakpoints
6465 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6466 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6467 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6468 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6469 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6470 specify some source line.
6471
6472 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6473 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6474 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6475 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6476 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6477
6478 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6479 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6480 program.
6481
6482 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6483 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6484 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6485
6486 @smallexample
6487 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6488 @end smallexample
6489
6490 @end table
6491
6492 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6493 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6494 thread list. For example:
6495
6496 @smallexample
6497 (@value{GDBP}) c
6498 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6502 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6503 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6504 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6505 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6506 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6507 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6508 command.
6509
6510 @node Interrupted System Calls
6511 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6512
6513 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6514 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6515 @cindex premature return from system calls
6516 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6517 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6518 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6519 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6520 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6521 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6522 stop execution.
6523
6524 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6525 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6526 style anyways.
6527
6528 For example, do not write code like this:
6529
6530 @smallexample
6531 sleep (10);
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6535 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6536
6537 Instead, write this:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 int unslept = 10;
6541 while (unslept > 0)
6542 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6543 @end smallexample
6544
6545 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6546 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6547 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6548 @value{GDBN}.
6549
6550 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6551 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6552 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6553 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6554
6555 @node Observer Mode
6556 @subsection Observer Mode
6557
6558 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6559 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6560 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6561 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6562 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6563
6564 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6565 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6566 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6567 mode.
6568
6569 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6570 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6571 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6572 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6573 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6574
6575 @table @code
6576
6577 @kindex observer
6578 @item set observer on
6579 @itemx set observer off
6580 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6581 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6582 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6583 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6584
6585 @item show observer
6586 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6587
6588 @kindex may-write-registers
6589 @item set may-write-registers on
6590 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6591 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6592 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6593 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6594
6595 @item show may-write-registers
6596 Show the current permission to write registers.
6597
6598 @kindex may-write-memory
6599 @item set may-write-memory on
6600 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6601 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6602 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6603 defaults to @code{on}.
6604
6605 @item show may-write-memory
6606 Show the current permission to write memory.
6607
6608 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6609 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6610 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6611 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6612 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6613 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6614
6615 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6616 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6617
6618 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6619 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6620 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6621 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6622 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6623 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6624 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6625
6626 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6627 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6628
6629 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6630 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6631 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6632 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6633 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6634 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6635 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6636
6637 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6639
6640 @kindex may-interrupt
6641 @item set may-interrupt on
6642 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6643 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6644 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6645 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6646 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6647
6648 @item show may-interrupt
6649 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6650
6651 @end table
6652
6653 @node Reverse Execution
6654 @chapter Running programs backward
6655 @cindex reverse execution
6656 @cindex running programs backward
6657
6658 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6659 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6660 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6661 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6662
6663 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6664 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6665 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6666 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6667 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6668 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6669
6670 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6671 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6672 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6673 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6674 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6675 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6676 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6677 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6678 prior values@footnote{
6679 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6680 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6681 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6682
6683 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6684 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6685 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6686 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6687 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6688 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6689 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6690 }.
6691
6692 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6693 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6694
6695 @table @code
6696 @kindex reverse-continue
6697 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6698 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6699 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6700 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6701 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6702 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6703 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6704
6705 @kindex reverse-step
6706 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6707 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6708 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6709 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6710
6711 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6712 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6713 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6714 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6715 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6716 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6717
6718 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6719 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6720
6721 @kindex reverse-stepi
6722 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6723 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6724 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6725 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6726 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6727 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6728 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6729
6730 @kindex reverse-next
6731 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6732 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6733 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6734 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6735 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6736 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6737 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6738 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6739 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6740 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6741
6742 @kindex reverse-nexti
6743 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6744 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6745 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6746 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6747 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6748 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6749 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6750 frame) is reached.
6751
6752 @kindex reverse-finish
6753 @item reverse-finish
6754 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6755 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6756 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6757 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6758
6759 @kindex set exec-direction
6760 @item set exec-direction
6761 Set the direction of target execution.
6762 @item set exec-direction reverse
6763 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6764 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6765 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6766 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6767 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6768 @item set exec-direction forward
6769 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6770 This is the default.
6771 @end table
6772
6773
6774 @node Process Record and Replay
6775 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6776 @cindex process record and replay
6777 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6778
6779 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6780 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6781 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6782
6783 @cindex replay mode
6784 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6785 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6786 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6787 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6788 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6789 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6790 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6791 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6792 execution log.
6793
6794 @cindex record mode
6795 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6796 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6797 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6798 for future replay.
6799
6800 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6801 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6802 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6803 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6804 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6805 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6806
6807 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6808 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6809 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6810 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6811
6812 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6813 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @kindex target record
6817 @kindex target record-full
6818 @kindex target record-btrace
6819 @kindex record
6820 @kindex record full
6821 @kindex record btrace
6822 @kindex record btrace bts
6823 @kindex record btrace pt
6824 @kindex record bts
6825 @kindex record pt
6826 @kindex rec
6827 @kindex rec full
6828 @kindex rec btrace
6829 @kindex rec btrace bts
6830 @kindex rec btrace pt
6831 @kindex rec bts
6832 @kindex rec pt
6833 @item record @var{method}
6834 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6835 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6836 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6837 recording methods are available:
6838
6839 @table @code
6840 @item full
6841 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6842 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6843 execution.
6844
6845 @item btrace @var{format}
6846 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6847 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6848 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6849 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6850 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6851 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6852 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6853
6854 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6855 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6856 formats are available:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item bts
6860 @cindex branch trace store
6861 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6862 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6863 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6864
6865 @item pt
6866 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6867 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6868 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6869 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6870
6871 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6872 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6873 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6874
6875 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6876 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6877 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6878 buffer-size with care.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6882 @end table
6883
6884 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6885 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6886 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6887 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6888
6889 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6890 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6891 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6892 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6893 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6894
6895 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6896 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6897 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6898 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6899 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6900 does not support these two modes.
6901
6902 @kindex record stop
6903 @kindex rec s
6904 @item record stop
6905 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6906 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6907 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6908
6909 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6910 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6911 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6912 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6913 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6914
6915 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6916 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6917 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6918 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6919 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6920
6921 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6922 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6923
6924 @kindex record goto
6925 @item record goto
6926 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6927 ways to specify the location to go to:
6928
6929 @table @code
6930 @item record goto begin
6931 @itemx record goto start
6932 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6933
6934 @item record goto end
6935 Go to the end of the execution log.
6936
6937 @item record goto @var{n}
6938 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 @kindex record save
6942 @item record save @var{filename}
6943 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6944 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6945 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6946
6947 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6948
6949 @kindex record restore
6950 @item record restore @var{filename}
6951 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6953
6954 @kindex set record full
6955 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6956 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6957 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6958 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6959
6960 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6961 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6962 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6963 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6964 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6965 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6966 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6967 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6968
6969 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6970 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6971 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6972
6973 @kindex show record full
6974 @item show record full insn-number-max
6975 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6976 recording method.
6977
6978 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6979 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6980 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6981 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6982 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6983 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6984 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6985 oldest one to be deleted.
6986
6987 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6988 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6989
6990 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6991 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6992
6993 @item set record full memory-query
6994 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6995 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6996 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6997 case.
6998
6999 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7000 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7001 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7002 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7003 results.
7004
7005 @item show record full memory-query
7006 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7007
7008 @kindex set record btrace
7009 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7010 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7011 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7012 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7013 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7014 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7015 You can use the following command for that:
7016
7017 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7018 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7019 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7020 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7021 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7022 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7023 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7024 position.
7025
7026 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7027 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7028 errata when decoding the trace.
7029
7030 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7031 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7032 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7033 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7034 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7035 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7036 which the trace was recorded.
7037
7038 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7039 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7040 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7041 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7042 disable the workarounds.
7043
7044 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7045 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7046 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7047 (default).
7048
7049 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7050 identifiers are currently supported:
7051
7052 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7053
7054 @item @code{intel}
7055 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7056
7057 @end multitable
7058
7059 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7060 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7061
7062 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7063 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7064 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7065
7066 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7067 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7068 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7069 supports.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7077 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7078 (gdb) info record
7079 Active record target: record-btrace
7080 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7081 Buffer size: 16kB.
7082 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 @kindex show record btrace
7086 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7087 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7088
7089 @item show record btrace cpu
7090 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7091 workarounds.
7092
7093 @kindex set record btrace bts
7094 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7095 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7096 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7097 format. Default is 64KB.
7098
7099 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7100 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7101 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7102 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7103 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7104 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7105 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7106
7107 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7109
7110 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7111 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7112
7113 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7114 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7115 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7116
7117 @kindex set record btrace pt
7118 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7119 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7120 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7121 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7122
7123 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7124 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7125 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7126 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7127 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7128 actual buffer size for each thread.
7129
7130 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7131 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7132
7133 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7134 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7135
7136 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7137 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7138 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7139
7140 @kindex info record
7141 @item info record
7142 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7143 method:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146 @item full
7147 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7148 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7149
7150 @itemize @bullet
7151 @item
7152 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7153 @item
7154 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7155 @item
7156 Highest recorded instruction number.
7157 @item
7158 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7159 @item
7160 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7161 @item
7162 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7163 @end itemize
7164
7165 @item btrace
7166 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7167
7168 @itemize @bullet
7169 @item
7170 Recording format.
7171 @item
7172 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7173 @item
7174 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7175 instructions.
7176 @item
7177 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185
7186 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7187 @itemize @bullet
7188 @item
7189 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7190 @end itemize
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @kindex record delete
7194 @kindex rec del
7195 @item record delete
7196 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7197 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7198 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7199 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7200
7201 @kindex record instruction-history
7202 @kindex rec instruction-history
7203 @item record instruction-history
7204 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7205 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7206 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7207 are printed in execution order.
7208
7209 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7210 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7211 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7212
7213 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7214 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7215 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7216 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7217 @code{/p} modifier.
7218
7219 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7220 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7221 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7222
7223 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7224 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7225
7226 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7227 disassemble:
7228
7229 @table @code
7230 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7231 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7232 @var{insn}.
7233
7234 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7235 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7236 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7237 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7238 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7239 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history
7242 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7243
7244 @item record instruction-history -
7245 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7246
7247 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7248 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7249 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7250 number @var{end} is included.
7251 @end table
7252
7253 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7254
7255 @kindex set record
7256 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7257 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7258 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7260 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7261
7262 @kindex show record
7263 @item show record instruction-history-size
7264 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7265 instruction-history} command.
7266
7267 @kindex record function-call-history
7268 @kindex rec function-call-history
7269 @item record function-call-history
7270 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7271 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7272 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7273 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7274 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7275 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7276 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7277 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7278 given together.
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7282 1 void foo (void)
7283 2 @{
7284 3 @}
7285 4
7286 5 void bar (void)
7287 6 @{
7288 7 ...
7289 8 foo ();
7290 9 ...
7291 10 @}
7292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7293 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7294 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7295 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7299 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7300 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7301 to print:
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7305 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7308 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7309 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7310 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7311 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history
7314 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7315
7316 @item record function-call-history -
7317 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7318
7319 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7320 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7321 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7322 @end table
7323
7324 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7325
7326 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7327 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7328 Define how many lines to print in the
7329 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7330 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7331
7332 @item show record function-call-history-size
7333 Show how many lines to print in the
7334 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7335 @end table
7336
7337
7338 @node Stack
7339 @chapter Examining the Stack
7340
7341 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7342 stopped and how it got there.
7343
7344 @cindex call stack
7345 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7346 is generated.
7347 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7348 the arguments of the call,
7349 and the local variables of the function being called.
7350 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7351 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7352 stack}.
7353
7354 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7355 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7356
7357 @cindex selected frame
7358 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7359 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7360 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7361 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7362 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7363 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7364
7365 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7366 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7367 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7368
7369 @menu
7370 * Frames:: Stack frames
7371 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7372 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7373 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7374 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7375 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7376
7377 @end menu
7378
7379 @node Frames
7380 @section Stack Frames
7381
7382 @cindex frame, definition
7383 @cindex stack frame
7384 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7385 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7386 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7387 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7388 which the function is executing.
7389
7390 @cindex initial frame
7391 @cindex outermost frame
7392 @cindex innermost frame
7393 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7394 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7395 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7396 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7397 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7398 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7399 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7400 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7401
7402 @cindex frame pointer
7403 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7404 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7405 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7406 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7407 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7408 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7409
7410 @cindex frame level
7411 @cindex frame number
7412 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7413 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7414 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7415 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7416 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7417 describe this number.
7418
7419 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7420 @c underflow problems.
7421 @cindex frameless execution
7422 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7423 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7424 @smallexample
7425 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7426 @end smallexample
7427 generates functions without a frame.)
7428 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7429 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7430 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7431 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7432 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7433 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7434 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7435
7436 @node Backtrace
7437 @section Backtraces
7438
7439 @cindex traceback
7440 @cindex call stack traces
7441 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7442 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7443 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7444 stack.
7445
7446 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7447 @kindex backtrace
7448 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7449 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7450 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7451 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7452 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7453 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7457 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7458 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7459 be one of the following:
7460
7461 @table @code
7462 @item @var{n}
7463 @itemx @var{n}
7464 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7465 number.
7466
7467 @item -@var{n}
7468 @itemx -@var{n}
7469 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7470 number.
7471
7472 @item full
7473 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7474 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7475
7476 @item no-filters
7477 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7478 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7479 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7480 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7481 support.
7482
7483 @item hide
7484 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7485 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7486 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7487 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7488 @end table
7489 @end table
7490
7491 @kindex where
7492 @kindex info stack
7493 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7494 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7495
7496 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7497 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7498 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7499 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7500 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7501 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7502 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7503 multi-threaded program.
7504
7505 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7506 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7507 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7508 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7509 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7510 line number.
7511
7512 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7513 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 @group
7517 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7518 at builtin.c:993
7519 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7520 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7521 at macro.c:71
7522 (More stack frames follow...)
7523 @end group
7524 @end smallexample
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7528 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7529 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7530
7531 @noindent
7532 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7533 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7534 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7535 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7536 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7537
7538 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7539 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7540 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7541 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7542 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7543 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7544 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7545 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7546 such a backtrace might look like:
7547
7548 @smallexample
7549 @group
7550 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7551 at builtin.c:993
7552 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7553 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7554 at macro.c:71
7555 (More stack frames follow...)
7556 @end group
7557 @end smallexample
7558
7559 @noindent
7560 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7561 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7562
7563 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7564 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7565 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7566
7567 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7568 @cindex program entry point
7569 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7570 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7571 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7572 @code{main}@footnote{
7573 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7574 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7575 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7576 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7577 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7578 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7579
7580 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7581 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7582
7583 @table @code
7584 @item set backtrace past-main
7585 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7586 @kindex set backtrace
7587 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-main off
7590 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7591 default.
7592
7593 @item show backtrace past-main
7594 @kindex show backtrace
7595 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-entry
7598 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7599 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7600 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7601 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7602
7603 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7604 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7605 application. This is the default.
7606
7607 @item show backtrace past-entry
7608 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7609
7610 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7611 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7612 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7613 @cindex backtrace limit
7614 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7615 or zero means unlimited levels.
7616
7617 @item show backtrace limit
7618 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 You can control how file names are displayed.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @item set filename-display
7625 @itemx set filename-display relative
7626 @cindex filename-display
7627 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7628
7629 @item set filename-display basename
7630 Display only basename of a filename.
7631
7632 @item set filename-display absolute
7633 Display an absolute filename.
7634
7635 @item show filename-display
7636 Show the current way to display filenames.
7637 @end table
7638
7639 @node Selection
7640 @section Selecting a Frame
7641
7642 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7643 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7644 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7645 of the stack frame just selected.
7646
7647 @table @code
7648 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7649 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7650 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7651 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7652 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7653 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame level
7657 @item @var{num}
7658 @item level @var{num}
7659 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7660 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7661 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7662 for @code{main}.
7663
7664 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7665 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7666 commands are equivalent:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7670 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @kindex frame address
7674 @item address @var{stack-address}
7675 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7676 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7677 @command{info frame}, for example:
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 (gdb) info frame
7681 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7682 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7683 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7684 source language c++.
7685 Arglist at unknown address.
7686 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7690 indicated by the line:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 @kindex frame function
7697 @item function @var{function-name}
7698 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7699 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7700 most stack frame is selected.
7701
7702 @kindex frame view
7703 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7704 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7705 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7706 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7707
7708 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7709 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7710 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7711 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7712
7713 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7714 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7715 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7716 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7717
7718 @end table
7719
7720 @kindex up
7721 @item up @var{n}
7722 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7723 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7724 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7725
7726 @kindex down
7727 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7728 @item down @var{n}
7729 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7730 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7731 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7732 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7733 @end table
7734
7735 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7736 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7737 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7738 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7739
7740 @need 1000
7741 For example:
7742
7743 @smallexample
7744 @group
7745 (@value{GDBP}) up
7746 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7747 at env.c:10
7748 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7749 @end group
7750 @end smallexample
7751
7752 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7753 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7754 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7755 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7756 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7757 for details.
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @kindex select-frame
7761 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7762 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7763 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7764 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7765 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7766 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7767 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex down-silently
7770 @kindex up-silently
7771 @item up-silently @var{n}
7772 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7773 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7774 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7775 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7776 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7777 distracting.
7778 @end table
7779
7780 @node Frame Info
7781 @section Information About a Frame
7782
7783 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7784 stack frame.
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item frame
7788 @itemx f
7789 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7790 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7791 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7792 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7793 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7794
7795 @kindex info frame
7796 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7797 @item info frame
7798 @itemx info f
7799 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7800 including:
7801
7802 @itemize @bullet
7803 @item
7804 the address of the frame
7805 @item
7806 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7807 @item
7808 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7809 @item
7810 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame's arguments
7813 @item
7814 the address of the frame's local variables
7815 @item
7816 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7817 @item
7818 which registers were saved in the frame
7819 @end itemize
7820
7821 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7822 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7823 the usual conventions.
7824
7825 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7826 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7827 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7828 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7829 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7830 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7831
7832 @kindex info args
7833 @item info args
7834 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7835
7836 @item info locals
7837 @kindex info locals
7838 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7839 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7840 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7841
7842 @end table
7843
7844 @node Frame Apply
7845 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7846 @kindex frame apply
7847 @cindex apply command to several frames
7848 @table @code
7849 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7850 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7851 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7852
7853 @table @code
7854 @item @code{all}
7855 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7856
7857 @item @var{count}
7858 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7859 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7860
7861 @item @var{-count}
7862 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7863 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7864
7865 @item @code{level}
7866 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7867 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7868 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7869 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7870 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7871 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7872
7873 @end table
7874
7875 @end table
7876
7877 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7878 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7879 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7880 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7881
7882 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7883 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7884 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7885 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7886 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7887
7888 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7889 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7890 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7891 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7892
7893 @table @code
7894 @item -c
7895 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7896 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7897 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7898 @item -s
7899 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7900 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7901 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7902 are not printed.
7903 @item -q
7904 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7905 information.
7906 @end table
7907
7908 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7909 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7910 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7911 @code{#1 main} frame.
7912
7913 @smallexample
7914 @group
7915 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7916 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7917 No symbol "j" in current context.
7918 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7919 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7920 No symbol "j" in current context.
7921 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7922 $1 = 5
7923 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7924 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7925 $2 = 5
7926 (gdb)
7927 @end group
7928 @end smallexample
7929
7930 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7931 information before the command output:
7932
7933 @smallexample
7934 @group
7935 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7936 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7937 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7938 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7939 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7940 (gdb)
7941 @end group
7942 @end smallexample
7943
7944 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7945 @smallexample
7946 @group
7947 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7948 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7949 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7950 (gdb)
7951 @end group
7952 @end smallexample
7953
7954 @table @code
7955
7956 @kindex faas
7957 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7958 @item faas @var{command}
7959 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7960 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7961
7962 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7963 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7964 is, using:
7965 @smallexample
7966 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7967 @end smallexample
7968
7969 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7970 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7971 @end table
7972
7973
7974 @node Frame Filter Management
7975 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7976 @cindex managing frame filters
7977
7978 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7979 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7980
7981 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7982 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7983
7984 @table @code
7985 @kindex info frame-filter
7986 @item info frame-filter
7987 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7988 their name, priority and enabled status.
7989
7990 @kindex disable frame-filter
7991 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7992 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7993 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7994 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7995 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7996 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7997 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7998 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7999 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8000 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8001 may be enabled again later.
8002
8003 @kindex enable frame-filter
8004 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8005 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8006 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8007 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8008 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8009 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8010 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8011 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8012 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8013
8014 Example:
8015
8016 @smallexample
8017 (gdb) info frame-filter
8018
8019 global frame-filters:
8020 Priority Enabled Name
8021 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8022 100 Yes Reverse
8023
8024 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8025 Priority Enabled Name
8026 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8027
8028 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8029 Priority Enabled Name
8030 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8031
8032 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8033 (gdb) info frame-filter
8034
8035 global frame-filters:
8036 Priority Enabled Name
8037 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8038 100 Yes Reverse
8039
8040 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8041 Priority Enabled Name
8042 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8043
8044 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8045 Priority Enabled Name
8046 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8047
8048 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8049 (gdb) info frame-filter
8050
8051 global frame-filters:
8052 Priority Enabled Name
8053 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8054 100 Yes Reverse
8055
8056 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8057 Priority Enabled Name
8058 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8059
8060 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8061 Priority Enabled Name
8062 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8063 @end smallexample
8064
8065 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8066 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8067 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8069 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8070 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8071 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8072
8073 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8074 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8075 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8076 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8077 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8078 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8079 dictionary resides.
8080
8081 Example:
8082
8083 @smallexample
8084 (gdb) info frame-filter
8085
8086 global frame-filters:
8087 Priority Enabled Name
8088 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8089 100 Yes Reverse
8090
8091 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8092 Priority Enabled Name
8093 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8094
8095 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8096 Priority Enabled Name
8097 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8098
8099 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8100 (gdb) info frame-filter
8101
8102 global frame-filters:
8103 Priority Enabled Name
8104 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8105 50 Yes Reverse
8106
8107 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8108 Priority Enabled Name
8109 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8110
8111 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8112 Priority Enabled Name
8113 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8114 @end smallexample
8115 @end table
8116
8117 @node Source
8118 @chapter Examining Source Files
8119
8120 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8121 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8122 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8123 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8124 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8125 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8126 source files by explicit command.
8127
8128 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8129 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8130 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8131
8132 @menu
8133 * List:: Printing source lines
8134 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8135 * Edit:: Editing source files
8136 * Search:: Searching source files
8137 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8138 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8139 @end menu
8140
8141 @node List
8142 @section Printing Source Lines
8143
8144 @kindex list
8145 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8146 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8147 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8148 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8149 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8150
8151 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8152
8153 @table @code
8154 @item list @var{linenum}
8155 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8156 current source file.
8157
8158 @item list @var{function}
8159 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8160 @var{function}.
8161
8162 @item list
8163 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8164 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8165 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8166 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8167 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8168
8169 @item list -
8170 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8171 @end table
8172
8173 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8174 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8175 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8176
8177 @table @code
8178 @kindex set listsize
8179 @item set listsize @var{count}
8180 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8181 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8182 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8183 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8184
8185 @kindex show listsize
8186 @item show listsize
8187 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8188 @end table
8189
8190 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8191 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8192 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8193 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8194 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8195
8196 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8197 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8198 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8199 to specify some source line.
8200
8201 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8202
8203 @table @code
8204 @item list @var{location}
8205 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8206
8207 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8208 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8209 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8210 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8211 the same source file as the first location.
8212
8213 @item list ,@var{last}
8214 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8215
8216 @item list @var{first},
8217 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8218
8219 @item list +
8220 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8221
8222 @item list -
8223 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8224
8225 @item list
8226 As described in the preceding table.
8227 @end table
8228
8229 @node Specify Location
8230 @section Specifying a Location
8231 @cindex specifying location
8232 @cindex location
8233 @cindex source location
8234
8235 @menu
8236 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8237 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8238 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8239 @end menu
8240
8241 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8242 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8243 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8244 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8245 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8246
8247 @node Linespec Locations
8248 @subsection Linespec Locations
8249 @cindex linespec locations
8250
8251 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8252 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8253 specifying a linespec:
8254
8255 @table @code
8256 @item @var{linenum}
8257 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8258
8259 @item -@var{offset}
8260 @itemx +@var{offset}
8261 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8262 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8263 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8264 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8265 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8266 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8267 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8268 linespec.
8269
8270 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8271 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8272 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8273 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8274 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8275 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8276 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8277
8278 @item @var{function}
8279 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8280 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8281
8282 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8283 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8284 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8285 means in all packages.
8286
8287 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8288 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8289 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8290
8291 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8292 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8293 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8294 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8295
8296 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8297
8298 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8299 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8300
8301 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8302 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8303 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8304 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8305 functions in different source files.
8306
8307 @item @var{label}
8308 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8309 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8310 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8311 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8312
8313 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8314 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8315 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8316 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8317 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8318 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8319
8320 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8321 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8322 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8323 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8324 each one of those probes.
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @node Explicit Locations
8328 @subsection Explicit Locations
8329 @cindex explicit locations
8330
8331 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8332 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8333
8334 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8335 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8336 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8337 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8338 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8339
8340 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8341 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8342 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8343 the symbol table to know.
8344
8345 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8346 following table:
8347
8348 @table @code
8349 @item -source @var{filename}
8350 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8351 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8352 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8353 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8354 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8355
8356 @item -function @var{function}
8357 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8358 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8359 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8360 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8361
8362 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8363 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8364 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8365 means in all packages.
8366
8367 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8368 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8369 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8370 breakpoint on both symbols.
8371
8372 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8373
8374 @item -qualified
8375
8376 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8377 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8378
8379 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8380 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8381 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8382
8383 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8384 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8385 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8386
8387 @item -label @var{label}
8388 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8389 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8390 selected stack frame.
8391
8392 @item -line @var{number}
8393 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8394 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8395 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8396 relative to the current line.
8397 @end table
8398
8399 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8400 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8401
8402 @node Address Locations
8403 @subsection Address Locations
8404 @cindex address locations
8405
8406 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8407 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8408
8409 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8410 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8411 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8412 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8413 source files.
8414
8415 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8416 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8417 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8418 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8419 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8420 of @var{address}:
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @item @var{expression}
8424 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8425
8426 @item @var{funcaddr}
8427 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8428 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8429 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8430 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8431 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8432 (although the Pascal form also works).
8433
8434 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8435 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8436
8437 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8438 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8439 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8440 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8441 functions with identical names in different source files.
8442 @end table
8443
8444 @node Edit
8445 @section Editing Source Files
8446 @cindex editing source files
8447
8448 @kindex edit
8449 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8450 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8451 The editing program of your choice
8452 is invoked with the current line set to
8453 the active line in the program.
8454 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8455 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @item edit @var{location}
8459 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8460 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8461 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8462 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8463 command most commonly used:
8464
8465 @table @code
8466 @item edit @var{number}
8467 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8468
8469 @item edit @var{function}
8470 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8471 @end table
8472
8473 @end table
8474
8475 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8476 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8477 @footnote{
8478 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8479 following command-line syntax:
8480 @smallexample
8481 ex +@var{number} file
8482 @end smallexample
8483 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8484 the file where to start editing.}.
8485 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8486 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8487 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8488 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8489 @smallexample
8490 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8491 export EDITOR
8492 gdb @dots{}
8493 @end smallexample
8494 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8495 @smallexample
8496 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8497 gdb @dots{}
8498 @end smallexample
8499
8500 @node Search
8501 @section Searching Source Files
8502 @cindex searching source files
8503
8504 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8505 regular expression.
8506
8507 @table @code
8508 @kindex search
8509 @kindex forward-search
8510 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8511 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8512 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8513 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8514 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8515 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8516 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8517 @code{fo}.
8518
8519 @kindex reverse-search
8520 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8521 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8522 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8523 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8524 this command as @code{rev}.
8525 @end table
8526
8527 @node Source Path
8528 @section Specifying Source Directories
8529
8530 @cindex source path
8531 @cindex directories for source files
8532 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8533 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8534 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8535 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8536 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8537 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8538 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8539
8540 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8541 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8542 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8543 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8544 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8545 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8546 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8547 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8548 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8549 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8550 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8551
8552 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8553 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8554 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8555 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8556 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8557 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8558
8559 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8560 source files.
8561
8562 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8563 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8564 each line is in the file.
8565
8566 @kindex directory
8567 @kindex dir
8568 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8569 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8570 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8571
8572 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8573 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8574
8575 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8576 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8577 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8578 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8579 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8580 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8581 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8582 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8583 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8584 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8585 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8586 name to look up the sources.
8587
8588 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8589 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8590 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8591 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8592 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8593 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8594 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8595 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8596
8597 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8598 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8599 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8600 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8601 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8602 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8603 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8604
8605 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8606 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8607 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8608 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8609 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8610 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8611 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8612 command.
8613
8614 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8615 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8616 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8617 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8618 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8619 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8620 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8621
8622 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8623 @cindex default source path substitution
8624 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8625 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8626 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8627 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8628 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8629 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8630 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8631 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8632 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8633 together.
8634
8635 @table @code
8636 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8637 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8638 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8639 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8640 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8641 part of absolute file names) or
8642 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8643 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8644
8645 @kindex cdir
8646 @kindex cwd
8647 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8648 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8649 @cindex compilation directory
8650 @cindex current directory
8651 @cindex working directory
8652 @cindex directory, current
8653 @cindex directory, compilation
8654 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8655 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8656 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8657 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8658 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8659 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8660
8661 @item directory
8662 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8663
8664 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8665 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8666
8667 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8668 @kindex set directories
8669 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8670 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8671
8672 @item show directories
8673 @kindex show directories
8674 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8675
8676 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8677 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8678 @kindex set substitute-path
8679 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8680 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8681 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8682
8683 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8684 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 @noindent
8691 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8692 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8693 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8694
8695 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8696 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8697 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8698 the substitution.
8699
8700 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8701
8702 @smallexample
8703 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8704 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8709 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8710 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8711 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8712
8713
8714 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8715 @kindex unset substitute-path
8716 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8717 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8718 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8719
8720 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8721
8722 @item show substitute-path [path]
8723 @kindex show substitute-path
8724 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8725 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8726
8727 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8728 rules.
8729
8730 @end table
8731
8732 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8733 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8734 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8735
8736 @enumerate
8737 @item
8738 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8739
8740 @item
8741 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8742 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8743 directories in one command.
8744 @end enumerate
8745
8746 @node Machine Code
8747 @section Source and Machine Code
8748 @cindex source line and its code address
8749
8750 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8751 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8752 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8753 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8754 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8755 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8756 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8757 well as hex.
8758
8759 @table @code
8760 @kindex info line
8761 @item info line
8762 @itemx info line @var{location}
8763 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8764 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8765 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8766 information about the current source line is printed.
8767 @end table
8768
8769 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8770 the object code for the first line of function
8771 @code{m4_changequote}:
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8775 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8776 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8777 @end smallexample
8778
8779 @noindent
8780 @cindex code address and its source line
8781 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8782 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8783 @smallexample
8784 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8785 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8786 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8787 @end smallexample
8788
8789 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8790 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8791 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8792 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8793 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8794 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8795 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8796 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8797 Variables}).
8798
8799 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8800 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8801 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8802 line.
8803
8804 @table @code
8805 @kindex disassemble
8806 @cindex assembly instructions
8807 @cindex instructions, assembly
8808 @cindex machine instructions
8809 @cindex listing machine instructions
8810 @item disassemble
8811 @itemx disassemble /m
8812 @itemx disassemble /s
8813 @itemx disassemble /r
8814 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8815 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8816 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8817 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8818 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8819 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8820 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8821 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8822 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8823 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8827 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8828 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8829 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8830 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8831 @end table
8832
8833 @noindent
8834 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8835 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8836
8837 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8838 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8839
8840 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8841 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8842 @end table
8843
8844 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8845 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8846
8847 @smallexample
8848 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8849 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8850 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8851 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8852 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8853 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8854 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8855 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8856 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8857 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8858 End of assembler dump.
8859 @end smallexample
8860
8861 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8862 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8863 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8864
8865 @smallexample
8866 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8867 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8868 5 @{
8869 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8870 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8871 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8872 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8873 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8874
8875 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8876 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8877 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8878
8879 7 return 0;
8880 8 @}
8881 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8882 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8883 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8884
8885 End of assembler dump.
8886 @end smallexample
8887
8888 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8889 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8890 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8891 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8892 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8893 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8894 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8895 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8896 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8897
8898 @file{foo.h}:
8899
8900 @smallexample
8901 int
8902 foo (int a)
8903 @{
8904 if (a < 0)
8905 return a * 2;
8906 if (a == 0)
8907 return 1;
8908 return a + 10;
8909 @}
8910 @end smallexample
8911
8912 @file{foo.c}:
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 #include "foo.h"
8916 volatile int x, y;
8917 int
8918 main ()
8919 @{
8920 x = foo (y);
8921 return 0;
8922 @}
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 @smallexample
8926 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8927 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8928 5 @{
8929
8930 6 x = foo (y);
8931 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8932 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8933
8934 7 return 0;
8935 8 @}
8936 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8937 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8938 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8939 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8940
8941 End of assembler dump.
8942 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8943 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8944 foo.c:
8945 5 @{
8946 6 x = foo (y);
8947 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8948
8949 foo.h:
8950 4 if (a < 0)
8951 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8952 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8953
8954 6 if (a == 0)
8955 7 return 1;
8956 8 return a + 10;
8957 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8958 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8959 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8960 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8961
8962 foo.c:
8963 6 x = foo (y);
8964 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8965
8966 7 return 0;
8967 8 @}
8968 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8969 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8970
8971 foo.h:
8972 5 return a * 2;
8973 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8974 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8975 End of assembler dump.
8976 @end smallexample
8977
8978 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8979
8980 @smallexample
8981 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8982 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8983 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8984 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8985 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8986 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8987 End of assembler dump.
8988 @end smallexample
8989
8990 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8991 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8992 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8993 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8994
8995 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8996 mnemonics or other syntax.
8997
8998 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8999 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9000 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9001 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9002 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9003
9004 @table @code
9005 @kindex set disassembler-options
9006 @cindex disassembler options
9007 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9008 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9009 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9010 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9011 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9012 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9013 The default value is the empty string.
9014
9015 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9016 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9017 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9018 and S/390.
9019
9020 @kindex show disassembler-options
9021 @item show disassembler-options
9022 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9023 @end table
9024
9025 @table @code
9026 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9027 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9028 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9029 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9030 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9031 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9032
9033 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9034 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9035 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9036 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9037
9038 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9039 @item show disassembly-flavor
9040 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9041 @end table
9042
9043 @table @code
9044 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9045 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9046 @item set disassemble-next-line
9047 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9048 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9049 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9050 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9051 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9052 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9053 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9054 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9055 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9056 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9057 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9058 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9059 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9060 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9061 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9062 instruction.
9063 @end table
9064
9065
9066 @node Data
9067 @chapter Examining Data
9068
9069 @cindex printing data
9070 @cindex examining data
9071 @kindex print
9072 @kindex inspect
9073 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9074 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9075 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9076 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9077 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9078 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9079
9080 @table @code
9081 @item print @var{expr}
9082 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9083 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9084 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9085 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9086 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9087 Formats}.
9088
9089 @item print
9090 @itemx print /@var{f}
9091 @cindex reprint the last value
9092 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9093 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9094 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9095 @end table
9096
9097 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9098 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9099 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9100
9101 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9102 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9103 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9104 Table}.
9105
9106 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9107 @kindex explore
9108 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9109 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9110 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9111 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9112 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9113 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9114 embedded in the higher level data types.
9115
9116 @table @code
9117 @item explore @var{arg}
9118 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9119 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9120 @end table
9121
9122 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9123 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9124 C program as
9125
9126 @smallexample
9127 struct SimpleStruct
9128 @{
9129 int i;
9130 double d;
9131 @};
9132
9133 struct ComplexStruct
9134 @{
9135 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9136 int arr[10];
9137 @};
9138 @end smallexample
9139
9140 @noindent
9141 followed by variable declarations as
9142
9143 @smallexample
9144 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9145 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9150 @code{explore} command as follows.
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (gdb) explore cs
9154 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9155 the following fields:
9156
9157 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9158 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9159
9160 Enter the field number of choice:
9161 @end smallexample
9162
9163 @noindent
9164 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9165 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9166 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9167 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9168 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9169 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9170 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9171 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9172
9173 @smallexample
9174 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9175 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9176 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9177 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9178
9179 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9180 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9181
9182 Press enter to return to parent value:
9183 @end smallexample
9184
9185 @noindent
9186 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9187 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9188 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9189 to explore.
9190
9191 @smallexample
9192 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9193 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9194
9195 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9196
9197 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9198
9199 Press enter to return to parent value:
9200 @end smallexample
9201
9202 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9203 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9204 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9205 level data structure).
9206
9207 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9208 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9209 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9210 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9211 same example as above, your can explore the type
9212 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9213 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9214
9215 @smallexample
9216 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 @noindent
9220 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9221 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9222 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9223 example.
9224
9225 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9226 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9227 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9228 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9229 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9230
9231 @table @code
9232 @item explore value @var{expr}
9233 @cindex explore value
9234 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9235 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9236 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9237 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9238 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9239
9240 @item explore type @var{arg}
9241 @cindex explore type
9242 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9243 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9244 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9245 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9246 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9247 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9248 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9249 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9250 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9251 @end table
9252
9253 @menu
9254 * Expressions:: Expressions
9255 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9256 * Variables:: Program variables
9257 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9258 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9259 * Memory:: Examining memory
9260 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9261 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9262 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9263 * Value History:: Value history
9264 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9265 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9266 * Registers:: Registers
9267 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9268 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9269 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9270 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9271 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9272 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9273 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9274 character set than GDB does
9275 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9276 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9277 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9278 @end menu
9279
9280 @node Expressions
9281 @section Expressions
9282
9283 @cindex expressions
9284 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9285 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9286 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9287 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9288 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9289 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9290 @ref{Compilation}.
9291
9292 @cindex arrays in expressions
9293 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9294 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9295 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9296 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9297 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9298 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9299
9300 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9301 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9302 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9303 languages.
9304
9305 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9306 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9307
9308 @cindex casts, in expressions
9309 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9310 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9311 at that address in memory.
9312 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9313
9314 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9315 to programming languages:
9316
9317 @table @code
9318 @item @@
9319 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9320 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9321
9322 @item ::
9323 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9324 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9325
9326 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9327 @cindex type casting memory
9328 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9329 @cindex casts, to view memory
9330 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9331 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9332 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9333 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9334 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9335 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9336 @end table
9337
9338 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9339 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9340 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9341
9342 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9343 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9344 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9345 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9346 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9347 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9348 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9349
9350 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9351 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9352 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9353 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9354 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9355 as well.
9356
9357 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9358 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9359 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9360 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9361 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9362 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9363 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9364 choices.
9365
9366 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9367 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9368 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9369
9370 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9371 @smallexample
9372 @group
9373 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9374 [0] cancel
9375 [1] all
9376 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9377 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9378 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9379 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9380 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9381 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9382 > 2 4 6
9383 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9384 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9385 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9386 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9387 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9388 breakpoints.
9389 (@value{GDBP})
9390 @end group
9391 @end smallexample
9392
9393 @table @code
9394 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9395 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9396 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9397
9398 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9399 is ambiguous.
9400
9401 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9402 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9403 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9404 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9405 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9406 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9407 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9408 in the use of the menu.
9409
9410 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9411 when an ambiguity is detected.
9412
9413 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9414 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9415
9416 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9417 @item show multiple-symbols
9418 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9419 @end table
9420
9421 @node Variables
9422 @section Program Variables
9423
9424 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9425 in your program.
9426
9427 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9428 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9429
9430 @itemize @bullet
9431 @item
9432 global (or file-static)
9433 @end itemize
9434
9435 @noindent or
9436
9437 @itemize @bullet
9438 @item
9439 visible according to the scope rules of the
9440 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9441 @end itemize
9442
9443 @noindent This means that in the function
9444
9445 @smallexample
9446 foo (a)
9447 int a;
9448 @{
9449 bar (a);
9450 @{
9451 int b = test ();
9452 bar (b);
9453 @}
9454 @}
9455 @end smallexample
9456
9457 @noindent
9458 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9459 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9460 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9461 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9462
9463 @cindex variable name conflict
9464 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9465 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9466 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9467 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9468 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9469 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9470 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9471
9472 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9473 @ifnotinfo
9474 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9475 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9476 @end ifnotinfo
9477 @smallexample
9478 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9479 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @noindent
9483 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9484 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9485 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9486 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9487
9488 @smallexample
9489 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9493 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9494 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9495 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9496 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9497
9498 @smallexample
9499 void
9500 foo (int a)
9501 @{
9502 if (a < 10)
9503 bar (a);
9504 else
9505 process (a); /* Stop here */
9506 @}
9507
9508 int
9509 bar (int a)
9510 @{
9511 foo (a + 5);
9512 @}
9513 @end smallexample
9514
9515 @noindent
9516 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9517 here is what you might see
9518 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9519
9520 @smallexample
9521 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9522 $1 = 10
9523 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9524 $2 = 5
9525 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9526 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9527 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9528 $3 = 5
9529 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9530 $4 = 0
9531 @end smallexample
9532
9533 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9534 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9535 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9536 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9537 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9538
9539 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9540 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9541 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9542 @code{some_global}.
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9546 $1 = 23
9547 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9548 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9549 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9550 $2 = 27
9551 @end smallexample
9552
9553 @cindex wrong values
9554 @cindex variable values, wrong
9555 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9556 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9557 @quotation
9558 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9559 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9560 scope, and just before exit.
9561 @end quotation
9562 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9563 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9564 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9565 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9566 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9567 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9568 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9569 variable definitions may be gone.
9570
9571 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9572 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9573 when compiling.
9574
9575 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9576 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9577 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9578 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9579 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9580 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9581 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9585 @end smallexample
9586
9587 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9588 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9589 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9590 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9591 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9592
9593 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9594 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9595 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9596 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9597
9598 @cindex no debug info variables
9599 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9600 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9601 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9602 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9603 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9604 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9605 example, in a C program:
9606
9607 @smallexample
9608 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9609 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9610 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9611 $1 = 3.14
9612 @end smallexample
9613
9614 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9615 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9616 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9617 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9618 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9619
9620 @smallexample
9621 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9622 29 i++;
9623 (gdb) next
9624 30 e (i);
9625 (gdb) print i
9626 $1 = 31
9627 (gdb) print i@@entry
9628 $2 = 30
9629 @end smallexample
9630
9631 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9632 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9633 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9634 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9635 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9636 For program code
9637
9638 @smallexample
9639 char var0[] = "A";
9640 signed char var1[] = "A";
9641 @end smallexample
9642
9643 You get during debugging
9644 @smallexample
9645 (gdb) print var0
9646 $1 = "A"
9647 (gdb) print var1
9648 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9649 @end smallexample
9650
9651 @node Arrays
9652 @section Artificial Arrays
9653
9654 @cindex artificial array
9655 @cindex arrays
9656 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9657 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9658 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9659 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9660 program.
9661
9662 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9663 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9664 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9665 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9666 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9667 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9668 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9669 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9670 example. If a program says
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9674 @end smallexample
9675
9676 @noindent
9677 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 p *array@@len
9681 @end smallexample
9682
9683 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9684 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9685 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9686 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9687 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9688
9689 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9690 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9691 The value need not be in memory:
9692 @smallexample
9693 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9694 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9698 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9699 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9700 @smallexample
9701 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9702 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9706 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9707 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9708 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9709 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9710 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9711 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9712 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9713 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9714 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9715
9716 @smallexample
9717 set $i = 0
9718 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9719 @key{RET}
9720 @key{RET}
9721 @dots{}
9722 @end smallexample
9723
9724 @node Output Formats
9725 @section Output Formats
9726
9727 @cindex formatted output
9728 @cindex output formats
9729 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9730 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9731 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9732 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9733 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9734
9735 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9736 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9737 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9738 letters supported are:
9739
9740 @table @code
9741 @item x
9742 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9743 hexadecimal.
9744
9745 @item d
9746 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9747
9748 @item u
9749 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9750
9751 @item o
9752 Print as integer in octal.
9753
9754 @item t
9755 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9756 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9757 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9758 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9759
9760 @item a
9761 @cindex unknown address, locating
9762 @cindex locate address
9763 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9764 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9765 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9769 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 @noindent
9773 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9774 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9775
9776 @item c
9777 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9778 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9779 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9780 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9781
9782 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9783 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9784 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9785 data.
9786
9787 @item f
9788 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9789 using typical floating point syntax.
9790
9791 @item s
9792 @cindex printing strings
9793 @cindex printing byte arrays
9794 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9795 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9796 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9797 natural types.
9798
9799 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9800 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9801 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9802 array.
9803
9804 @item z
9805 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9806 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9807 to the size of the integer type.
9808
9809 @item r
9810 @cindex raw printing
9811 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9812 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9813 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9814 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9815 pretty-printer which might exist.
9816 @end table
9817
9818 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9819
9820 @smallexample
9821 p/x $pc
9822 @end smallexample
9823
9824 @noindent
9825 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9826 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9827
9828 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9829 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9830 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9831
9832 @node Memory
9833 @section Examining Memory
9834
9835 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9836 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9837
9838 @cindex examining memory
9839 @table @code
9840 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9841 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9842 @itemx x @var{addr}
9843 @itemx x
9844 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9845 @end table
9846
9847 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9848 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9849 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9850 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9851 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9852
9853 @table @r
9854 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9855 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9856 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9857 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9858 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9859 @c 4.1.2.
9860
9861 @item @var{f}, the display format
9862 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9863 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9864 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9865 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9866 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9867
9868 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9869 The unit size is any of
9870
9871 @table @code
9872 @item b
9873 Bytes.
9874 @item h
9875 Halfwords (two bytes).
9876 @item w
9877 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9878 @item g
9879 Giant words (eight bytes).
9880 @end table
9881
9882 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9883 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9884 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9885 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9886 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9887 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9888 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9889 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9890 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9891 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9892 be altered.
9893
9894 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9895 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9896 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9897 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9898 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9899 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9900 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9901 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9902 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9903 a value from memory).
9904 @end table
9905
9906 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9907 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9908 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9909 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9910 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9911
9912 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9913 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9914 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9915
9916 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9917 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9918 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9919 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9920 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9921
9922 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9923 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9924 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9925 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9926 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9927 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9928 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9929 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9930 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9931
9932 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9933 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9934 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9935 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9936 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9937 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9938
9939 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9940 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9941 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9942 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9943 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9944 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9945 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9946
9947 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9948 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9949
9950 @smallexample
9951 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9952 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9953 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9954 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9955 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9956 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9957 @end smallexample
9958
9959 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9960 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9961 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9962 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9963 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9964 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9965 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9966 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9967 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9968
9969 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9970 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9971 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9972
9973 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9974 @cindex addressable memory unit
9975 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9976 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9977 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9978 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9979 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9980 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9981 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9982 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9983 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9984
9985 @cindex remote memory comparison
9986 @cindex target memory comparison
9987 @cindex verify remote memory image
9988 @cindex verify target memory image
9989 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9990 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9991 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9992 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9993 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9994 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @kindex compare-sections
9998 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9999 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10000 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10001 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10002 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10003 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10004
10005 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10006 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10007 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10008 @end table
10009
10010 @node Auto Display
10011 @section Automatic Display
10012 @cindex automatic display
10013 @cindex display of expressions
10014
10015 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10016 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10017 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10018 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10019 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10020 The automatic display looks like this:
10021
10022 @smallexample
10023 2: foo = 38
10024 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10029 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10030 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10031 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10032 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10033 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10034
10035 @table @code
10036 @kindex display
10037 @item display @var{expr}
10038 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10039 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10040
10041 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10042
10043 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10044 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10045 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10046 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10047 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10048
10049 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10050 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10051 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10052 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10053 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10054 @end table
10055
10056 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10057 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10058 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10059
10060 @table @code
10061 @kindex delete display
10062 @kindex undisplay
10063 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10064 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10065 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10066 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10067 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10068 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10069 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10070
10071 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10072 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10073
10074 @kindex disable display
10075 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10076 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10077 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10078 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10079 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10080 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10081 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10082 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10083
10084 @kindex enable display
10085 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10086 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10087 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10088 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10089 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10090 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10091 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10092
10093 @item display
10094 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10095 done when your program stops.
10096
10097 @kindex info display
10098 @item info display
10099 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10100 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10101 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10102 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10103 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10104 @end table
10105
10106 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10107 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10108 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10109 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10110 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10111 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10112 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10113 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10114 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10115 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10116 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10117
10118 @node Print Settings
10119 @section Print Settings
10120
10121 @cindex format options
10122 @cindex print settings
10123 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10124 and symbols are printed.
10125
10126 @noindent
10127 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10128
10129 @table @code
10130 @kindex set print
10131 @item set print address
10132 @itemx set print address on
10133 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10134 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10135 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10136 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10137 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10138 @code{set print address on}:
10139
10140 @smallexample
10141 @group
10142 (@value{GDBP}) f
10143 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10144 at input.c:530
10145 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10146 @end group
10147 @end smallexample
10148
10149 @item set print address off
10150 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10151 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10152
10153 @smallexample
10154 @group
10155 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10156 (@value{GDBP}) f
10157 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10158 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10159 @end group
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10163 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10164 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10165 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10166
10167 @kindex show print
10168 @item show print address
10169 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10170 @end table
10171
10172 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10173 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10174 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10175 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10176 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10177 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10178 it prints a symbolic address:
10179
10180 @table @code
10181 @item set print symbol-filename on
10182 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10183 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10184 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10185 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10186
10187 @item set print symbol-filename off
10188 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10189 default.
10190
10191 @item show print symbol-filename
10192 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10193 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10194 @end table
10195
10196 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10197 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10198 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10199
10200 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10201 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10202
10203 @table @code
10204 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10205 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10206 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10207 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10208 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10209 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10210 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10211 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10212
10213 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10214 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10215 symbolic address.
10216 @end table
10217
10218 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10219 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10220 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10221 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10222 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10223 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10224 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10225 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10226
10227 @smallexample
10228 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10229 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10230 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10231 @end smallexample
10232
10233 @quotation
10234 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10235 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10236 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10237 @end quotation
10238
10239 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10240 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10241
10242 @table @code
10243 @item set print symbol on
10244 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10245 one exists.
10246
10247 @item set print symbol off
10248 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10249 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10250 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10251
10252 @item show print symbol
10253 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10254 address.
10255 @end table
10256
10257 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10258
10259 @table @code
10260 @item set print array
10261 @itemx set print array on
10262 @cindex pretty print arrays
10263 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10264 but uses more space. The default is off.
10265
10266 @item set print array off
10267 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10268
10269 @item show print array
10270 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10271 arrays.
10272
10273 @cindex print array indexes
10274 @item set print array-indexes
10275 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10276 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10277 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10278 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10279
10280 @item set print array-indexes off
10281 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10282
10283 @item show print array-indexes
10284 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10285 arrays.
10286
10287 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10288 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10289 @cindex number of array elements to print
10290 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10291 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10292 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10293 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10294 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10295 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10296 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10297 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10298
10299 @item show print elements
10300 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10301 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10302
10303 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10304 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10305 @cindex printing frame argument values
10306 @cindex print all frame argument values
10307 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10308 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10309 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10310 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10311 values are:
10312
10313 @table @code
10314 @item all
10315 The values of all arguments are printed.
10316
10317 @item scalars
10318 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10319 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10320 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10321 only scalar arguments are shown:
10322
10323 @smallexample
10324 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10325 at frame-args.c:23
10326 @end smallexample
10327
10328 @item none
10329 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10330 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10331
10332 @smallexample
10333 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10334 at frame-args.c:23
10335 @end smallexample
10336 @end table
10337
10338 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10339 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10340 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10341 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10342 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10343 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10344 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10345 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10346 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10347 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10348
10349 @item show print frame-arguments
10350 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10351
10352 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10353 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10354
10355 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10356 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10357 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10358 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10359 This is the default.
10360
10361 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10362 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10363
10364 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10365 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10366 @kindex set print entry-values
10367 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10368 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10369 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10370 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10371 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10372
10373 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10374 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10375 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10376 @code{no} setting.
10377
10378 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10379 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10380 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10381 this information.
10382
10383 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10384
10385 @table @code
10386 @item no
10387 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10388 point.
10389 @smallexample
10390 #0 equal (val=5)
10391 #0 different (val=6)
10392 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10393 #0 born (val=10)
10394 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10395 @end smallexample
10396
10397 @item only
10398 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10399 values are never printed.
10400 @smallexample
10401 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10402 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10403 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10404 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10405 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10406 @end smallexample
10407
10408 @item preferred
10409 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10410 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10411 value for such parameter.
10412 @smallexample
10413 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10414 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10415 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10416 #0 born (val=10)
10417 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10418 @end smallexample
10419
10420 @item if-needed
10421 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10422 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10423 parameter.
10424 @smallexample
10425 #0 equal (val=5)
10426 #0 different (val=6)
10427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10428 #0 born (val=10)
10429 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10430 @end smallexample
10431
10432 @item both
10433 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10434 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10435 optimizations.
10436 @smallexample
10437 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10438 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10439 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10440 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10441 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 @item compact
10445 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10446 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10447 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10448 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10449 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10450 @smallexample
10451 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10452 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10453 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10454 #0 born (val=10)
10455 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10456 @end smallexample
10457
10458 @item default
10459 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10460 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10461 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10462 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10463 @smallexample
10464 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10465 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10466 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10467 #0 born (val=10)
10468 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10469 @end smallexample
10470 @end table
10471
10472 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10473 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10474
10475 @item show print entry-values
10476 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10477 entry.
10478
10479 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10480 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10481 @cindex repeated array elements
10482 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10483 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10484 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10485 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10486 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10487 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10488 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10489 is 10.
10490
10491 @item show print repeats
10492 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10493 elements.
10494
10495 @item set print null-stop
10496 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10497 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10498 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10499 contain only short strings.
10500 The default is off.
10501
10502 @item show print null-stop
10503 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10504 @sc{null} character.
10505
10506 @item set print pretty on
10507 @cindex print structures in indented form
10508 @cindex indentation in structure display
10509 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10510 per line, like this:
10511
10512 @smallexample
10513 @group
10514 $1 = @{
10515 next = 0x0,
10516 flags = @{
10517 sweet = 1,
10518 sour = 1
10519 @},
10520 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10521 @}
10522 @end group
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 @item set print pretty off
10526 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 @group
10530 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10531 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10532 @end group
10533 @end smallexample
10534
10535 @noindent
10536 This is the default format.
10537
10538 @item show print pretty
10539 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10540
10541 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10542 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10543 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10544 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10545 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10546 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10547 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10548 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10549
10550 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10551 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10552 international character sets, and is the default.
10553
10554 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10555 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10556
10557 @item set print union on
10558 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10559 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10560 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10561
10562 @item set print union off
10563 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10564 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10565 instead.
10566
10567 @item show print union
10568 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10569 structures and other unions.
10570
10571 For example, given the declarations
10572
10573 @smallexample
10574 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10575 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10576 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10577 Bug_forms;
10578
10579 struct thing @{
10580 Species it;
10581 union @{
10582 Tree_forms tree;
10583 Bug_forms bug;
10584 @} form;
10585 @};
10586
10587 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10588 @end smallexample
10589
10590 @noindent
10591 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10592
10593 @smallexample
10594 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10595 @end smallexample
10596
10597 @noindent
10598 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10599
10600 @smallexample
10601 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10602 @end smallexample
10603
10604 @noindent
10605 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10606 and in Pascal.
10607 @end table
10608
10609 @need 1000
10610 @noindent
10611 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10612
10613 @table @code
10614 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10615 @item set print demangle
10616 @itemx set print demangle on
10617 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10618 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10619 linkage. The default is on.
10620
10621 @item show print demangle
10622 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10623
10624 @item set print asm-demangle
10625 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10626 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10627 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10628 The default is off.
10629
10630 @item show print asm-demangle
10631 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10632 or demangled form.
10633
10634 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10635 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10636 @kindex set demangle-style
10637 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10638 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10639 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10640
10641 @table @code
10642 @item auto
10643 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10644 This is the default.
10645
10646 @item gnu
10647 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10648
10649 @item hp
10650 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10651
10652 @item lucid
10653 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10654
10655 @item arm
10656 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10657 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10658 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10659 require further enhancement to permit that.
10660
10661 @end table
10662 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10663
10664 @item show demangle-style
10665 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10666
10667 @item set print object
10668 @itemx set print object on
10669 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10670 @cindex display derived types
10671 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10672 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10673 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10674 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10675 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10676 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10677 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10678
10679 @item set print object off
10680 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10681 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10682
10683 @item show print object
10684 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10685
10686 @item set print static-members
10687 @itemx set print static-members on
10688 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10689 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10690
10691 @item set print static-members off
10692 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10693
10694 @item show print static-members
10695 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10696
10697 @item set print pascal_static-members
10698 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10699 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10700 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10701 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10702
10703 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10704 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10705
10706 @item show print pascal_static-members
10707 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10708
10709 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10710 @item set print vtbl
10711 @itemx set print vtbl on
10712 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10713 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10714 @cindex VTBL display
10715 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10716 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10717 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10718
10719 @item set print vtbl off
10720 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10721
10722 @item show print vtbl
10723 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10724 @end table
10725
10726 @node Pretty Printing
10727 @section Pretty Printing
10728
10729 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10730 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10731 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10732
10733 @menu
10734 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10735 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10736 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10737 @end menu
10738
10739 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10740 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10741
10742 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10743 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10744 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10745
10746 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10747 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10748 pretty-printers with their names.
10749 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10750 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10751 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10752 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10753
10754 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10755 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10756 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10757 do anything special.
10758
10759 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10760
10761 @itemize @bullet
10762 @item
10763 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10764 all inferiors.
10765
10766 @item
10767 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10768 when debugging that program.
10769 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10770
10771 @item
10772 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10773 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10774 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10775 @end itemize
10776
10777 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10778 pretty-printers are selected,
10779
10780 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10781 for new types.
10782
10783 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10784 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10785
10786 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10787
10788 @smallexample
10789 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10790 $1 = @{
10791 static npos = 4294967295,
10792 _M_dataplus = @{
10793 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10794 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10795 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10796 @},
10797 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10798 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10799 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10800 @}
10801 @}
10802 @end smallexample
10803
10804 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10805
10806 @smallexample
10807 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10808 $2 = "abcd"
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10812 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10813 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10814
10815 @table @code
10816 @kindex info pretty-printer
10817 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10818 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10819 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10820
10821 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10822 whose pretty-printers to list.
10823 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10824 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10825 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10826 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10827 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10828
10829 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10830 to list.
10831
10832 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10833 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10834 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10835 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10836
10837 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10838 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10839 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10840 @end table
10841
10842 Example:
10843
10844 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10845 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10846 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10847 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10851 library1.so:
10852 foo
10853 library2.so:
10854 bar
10855 bar1
10856 bar2
10857 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10858 library2.so:
10859 bar
10860 bar1
10861 bar2
10862 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10863 1 printer disabled
10864 2 of 3 printers enabled
10865 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10866 library1.so:
10867 foo [disabled]
10868 library2.so:
10869 bar
10870 bar1
10871 bar2
10872 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10873 1 printer disabled
10874 1 of 3 printers enabled
10875 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10876 library1.so:
10877 foo [disabled]
10878 library2.so:
10879 bar
10880 bar1 [disabled]
10881 bar2
10882 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10883 1 printer disabled
10884 0 of 3 printers enabled
10885 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10886 library1.so:
10887 foo [disabled]
10888 library2.so:
10889 bar [disabled]
10890 bar1 [disabled]
10891 bar2
10892 @end smallexample
10893
10894 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10895 as can each individual subprinter.
10896
10897 @node Value History
10898 @section Value History
10899
10900 @cindex value history
10901 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10902 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10903 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10904 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10905 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10906 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10907 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10908 symbol table.
10909
10910 @cindex @code{$}
10911 @cindex @code{$$}
10912 @cindex history number
10913 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10914 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10915 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10916 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10917 history number.
10918
10919 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10920 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10921 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10922 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10923 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10924 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10925 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10926
10927 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10928 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 p *$
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10935 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10936
10937 @smallexample
10938 p *$.next
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 @noindent
10942 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10943 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10944
10945 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10946 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10947
10948 @smallexample
10949 print x
10950 set x=5
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 @noindent
10954 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10955 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10956
10957 @table @code
10958 @kindex show values
10959 @item show values
10960 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10961 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10962 values} does not change the history.
10963
10964 @item show values @var{n}
10965 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10966
10967 @item show values +
10968 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10969 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10970 @end table
10971
10972 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10973 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10974
10975 @node Convenience Vars
10976 @section Convenience Variables
10977
10978 @cindex convenience variables
10979 @cindex user-defined variables
10980 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10981 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10982 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10983 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10984 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10985
10986 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10987 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10988 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10989 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10990 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10991
10992 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10993 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10994 For example:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 set $foo = *object_ptr
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @noindent
11001 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11002 @code{object_ptr}.
11003
11004 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11005 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11006 value with another assignment at any time.
11007
11008 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11009 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11010 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11011 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11012
11013 @table @code
11014 @kindex show convenience
11015 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11016 @item show convenience
11017 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11018 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11019 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11020
11021 @kindex init-if-undefined
11022 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11023 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11024 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11025 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11026 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11027 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11028 override default values used in a command script.
11029
11030 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11031 any side-effects do not occur.
11032 @end table
11033
11034 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11035 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11036 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11037
11038 @smallexample
11039 set $i = 0
11040 print bar[$i++]->contents
11041 @end smallexample
11042
11043 @noindent
11044 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11045
11046 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11047 values likely to be useful.
11048
11049 @table @code
11050 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11051 @item $_
11052 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11053 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11054 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11055 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11056 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11057 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11058 to the type of @code{$__}.
11059
11060 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11061 @item $__
11062 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11063 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11064 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11065
11066 @item $_exitcode
11067 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11068 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11069 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11070 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11071
11072 @item $_exitsignal
11073 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11074 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11075 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11076 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11077
11078 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11079 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11080 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11081 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11082 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11083
11084 @smallexample
11085 #include <signal.h>
11086
11087 int
11088 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11089 @{
11090 raise (SIGALRM);
11091 return 0;
11092 @}
11093 @end smallexample
11094
11095 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11096 or signalled would be:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11100 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11101 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11102 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11103 >echo The program has exited\n
11104 >else
11105 >echo The program has signalled\n
11106 >end
11107 >end
11108 (@value{GDBP}) run
11109 Starting program:
11110
11111 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11112 The program no longer exists.
11113 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11114 The program has signalled
11115 @end smallexample
11116
11117 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11118 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11119 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11120 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11121
11122 @smallexample
11123 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11124 The program has exited
11125 @end smallexample
11126
11127 @item $_exception
11128 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11129 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11130
11131 @item $_probe_argc
11132 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11133 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11134
11135 @item $_sdata
11136 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11137 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11138 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11139 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11140 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11141
11142 @item $_siginfo
11143 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11144 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11145 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11146 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11147 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11148
11149 @item $_tlb
11150 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11151 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11152 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11153 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11154 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11155 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11156
11157 @item $_inferior
11158 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11159 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11160
11161 @item $_thread
11162 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11163
11164 @item $_gthread
11165 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11166
11167 @end table
11168
11169 @node Convenience Funs
11170 @section Convenience Functions
11171
11172 @cindex convenience functions
11173 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11174 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11175 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11176 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11177 @value{GDBN}.
11178
11179 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11180 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183
11184 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11185 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11186 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11187 returns zero.
11188
11189 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11190 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11191 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11192 it is @code{void}:
11193
11194 @smallexample
11195 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11196 $1 = void
11197 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11198 $2 = 1
11199 (@value{GDBP}) run
11200 Starting program: ./a.out
11201 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11202 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11203 $3 = 0
11204 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11205 $4 = 0
11206 @end smallexample
11207
11208 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11209 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11210 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11211 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11212 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11213 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11214 anymore.
11215
11216 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11217 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11218
11219 @smallexample
11220 void
11221 foo (void)
11222 @{
11223 @}
11224 @end smallexample
11225
11226 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11227
11228 @smallexample
11229 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11230 $1 = void
11231 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11232 $2 = 1
11233 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11234 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11235 $3 = void
11236 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11237 $4 = 1
11238 @end smallexample
11239
11240 @end table
11241
11242 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11243 @code{Python} support.
11244
11245 @table @code
11246
11247 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11248 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11249 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11250 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11251 Otherwise it returns zero.
11252
11253 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11254 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11255 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11256 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11257 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11258 regular expression support.
11259
11260 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11261 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11262 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11263 Otherwise it returns zero.
11264
11265 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11266 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11267 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11268
11269 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11270 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11271 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11272 Otherwise it returns zero.
11273
11274 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11275 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11276 The default is 1.
11277
11278 Example:
11279
11280 @smallexample
11281 (gdb) backtrace
11282 #0 bottom_func ()
11283 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11284 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11285 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11286 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11287 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11288 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11289 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11290 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11291 $1 = 1
11292 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11293 $1 = 1
11294 @end smallexample
11295
11296 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11297 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11298 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11299 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11300
11301 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11302 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11303 The default is 1.
11304
11305 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11306 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11307 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11308 Otherwise it returns zero.
11309
11310 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11311 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11312 The default is 1.
11313
11314 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11315 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11316 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11317 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11318
11319 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11320 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11321 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11322 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11323
11324 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11325 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11326 The default is 1.
11327
11328 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11329 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11330 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11331 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11332
11333 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11334 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11335 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11336
11337 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11338 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11339 an enumerated type:
11340
11341 @smallexample
11342 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11343 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11344 @end smallexample
11345
11346 @end table
11347
11348 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11349 convenience functions.
11350
11351 @table @code
11352 @item help function
11353 @kindex help function
11354 @cindex show all convenience functions
11355 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @node Registers
11359 @section Registers
11360
11361 @cindex registers
11362 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11363 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11364 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11365 your machine.
11366
11367 @table @code
11368 @kindex info registers
11369 @item info registers
11370 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11371 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11372
11373 @kindex info all-registers
11374 @cindex floating point registers
11375 @item info all-registers
11376 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11377 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11378
11379 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11380 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11381 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11382 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11383
11384 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11385 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11386 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11387 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11388 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11389 @end table
11390
11391 @anchor{standard registers}
11392 @cindex stack pointer register
11393 @cindex program counter register
11394 @cindex process status register
11395 @cindex frame pointer register
11396 @cindex standard registers
11397 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11398 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11399 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11400 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11401 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11402 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11403 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11404 you could print the program counter in hex with
11405
11406 @smallexample
11407 p/x $pc
11408 @end smallexample
11409
11410 @noindent
11411 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11412
11413 @smallexample
11414 x/i $pc
11415 @end smallexample
11416
11417 @noindent
11418 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11419 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11420 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11421 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11422 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11423 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11424 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11425
11426 @smallexample
11427 set $sp += 4
11428 @end smallexample
11429
11430 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11431 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11432 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11433 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11434 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11435 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11436 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11437
11438 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11439 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11440 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11441 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11442 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11443 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11444 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11445
11446 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11447 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11448 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11449 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11450 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11451 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11452 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11453 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11454 prints the data in both formats.
11455
11456 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11457 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11458 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11459 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11460 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11461 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11462 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11463
11464 @smallexample
11465 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11466 $1 = @{
11467 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11468 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11469 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11470 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11471 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11472 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11473 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11474 @}
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 @noindent
11478 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11479 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11480 value to a @code{struct} member:
11481
11482 @smallexample
11483 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11484 @end smallexample
11485
11486 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11487 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11488 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11489 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11490 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11491 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11492
11493 @cindex caller-saved registers
11494 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11495 @cindex volatile registers
11496 @cindex <not saved> values
11497 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11498 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11499 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11500 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11501 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11502 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11503 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11504 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11505 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11506 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11507 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11508 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11509 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11510 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11511 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11512 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11513 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11514 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11515 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11516 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11517 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11518 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11519 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11520
11521 @node Floating Point Hardware
11522 @section Floating Point Hardware
11523 @cindex floating point
11524
11525 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11526 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11527
11528 @table @code
11529 @kindex info float
11530 @item info float
11531 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11532 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11533 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11534 the ARM and x86 machines.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 @node Vector Unit
11538 @section Vector Unit
11539 @cindex vector unit
11540
11541 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11542 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11543
11544 @table @code
11545 @kindex info vector
11546 @item info vector
11547 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11548 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 @node OS Information
11552 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11553 @cindex OS information
11554
11555 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11556 you debug your program.
11557
11558 @cindex auxiliary vector
11559 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11560 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11561 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11562 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11563 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11564 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11565 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11566 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11567 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11568 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11569 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11570 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11571
11572 @table @code
11573 @kindex info auxv
11574 @item info auxv
11575 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11576 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11577 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11578 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11579 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11580 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11581 an unrecognized tag.
11582 @end table
11583
11584 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11585 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11586 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11587 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11588 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11589 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11590 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11591
11592 @table @code
11593 @kindex info os
11594 @item info os @var{infotype}
11595
11596 Display OS information of the requested type.
11597
11598 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11599
11600 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11601 @table @code
11602 @kindex info os cpus
11603 @item cpus
11604 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11605 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11606 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11607 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11608 kernel initialization.
11609
11610 @kindex info os files
11611 @item files
11612 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11613 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11614 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11615 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11616
11617 @kindex info os modules
11618 @item modules
11619 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11620 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11621 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11622 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11623 in memory.
11624
11625 @kindex info os msg
11626 @item msg
11627 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11628 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11629 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11630 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11631 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11632 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11633 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11634 the message queue was last changed.
11635
11636 @kindex info os processes
11637 @item processes
11638 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11639 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11640 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11641 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11642 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11643 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11644
11645 @kindex info os procgroups
11646 @item procgroups
11647 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11648 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11649 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11650 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11651 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11652 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11653 and the process group leader is listed first.
11654
11655 @kindex info os semaphores
11656 @item semaphores
11657 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11658 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11659 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11660 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11661 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11662
11663 @kindex info os shm
11664 @item shm
11665 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11666 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11667 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11668 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11669 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11670 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11671 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11672
11673 @kindex info os sockets
11674 @item sockets
11675 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11676 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11677 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11678 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11679 connection.
11680
11681 @kindex info os threads
11682 @item threads
11683 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11684 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11685 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11686 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11687 process is not listed.
11688 @end table
11689
11690 @item info os
11691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11694 types, this command will report an error.
11695 @end table
11696
11697 @node Memory Region Attributes
11698 @section Memory Region Attributes
11699 @cindex memory region attributes
11700
11701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11707 user can override the fetched regions.
11708
11709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11713 all memory.
11714
11715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11717
11718 @table @code
11719 @kindex mem
11720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11726
11727 @item mem auto
11728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11730
11731 @kindex delete mem
11732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11735
11736 @kindex disable mem
11737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11740 It may be enabled again later.
11741
11742 @kindex enable mem
11743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11745
11746 @kindex info mem
11747 @item info mem
11748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11749 for each region:
11750
11751 @table @emph
11752 @item Memory Region Number
11753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11756
11757 @item Lo Address
11758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11759
11760 @item Hi Address
11761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11762
11763 @item Attributes
11764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11765 @end table
11766 @end table
11767
11768
11769 @subsection Attributes
11770
11771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11773 write accesses to a memory region.
11774
11775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11778
11779 @table @code
11780 @item ro
11781 Memory is read only.
11782 @item wo
11783 Memory is write only.
11784 @item rw
11785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11786 @end table
11787
11788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11793
11794 @table @code
11795 @item 8
11796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11797 @item 16
11798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11799 @item 32
11800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11801 @item 64
11802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11803 @end table
11804
11805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11809 @c
11810 @c @table @code
11811 @c @item hwbreak
11812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11813 @c @item swbreak (default)
11814 @c @end table
11815
11816 @subsubsection Data Cache
11817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11821 registers.
11822
11823 @table @code
11824 @item cache
11825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11826 @item nocache
11827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11828 @end table
11829
11830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11835
11836 @table @code
11837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11844 The default value is @code{on}.
11845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11848 @end table
11849
11850
11851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11854 @c
11855 @c @table @code
11856 @c @item verify
11857 @c @item noverify (default)
11858 @c @end table
11859
11860 @node Dump/Restore Files
11861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11862 @cindex dump/restore files
11863 @cindex append data to a file
11864 @cindex dump data to a file
11865 @cindex restore data from a file
11866
11867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11872 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11873 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11874
11875 @table @code
11876
11877 @kindex dump
11878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11882
11883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11884 @table @code
11885 @item binary
11886 Raw binary form.
11887 @item ihex
11888 Intel hex format.
11889 @item srec
11890 Motorola S-record format.
11891 @item tekhex
11892 Tektronix Hex format.
11893 @item verilog
11894 Verilog Hex format.
11895 @end table
11896
11897 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11898 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11899 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11900 form.
11901
11902 @kindex append
11903 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11904 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11905 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11906 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11907 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11908
11909 @kindex restore
11910 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11911 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11912 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11913 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11914 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11915
11916 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11917 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11918 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11919 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11920 from that location.
11921
11922 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11923 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11924 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11925 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11926
11927 @end table
11928
11929 @node Core File Generation
11930 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11931 @cindex dump core from inferior
11932
11933 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11934 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11935 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11936 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11937 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11938 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11939 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11940
11941 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11942 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11943 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11944
11945 @table @code
11946 @kindex gcore
11947 @kindex generate-core-file
11948 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11949 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11950 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11951 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11952 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11953 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11954
11955 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11956 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11957
11958 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11959 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11960 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11961 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11962 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11963
11964 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11965 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11966 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11967 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11968 Enable or disable the use of the file
11969 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11970 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11971 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11972 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11973
11974 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11975 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11976 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11977 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11978 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11979 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11980 about the bits that can be set in the
11981 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11982 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11983
11984 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11985 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11986 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11987 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11988 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11989 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11990 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11991 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11992
11993 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11994 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11995 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11996 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11997 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11998 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11999 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12000
12001 The default value is @code{off}.
12002 @end table
12003
12004 @node Character Sets
12005 @section Character Sets
12006 @cindex character sets
12007 @cindex charset
12008 @cindex translating between character sets
12009 @cindex host character set
12010 @cindex target character set
12011
12012 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12013 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12014 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12015 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12016 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12017 @dfn{target character set}.
12018
12019 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12020 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12021 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12022 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12023 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12024 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12025 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12026 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12027 character and string literals in expressions.
12028
12029 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12030 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12031 target-charset} command, described below.
12032
12033 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12034 support:
12035
12036 @table @code
12037 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12038 @kindex set target-charset
12039 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12040 list of supported target character sets, type
12041 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12042
12043 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12044 @kindex set host-charset
12045 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12046
12047 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12048 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12049 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12050 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12051 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12052
12053 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12054 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12055 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12056
12057 @item set charset @var{charset}
12058 @kindex set charset
12059 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12060 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12061 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12062 for both host and target.
12063
12064 @item show charset
12065 @kindex show charset
12066 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12067
12068 @item show host-charset
12069 @kindex show host-charset
12070 Show the name of the current host character set.
12071
12072 @item show target-charset
12073 @kindex show target-charset
12074 Show the name of the current target character set.
12075
12076 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12077 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12078 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12079 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12080 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12081 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12082
12083 @item show target-wide-charset
12084 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12085 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12086 @end table
12087
12088 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12089 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12090 @file{charset-test.c}:
12091
12092 @smallexample
12093 #include <stdio.h>
12094
12095 char ascii_hello[]
12096 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12097 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12098 char ibm1047_hello[]
12099 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12100 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12101
12102 main ()
12103 @{
12104 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12105 @}
12106 @end smallexample
12107
12108 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12109 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12110 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12111
12112 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12113
12114 @smallexample
12115 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12116 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12117 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12118 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12119 @dots{}
12120 (@value{GDBP})
12121 @end smallexample
12122
12123 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12124 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12125 strings:
12126
12127 @smallexample
12128 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12129 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12130 (@value{GDBP})
12131 @end smallexample
12132
12133 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12134 initial character set:
12135 @smallexample
12136 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12137 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12138 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12139 (@value{GDBP})
12140 @end smallexample
12141
12142 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12143 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12144 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12145 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12146 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12147
12148 @smallexample
12149 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12150 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12151 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12152 $2 = 72 'H'
12153 (@value{GDBP})
12154 @end smallexample
12155
12156 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12157 literals you use in expressions:
12158
12159 @smallexample
12160 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12161 $3 = 43 '+'
12162 (@value{GDBP})
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12166 character.
12167
12168 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12169 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12170 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12171
12172 @smallexample
12173 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12174 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12175 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12176 $5 = 200 '\310'
12177 (@value{GDBP})
12178 @end smallexample
12179
12180 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12181 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12182
12183 @smallexample
12184 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12185 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12186 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12187 @end smallexample
12188
12189 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12190 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12191 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12192 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12193 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12197 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12198 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12199 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12200 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12201 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12202 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12203 $7 = 72 '\110'
12204 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12205 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12206 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12207 $9 = 200 'H'
12208 (@value{GDBP})
12209 @end smallexample
12210
12211 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12212 string literals you use in expressions:
12213
12214 @smallexample
12215 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12216 $10 = 78 '+'
12217 (@value{GDBP})
12218 @end smallexample
12219
12220 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12221 character.
12222
12223 @node Caching Target Data
12224 @section Caching Data of Targets
12225 @cindex caching data of targets
12226
12227 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12228 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12229 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12230 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12231 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12232 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12233 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12234 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12235 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12236 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12237 is executing.
12238 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12239 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12240 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12241 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12242 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12243 in the code segment.
12244 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12245 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12246
12247 @table @code
12248 @kindex set remotecache
12249 @item set remotecache on
12250 @itemx set remotecache off
12251 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12252 with old scripts.
12253
12254 @kindex show remotecache
12255 @item show remotecache
12256 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12257
12258 @kindex set stack-cache
12259 @item set stack-cache on
12260 @itemx set stack-cache off
12261 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12262 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12263
12264 @kindex show stack-cache
12265 @item show stack-cache
12266 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12267
12268 @kindex set code-cache
12269 @item set code-cache on
12270 @itemx set code-cache off
12271 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12272 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12273 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12274
12275 @kindex show code-cache
12276 @item show code-cache
12277 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12278 accesses.
12279
12280 @kindex info dcache
12281 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12282 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12283 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12284 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12285 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12286 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12287
12288 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12289 printed in hex.
12290
12291 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12292 @cindex dcache size
12293 @kindex set dcache size
12294 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12295
12296 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12297 @cindex dcache line-size
12298 @kindex set dcache line-size
12299 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12300 Must be a power of 2.
12301
12302 @item show dcache size
12303 @kindex show dcache size
12304 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12305
12306 @item show dcache line-size
12307 @kindex show dcache line-size
12308 Show default size of dcache lines.
12309
12310 @end table
12311
12312 @node Searching Memory
12313 @section Search Memory
12314 @cindex searching memory
12315
12316 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12317 @code{find} command.
12318
12319 @table @code
12320 @kindex find
12321 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12322 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12323 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12324 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12325 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12326 @end table
12327
12328 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12329 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12330
12331 @table @r
12332 @item @var{s}, search query size
12333 The size of each search query value.
12334
12335 @table @code
12336 @item b
12337 bytes
12338 @item h
12339 halfwords (two bytes)
12340 @item w
12341 words (four bytes)
12342 @item g
12343 giant words (eight bytes)
12344 @end table
12345
12346 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12347 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12348 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12349 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12350 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12351
12352 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12353 value's type in the current language.
12354 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12355 pattern as a mixture of types.
12356 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12357 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12358 which is typically four bytes.
12359
12360 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12361 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12362 @end table
12363
12364 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12365 (@code{"}).
12366 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12367 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12368
12369 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12370 number of matches found.
12371
12372 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12373 @samp{$_}.
12374 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12375
12376 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12377
12378 @smallexample
12379 void
12380 hello ()
12381 @{
12382 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12383 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12384 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12385 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12386 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12387 @}
12388 @end smallexample
12389
12390 @noindent
12391 you get during debugging:
12392
12393 @smallexample
12394 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12395 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12396 1 pattern found
12397 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12398 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12399 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12400 2 patterns found.
12401 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12402 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12403 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12404 2 patterns found.
12405 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12406 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12407 1 pattern found
12408 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12409 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12410 1 pattern found
12411 (gdb) print $numfound
12412 $1 = 1
12413 (gdb) print $_
12414 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12415 @end smallexample
12416
12417 @node Value Sizes
12418 @section Value Sizes
12419
12420 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12421 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12422 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12423 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12424 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12425
12426 @table @code
12427 @kindex set max-value-size
12428 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12429 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12430 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12431 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12432 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12433
12434 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12435 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12436
12437 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12438 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12439 currently 16 bytes.
12440
12441 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12442 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12443 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12444 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12445 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12446 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12447 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12448 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12449
12450 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12451
12452 @kindex show max-value-size
12453 @item show max-value-size
12454 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12455 allocate for the contents of a value.
12456 @end table
12457
12458 @node Optimized Code
12459 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12460 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12461 @cindex debugging optimized code
12462
12463 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12464 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12465 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12466 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12467 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12468 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12469 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12470
12471 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12472 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12473 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12474 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12475
12476 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12477 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12478 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12479 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12480 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12481 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12482
12483 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12484 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12485 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12486 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12487 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12488
12489 @menu
12490 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12491 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12492 @end menu
12493
12494 @node Inline Functions
12495 @section Inline Functions
12496 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12497
12498 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12499 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12500 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12501 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12502 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12503 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12504 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12505 @code{info frame} command.
12506
12507 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12508 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12509 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12510 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12511 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12512 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12513 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12514 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12515 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12516 local variables in the caller.
12517
12518 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12519 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12520 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12521 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12522 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12523 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12524 instructions are executed.
12525
12526 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12527 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12528 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12529 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12530
12531 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12532 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12533
12534 @itemize @bullet
12535 @item
12536 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12537 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12538 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12539 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12540 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12541 or inside the inlined function instead.
12542
12543 @item
12544 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12545 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12546 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12547 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12548
12549 @end itemize
12550
12551 @node Tail Call Frames
12552 @section Tail Call Frames
12553 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12554
12555 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12556 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12557 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12558 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12559 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12560
12561 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12562 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12563 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12564 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12565 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12566 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12567 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12568
12569 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12570 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12571 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12572 this information.
12573
12574 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12575 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12576
12577 @smallexample
12578 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12579 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12580 (gdb) info frame
12581 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12582 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12583 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12584 source language c++.
12585 Arglist at unknown address.
12586 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12587 @end smallexample
12588
12589 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12590 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12591 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12592 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12593 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12594 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12595
12596 @table @code
12597 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12598 @item set debug entry-values
12599 @kindex set debug entry-values
12600 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12601 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12602 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12603 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12604 result.
12605
12606 @item show debug entry-values
12607 @kindex show debug entry-values
12608 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12609 values at function entry and tail calls.
12610 @end table
12611
12612 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12613 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12614 reference by variable @code{x}):
12615
12616 @smallexample
12617 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12618 void (*x) (void) = c;
12619 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12620 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12621 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12622
12623 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12624 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12625 a () at t.c:3
12626 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12627 (gdb) bt
12628 #0 a () at t.c:3
12629 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12630 @end smallexample
12631
12632 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12633
12634 @smallexample
12635 int i;
12636 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12637 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12638 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12639 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12640 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12641 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12642 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12643 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12644
12645 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12646 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12647 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12648 (gdb) bt
12649 #0 f () at t.c:2
12650 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12651 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12652 @end smallexample
12653
12654 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12655 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12656
12657 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12658 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12659 @set ARROW @click{}
12660 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12661 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12662 @end ifset
12663 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12664 @set ARROW ->
12665 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12666 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12667 @end ifclear
12668
12669 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12670 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12671 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12672
12673 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12674 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12675 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12676 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12677 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12678 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12679
12680 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12681 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12682 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12683 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12684 omitted.
12685
12686 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12687 entry may fail:
12688
12689 @smallexample
12690 int v;
12691 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12692 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12693 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12694 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12695 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12696 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12697
12698 (gdb) bt
12699 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12700 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12701 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12702 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12703 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12704 @end smallexample
12705
12706 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12707 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12708 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12709 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12710 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12711
12712 @node Macros
12713 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12714
12715 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12716 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12717 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12718 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12719 where it was defined.
12720
12721 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12722 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12723 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12724 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12725
12726 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12727 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12728 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12729 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12730 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12731 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12732 see @ref{List}.
12733
12734 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12735 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12736 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12737
12738 @table @code
12739
12740 @kindex macro expand
12741 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12742 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12743 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12744 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12745 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12746 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12747 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12748 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12749 it can be any string of tokens.
12750
12751 @kindex macro exp1
12752 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12753 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12754 @cindex expand macro once
12755 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12756 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12757 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12758 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12759 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12760 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12761 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12762 can be any string of tokens.
12763
12764 @kindex info macro
12765 @cindex macro definition, showing
12766 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12767 @cindex macros, from debug info
12768 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12769 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12770 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12771 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12772 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12773 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12774
12775 @kindex info macros
12776 @item info macros @var{location}
12777 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12778 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12779 command-line where those definitions were established.
12780
12781 @kindex macro define
12782 @cindex user-defined macros
12783 @cindex defining macros interactively
12784 @cindex macros, user-defined
12785 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12786 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12787 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12788 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12789 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12790 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12791 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12792 @var{arglist}.
12793
12794 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12795 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12796 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12797 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12798 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12799
12800 @kindex macro undef
12801 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12802 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12803 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12804 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12805 in the program being debugged.
12806
12807 @kindex macro list
12808 @item macro list
12809 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12810 @end table
12811
12812 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12813 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12814 show our source files:
12815
12816 @smallexample
12817 $ cat sample.c
12818 #include <stdio.h>
12819 #include "sample.h"
12820
12821 #define M 42
12822 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12823
12824 main ()
12825 @{
12826 #define N 28
12827 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12828 #undef N
12829 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12830 #define N 1729
12831 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12832 @}
12833 $ cat sample.h
12834 #define Q <
12835 $
12836 @end smallexample
12837
12838 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12839 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12840 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12841 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12842 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12843 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12844 information.
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12848 $
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12852
12853 @smallexample
12854 $ gdb -nw sample
12855 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12856 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12857 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12858 (@value{GDBP})
12859 @end smallexample
12860
12861 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12862 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12863 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12864
12865 @smallexample
12866 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12867 3
12868 4 #define M 42
12869 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12870 6
12871 7 main ()
12872 8 @{
12873 9 #define N 28
12874 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12875 11 #undef N
12876 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12877 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12878 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12879 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12880 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12881 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12882 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12883 #define Q <
12884 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12885 expands to: (42 + 1)
12886 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12887 expands to: once (M + 1)
12888 (@value{GDBP})
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12892 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12893 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12894 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12895
12896 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12897 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12898
12899 @smallexample
12900 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12901 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12902 (@value{GDBP}) run
12903 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12904
12905 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12906 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12907 (@value{GDBP})
12908 @end smallexample
12909
12910 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12911
12912 @smallexample
12913 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12914 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12915 #define N 28
12916 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12917 expands to: 28 < 42
12918 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12919 $1 = 1
12920 (@value{GDBP})
12921 @end smallexample
12922
12923 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12924 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12925 thereof) in force at each point:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 (@value{GDBP}) next
12929 Hello, world!
12930 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12931 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12932 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12933 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12934 (@value{GDBP}) next
12935 We're so creative.
12936 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12937 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12938 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12939 #define N 1729
12940 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12941 expands to: 1729 < 42
12942 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12943 $2 = 0
12944 (@value{GDBP})
12945 @end smallexample
12946
12947 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12948 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12949 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12950 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12951
12952 @smallexample
12953 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12954 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12955 -D__STDC__=1
12956 (@value{GDBP})
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959
12960 @node Tracepoints
12961 @chapter Tracepoints
12962 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12963 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12964
12965 @cindex tracepoints
12966 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12967 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12968 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12969 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12970 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12971 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12972 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12973
12974 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12975 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12976 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12977 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12978 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12979 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12980 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12981 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12982 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12983 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12984 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12985
12986 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12987 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12988 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12989 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12990 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12991 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12992 Packets}.
12993
12994 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12995 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12996 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12997
12998 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12999
13000 @menu
13001 * Set Tracepoints::
13002 * Analyze Collected Data::
13003 * Tracepoint Variables::
13004 * Trace Files::
13005 @end menu
13006
13007 @node Set Tracepoints
13008 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13009
13010 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13011 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13012 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13013 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13014 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13015 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13016 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13017
13018 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13019 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13020 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13021 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13022 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13023 tracepoint was hit.
13024
13025 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13026 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13027 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13028 either.
13029
13030 @cindex fast tracepoints
13031 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13032 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13033 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13034
13035 @cindex static tracepoints
13036 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13037 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13038 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13039 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13040 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13041 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13042 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13043 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13044 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13045 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13046 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13047 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13048 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13049 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13050 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13051 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13052 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13053 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13054 static tracepoint marker.
13055
13056 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13057 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13058
13059 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13060 conditions and actions.
13061
13062 @menu
13063 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13064 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13065 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13066 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13067 * Trace State Variables::
13068 * Tracepoint Actions::
13069 * Listing Tracepoints::
13070 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13071 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13072 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13073 @end menu
13074
13075 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13076 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13077
13078 @table @code
13079 @cindex set tracepoint
13080 @kindex trace
13081 @item trace @var{location}
13082 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13083 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13084 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13085 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13086 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13087 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13088 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13089 in tracing}).
13090 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13091 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13092 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13093 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13094 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13095 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13096 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13097 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13098 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13099 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13100 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13101 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13102
13103 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13104
13105 @smallexample
13106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13107
13108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13109
13110 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13111
13112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13113
13114 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13115 @end smallexample
13116
13117 @noindent
13118 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13119
13120 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13121 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13122 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13123 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13124 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13125 information on tracepoint conditions.
13126
13127 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13128 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13129 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13130 @kindex ftrace
13131 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13132 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13133 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13134 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13135 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13136 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13137 message.
13138
13139 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13140 @code{trace}.
13141
13142 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13143 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13144 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13145 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13146 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13147 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13148 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13149 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13150
13151 @example
13152 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13153 @end example
13154
13155 @noindent
13156 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13157 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13158
13159 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13160 @cindex set static tracepoint
13161 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13162 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13163 @kindex strace
13164 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13165 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13166 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13167 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13168 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13169
13170 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13171 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13172 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13173 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13174 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13175 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13176 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13177 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13178 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13179 tracing engine:
13180
13181 @smallexample
13182 main ()
13183 @{
13184 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13185 @}
13186 @end smallexample
13187
13188 @noindent
13189 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13190 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13191
13192 @smallexample
13193 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13194 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13195 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13196 Data: "str %s"
13197 [etc...]
13198 @end smallexample
13199
13200 @noindent
13201 so you may probe the marker above with:
13202
13203 @smallexample
13204 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13205 @end smallexample
13206
13207 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13208 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13209 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13210 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13211 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13212 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13213 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13214 the @samp{Data:} field.
13215
13216 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13217 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13218 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13219
13220 @vindex $tpnum
13221 @cindex last tracepoint number
13222 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13223 @cindex tracepoint number
13224 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13225 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13226
13227 @kindex delete tracepoint
13228 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13229 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13230 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13231 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13232 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13233
13234 Examples:
13235
13236 @smallexample
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13238
13239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13240 @end smallexample
13241
13242 @noindent
13243 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13244 @end table
13245
13246 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13247 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13248
13249 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13250
13251 @table @code
13252 @kindex disable tracepoint
13253 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13254 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13255 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13256 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13257 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13258 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13259 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13260 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13261 next trace experiment.
13262
13263 @kindex enable tracepoint
13264 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13265 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13266 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13267 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13268 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13269 next time a trace experiment is run.
13270 @end table
13271
13272 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13273 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13274
13275 @table @code
13276 @kindex passcount
13277 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13278 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13279 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13280 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13281 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13282 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13283 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13284 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13285 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13286 user.
13287
13288 Examples:
13289
13290 @smallexample
13291 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13292 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13293
13294 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13295 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13296 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13302 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13303 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13304 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13305 @end smallexample
13306 @end table
13307
13308 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13309 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13310 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13311 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13312
13313 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13314 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13315 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13316 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13317 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13318 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13319 is true.
13320
13321 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13322 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13323 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13324 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13325 just as with breakpoints.
13326
13327 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13328 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13329 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13330 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13331 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13332 accesses, and so forth.
13333
13334 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13335 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13336 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13337 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13338 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13339 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13340 search through.
13341
13342 @smallexample
13343 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13344 @end smallexample
13345
13346 @node Trace State Variables
13347 @subsection Trace State Variables
13348 @cindex trace state variables
13349
13350 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13351 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13352 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13353 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13354 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13355 integers.
13356
13357 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13358 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13359 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13360 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13361
13362 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13363 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13364 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13365 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13366 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13367 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13368 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13369 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13370 variable with the same name.
13371
13372 @table @code
13373
13374 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13375 @kindex tvariable
13376 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13377 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13378 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13379 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13380 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13381 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13382 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13383 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13384 value. The default initial value is 0.
13385
13386 @item info tvariables
13387 @kindex info tvariables
13388 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13389 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13390 currently running.
13391
13392 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13393 @kindex delete tvariable
13394 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13395 are specified.
13396
13397 @end table
13398
13399 @node Tracepoint Actions
13400 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13401
13402 @table @code
13403 @kindex actions
13404 @cindex tracepoint actions
13405 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13406 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13407 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13408 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13409 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13410 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13411 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13412 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13413 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13414 @code{while-stepping}.
13415
13416 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13417 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13418 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13419
13420 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13421 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13422 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13423
13424 @smallexample
13425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13426
13427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13428
13429 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13430 @end smallexample
13431
13432 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13433 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13434 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13435 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13436 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13437 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13438 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13439 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13440
13441 @smallexample
13442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13444 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13445 > collect bar,baz
13446 > collect $regs
13447 > while-stepping 12
13448 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13449 > end
13450 end
13451 @end smallexample
13452
13453 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13454 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13455 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13456 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13457 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13458 special arguments are supported:
13459
13460 @table @code
13461 @item $regs
13462 Collect all registers.
13463
13464 @item $args
13465 Collect all function arguments.
13466
13467 @item $locals
13468 Collect all local variables.
13469
13470 @item $_ret
13471 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13472 of a backtrace.
13473
13474 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13475 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13476 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13477 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13478 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13479 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13480
13481 @item $_probe_argc
13482 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13483 tracepoint is located.
13484 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13485
13486 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13487 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13488 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13489 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13490
13491 @item $_sdata
13492 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13493 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13494 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13495 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13496 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13497 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13498 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13499 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13500 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13501
13502 @smallexample
13503 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13504 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13505 @end smallexample
13506
13507 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13508 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13509 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13510 @value{GDBN}.
13511 @end table
13512
13513 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13514 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13515 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13516
13517 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13518 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13519 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13520 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13521 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13522 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13523 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13524 @samp{mystr}.
13525
13526 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13527 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13528
13529 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13530 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13531 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13532 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13533 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13534 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13535 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13536 action were used.
13537
13538 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13539 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13540 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13541 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13542 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13543 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13544
13545 @smallexample
13546 > while-stepping 12
13547 > collect $regs, myglobal
13548 > end
13549 >
13550 @end smallexample
13551
13552 @noindent
13553 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13554 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13555 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13556 @code{stepping}.
13557
13558 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13559 @kindex set default-collect
13560 @cindex default collection action
13561 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13562 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13563 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13564 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13565 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13566 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13567
13568 @item show default-collect
13569 @kindex show default-collect
13570 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13571 tracepoint hit.
13572
13573 @end table
13574
13575 @node Listing Tracepoints
13576 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13577
13578 @table @code
13579 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13580 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13581 @cindex information about tracepoints
13582 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13583 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13584 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13585 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13586 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13587 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13588
13589 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13590 tracing:
13591
13592 @itemize @bullet
13593 @item
13594 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13595
13596 @item
13597 the state about installed on target of each location
13598 @end itemize
13599
13600 @smallexample
13601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13602 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13603 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13604 while-stepping 20
13605 collect globfoo, $regs
13606 end
13607 collect globfoo2
13608 end
13609 pass count 1200
13610 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13611 collect $eip
13612 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13613 installed on target
13614 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13615 installed on target
13616 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13617 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13618 not installed on target
13619 (@value{GDBP})
13620 @end smallexample
13621
13622 @noindent
13623 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13624 @end table
13625
13626 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13627 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13628
13629 @table @code
13630 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13631 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13632 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13633 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13634 program.
13635
13636 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13637
13638 @table @emph
13639 @item Count
13640 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13641 stable identifier.
13642 @item ID
13643 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13644 @item Enabled or Disabled
13645 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13646 that are not enabled.
13647 @item Address
13648 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13649 @item What
13650 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13651 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13652 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13653 will be left blank.
13654 @end table
13655
13656 @noindent
13657 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13658
13659 @table @emph
13660 @item Data
13661 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13662 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13663 marker call.
13664 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13665 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13666 @end table
13667
13668 @smallexample
13669 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13670 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13671 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13672 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13673 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13674 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13675 Data: str %s
13676 (@value{GDBP})
13677 @end smallexample
13678 @end table
13679
13680 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13681 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13682
13683 @table @code
13684 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13685 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13686 @cindex collected data discarded
13687 @item tstart
13688 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13689 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13690 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13691 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13692 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13693 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13694 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13695 information, and so forth.
13696
13697 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13698 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13699 @item tstop
13700 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13701 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13702 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13703 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13704 needs to be stopped quickly.
13705
13706 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13707 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13708 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13709
13710 @kindex tstatus
13711 @cindex status of trace data collection
13712 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13713 @item tstatus
13714 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13715 collection.
13716 @end table
13717
13718 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13719
13720 @smallexample
13721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13723 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13724 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13725 > while-stepping 11
13726 > collect $regs
13727 > end
13728 > end
13729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13730 [time passes @dots{}]
13731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13732 @end smallexample
13733
13734 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13735 @cindex disconnected tracing
13736 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13737 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13738 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13739 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13740 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13741 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13742 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13743 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13744
13745 @table @code
13746 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13747 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13748 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13749 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13750 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13751 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13752 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13753 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13754
13755 @item show disconnected-tracing
13756 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13757 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13758
13759 @end table
13760
13761 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13762 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13763 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13764 it will continue after reconnection.
13765
13766 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13767 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13768 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13769 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13770 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13771 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13772 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13773 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13774 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13775 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13776
13777 @cindex circular trace buffer
13778 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13779 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13780 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13781 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13782 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13783 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13784 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13785 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13786 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13787 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13788 the next run.
13789
13790 @table @code
13791 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13792 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13793 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13794 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13795 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13796 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13797 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13798
13799 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13800 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13801 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13802 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13803 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13804 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13805
13806 @end table
13807
13808 @table @code
13809 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13810 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13811 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13812 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13813 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13814 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13815 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13816 likes. This is also the default.
13817
13818 @item show trace-buffer-size
13819 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13820 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13821 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13822 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13823 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13824 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13825 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13826 @end table
13827
13828 @table @code
13829 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13830 @kindex set trace-user
13831
13832 @item show trace-user
13833 @kindex show trace-user
13834
13835 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13836 @kindex set trace-notes
13837 Set the trace run's notes.
13838
13839 @item show trace-notes
13840 @kindex show trace-notes
13841 Show the trace run's notes.
13842
13843 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13844 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13845 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13846 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13847 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13848
13849 @item show trace-stop-notes
13850 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13851 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13852
13853 @end table
13854
13855 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13856 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13857
13858 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13859 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13860 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13861 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13862 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13863 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13864 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13865 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13866 mentioned here.
13867
13868 @itemize @bullet
13869
13870 @item
13871 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13872 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13873 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13874 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13875 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13876 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13877 cannot be collected either.
13878
13879 @item
13880 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13881 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13882 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13883 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13884 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13885 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13886 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13887 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13888 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13889 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13890
13891 @item
13892 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13893 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13894 in a misleading way.
13895
13896 @item
13897 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13898 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13899 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13900 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13901 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13902 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13903 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13904 by @code{ptr}.
13905
13906 @item
13907 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13908 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13909 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13910 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13911 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13912 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13913 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13914 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13915 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13916 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13917 invalid address.
13918
13919 @item
13920 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13921 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13922 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13923 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13924 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13925 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13926 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13927 it to zero.
13928
13929 @end itemize
13930
13931 @node Analyze Collected Data
13932 @section Using the Collected Data
13933
13934 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13935 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13936 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13937 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13938 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13939 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13940 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13941 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13942 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13943 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13944 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13945 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13946 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13947 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13948 the buffer will fail.
13949
13950 @menu
13951 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13952 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13953 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13954 @end menu
13955
13956 @node tfind
13957 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13958
13959 @kindex tfind
13960 @cindex select trace snapshot
13961 @cindex find trace snapshot
13962 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13963 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13964 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13965 snapshot is selected.
13966
13967 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13968
13969 @table @code
13970 @item tfind start
13971 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13972 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13973
13974 @item tfind none
13975 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13976
13977 @item tfind end
13978 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13979
13980 @item tfind
13981 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13982 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13983
13984 @item tfind -
13985 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13986 retracing earlier steps.
13987
13988 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13989 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13990 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13991 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13992 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13993
13994 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13995 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13996 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13997 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13998 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13999
14000 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14001 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14002 addresses (exclusive).
14003
14004 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14005 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14006 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14007
14008 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14009 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14010 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14011 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14012 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14013 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14014 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14015 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14016 @end table
14017
14018 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14019 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14020 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14021 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14022 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14023 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14024 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14025 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14026 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14027 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14028 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14029 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14030 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14031 tracepoint as the current one.
14032
14033 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14034 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14035 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14036 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14037 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14038
14039 @smallexample
14040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14042 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14043 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14044 > tfind
14045 > end
14046
14047 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14048 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14049 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14050 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14051 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14052 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14053 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14054 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14055 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14056 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14057 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14058 @end smallexample
14059
14060 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14061 the buffer:
14062
14063 @smallexample
14064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14065 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14066 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14067 > tfind line
14068 > end
14069
14070 Frame 0, X = 1
14071 Frame 7, X = 2
14072 Frame 13, X = 255
14073 @end smallexample
14074
14075 @node tdump
14076 @subsection @code{tdump}
14077 @kindex tdump
14078 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14079 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14080
14081 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14082 the current trace snapshot.
14083
14084 @smallexample
14085 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14086 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14087 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14088 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14089 > end
14090
14091 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14092
14093 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14094 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14095 at gdb_test.c:444
14096 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14097
14098 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14099 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14100 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14101 d1 0x18 24
14102 d2 0x80 128
14103 d3 0x33 51
14104 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14105 d5 0x22 34
14106 d6 0xe0 224
14107 d7 0x380035 3670069
14108 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14109 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14110 a2 0x100 256
14111 a3 0x322000 3284992
14112 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14113 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14114 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14115 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14116 ps 0x0 0
14117 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14118 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14119 fpstatus 0x0 0
14120 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14121 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14122 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14123 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14124 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14125 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14126 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14127 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14128 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14129
14130 (@value{GDBP})
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14134 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14135 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14136 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14137
14138 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14139 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14140 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14141 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14142 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14143 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14144 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14145 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14146 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14147 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14148
14149 @node save tracepoints
14150 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14151 @kindex save tracepoints
14152 @kindex save-tracepoints
14153 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14154
14155 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14156 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14157 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14158 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14159 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14160 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14161
14162 @node Tracepoint Variables
14163 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14164 @cindex tracepoint variables
14165 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14166
14167 @table @code
14168 @vindex $trace_frame
14169 @item (int) $trace_frame
14170 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14171 snapshot is selected.
14172
14173 @vindex $tracepoint
14174 @item (int) $tracepoint
14175 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14176
14177 @vindex $trace_line
14178 @item (int) $trace_line
14179 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14180
14181 @vindex $trace_file
14182 @item (char []) $trace_file
14183 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14184
14185 @vindex $trace_func
14186 @item (char []) $trace_func
14187 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14188 @end table
14189
14190 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14191 use @code{output} instead.
14192
14193 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14194 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14195 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14196 which are managed by the target.
14197
14198 @smallexample
14199 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14200
14201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14202 > output $trace_file
14203 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14204 > tfind
14205 > end
14206 @end smallexample
14207
14208 @node Trace Files
14209 @section Using Trace Files
14210 @cindex trace files
14211
14212 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14213 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14214 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14215 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14216 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14217
14218 @table @code
14219
14220 @kindex tsave
14221 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14222 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14223 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14224 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14225 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14226 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14227 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14228 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14229 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14230 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14231 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14232 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14233 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14234 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14235 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14236
14237 @kindex target tfile
14238 @kindex tfile
14239 @kindex target ctf
14240 @kindex ctf
14241 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14242 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14243 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14244 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14245 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14246 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14247 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14248 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14249 the host.
14250
14251 @smallexample
14252 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14253 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14254 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14255 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14256 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14257 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14258 i = 0
14259 a = 0
14260 b = 1 '\001'
14261 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14262 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14263 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14264 $1 = 1
14265 @end smallexample
14266
14267 @end table
14268
14269 @node Overlays
14270 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14271 @cindex overlays
14272
14273 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14274 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14275 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14276 use overlays.
14277
14278 @menu
14279 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14280 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14281 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14282 mapped by asking the inferior.
14283 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @node How Overlays Work
14287 @section How Overlays Work
14288 @cindex mapped overlays
14289 @cindex unmapped overlays
14290 @cindex load address, overlay's
14291 @cindex mapped address
14292 @cindex overlay area
14293
14294 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14295 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14296 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14297 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14298 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14299
14300 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14301 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14302 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14303 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14304 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14305 largest overlay as well.
14306
14307 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14308 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14309 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14310 there.
14311
14312 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14313 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14314 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14315
14316 @smallexample
14317 @group
14318 Data Instruction Larger
14319 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14320 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14321 | | | | | |
14322 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14323 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14324 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14325 | and heap | | | | | |
14326 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14327 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14328 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14329 | | | | | |
14330 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14331 address | | | | | |
14332 | overlay | <-' | | |
14333 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14334 | | <---. | | load address
14335 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14336 | | | |
14337 +-----------+ | |
14338 +-----------+
14339 | |
14340 +-----------+
14341
14342 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14343 @end group
14344 @end smallexample
14345
14346 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14347 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14348 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14349 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14350 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14351 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14352 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14353 program and the overlay area.
14354
14355 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14356 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14357 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14358 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14359 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14360 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14361 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14362
14363 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14364 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14365 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14366
14367 @itemize @bullet
14368
14369 @item
14370 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14371 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14372 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14373 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14374
14375 @item
14376 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14377 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14378 your program's performance.
14379
14380 @item
14381 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14382 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14383 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14384 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14385 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14386 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14387 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14388
14389 @item
14390 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14391 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14392 instruction and data spaces.
14393
14394 @end itemize
14395
14396 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14397 improved in many ways:
14398
14399 @itemize @bullet
14400
14401 @item
14402 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14403 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14404 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14405 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14406 area in the usual way.
14407
14408 @item
14409 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14410 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14411
14412 @item
14413 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14414 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14415 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14416 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14417 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14418 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14419 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14420
14421 @end itemize
14422
14423
14424 @node Overlay Commands
14425 @section Overlay Commands
14426
14427 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14428 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14429 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14430 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14431 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14432 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14433
14434 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14435 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14436
14437 @table @code
14438 @item overlay off
14439 @kindex overlay
14440 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14441 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14442 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14443 overlay support is disabled.
14444
14445 @item overlay manual
14446 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14447 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14448 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14449 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14450 commands described below.
14451
14452 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14453 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14454 @cindex map an overlay
14455 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14456 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14457 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14458 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14459 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14460 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14461
14462 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14463 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14464 @cindex unmap an overlay
14465 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14466 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14467 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14468 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14469
14470 @item overlay auto
14471 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14472 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14473 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14474 Overlay Debugging}.
14475
14476 @item overlay load-target
14477 @itemx overlay load
14478 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14479 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14480 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14481 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14482 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14483 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14484
14485 @item overlay list-overlays
14486 @itemx overlay list
14487 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14488 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14489 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14490
14491 @end table
14492
14493 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14494 of the function the address falls in:
14495
14496 @smallexample
14497 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14498 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14499 @end smallexample
14500 @noindent
14501 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14502 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14503 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14504 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14505
14506 @smallexample
14507 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14508 No sections are mapped.
14509 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14510 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14511 @end smallexample
14512 @noindent
14513 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14514 name normally:
14515
14516 @smallexample
14517 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14518 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14519 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14520 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14521 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14522 @end smallexample
14523
14524 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14525 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14526 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14527 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14528 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14529
14530 @itemize @bullet
14531 @item
14532 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14533 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14534 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14535 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14536 @item
14537 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14538 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14539 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14540 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14541 breakpoints properly.
14542 @end itemize
14543
14544
14545 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14546 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14547 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14548
14549 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14550 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14551 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14552 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14553 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14554 current state of the overlays.
14555
14556 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14557 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14558
14559 @table @asis
14560
14561 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14562 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14563
14564 @smallexample
14565 struct
14566 @{
14567 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14568 unsigned long vma;
14569
14570 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14571 unsigned long size;
14572
14573 /* The overlay's load address. */
14574 unsigned long lma;
14575
14576 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14577 zero otherwise. */
14578 unsigned long mapped;
14579 @}
14580 @end smallexample
14581
14582 @item @code{_novlys}:
14583 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14584 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14585
14586 @end table
14587
14588 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14589 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14590 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14591 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14592 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14593 currently mapped.
14594
14595 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14596 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14597 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14598 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14599 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14600 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14601 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14602 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14603 are not being executed.
14604
14605 @node Overlay Sample Program
14606 @section Overlay Sample Program
14607 @cindex overlay example program
14608
14609 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14610 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14611 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14612 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14613 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14614 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14615 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14616
14617 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14618 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14619 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14620 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14621
14622 @table @file
14623 @item overlays.c
14624 The main program file.
14625 @item ovlymgr.c
14626 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14627 @item foo.c
14628 @itemx bar.c
14629 @itemx baz.c
14630 @itemx grbx.c
14631 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14632 @item d10v.ld
14633 @itemx m32r.ld
14634 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14635 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14636 @end table
14637
14638 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14639 cross-compiler like this:
14640
14641 @smallexample
14642 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14643 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14644 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14645 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14646 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14647 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14648 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14649 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14650 @end smallexample
14651
14652 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14653 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14654 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14655
14656
14657 @node Languages
14658 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14659 @cindex languages
14660
14661 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14662 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14663 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14664 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14665 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14666 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14667
14668 @cindex working language
14669 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14670 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14671 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14672 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14673 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14674 language}.
14675
14676 @menu
14677 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14678 * Show:: Displaying the language
14679 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14680 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14681 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14682 @end menu
14683
14684 @node Setting
14685 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14686
14687 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14688 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14689 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14690 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14691 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14692 are printed, etc.
14693
14694 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14695 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14696 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14697 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14698 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14699 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14700 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14701 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14702 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14703 Displaying the Language}.
14704
14705 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14706 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14707 another language. In that case, make the
14708 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14709 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14710 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14711
14712 @menu
14713 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14714 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14715 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14716 @end menu
14717
14718 @node Filenames
14719 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14720
14721 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14722 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14723
14724 @table @file
14725 @item .ada
14726 @itemx .ads
14727 @itemx .adb
14728 @itemx .a
14729 Ada source file.
14730
14731 @item .c
14732 C source file
14733
14734 @item .C
14735 @itemx .cc
14736 @itemx .cp
14737 @itemx .cpp
14738 @itemx .cxx
14739 @itemx .c++
14740 C@t{++} source file
14741
14742 @item .d
14743 D source file
14744
14745 @item .m
14746 Objective-C source file
14747
14748 @item .f
14749 @itemx .F
14750 Fortran source file
14751
14752 @item .mod
14753 Modula-2 source file
14754
14755 @item .s
14756 @itemx .S
14757 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14758 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14759 @end table
14760
14761 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14762 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14763
14764 @node Manually
14765 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14766
14767 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14768 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14769 your program.
14770
14771 @kindex set language
14772 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14773 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14774 a language, such as
14775 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14776 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14777
14778 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14779 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14780 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14781 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14782 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14783 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14784 command such as:
14785
14786 @smallexample
14787 print a = b + c
14788 @end smallexample
14789
14790 @noindent
14791 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14792 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14793 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14794 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14795
14796 @node Automatically
14797 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14798
14799 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14800 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14801 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14802 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14803 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14804 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14805 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14806 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14807 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14808
14809 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14810 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14811 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14812 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14813 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14814
14815 @node Show
14816 @section Displaying the Language
14817
14818 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14819 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14820
14821 @table @code
14822 @item show language
14823 @anchor{show language}
14824 @kindex show language
14825 Display the current working language. This is the
14826 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14827 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14828
14829 @item info frame
14830 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14831 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14832 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14833 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14834 information listed here.
14835
14836 @item info source
14837 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14838 Display the source language of this source file.
14839 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14840 information listed here.
14841 @end table
14842
14843 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14844 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14845 with a language explicitly:
14846
14847 @table @code
14848 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14849 @kindex set extension-language
14850 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14851 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14852
14853 @item info extensions
14854 @kindex info extensions
14855 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14856 @end table
14857
14858 @node Checks
14859 @section Type and Range Checking
14860
14861 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14862 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14863 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14864 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14865 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14866 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14867 errors when your program is running.
14868
14869 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14870 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14871 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14872 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14873
14874 @menu
14875 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14876 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14877 @end menu
14878
14879 @cindex type checking
14880 @cindex checks, type
14881 @node Type Checking
14882 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14883
14884 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14885 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14886 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14887 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14888
14889 @smallexample
14890 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14891
14892 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14893 $1 = 2
14894 @exdent but
14895 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14896 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14897 @end smallexample
14898
14899 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14900 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14901
14902 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14903 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14904 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14905 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14906 expressions like the second example above.
14907
14908 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14909 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14910 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14911 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14912 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14913 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14914
14915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14916
14917 @kindex set check type
14918 @kindex show check type
14919 @table @code
14920 @item set check type on
14921 @itemx set check type off
14922 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14923 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14924 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14925
14926 @item show check type
14927 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14928 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14929 @end table
14930
14931 @cindex range checking
14932 @cindex checks, range
14933 @node Range Checking
14934 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14935
14936 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14937 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14938 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14939 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14940 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14941
14942 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14943 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14944 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14945 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14946
14947 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14948 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14949 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14950 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14951 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14952 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14953
14954 @smallexample
14955 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14956 @end smallexample
14957
14958 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14959 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14960 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14961
14962 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14963
14964 @kindex set check range
14965 @kindex show check range
14966 @table @code
14967 @item set check range auto
14968 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14969 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14970 each language.
14971
14972 @item set check range on
14973 @itemx set check range off
14974 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14975 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14976 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14977 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14978
14979 @item set check range warn
14980 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14981 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14982 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14983 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14984 systems).
14985
14986 @item show range
14987 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14988 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @node Supported Languages
14992 @section Supported Languages
14993
14994 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14995 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14996 @c This is false ...
14997 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14998 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14999 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15000 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15001 language.
15002
15003 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15004 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15005 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15006 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15007 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15008 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15009 language reference or tutorial.
15010
15011 @menu
15012 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15013 * D:: D
15014 * Go:: Go
15015 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15016 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15017 * Fortran:: Fortran
15018 * Pascal:: Pascal
15019 * Rust:: Rust
15020 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15021 * Ada:: Ada
15022 @end menu
15023
15024 @node C
15025 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15026
15027 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15028 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15029
15030 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15031 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15032 together.
15033
15034 @cindex C@t{++}
15035 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15036 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15037 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15038 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15039 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15040 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15041 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15042
15043 @menu
15044 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15045 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15046 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15047 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15048 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15049 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15050 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15051 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15052 @end menu
15053
15054 @node C Operators
15055 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15056
15057 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15058
15059 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15060 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15061 often defined on groups of types.
15062
15063 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15064
15065 @itemize @bullet
15066
15067 @item
15068 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15069 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15070
15071 @item
15072 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15073 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15074
15075 @item
15076 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15077
15078 @item
15079 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15080
15081 @end itemize
15082
15083 @noindent
15084 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15085 in order of increasing precedence:
15086
15087 @table @code
15088 @item ,
15089 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15090 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15091 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15092
15093 @item =
15094 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15095 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15096
15097 @item @var{op}=
15098 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15099 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15100 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15101 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15102 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15103
15104 @item ?:
15105 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15106 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15107 should be of an integral type.
15108
15109 @item ||
15110 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15111
15112 @item &&
15113 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15114
15115 @item |
15116 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15117
15118 @item ^
15119 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15120
15121 @item &
15122 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15123
15124 @item ==@r{, }!=
15125 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15126 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15127
15128 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15129 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15130 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15131 and non-zero for true.
15132
15133 @item <<@r{, }>>
15134 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15135
15136 @item @@
15137 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15138
15139 @item +@r{, }-
15140 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15141 pointer types.
15142
15143 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15144 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15145 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15146 integral types.
15147
15148 @item ++@r{, }--
15149 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15150 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15151 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15152 operation takes place.
15153
15154 @item *
15155 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15156 @code{++}.
15157
15158 @item &
15159 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15160
15161 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15162 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15163 to examine the address
15164 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15165 stored.
15166
15167 @item -
15168 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15169 precedence as @code{++}.
15170
15171 @item !
15172 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15173 @code{++}.
15174
15175 @item ~
15176 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15177 @code{++}.
15178
15179
15180 @item .@r{, }->
15181 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15182 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15183 pointer based on the stored type information.
15184 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15185
15186 @item .*@r{, }->*
15187 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15188
15189 @item []
15190 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15191 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15192
15193 @item ()
15194 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15195
15196 @item ::
15197 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15198 and @code{class} types.
15199
15200 @item ::
15201 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15202 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15203 above.
15204 @end table
15205
15206 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15207 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15208 predefined meaning.
15209
15210 @node C Constants
15211 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15212
15213 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15214
15215 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15216 following ways:
15217
15218 @itemize @bullet
15219 @item
15220 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15221 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15222 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15223 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15224 @code{long} value.
15225
15226 @item
15227 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15228 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15229 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15230 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15231 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15232 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15233 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15234 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15235 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15236 constant.
15237
15238 @item
15239 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15240 integral equivalents.
15241
15242 @item
15243 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15244 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15245 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15246 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15247 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15248 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15249 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15250 @samp{\n} for newline.
15251
15252 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15253 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15254 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15255 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15256
15257 @item
15258 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15259 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15260 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15261 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15262 characters.
15263
15264 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15265 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15266 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15267
15268 @item
15269 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15270 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15271
15272 @item
15273 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15274 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15275 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15276 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15277 @end itemize
15278
15279 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15280 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15281
15282 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15283 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15284
15285 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15286 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15287 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15288 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15289 @quotation
15290 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15291 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15292 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15293 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15294 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15295 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15296 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15297 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15298 @end quotation
15299
15300 @enumerate
15301
15302 @cindex member functions
15303 @item
15304 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15305
15306 @smallexample
15307 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15308 @end smallexample
15309
15310 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15311 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15312 @item
15313 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15314 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15315 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15316 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15317 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15318
15319 @cindex call overloaded functions
15320 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15321 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15322 @item
15323 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15324 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15325 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15326 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15327 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15328 default arguments.
15329
15330 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15331 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15332 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15333 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15334 number of function arguments.
15335
15336 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15337 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15338 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15339
15340 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15341 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15342 @smallexample
15343 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15344 @end smallexample
15345
15346 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15347 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15348
15349 @cindex reference declarations
15350 @item
15351 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15352 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15353 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15354
15355 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15356 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15357 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15358 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15359 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15360
15361 @item
15362 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15363 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15364 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15365 necessary, for example in an expression like
15366 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15367 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15368 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15369
15370 @item
15371 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15372 specification.
15373 @end enumerate
15374
15375 @node C Defaults
15376 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15377
15378 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15379
15380 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15381 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15382 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15383 selects the working language.
15384
15385 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15386 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15387 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15388 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15389 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15390 for further details.
15391
15392 @node C Checks
15393 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15394
15395 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15396
15397 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15398 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15399 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15400 constants to pointers.
15401
15402 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15403 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15404 that is not itself an array.
15405
15406 @node Debugging C
15407 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15408
15409 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15410 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15411 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15412 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15413
15414 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15415 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15416 ,Expressions}.
15417
15418 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15419 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15420
15421 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15422
15423 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15424 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15425
15426 @table @code
15427 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15428 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15429 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15430 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15431 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15432 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15433
15434 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15435 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15436 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15437 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15438 classes.
15439 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15440
15441 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15442 @item catch throw
15443 @itemx catch rethrow
15444 @itemx catch catch
15445 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15446 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15447
15448 @cindex inheritance
15449 @item ptype @var{typename}
15450 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15451 @var{typename}.
15452 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15453
15454 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15455 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15456 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15457 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15458 multiple inheritance is in use.
15459
15460 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15461 @item demangle @var{name}
15462 Demangle @var{name}.
15463 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15464
15465 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15466 @item set print demangle
15467 @itemx show print demangle
15468 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15469 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15470 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15471 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15472 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15473
15474 @item set print object
15475 @itemx show print object
15476 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15477 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15478
15479 @item set print vtbl
15480 @itemx show print vtbl
15481 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15482 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15483 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15484 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15485
15486 @kindex set overload-resolution
15487 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15488 @item set overload-resolution on
15489 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15490 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15491 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15492 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15493 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15494 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15495
15496 @item set overload-resolution off
15497 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15498 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15499 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15500 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15501 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15502 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15503 argument types.
15504
15505 @kindex show overload-resolution
15506 @item show overload-resolution
15507 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15508
15509 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15510 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15511 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15512 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15513 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15514 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15515 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15516
15517 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15518
15519 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15520 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15521 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15522 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15523 for more detail.
15524
15525 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15526 function that returns a std::string:
15527
15528 @smallexample
15529 std::string function(int);
15530 @end smallexample
15531
15532 @noindent
15533 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15534 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15535
15536 @smallexample
15537 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15538 @end smallexample
15539
15540 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15541 tag. For example:
15542
15543 @smallexample
15544 (gdb) b function(int)
15545 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15546 (gdb) info breakpoints
15547 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15548 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15549 at main.cc:10
15550 @end smallexample
15551
15552 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15553 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15554 name, like:
15555
15556 @smallexample
15557 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15558 @end smallexample
15559 @end table
15560
15561 @node Decimal Floating Point
15562 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15563 @cindex decimal floating point format
15564
15565 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15566 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15567 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15568 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15569
15570 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15571 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15572 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15573 configured target.
15574
15575 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15576 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15577 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15578
15579 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15580 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15581 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15582
15583 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15584 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15585 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15586
15587 @node D
15588 @subsection D
15589
15590 @cindex D
15591 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15592 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15593 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15594
15595 @node Go
15596 @subsection Go
15597
15598 @cindex Go (programming language)
15599 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15600 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15601
15602 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15603
15604 @table @code
15605 @cindex current Go package
15606 @item The current Go package
15607 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15608 specifying global variables and functions.
15609
15610 For example, given the program:
15611
15612 @example
15613 package main
15614 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15615 func main () @{
15616 // ...
15617 @}
15618 @end example
15619
15620 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15621
15622 @example
15623 (gdb) p myglob
15624 (gdb) p main.myglob
15625 @end example
15626
15627 @cindex builtin Go types
15628 @item Builtin Go types
15629 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15630 as a string.
15631
15632 @cindex builtin Go functions
15633 @item Builtin Go functions
15634 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15635 function and handles it internally.
15636
15637 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15638 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15639 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15640 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15641 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15642 @end table
15643
15644 @node Objective-C
15645 @subsection Objective-C
15646
15647 @cindex Objective-C
15648 This section provides information about some commands and command
15649 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15650 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15651 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15652
15653 @menu
15654 * Method Names in Commands::
15655 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15656 @end menu
15657
15658 @node Method Names in Commands
15659 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15660
15661 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15662 names as line specifications:
15663
15664 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15665 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15666 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15667 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15668 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15669 @itemize
15670 @item @code{clear}
15671 @item @code{break}
15672 @item @code{info line}
15673 @item @code{jump}
15674 @item @code{list}
15675 @end itemize
15676
15677 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15678
15679 @smallexample
15680 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15681 @end smallexample
15682
15683 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15684 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15685 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15686 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15687 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15688 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15689 debugged, enter:
15690
15691 @smallexample
15692 break -[Fruit create]
15693 @end smallexample
15694
15695 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15696 enter:
15697
15698 @smallexample
15699 list +[NSText initialize]
15700 @end smallexample
15701
15702 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15703 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15704 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15705 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15706
15707 @smallexample
15708 break create
15709 @end smallexample
15710
15711 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15712 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15713 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15714 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15715 none apply.
15716
15717 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15718 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15719
15720 @smallexample
15721 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15722 @end smallexample
15723
15724 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15725 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15726 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15727 @kindex print-object
15728 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15729
15730 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15731
15732 @smallexample
15733 print -[@var{object} hash]
15734 @end smallexample
15735
15736 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15737 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15738 @noindent
15739 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15740 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15741 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15742 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15743 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15744 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15745
15746 @node OpenCL C
15747 @subsection OpenCL C
15748
15749 @cindex OpenCL C
15750 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15751
15752 @menu
15753 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15754 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15755 * OpenCL C Operators::
15756 @end menu
15757
15758 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15759 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15760
15761 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15762 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15763 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15764 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15765 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15766
15767 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15768 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15769
15770 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15771 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15772 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15773 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15774
15775 @node OpenCL C Operators
15776 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15777
15778 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15779 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15780 vector data types.
15781
15782 @node Fortran
15783 @subsection Fortran
15784 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15785
15786 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15787 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15788
15789 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15790 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15791 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15792 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15793 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15794 underscore.
15795
15796 @menu
15797 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15798 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15799 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15800 @end menu
15801
15802 @node Fortran Operators
15803 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15804
15805 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15806
15807 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15808 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15809 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15810
15811 @table @code
15812 @item **
15813 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15814 of the second one.
15815
15816 @item :
15817 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15818 represent a section of array.
15819
15820 @item %
15821 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15822 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15823 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15824 union type.
15825 @end table
15826
15827 @node Fortran Defaults
15828 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15829
15830 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15831
15832 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15833 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15834 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15835 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15836
15837 @node Special Fortran Commands
15838 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15839
15840 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15841
15842 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15843 such as displaying common blocks.
15844
15845 @table @code
15846 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15847 @kindex info common
15848 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15849 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15850 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15851 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15852 printed.
15853 @end table
15854
15855 @node Pascal
15856 @subsection Pascal
15857
15858 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15859 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15860 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15861 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15862 syntax.
15863
15864 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15865 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15866 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15867
15868 @node Rust
15869 @subsection Rust
15870
15871 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15872 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15873 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15874 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15875
15876 @itemize @bullet
15877 @item
15878 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15879 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15880 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15881
15882 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15883 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15884 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15885 @samp{B}.
15886
15887 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15888 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15889
15890 @item
15891 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15892 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15893 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15894 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15895 @samp{K::x::y}.
15896
15897 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15898 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15899 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15900 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15901 scope.
15902
15903 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15904 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15905
15906 @item
15907 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15908 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15909
15910 @item
15911 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15912
15913 @item
15914 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15915 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15916 never be destroyed.
15917
15918 @item
15919 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15920 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15921 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15922
15923 @item
15924 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15925 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15926 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15927 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15928 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15929 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15930 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15931 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15932
15933 @item
15934 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15935 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15936 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15937 @itemize @bullet
15938
15939 @item
15940 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15941
15942 @item
15943 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15944
15945 @item
15946 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15947 type names.
15948
15949 @item
15950 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15951
15952 @item
15953 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15954 available in the crate.
15955 @end itemize
15956 @end itemize
15957
15958 @node Modula-2
15959 @subsection Modula-2
15960
15961 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15962
15963 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15964 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15965 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15966 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15967 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15968 table.
15969
15970 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15971 @menu
15972 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15973 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15974 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15975 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15976 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15977 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15978 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15979 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15980 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15981 @end menu
15982
15983 @node M2 Operators
15984 @subsubsection Operators
15985 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15986
15987 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15988 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15989 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15990 following definitions hold:
15991
15992 @itemize @bullet
15993
15994 @item
15995 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15996 their subranges.
15997
15998 @item
15999 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16000
16001 @item
16002 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16003
16004 @item
16005 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16006 @var{type}}.
16007
16008 @item
16009 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16010
16011 @item
16012 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16013
16014 @item
16015 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16016 @end itemize
16017
16018 @noindent
16019 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16020 increasing precedence:
16021
16022 @table @code
16023 @item ,
16024 Function argument or array index separator.
16025
16026 @item :=
16027 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16028 @var{value}.
16029
16030 @item <@r{, }>
16031 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16032 types.
16033
16034 @item <=@r{, }>=
16035 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16036 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16037 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16038
16039 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16040 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16041 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16042 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16043 comment character.
16044
16045 @item IN
16046 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16047 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16048
16049 @item OR
16050 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16051
16052 @item AND@r{, }&
16053 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16054
16055 @item @@
16056 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16057
16058 @item +@r{, }-
16059 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16060 and difference on set types.
16061
16062 @item *
16063 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16064 on set types.
16065
16066 @item /
16067 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16068 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16069
16070 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16071 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16072 precedence as @code{*}.
16073
16074 @item -
16075 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16076
16077 @item ^
16078 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16079
16080 @item NOT
16081 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16082 @code{^}.
16083
16084 @item .
16085 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16086 precedence as @code{^}.
16087
16088 @item []
16089 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16090
16091 @item ()
16092 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16093 as @code{^}.
16094
16095 @item ::@r{, }.
16096 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16097 @end table
16098
16099 @quotation
16100 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16101 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16102 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16103 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16104 @end quotation
16105
16106
16107 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16108 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16109 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16110
16111 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16112 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16113
16114 @table @var
16115
16116 @item a
16117 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16118
16119 @item c
16120 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16121
16122 @item i
16123 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16124
16125 @item m
16126 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16127 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16128 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16129
16130 @item n
16131 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16132
16133 @item r
16134 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16135
16136 @item t
16137 represents a type.
16138
16139 @item v
16140 represents a variable.
16141
16142 @item x
16143 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16144 explanation of the function for details.
16145 @end table
16146
16147 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16148
16149 @table @code
16150 @item ABS(@var{n})
16151 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16152
16153 @item CAP(@var{c})
16154 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16155 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16156
16157 @item CHR(@var{i})
16158 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16159
16160 @item DEC(@var{v})
16161 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16162
16163 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16164 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16165 new value.
16166
16167 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16168 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16169 set.
16170
16171 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16172 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16173
16174 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16175 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16176
16177 @item INC(@var{v})
16178 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16179
16180 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16181 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16182 new value.
16183
16184 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16185 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16186 there. Returns the new set.
16187
16188 @item MAX(@var{t})
16189 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16190
16191 @item MIN(@var{t})
16192 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16193
16194 @item ODD(@var{i})
16195 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16196
16197 @item ORD(@var{x})
16198 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16199 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16200 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16201 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16202
16203 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16204 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16205 variable or a type.
16206
16207 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16208 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16209
16210 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16211 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16212 variable or a type.
16213
16214 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16215 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16216 @end table
16217
16218 @quotation
16219 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16220 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16221 an error.
16222 @end quotation
16223
16224 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16225 @node M2 Constants
16226 @subsubsection Constants
16227
16228 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16229 ways:
16230
16231 @itemize @bullet
16232
16233 @item
16234 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16235 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16236 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16237 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16238
16239 @item
16240 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16241 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16242 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16243 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16244 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16245 digits.
16246
16247 @item
16248 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16249 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16250 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16251 followed by a @samp{C}.
16252
16253 @item
16254 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16255 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16256 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16257 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16258 sequences.
16259
16260 @item
16261 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16262
16263 @item
16264 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16265 @code{FALSE}.
16266
16267 @item
16268 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16269
16270 @item
16271 Set constants are not yet supported.
16272 @end itemize
16273
16274 @node M2 Types
16275 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16276 @cindex Modula-2 types
16277
16278 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16279 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16280 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16281 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16282 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16283 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16284
16285 The first example contains the following section of code:
16286
16287 @smallexample
16288 VAR
16289 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16290 r: [20..40] ;
16291 @end smallexample
16292
16293 @noindent
16294 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16295 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16299 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16300 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16301 SET OF CHAR
16302 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16303 21
16304 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16305 [20..40]
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308 @noindent
16309 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 VAR
16313 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16314 @end smallexample
16315
16316 @noindent
16317 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16318
16319 @smallexample
16320 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16321 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16322 @end smallexample
16323
16324 @noindent
16325 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16326 expressions using the debugger.
16327
16328 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16329 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16330
16331 @smallexample
16332 VAR
16333 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @smallexample
16337 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16338 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16339 @end smallexample
16340
16341 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16342 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16343 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16344 above.
16345
16346 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 TYPE
16350 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16351 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16352 VAR
16353 s: t ;
16354 BEGIN
16355 s := blue ;
16356 @end smallexample
16357
16358 @noindent
16359 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16360 and value of a variable.
16361
16362 @smallexample
16363 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16364 $1 = blue
16365 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16366 type = [blue..yellow]
16367 @end smallexample
16368
16369 @noindent
16370 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16371 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16372 their @code{C} counterparts.
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 VAR
16376 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16377 BEGIN
16378 s[1] := 1 ;
16379 @end smallexample
16380
16381 @smallexample
16382 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16383 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16384 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16385 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16386 @end smallexample
16387
16388 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16389 pointer types as shown in this example:
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 VAR
16393 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16394 BEGIN
16395 NEW(s) ;
16396 s^[1] := 1 ;
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 @noindent
16400 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16404 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16405 @end smallexample
16406
16407 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16408 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16409 types:
16410
16411 @smallexample
16412 TYPE
16413 foo = RECORD
16414 f1: CARDINAL ;
16415 f2: CHAR ;
16416 f3: myarray ;
16417 END ;
16418
16419 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16420 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16421 VAR
16422 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16423 @end smallexample
16424
16425 @noindent
16426 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16427 below.
16428
16429 @smallexample
16430 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16431 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16432 f1 : CARDINAL;
16433 f2 : CHAR;
16434 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16435 END
16436 @end smallexample
16437
16438 @node M2 Defaults
16439 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16440 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16441
16442 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16443 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16444 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16445 selected the working language.
16446
16447 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16448 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16449 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16450 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16451
16452 @node Deviations
16453 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16454 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16455
16456 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16457 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16458
16459 @itemize @bullet
16460 @item
16461 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16462 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16463 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16464 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16465 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16466 returned a pointer.)
16467
16468 @item
16469 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16470 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16471 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16472 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16473
16474 @item
16475 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16476 argument.
16477
16478 @item
16479 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16480 @end itemize
16481
16482 @node M2 Checks
16483 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16484 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16485
16486 @quotation
16487 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16488 range checking.
16489 @end quotation
16490 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16491
16492 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16493
16494 @itemize @bullet
16495 @item
16496 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16497 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16498
16499 @item
16500 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16501 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16502 @end itemize
16503
16504 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16505 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16506
16507 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16508 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16509
16510 @node M2 Scope
16511 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16512 @cindex scope
16513 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16514 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16515 @ifinfo
16516 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16517 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16518 @end ifinfo
16519 @ifnotinfo
16520 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16521 @end ifnotinfo
16522
16523 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16524 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16525 similar syntax:
16526
16527 @smallexample
16528
16529 @var{module} . @var{id}
16530 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16531 @end smallexample
16532
16533 @noindent
16534 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16535 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16536 identifier within your program, except another module.
16537
16538 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16539 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16540 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16541 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16542
16543 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16544 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16545 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16546 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16547 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16548 @var{module}.
16549
16550 @node GDB/M2
16551 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16552
16553 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16554 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16555 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16556 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16557 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16558 analogue in Modula-2.
16559
16560 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16561 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16562 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16563 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16564 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16565 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16566
16567 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16568 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16569 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16570
16571 @node Ada
16572 @subsection Ada
16573 @cindex Ada
16574
16575 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16576 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16577 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16578 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16579 to be difficult.
16580
16581
16582 @cindex expressions in Ada
16583 @menu
16584 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16585 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16586 in @value{GDBN}.
16587 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16588 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16589 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16590 subprograms.
16591 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16592 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16593 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16594 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16595 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16596 Profile
16597 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16598 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16599 @end menu
16600
16601 @node Ada Mode Intro
16602 @subsubsection Introduction
16603 @cindex Ada mode, general
16604
16605 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16606 syntax, with some extensions.
16607 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16608
16609 @itemize @bullet
16610 @item
16611 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16612 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16613 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16614 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16615
16616 @item
16617 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16618 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16619
16620 @item
16621 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16622 @end itemize
16623
16624 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16625 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16626 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16627 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16628 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16629
16630 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16631 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16632 was translated from an Ada source file.
16633
16634 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16635 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16636 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16637 middle (to allow based literals).
16638
16639 @node Omissions from Ada
16640 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16641 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16642
16643 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16644
16645 @itemize @bullet
16646 @item
16647 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16648
16649 @itemize @minus
16650 @item
16651 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16652 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16653
16654 @item
16655 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16656
16657 @item
16658 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16659
16660 @item
16661 @t{'Tag}.
16662
16663 @item
16664 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16665 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16666
16667 @item
16668 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16669 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16670
16671 @item
16672 @t{'Address}.
16673 @end itemize
16674
16675 @item
16676 The names in
16677 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16678 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16679 not currently available.
16680
16681 @item
16682 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16683 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16684 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16685 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16686 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16687 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16688 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16689 indeterminate values.
16690
16691 @item
16692 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16693 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16694 are not implemented.
16695
16696 @item
16697 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16698 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16699 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16700 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16701 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16702
16703 @smallexample
16704 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16705 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16706 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16707 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16708 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16709 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16710 @end smallexample
16711
16712 Changing a
16713 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16714 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16715 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16716 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16717 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16718 declared to have a type such as:
16719
16720 @smallexample
16721 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16722 Id : Integer;
16723 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16724 end record;
16725 @end smallexample
16726
16727 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16728 assignments:
16729
16730 @smallexample
16731 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16732 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16733 @end smallexample
16734
16735 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16736 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16737 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16738 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16739 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16740 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16741 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16742 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16743
16744 @item
16745 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16746
16747 @item
16748 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16749 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16750 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16751 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16752 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16753 the proper resolution.
16754
16755 @item
16756 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16757
16758 @item
16759 Entry calls are not implemented.
16760
16761 @item
16762 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16763 formats are not supported.
16764
16765 @item
16766 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16767
16768 @item
16769 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16770 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16771 context.
16772 Should your program
16773 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16774 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16775 @end itemize
16776
16777 @node Additions to Ada
16778 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16779 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16780
16781 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16782 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16783
16784 @itemize @bullet
16785 @item
16786 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16787 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16788 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16789 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16790 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16791 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16792 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16793 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16794
16795 @item
16796 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16797 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16798 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16799
16800 @item
16801 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16802 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16803
16804 @item
16805 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16806 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16807 @end itemize
16808
16809 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16810 additions specific to Ada:
16811
16812 @itemize @bullet
16813 @item
16814 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16815 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16816
16817 @smallexample
16818 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16819 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16820 @end smallexample
16821
16822 @item
16823 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16824 the value of its right-hand operand.
16825 This allows, for example,
16826 complex conditional breaks:
16827
16828 @smallexample
16829 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16830 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16831 @end smallexample
16832
16833 @item
16834 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16835 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16836 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16837 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16838 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16839 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16840 in strings. For example,
16841 @smallexample
16842 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16843 @end smallexample
16844 @noindent
16845 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16846 after each period.
16847
16848 @item
16849 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16850 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16851 to write
16852
16853 @smallexample
16854 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16855 @end smallexample
16856
16857 @item
16858 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16859 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16860 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16861 of 3 might print as
16862
16863 @smallexample
16864 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16865 @end smallexample
16866
16867 @noindent
16868 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16869 clause.
16870
16871 @item
16872 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16873 multi-character subsequence of
16874 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16875 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16876 in place of @t{a'length}.
16877
16878 @item
16879 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16880 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16881 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16882 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16883 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16884 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16885 For example,
16886 @smallexample
16887 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16888 @end smallexample
16889
16890 @item
16891 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16892 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16893 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16894 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16895 object.
16896
16897 @end itemize
16898
16899 @node Overloading support for Ada
16900 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16901 @cindex overloading, Ada
16902
16903 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16904 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16905 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16906 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16907 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16908 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16909
16910 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16911 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16912 use, for instance:
16913
16914 @smallexample
16915 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16916 Multiple matches for f
16917 [0] cancel
16918 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16919 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16920 >
16921 @end smallexample
16922
16923 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16924 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16925 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16926
16927 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16928 case:
16929
16930 @table @code
16931
16932 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16933 @item set ada print-signatures
16934 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16935 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16936 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16937
16938 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16939 @item show ada print-signatures
16940 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16941 overloads selection menu.
16942 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16943
16944 @end table
16945
16946 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16947 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16948
16949 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16950 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16951 before reaching the main procedure.
16952 As defined in the Ada Reference
16953 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16954 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16955 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16956 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16957
16958 @node Ada Exceptions
16959 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16960
16961 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16962
16963 @table @code
16964 @kindex info exceptions
16965 @item info exceptions
16966 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16967 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16968 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16969 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16970 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16971 @end table
16972
16973 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16974 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16975 argument.
16976
16977 @smallexample
16978 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16979 All defined Ada exceptions:
16980 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16981 program_error: 0x613d20
16982 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16983 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16984 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16985 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16986 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16987 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16988 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16989 @end smallexample
16990
16991 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16992 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16993
16994 @node Ada Tasks
16995 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16996 @cindex Ada, tasking
16997
16998 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16999 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17000
17001 @table @code
17002 @kindex info tasks
17003 @item info tasks
17004 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17005
17006
17007 @smallexample
17008 @iftex
17009 @leftskip=0.5cm
17010 @end iftex
17011 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17012 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17013 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17014 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17015 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17016 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17017
17018 @end smallexample
17019
17020 @noindent
17021 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17022 task currently being inspected.
17023
17024 @table @asis
17025 @item ID
17026 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17027
17028 @item TID
17029 The Ada task ID.
17030
17031 @item P-ID
17032 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17033
17034 @item Pri
17035 The base priority of the task.
17036
17037 @item State
17038 Current state of the task.
17039
17040 @table @code
17041 @item Unactivated
17042 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17043 executing.
17044
17045 @item Runnable
17046 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17047 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17048
17049 @item Terminated
17050 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17051 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17052 terminated themselves.
17053
17054 @item Child Activation Wait
17055 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17056
17057 @item Accept Statement
17058 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17059
17060 @item Waiting on entry call
17061 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17062
17063 @item Async Select Wait
17064 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17065 select statement.
17066
17067 @item Delay Sleep
17068 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17069 alternative open.
17070
17071 @item Child Termination Wait
17072 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17073 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17074 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17075
17076 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17077 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17078 finish terminating.
17079
17080 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17081 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17082 @end table
17083
17084 @item Name
17085 Name of the task in the program.
17086
17087 @end table
17088
17089 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17090 @item info task @var{taskno}
17091 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17092 the following example:
17093 @smallexample
17094 @iftex
17095 @leftskip=0.5cm
17096 @end iftex
17097 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17098 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17099 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17100 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17101 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17102 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17103 Name: task_1
17104 Thread: 0x807f378
17105 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17106 Base Priority: 15
17107 State: Runnable
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @item task
17111 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17112 @cindex current Ada task ID
17113 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @iftex
17117 @leftskip=0.5cm
17118 @end iftex
17119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17121 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17122 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17123 (@value{GDBP}) task
17124 [Current task is 2]
17125 @end smallexample
17126
17127 @item task @var{taskno}
17128 @cindex Ada task switching
17129 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17130 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17131 from the current task to the given task.
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 @iftex
17135 @leftskip=0.5cm
17136 @end iftex
17137 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17138 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17139 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17140 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17141 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17142 [Switching to task 1]
17143 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17144 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17145 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17146 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17147 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17148 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17149 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17150 @end smallexample
17151
17152 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17153 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17154 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17155 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17156 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17157 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17158 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17159 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17160 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17161
17162 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17163 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17164 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17165 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17166 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17167
17168 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17169 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17170 program.
17171
17172 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17173 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17174 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17175
17176 For example,
17177
17178 @smallexample
17179 @iftex
17180 @leftskip=0.5cm
17181 @end iftex
17182 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17183 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17184 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17185 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17186 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17187 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17188 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17189 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17190 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17191 Continuing.
17192 task # 1 running
17193 task # 2 running
17194
17195 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17196 15 flush;
17197 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17198 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17199 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17200 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17201 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17202 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17203 @end smallexample
17204 @end table
17205
17206 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17207 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17208 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17209
17210 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17211 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17212 the platform being used.
17213 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17214 switching is not supported.
17215
17216 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17217 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17218 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17219 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17220 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17221 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17222
17223 @node Ravenscar Profile
17224 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17225 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17226
17227 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17228 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17229 requirements.
17230
17231 @table @code
17232 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17233 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17234 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17235 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17236 Profile. This is the default.
17237
17238 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17239 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17240 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17241 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17242 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17243 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17244 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17245
17246 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17247 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17248 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17249 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17250
17251 @end table
17252
17253 @node Ada Settings
17254 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17255 @cindex Ada settings
17256
17257 @table @code
17258 @kindex set varsize-limit
17259 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17260 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17261 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17262 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17263 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17264 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17265 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17266
17267 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17268 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17269 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17270 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17271 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17272 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17273 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17274 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17275 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17276 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17277 size is less than @var{size}.
17278
17279 @kindex show varsize-limit
17280 @item show varsize-limit
17281 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17282 @end table
17283
17284 @node Ada Glitches
17285 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17286 @cindex Ada, problems
17287
17288 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17289 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17290 @value{GDBN},
17291 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17292 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17293
17294 @itemize @bullet
17295 @item
17296 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17297 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17298
17299 @item
17300 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17301 argument lists are treated as positional).
17302
17303 @item
17304 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17305
17306 @item
17307 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17308 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17309 the host machine.
17310
17311 @item
17312 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17313 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17314 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17315 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17316 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17317 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17318 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17319 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17320 you can usually resolve the confusion
17321 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17322 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17323 @end itemize
17324
17325 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17326 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17327 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17328 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17329 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17330 enabled.
17331
17332 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17333 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17334 @table @code
17335
17336 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17337 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17338 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17339 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17340 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17341 This is the default.
17342
17343 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17344 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17345 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17346 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17347 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17348 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17349 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17350
17351 @end table
17352
17353 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17354 @cindex GNAT encoding
17355 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17356 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17357 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17358 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17359 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17360 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17361
17362 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17363 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17364 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17365 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17366 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17367 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17368 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17369 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17370
17371 @table @code
17372
17373 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17374 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17375 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17376 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17377
17378 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17379 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17380 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17381
17382 @end table
17383
17384 @node Unsupported Languages
17385 @section Unsupported Languages
17386
17387 @cindex unsupported languages
17388 @cindex minimal language
17389 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17390 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17391 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17392 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17393 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17394 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17395
17396 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17397 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17398 language.
17399
17400 @node Symbols
17401 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17402
17403 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17404 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17405 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17406 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17407 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17408 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17409 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17410
17411 @cindex symbol names
17412 @cindex names of symbols
17413 @cindex quoting names
17414 @anchor{quoting names}
17415 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17416 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17417 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17418 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17419 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17420 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17421 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17422 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17423
17424 @smallexample
17425 p 'foo.c'::x
17426 @end smallexample
17427
17428 @noindent
17429 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17430
17431 @table @code
17432 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17433 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17434 @kindex set case-sensitive
17435 @item set case-sensitive on
17436 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17437 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17438 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17439 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17440 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17441 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17442 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17443 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17444 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17445 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17446 case-insensitive matches.
17447
17448 @kindex show case-sensitive
17449 @item show case-sensitive
17450 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17451 lookups.
17452
17453 @kindex set print type methods
17454 @item set print type methods
17455 @itemx set print type methods on
17456 @itemx set print type methods off
17457 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17458 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17459 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17460 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17461 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17462 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17463
17464 @kindex show print type methods
17465 @item show print type methods
17466 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17467 classes.
17468
17469 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17470 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17471 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17472 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17473 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17474 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17475 types defined in classes.
17476
17477 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17478 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17479 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17480 printing classes.
17481
17482 @kindex set print type typedefs
17483 @item set print type typedefs
17484 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17485 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17486
17487 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17488 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17489 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17490 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17491 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17492 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17493 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17494 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17495 types.
17496
17497 @kindex show print type typedefs
17498 @item show print type typedefs
17499 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17500 printing classes.
17501
17502 @kindex info address
17503 @cindex address of a symbol
17504 @item info address @var{symbol}
17505 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17506 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17507 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17508 is always stored.
17509
17510 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17511 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17512 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17513
17514 @kindex info symbol
17515 @cindex symbol from address
17516 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17517 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17518 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17519 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17520 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17521
17522 @smallexample
17523 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17524 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17525 @end smallexample
17526
17527 @noindent
17528 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17529 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17530
17531 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17532 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17533
17534 @smallexample
17535 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17536 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17537 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17538 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 @kindex demangle
17542 @cindex demangle
17543 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17544 Demangle @var{name}.
17545 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17546 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17547
17548 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17549 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17550
17551 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17552 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17553
17554 @kindex whatis
17555 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17556 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17557 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17558 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17559
17560 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17561 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17562 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17563
17564 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17565 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17566 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17567 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17568 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17569 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17570 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17571 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17572 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17573
17574 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17575 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17576 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17577 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17578 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17579 unroll it.
17580
17581 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17582 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17583 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17584
17585 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17586 Available flags are:
17587
17588 @table @code
17589 @item r
17590 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17591 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17592 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17593
17594 @item m
17595 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17596
17597 @item M
17598 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17599 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17600
17601 @item t
17602 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17603 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17604 names are substituted when printing other types.
17605
17606 @item T
17607 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17608 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17609
17610 @item o
17611 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17612 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17613
17614 For example, given the following declarations:
17615
17616 @smallexample
17617 struct tuv
17618 @{
17619 int a1;
17620 char *a2;
17621 int a3;
17622 @};
17623
17624 struct xyz
17625 @{
17626 int f1;
17627 char f2;
17628 void *f3;
17629 struct tuv f4;
17630 @};
17631
17632 union qwe
17633 @{
17634 struct tuv fff1;
17635 struct xyz fff2;
17636 @};
17637
17638 struct tyu
17639 @{
17640 int a1 : 1;
17641 int a2 : 3;
17642 int a3 : 23;
17643 char a4 : 2;
17644 int64_t a5;
17645 int a6 : 5;
17646 int64_t a7 : 3;
17647 @};
17648 @end smallexample
17649
17650 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17651
17652 @smallexample
17653 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17654 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17655 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17656 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17657 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17658 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17659
17660 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17661 @}
17662 @end smallexample
17663
17664 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17665 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17666 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17667 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17668 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17669 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17670 its fields.
17671
17672 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17673
17674 @smallexample
17675 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17676 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17677 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17678 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17679 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17680 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17681 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17682
17683 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17684 @} fff1;
17685 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17686 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17687 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17688 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17689 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17690 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17691 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17692 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17693 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17694 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17695
17696 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17697 @} f4;
17698
17699 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17700 @} fff2;
17701
17702 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17703 @}
17704 @end smallexample
17705
17706 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17707 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17708 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17709 of these structures' fields.
17710
17711 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17712 bitfields:
17713
17714 @smallexample
17715 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17716 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17717 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17718 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17719 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17720 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17721 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17722 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17723 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17724 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17725 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17726
17727 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17728 @}
17729 @end smallexample
17730
17731 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17732 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17733 @end table
17734
17735 @kindex ptype
17736 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17737 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17738 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17739 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17740
17741 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17742 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17743 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17744 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17745 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17746 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17747 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17748 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17749
17750 For example, for this variable declaration:
17751
17752 @smallexample
17753 typedef double real_t;
17754 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17755 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17756 complex_t var;
17757 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17758 @end smallexample
17759
17760 @noindent
17761 the two commands give this output:
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 @group
17765 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17766 type = complex_t
17767 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17768 type = struct complex @{
17769 real_t real;
17770 double imag;
17771 @}
17772 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17773 type = struct complex
17774 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17775 type = struct complex
17776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17777 type = struct complex @{
17778 real_t real;
17779 double imag;
17780 @}
17781 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17782 type = real_t *
17783 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17784 type = double *
17785 @end group
17786 @end smallexample
17787
17788 @noindent
17789 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17790 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17791
17792 @cindex incomplete type
17793 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17794 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17795 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17796 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17797 given these declarations:
17798
17799 @smallexample
17800 struct foo;
17801 struct foo *fooptr;
17802 @end smallexample
17803
17804 @noindent
17805 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17806
17807 @smallexample
17808 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17809 $1 = <incomplete type>
17810 @end smallexample
17811
17812 @noindent
17813 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17814 completely specified.
17815
17816 @cindex unknown type
17817 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17818 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17819 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17820 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17821 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17822 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17823 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17824 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17828 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17829 @end smallexample
17830
17831 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17832 of such variables.
17833
17834 @kindex info types
17835 @item info types @var{regexp}
17836 @itemx info types
17837 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17838 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17839 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17840 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17841 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17842 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17843 name is @code{value}.
17844
17845 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17846 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17847 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17848
17849 @kindex info type-printers
17850 @item info type-printers
17851 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17852 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17853 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17854 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17855 type printers.
17856
17857 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17858
17859 @kindex enable type-printer
17860 @kindex disable type-printer
17861 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17862 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17863 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17864
17865 @kindex info scope
17866 @cindex local variables
17867 @item info scope @var{location}
17868 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17869 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17870 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17871 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17872 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17873
17874 @smallexample
17875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17876 Scope for command_line_handler:
17877 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17878 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17879 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17880 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17881 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17882 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17883 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17884 @end smallexample
17885
17886 @noindent
17887 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17888 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17889 collect}.
17890
17891 @kindex info source
17892 @item info source
17893 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17894 the function containing the current point of execution:
17895 @itemize @bullet
17896 @item
17897 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17898 @item
17899 the directory it was compiled in,
17900 @item
17901 its length, in lines,
17902 @item
17903 which programming language it is written in,
17904 @item
17905 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17906 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17907 @item
17908 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17909 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17910 @item
17911 whether the debugging information includes information about
17912 preprocessor macros.
17913 @end itemize
17914
17915
17916 @kindex info sources
17917 @item info sources
17918 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17919 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17920 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17921
17922 @kindex info functions
17923 @item info functions
17924 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17925 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17926 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17927 number.
17928
17929 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17930 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17931 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17932 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17933 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17934 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17935 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17936 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17937
17938 @kindex info variables
17939 @item info variables
17940 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17941 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17942 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17943 their respective source line numbers.
17944
17945 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17946 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17947 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17948 @var{regexp}.
17949
17950 @kindex info classes
17951 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17952 @item info classes
17953 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17954 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17955 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17956 expression.
17957
17958 @kindex info selectors
17959 @item info selectors
17960 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17961 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17962 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17963 expression.
17964
17965 @ignore
17966 This was never implemented.
17967 @kindex info methods
17968 @item info methods
17969 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17970 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17971 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17972 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17973 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17974 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17975 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17976 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17977 @end ignore
17978
17979 @cindex opaque data types
17980 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17981 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17982 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17983 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17984 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17985 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17986 another source file. The default is on.
17987
17988 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17989 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17990
17991 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17992 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17993 is printed as follows:
17994 @smallexample
17995 @{<no data fields>@}
17996 @end smallexample
17997
17998 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17999 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18000 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18001
18002 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18003 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18004 @item set print symbol-loading
18005 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18006 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18007 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18008 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18009 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18010 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18011 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18012 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18013 can be annoying.
18014 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18015 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18016 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18017 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18018
18019 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18020 @item show print symbol-loading
18021 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18022 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18023
18024 @kindex maint print symbols
18025 @cindex symbol dump
18026 @kindex maint print psymbols
18027 @cindex partial symbol dump
18028 @kindex maint print msymbols
18029 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18030 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18031 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18032 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18033 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18034 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18035 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18036 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18037 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18038 that objfile.
18039 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18040 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18041 @code{main}.
18042 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18043 source file.
18044
18045 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18046 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18047 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18048 tables.
18049 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18050 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18051 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18052 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18053 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18054 ``ELF symbols''.
18055
18056 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18057 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18058
18059 @kindex maint info symtabs
18060 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18061 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18062 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18063 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18064 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18065 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18066 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18067
18068 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18069 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18070 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18071 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18072 structure in more detail. For example:
18073
18074 @smallexample
18075 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18076 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18077 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18078 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18079 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18080 readin no
18081 fullname (null)
18082 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18083 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18084 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18085 dependencies (none)
18086 @}
18087 @}
18088 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18089 (@value{GDBP})
18090 @end smallexample
18091 @noindent
18092 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18093 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18094 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18095 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18096 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18097
18098 @smallexample
18099 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18100 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18101 line 1574.
18102 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18103 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18104 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18105 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18106 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18107 dirname (null)
18108 fullname (null)
18109 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18110 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18111 debugformat DWARF 2
18112 @}
18113 @}
18114 (@value{GDBP})
18115 @end smallexample
18116
18117 @kindex maint info line-table
18118 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18119 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18120 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18121
18122 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18123 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18124 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18125
18126 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18127 @cindex symbol cache size
18128 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18129 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18130 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18131 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18132 with different sizes.
18133
18134 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18135 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18136 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18137
18138 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18139 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18140 @item maint print symbol-cache
18141 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18142 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18143
18144 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18145 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18146 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18147 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18148 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18149
18150 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18151 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18152 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18153 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18154 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18155 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18156
18157 @end table
18158
18159 @node Altering
18160 @chapter Altering Execution
18161
18162 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18163 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18164 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18165 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18166 program.
18167
18168 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18169 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18170 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18171
18172 @menu
18173 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18174 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18175 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18176 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18177 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18178 * Patching:: Patching your program
18179 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18180 @end menu
18181
18182 @node Assignment
18183 @section Assignment to Variables
18184
18185 @cindex assignment
18186 @cindex setting variables
18187 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18188 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18189
18190 @smallexample
18191 print x=4
18192 @end smallexample
18193
18194 @noindent
18195 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18196 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18197 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18198 information on operators in supported languages.
18199
18200 @kindex set variable
18201 @cindex variables, setting
18202 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18203 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18204 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18205 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18206 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18207
18208 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18209 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18210 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18211 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18212 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18213 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18214 command @code{set width}:
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18218 type = double
18219 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18220 $4 = 13
18221 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18222 Invalid syntax in expression.
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 @noindent
18226 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18227 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18231 @end smallexample
18232
18233 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18234 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18235 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18236 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18237 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18238 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18239
18240 @smallexample
18241 @group
18242 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18243 type = double
18244 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18245 $1 = 1
18246 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18247 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18248 $2 = 1
18249 (@value{GDBP}) r
18250 The program being debugged has been started already.
18251 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18252 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18253 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18254 Invalid bfd target.
18255 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18256 The current BFD target is "=4".
18257 @end group
18258 @end smallexample
18259
18260 @noindent
18261 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18262 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18263 @code{g}, use
18264
18265 @smallexample
18266 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18267 @end smallexample
18268
18269 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18270 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18271 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18272 same length or shorter.
18273 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18274 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18275
18276 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18277 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18278 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18279 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18280 and representation in memory), and
18281
18282 @smallexample
18283 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18284 @end smallexample
18285
18286 @noindent
18287 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18288
18289 @node Jumping
18290 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18291
18292 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18293 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18294 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @kindex jump
18298 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18299 @item jump @var{location}
18300 @itemx j @var{location}
18301 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18302 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18303 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18304 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18305 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18306
18307 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18308 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18309 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18310 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18311 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18312 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18313 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18314 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18315 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18316 @end table
18317
18318 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18319 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18320 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18321 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18322 example,
18323
18324 @smallexample
18325 set $pc = 0x485
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 @noindent
18329 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18330 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18331 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18332
18333 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18334 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18335 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18336 detail.
18337
18338 @c @group
18339 @node Signaling
18340 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18341 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18342
18343 @table @code
18344 @kindex signal
18345 @item signal @var{signal}
18346 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18347 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18348 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18349 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18350
18351 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18352 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18353 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18354 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18355 signal.
18356
18357 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18358 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18359 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18360 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18361 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18362 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18363 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18364 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18365
18366 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18367 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18368 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18369 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18370 passes the signal directly to your program.
18371
18372 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18373 after executing the command.
18374
18375 @kindex queue-signal
18376 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18377 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18378 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18379 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18380 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18381 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18382 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18383 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18384 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18385
18386 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18387 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18388 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18389 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18390 @code{continue} command.
18391
18392 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18393 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18394 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18395 (@pxref{Signals}).
18396 @end table
18397 @c @end group
18398
18399 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18400 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18401
18402 @node Returning
18403 @section Returning from a Function
18404
18405 @table @code
18406 @cindex returning from a function
18407 @kindex return
18408 @item return
18409 @itemx return @var{expression}
18410 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18411 command. If you give an
18412 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18413 value.
18414 @end table
18415
18416 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18417 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18418 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18419 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18420
18421 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18422 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18423 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18424 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18425 of functions.
18426
18427 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18428 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18429 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18430 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18431 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18432
18433 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18434 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18435 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18436 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18437 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18438 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18439 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18440 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18441 assignment into the right register(s).
18442
18443 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18444 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18445 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18446 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18447 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18448 into a @code{long long int}:
18449
18450 @smallexample
18451 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18452 29 return 31;
18453 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18454 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18455 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18456 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18457 (@value{GDBP})
18458 @end smallexample
18459
18460 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18461 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18462 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18463 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18464 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18465 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18466 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18467 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18468
18469 @smallexample
18470 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18471 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18472 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18473 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18474 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18475 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18476 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18477 (@value{GDBP})
18478 @end smallexample
18479
18480 @node Calling
18481 @section Calling Program Functions
18482
18483 @table @code
18484 @cindex calling functions
18485 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18486 @item print @var{expr}
18487 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18488 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18489 debugged.
18490
18491 @kindex call
18492 @item call @var{expr}
18493 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18494 returned values.
18495
18496 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18497 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18498 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18499 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18500 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18501 value history.
18502 @end table
18503
18504 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18505 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18506 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18507 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18508
18509 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18510 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18511 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18512 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18513 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18514 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18515 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18516 in that case is controlled by the
18517 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18518
18519 @table @code
18520 @item set unwindonsignal
18521 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18522 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18523 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18524 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18525 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18526 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18527 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18528 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18529 received.
18530
18531 @item show unwindonsignal
18532 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18533 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18534 @value{GDBN}.
18535
18536 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18537 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18538 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18539 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18540 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18541 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18542 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18543 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18544 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18545 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18546
18547 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18548 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18549 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18550 @value{GDBN}.
18551
18552 @end table
18553
18554 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18555
18556 @cindex no debug info functions
18557 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18558 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18559 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18560 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18561 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18562 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18563
18564 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18565 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18566 declared return type. For example:
18567
18568 @smallexample
18569 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18570 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18571 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18572 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18573 @end smallexample
18574
18575 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18576 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18577 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18578 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18579
18580 @smallexample
18581 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18582 @end smallexample
18583
18584 @noindent
18585 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18589 @end smallexample
18590
18591 @noindent
18592 these calls are equivalent:
18593
18594 @smallexample
18595 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18596 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18597 @end smallexample
18598
18599 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18600 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18601 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18602 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18603 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18604 float parameters, and no debug info:
18605
18606 @smallexample
18607 float
18608 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18609 float v1, v2;
18610 @{
18611 return v1 * v2;
18612 @}
18613 @end smallexample
18614
18615 @noindent
18616 you call it like this:
18617
18618 @smallexample
18619 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18620 @end smallexample
18621
18622 @node Patching
18623 @section Patching Programs
18624
18625 @cindex patching binaries
18626 @cindex writing into executables
18627 @cindex writing into corefiles
18628
18629 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18630 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18631 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18632 patching your program's binary.
18633
18634 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18635 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18636 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18637 repairs.
18638
18639 @table @code
18640 @kindex set write
18641 @item set write on
18642 @itemx set write off
18643 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18644 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18645 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18646
18647 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18648 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18649 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18650
18651 @item show write
18652 @kindex show write
18653 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18654 as well as reading.
18655 @end table
18656
18657 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18658 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18659 @cindex injecting code
18660 @cindex writing into executables
18661 @cindex compiling code
18662
18663 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18664 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18665 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18666 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @kindex compile code
18670 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18671 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18672 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18673 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18674 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18675 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18676 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18677 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18678 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18679 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18680 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18681 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18682
18683 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18684 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18685 E.g.:
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18689 @end smallexample
18690
18691 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18692 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18693 from actual source code. E.g.:
18694
18695 @smallexample
18696 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18697 @end smallexample
18698
18699 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18700 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18701 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18702 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18703 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18704 editor.
18705
18706 @smallexample
18707 compile code
18708 >printf ("hello\n");
18709 >printf ("world\n");
18710 >end
18711 @end smallexample
18712
18713 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18714 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18715 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18716 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18717 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18718 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18719 inferior symbols otherwise.
18720
18721 @kindex compile file
18722 @item compile file @var{filename}
18723 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18724 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18725
18726 @smallexample
18727 compile file /home/user/example.c
18728 @end smallexample
18729 @end table
18730
18731 @table @code
18732 @item compile print @var{expr}
18733 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18734 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18735 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18736 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18737 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18738 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18739 Formats}.
18740
18741 @item compile print
18742 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18743 @cindex reprint the last value
18744 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18745 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18746 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18747 multiple-line editor.
18748 @end table
18749
18750 @noindent
18751 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18752
18753 @table @code
18754 @anchor{set debug compile}
18755 @item set debug compile
18756 @cindex compile command debugging info
18757 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18758 injecting the code. The default is off.
18759
18760 @item show debug compile
18761 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18762 compiling and injecting the code.
18763
18764 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18765 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18766 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18767 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18768 The default is off.
18769
18770 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18771 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18772 C@t{++} type conversion.
18773 @end table
18774
18775 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18776
18777 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18778 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18779 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18780 injecting process.
18781
18782 @noindent
18783 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18784
18785 @table @asis
18786 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18787 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18788 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18789 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18790
18791 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18792 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18793 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18794 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18795 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18796 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18797 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18798 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18799
18800 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18801 @end table
18802
18803 @noindent
18804 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18805
18806 @table @code
18807 @item set compile-args
18808 @cindex compile command options override
18809 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18810 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18811 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18812 compilation.
18813
18814 @item show compile-args
18815 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18816 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18817 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18818 @end table
18819
18820 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18821
18822 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18823 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18824 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18825
18826 @table @asis
18827 @item C code examples and caveats
18828 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18829 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18830 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18831 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18832 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18833
18834 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18835 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18836 much like any other normal debugging session.
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 void function1 (void)
18840 @{
18841 int i = 42;
18842 printf ("function 1\n");
18843 @}
18844
18845 void function2 (void)
18846 @{
18847 int j = 12;
18848 function1 ();
18849 @}
18850
18851 int main(void)
18852 @{
18853 int k = 6;
18854 int *p;
18855 function2 ();
18856 return 0;
18857 @}
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18861 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18862 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18863
18864 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18865 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18866 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18867 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18868 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18869
18870 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18871 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18872 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18873 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18874 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18875 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18876 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18877 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18878 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18879 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18880
18881 @smallexample
18882 compile code k = 3;
18883 @end smallexample
18884
18885 @noindent
18886 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18887 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18888 @code{compile} command changes it.
18889
18890 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18891 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18892 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18893 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18894 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18895
18896 @smallexample
18897 compile code j = 3;
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 @noindent
18901 will result in a compilation error message.
18902
18903 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18904 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18905 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18906
18907 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18908 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18909 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18910 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18914 @end smallexample
18915
18916 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18917 command has completed:
18918
18919 @smallexample
18920 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18921 @end smallexample
18922
18923 @noindent
18924 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18925 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18926 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18927 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18928 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18929
18930 @smallexample
18931 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18932 @end smallexample
18933
18934 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18935 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18936 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18937 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18938 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18939 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18940 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18941 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18942
18943 @smallexample
18944 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18945 @end smallexample
18946
18947 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18948 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18949 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18950 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18951 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18952 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18953 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18954
18955 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18956 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18957 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18958 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18959 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18960 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18961
18962 @smallexample
18963 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18964 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18965 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18966 Compilation failed.
18967 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18968 42
18969 @end smallexample
18970
18971 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18972 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18973 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18974 will print to the console.
18975 @end table
18976
18977 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18978
18979 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18980 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18981 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18982 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18983 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18984 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18985 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18986 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18987
18988
18989 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18990 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18991 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18992 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18993 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18994 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18995 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18996
18997 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18998 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18999 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19000 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19001 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19002 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19003 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19004
19005 @table @code
19006 @item set compile-gcc
19007 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19008 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19009 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19010 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19011 default.
19012
19013 @item show compile-gcc
19014 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19015 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19016 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19017 @end table
19018
19019 @node GDB Files
19020 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19021
19022 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19023 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19024 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19025 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19026
19027 @menu
19028 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19029 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19030 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19031 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19032 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19033 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19034 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19035 @end menu
19036
19037 @node Files
19038 @section Commands to Specify Files
19039
19040 @cindex symbol table
19041 @cindex core dump file
19042
19043 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19044 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19045 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19046 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19047
19048 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19049 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19050 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19051 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19052 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19053 new files are useful.
19054
19055 @table @code
19056 @cindex executable file
19057 @kindex file
19058 @item file @var{filename}
19059 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19060 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19061 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19062 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19063 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19064 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19065 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19066 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19067
19068 @cindex unlinked object files
19069 @cindex patching object files
19070 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19071 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19072 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19073 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19074 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19075 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19076 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19077 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19078
19079 @item file
19080 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19081 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19082
19083 @kindex exec-file
19084 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19085 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19086 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19087 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19088 discard information on the executable file.
19089
19090 @kindex symbol-file
19091 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19092 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19093 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19094 table and program to run from the same file.
19095
19096 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19097 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19098 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19099 enabled.
19100
19101 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19102 program's symbol table.
19103
19104 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19105 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19106 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19107 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19108 @value{GDBN}.
19109
19110 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19111 executing it once.
19112
19113 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19114 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19115 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19116 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19117 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19118 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19119 optimized code.
19120
19121 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19122 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19123 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19124 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19125 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19126
19127 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19128 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19129 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19130 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19131 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19132 Warnings and Messages}.)
19133
19134 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19135 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19136 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19137 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19138 in stabs format.
19139
19140 @kindex readnow
19141 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19142 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19143 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19144 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19145 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19146 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19147 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19148 entire symbol table available.
19149
19150 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19151 @cindex never read symbols
19152 @cindex symbols, never read
19153 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19154 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19155 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19156 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19157 @xref{--readnever}.
19158
19159 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19160 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19161 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19162 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19163 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19164 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19165 @c files.
19166
19167 @kindex core-file
19168 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19169 @itemx core
19170 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19171 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19172 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19173 executable file itself for other parts.
19174
19175 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19176 to be used.
19177
19178 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19179 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19180 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19181 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19182 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19183
19184 @kindex add-symbol-file
19185 @cindex dynamic linking
19186 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19187 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19188 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19189 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19190 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19191 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19192 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19193 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19194 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19195 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19196 can be given as an expression.
19197
19198 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19199 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19200 specified explicitly.
19201
19202 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19203 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19204 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19205 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19206
19207 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19208
19209 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19210 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19211 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19212 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19213 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19214 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19215 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19216 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19217 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19218
19219 @itemize @bullet
19220 @item
19221 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19222 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19223 @item
19224 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19225 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19226 @item
19227 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19228 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19229 @end itemize
19230
19231 @noindent
19232 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19233 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19234 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19235 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19236 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19237 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19238 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19239 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19240 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19241 way.
19242
19243 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19244
19245 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19246 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19247 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19248 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19249 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19250 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19251
19252 @smallexample
19253 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19254 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19255 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19256 (y or n) y
19257 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19258 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19259 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19260 (gdb)
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263
19264 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19265
19266 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19267 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19268 @cindex load symbols from memory
19269 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19270 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19271 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19272 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19273 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19274 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19275 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19276 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19277 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19278
19279 @kindex section
19280 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19281 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19282 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19283 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19284 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19285 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19286 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19287 their addresses.
19288
19289 @kindex info files
19290 @kindex info target
19291 @item info files
19292 @itemx info target
19293 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19294 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19295 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19296 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19297 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19298 current ones.
19299
19300 @kindex maint info sections
19301 @item maint info sections
19302 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19303 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19304 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19305 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19306 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19307 may be arbitrarily combined):
19308
19309 @table @code
19310 @item ALLOBJ
19311 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19312 @item @var{sections}
19313 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19314 @item @var{section-flags}
19315 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19316 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19317 @table @code
19318 @item ALLOC
19319 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19320 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19321 @item LOAD
19322 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19323 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19324 @item RELOC
19325 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19326 @item READONLY
19327 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19328 @item CODE
19329 Section contains executable code only.
19330 @item DATA
19331 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19332 @item ROM
19333 Section will reside in ROM.
19334 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19335 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19336 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19337 Section is not empty.
19338 @item NEVER_LOAD
19339 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19340 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19341 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19342 COFF shared library information.
19343 @item IS_COMMON
19344 Section contains common symbols.
19345 @end table
19346 @end table
19347 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19348 @cindex read-only sections
19349 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19350 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19351 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19352 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19353 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19354 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19355 enhancement to debugging performance.
19356
19357 The default is off.
19358
19359 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19360 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19361 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19362 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19363
19364 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19365 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19366 @end table
19367
19368 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19369 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19370 name and remembers it that way.
19371
19372 @cindex shared libraries
19373 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19374 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19375 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19376 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19377
19378 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19379 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19380
19381 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19382 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19383 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19384 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19385 debugging a core file).
19386
19387 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19388 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19389 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19390
19391 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19392 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19393 particularly large or there are many of them.
19394
19395 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19396 commands:
19397
19398 @table @code
19399 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19400 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19401 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19402 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19403 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19404 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19405 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19406 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19407
19408 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19409 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19410 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19411 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19412 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19413 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19414 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19415 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19416 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19417
19418 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19419 @item show auto-solib-add
19420 Display the current autoloading mode.
19421 @end table
19422
19423 @cindex load shared library
19424 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19425 command:
19426
19427 @table @code
19428 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19429 @kindex info share
19430 @item info share @var{regex}
19431 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19432 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19433 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19434 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19435
19436 @kindex info dll
19437 @item info dll @var{regex}
19438 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19439
19440 @kindex sharedlibrary
19441 @kindex share
19442 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19443 @itemx share @var{regex}
19444 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19445 Unix regular expression.
19446 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19447 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19448 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19449 loaded.
19450
19451 @item nosharedlibrary
19452 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19453 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19454 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19455 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19456 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19457 discarded.
19458 @end table
19459
19460 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19461 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19462 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19463 Catchpoints}).
19464
19465 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19466 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19467 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19468 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19469
19470 @table @code
19471 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19472 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19473 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19474 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19475 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19476 shared library.
19477
19478 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19479 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19480 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19481 library events happen.
19482 @end table
19483
19484 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19485 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19486 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19487 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19488 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19489 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19490 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19491 not.
19492
19493 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19494 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19495 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19496 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19497 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19498
19499 @table @code
19500 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19501 @cindex system root, alternate
19502 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19503 @kindex set sysroot
19504 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19505 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19506 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19507 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19508 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19509 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19510 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19511 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19512 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19513 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19514 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19515 @var{path}.
19516
19517 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19518 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19519 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19520 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19521 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19522 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19523 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19524 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19525 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19526 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19527 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19528 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19529 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19530 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19531
19532 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19533 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19534 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19535 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19536 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19537
19538 @smallexample
19539 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19540 @end smallexample
19541
19542 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19543 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19544 system:
19545
19546 @smallexample
19547 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19548 @end smallexample
19549
19550 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19551 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19552 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19553 colons:
19554
19555 @smallexample
19556 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19557 @end smallexample
19558
19559 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19560 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19561 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19562 @samp{z}):
19563
19564 @smallexample
19565 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19566 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19567 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19568 @end smallexample
19569
19570 @noindent
19571 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19572 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19573 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19574
19575 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19576 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19577
19578 @smallexample
19579 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19580 @end smallexample
19581
19582 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19583 if you don't want or need to.
19584
19585 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19586 sysroot}.
19587
19588 @cindex default system root
19589 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19590 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19591 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19592 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19593 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19594 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19595 location.
19596
19597 @kindex show sysroot
19598 @item show sysroot
19599 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19600
19601 @kindex set solib-search-path
19602 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19603 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19604 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19605 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19606 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19607 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19608 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19609 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19610 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19611 of shared library symbols.
19612
19613 @kindex show solib-search-path
19614 @item show solib-search-path
19615 Display the current shared library search path.
19616
19617 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19618 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19619 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19620 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19621 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19622
19623 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19624 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19625 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19626 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19627 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19628 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19629 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19630 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19631 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19632 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19633 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19634 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19635 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19636 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19637 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19638 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19639 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19640 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19641 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19642 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19643 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19644 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19645
19646 @table @code
19647 @item unix
19648 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19649 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19650 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19651 the forward slash.
19652
19653 @item dos-based
19654 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19655 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19656 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19657 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19658 considered directory separators.
19659
19660 @item auto
19661 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19662 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19663 This is the default.
19664 @end table
19665 @end table
19666
19667 @cindex file name canonicalization
19668 @cindex base name differences
19669 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19670 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19671 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19672 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19673 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19674 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19675 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19676 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19677 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19678 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19679 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19680 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19681 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19682 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19683 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19684
19685 @table @code
19686 @item set basenames-may-differ
19687 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19688 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19689
19690 @item show basenames-may-differ
19691 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19692 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19693 @end table
19694
19695 @node File Caching
19696 @section File Caching
19697 @cindex caching of opened files
19698 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19699
19700 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19701 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19702 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19703 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19704
19705 @table @code
19706 @kindex maint info bfds
19707 @item maint info bfds
19708 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19709 @value{GDBN}.
19710
19711 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19712 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19713 @kindex bfd caching
19714 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19715 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19716 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19717 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19718 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19719 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19720 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19721 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19722 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19723
19724 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19725 @kindex bfd caching
19726 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19727 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19728
19729 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19730 @kindex bfd caching
19731 @item show debug bfd-cache
19732 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19733 @end table
19734
19735 @node Separate Debug Files
19736 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19737 @cindex separate debugging information files
19738 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19739 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19740 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19741 @cindex global debugging information directories
19742 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19743 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19744
19745 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19746 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19747 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19748 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19749 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19750 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19751 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19752
19753 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19754 file:
19755
19756 @itemize @bullet
19757 @item
19758 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19759 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19760 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19761 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19762 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19763 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19764 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19765 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19766
19767 @item
19768 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19769 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19770 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19771 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19772 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19773 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19774 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19775 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19776 below.
19777 @end itemize
19778
19779 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19780 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19781
19782 @itemize @bullet
19783 @item
19784 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19785 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19786 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19787 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19788 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19789
19790 @item
19791 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19792 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19793 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19794 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19795 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19796 hex characters, not 10.)
19797 @end itemize
19798
19799 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19800 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19801 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19802 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19803 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19804 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19805
19806 @itemize @minus
19807 @item
19808 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19809 @item
19810 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19811 @item
19812 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19813 @item
19814 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19815 @end itemize
19816
19817 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19818 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19819 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19820 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19821 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19822
19823 @table @code
19824
19825 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19826 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19827 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19828 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19829 concatenating them by a path separator.
19830
19831 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19832 @item show debug-file-directory
19833 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19834 information files.
19835
19836 @end table
19837
19838 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19839 @cindex debug link sections
19840 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19841 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19842
19843 @itemize
19844 @item
19845 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19846 a zero byte,
19847 @item
19848 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19849 boundary within the section, and
19850 @item
19851 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19852 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19853 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19854 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19855 @end itemize
19856
19857 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19858 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19859 described above.
19860
19861 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19862 @cindex build ID sections
19863 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19864 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19865 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19866 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19867 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19868 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19869 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19870 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19871 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19872
19873 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19874 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19875 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19876 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19877 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19878 in an ordinary executable.
19879
19880 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19881 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19882 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19883 following commands:
19884
19885 @smallexample
19886 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19887 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19888 @end smallexample
19889
19890 @noindent
19891 These commands remove the debugging
19892 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19893 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19894 two files:
19895
19896 @itemize @bullet
19897 @item
19898 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19899 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19900
19901 @smallexample
19902 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19903 @end smallexample
19904
19905 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19906 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19907 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19908 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19909
19910 @item
19911 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19912 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19913 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19914 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19915 @end itemize
19916
19917 @noindent
19918
19919 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19920 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19921 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19922
19923 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19924 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19925 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19926 @c different ways!
19927 @ifhtml
19928 @display
19929 @html
19930 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19931 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19932 @end html
19933 @end display
19934 @end ifhtml
19935 @ifnothtml
19936 @display
19937 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19938 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19939 @end display
19940 @end ifnothtml
19941
19942 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19943 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19944 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19945 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19946 CRC.
19947
19948 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19949 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19950 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19951 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19952 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19953
19954 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19955 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19956 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19957 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19958 @code{0xffffffff}.
19959
19960 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19961 @smallexample
19962 unsigned long
19963 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19964 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19965 @{
19966 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19967 @{
19968 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19969 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19970 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19971 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19972 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19973 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19974 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19975 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19976 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19977 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19978 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19979 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19980 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19981 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19982 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19983 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19984 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19985 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19986 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19987 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19988 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19989 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19990 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19991 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19992 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19993 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19994 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19995 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19996 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19997 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19998 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19999 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20000 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20001 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20002 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20003 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20004 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20005 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20006 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20007 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20008 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20009 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20010 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20011 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20012 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20013 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20014 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20015 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20016 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20017 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20018 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20019 0x2d02ef8d
20020 @};
20021 unsigned char *end;
20022
20023 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20024 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20025 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20026 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20027 @}
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 @noindent
20031 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20032
20033 @node MiniDebugInfo
20034 @section Debugging information in a special section
20035 @cindex separate debug sections
20036 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20037
20038 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20039 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20040 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20041 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20042
20043 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20044 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20045 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20046 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20047 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20048 debugging information might be included in the section.
20049
20050 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20051 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20052 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20053
20054 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20055 standard utilities:
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20059 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20060 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20061 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20062
20063 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20064 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20065 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20066 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20067 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20068 | sort > funcsyms
20069
20070 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20071 # table.
20072 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20073
20074 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20075 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20076
20077 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20078 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20079 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20080 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20081
20082 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20083 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20084
20085 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20086 # original binary.
20087 xz mini_debuginfo
20088 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20089 @end smallexample
20090
20091 @node Index Files
20092 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20093 @cindex index files
20094 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20095
20096 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20097 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20098 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20099 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20100 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20101 startup.
20102
20103 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20104 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20105 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20106
20107 @smallexample
20108 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20109 @end smallexample
20110
20111 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20112
20113 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20114 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20115
20116 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20117 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20118 using @command{objcopy}.
20119
20120 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20121
20122 @table @code
20123 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20124 @kindex save gdb-index
20125 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20126 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20127 default creates it produces a single file
20128 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20129 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20130 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20131 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20132 given @var{directory}.
20133 @end table
20134
20135 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20136 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20137
20138 @smallexample
20139 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20140 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20141 @end smallexample
20142
20143 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20144
20145 @smallexample
20146 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20147 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20148 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20149 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20150 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20151 @end smallexample
20152
20153 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20154 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20155 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20156 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20157 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20158 The default is @code{off}.
20159 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20160 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20161
20162 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20163 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20164
20165 @smallexample
20166 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20167 @end smallexample
20168
20169 Instead you must do, for example,
20170
20171 @smallexample
20172 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20173 @end smallexample
20174
20175 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20176 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20177 currently work for programs using Ada.
20178
20179 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20180
20181 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20182 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20183 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20184 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20185
20186 @table @code
20187
20188 @item set index-cache on
20189 @itemx set index-cache off
20190 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20191
20192 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20193 @itemx show index-cache directory
20194 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20195
20196 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20197 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20198 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20199 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20200 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20201 differ according to local convention.
20202
20203 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20204 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20205
20206 @item show index-cache stats
20207 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20208
20209 @end table
20210
20211 @node Symbol Errors
20212 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20213
20214 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20215 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20216 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20217 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20218 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20219 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20220 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20221 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20222 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20223 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20224 Messages}).
20225
20226 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20227
20228 @table @code
20229 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20230
20231 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20232 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20233 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20234 in its outer scope blocks.
20235
20236 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20237 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20238 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20239 function.
20240
20241 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20242
20243 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20244 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20245 do so.
20246
20247 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20248 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20249 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20250 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20251 Messages}.)
20252
20253 @item bad block start address patched
20254
20255 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20256 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20257 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20258
20259 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20260 starting on the previous source line.
20261
20262 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20263
20264 @cindex foo
20265 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20266 larger than the size of the string table.
20267
20268 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20269 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20270 with this name.
20271
20272 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20273
20274 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20275 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20276 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20277
20278 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20279 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20280 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20281 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20282 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20283 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20284
20285 @item stub type has NULL name
20286
20287 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20288
20289 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20290 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20291 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20292 it.
20293
20294 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20295
20296 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20297
20298 @end table
20299
20300 @node Data Files
20301 @section GDB Data Files
20302
20303 @cindex prefix for data files
20304 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20305 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20306
20307 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20308 is currently using.
20309
20310 @table @code
20311 @kindex set data-directory
20312 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20313 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20314 to @var{directory}.
20315
20316 @kindex show data-directory
20317 @item show data-directory
20318 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20319 @end table
20320
20321 @cindex default data directory
20322 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20323 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20324 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20325 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20326 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20327 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20328 location.
20329
20330 The data directory may also be specified with the
20331 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20332 @xref{Mode Options}.
20333
20334 @node Targets
20335 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20336
20337 @cindex debugging target
20338 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20339
20340 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20341 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20342 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20343 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20344 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20345 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20346 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20347 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20348
20349 @cindex target architecture
20350 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20351 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20352 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20353 command.
20354
20355 @table @code
20356 @kindex set architecture
20357 @kindex show architecture
20358 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20359 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20360 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20361 supported architectures.
20362
20363 @item show architecture
20364 Show the current target architecture.
20365
20366 @item set processor
20367 @itemx processor
20368 @kindex set processor
20369 @kindex show processor
20370 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20371 and @code{show architecture}.
20372 @end table
20373
20374 @menu
20375 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20376 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20377 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20378 @end menu
20379
20380 @node Active Targets
20381 @section Active Targets
20382
20383 @cindex stacking targets
20384 @cindex active targets
20385 @cindex multiple targets
20386
20387 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20388 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20389 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20390 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20391 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20392 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20393 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20394 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20395 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20396
20397 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20398 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20399 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20400 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20401
20402 @node Target Commands
20403 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20404
20405 @table @code
20406 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20407 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20408 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20409 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20410 protocol of the target machine.
20411
20412 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20413 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20414 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20415
20416 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20417 after executing the command.
20418
20419 @kindex help target
20420 @item help target
20421 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20422 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20423 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20424
20425 @item help target @var{name}
20426 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20427 select it.
20428
20429 @kindex set gnutarget
20430 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20431 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20432 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20433 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20434 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20435 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20436
20437 @quotation
20438 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20439 you must know the actual BFD name.
20440 @end quotation
20441
20442 @noindent
20443 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20444
20445 @kindex show gnutarget
20446 @item show gnutarget
20447 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20448 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20449 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20450 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20451 @end table
20452
20453 @cindex common targets
20454 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20455 configuration):
20456
20457 @table @code
20458 @kindex target
20459 @item target exec @var{program}
20460 @cindex executable file target
20461 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20462 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20463
20464 @item target core @var{filename}
20465 @cindex core dump file target
20466 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20467 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20468
20469 @item target remote @var{medium}
20470 @cindex remote target
20471 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20472 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20473 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20474
20475 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20476 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20477
20478 @smallexample
20479 target remote /dev/ttya
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20483 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20484 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20485 clobbered by the download.
20486
20487 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20488 @cindex built-in simulator target
20489 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20490 In general,
20491 @smallexample
20492 target sim
20493 load
20494 run
20495 @end smallexample
20496 @noindent
20497 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20498 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20499 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20500 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20501 Processors}.
20502
20503 @item target native
20504 @cindex native target
20505 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20506 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20507 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20508 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20509
20510 @end table
20511
20512 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20513 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20514
20515 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20516 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20517 various aspects of this process.
20518
20519 @table @code
20520
20521 @item set hash
20522 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20523 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20524 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20525 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20526 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20527 monitor.
20528
20529 @item show hash
20530 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20531 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20532
20533 @item set debug monitor
20534 @kindex set debug monitor
20535 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20536 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20537 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20538
20539 @item show debug monitor
20540 @kindex show debug monitor
20541 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20542 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20543 @end table
20544
20545 @table @code
20546
20547 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20548 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20549 @anchor{load}
20550 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20551 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20552 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20553 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20554 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20555 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20556
20557 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20558 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20559 target is @dots{}}''
20560
20561 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20562 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20563 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20564 specifies a fixed address.
20565 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20566
20567 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20568 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20569 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20570
20571 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20572 load programs into flash memory.
20573
20574 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20575 @end table
20576
20577 @table @code
20578
20579 @kindex flash-erase
20580 @item flash-erase
20581 @anchor{flash-erase}
20582
20583 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20584
20585 @end table
20586
20587 @node Byte Order
20588 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20589
20590 @cindex choosing target byte order
20591 @cindex target byte order
20592
20593 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20594 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20595 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20596 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20597 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20598 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20599
20600 @table @code
20601 @kindex set endian
20602 @item set endian big
20603 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20604
20605 @item set endian little
20606 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20607
20608 @item set endian auto
20609 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20610 executable.
20611
20612 @item show endian
20613 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20614
20615 @end table
20616
20617 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20618 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20619 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20620 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20621 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20622 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20623 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20624 and @code{big} otherwise.
20625
20626 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20627 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20628 target system.
20629
20630
20631 @node Remote Debugging
20632 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20633 @cindex remote debugging
20634
20635 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20636 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20637 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20638 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20639 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20640
20641 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20642 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20643 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20644 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20645 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20646 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20647
20648 Other remote targets may be available in your
20649 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20650
20651 @menu
20652 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20653 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20654 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20655 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20656 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20657 @end menu
20658
20659 @node Connecting
20660 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20661 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20662 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20663 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20664 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20665 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20666 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20667
20668 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20669 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20670 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20671 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20672
20673 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20674
20675 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20676 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20677 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20678 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20679
20680 @table @asis
20681
20682 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20683 @item Result of detach or program exit
20684 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20685 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20686 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20687
20688 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20689 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20690 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20691 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20692
20693 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20694 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20695 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20696 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20697
20698 @item Specifying the program to debug
20699 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20700 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20701 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20702 target.
20703
20704 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20705 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20706 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20707
20708 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20709 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20710 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20711 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20712
20713 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20714 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20715 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20716 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20717 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20718 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20719 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20720 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20721 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20722
20723 @item The @code{run} command
20724 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20725 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20726 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20727 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20728 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20729
20730 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20731 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20732 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20733 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20734 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20735
20736 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20737 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20738 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20739 @code{target remote} mode.
20740
20741 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20742 @item Attaching
20743 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20744 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20745 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20746
20747 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20748 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20749 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20750 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20751 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20752
20753 @end table
20754
20755 @anchor{Host and target files}
20756 @subsection Host and Target Files
20757 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20758 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20759
20760 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20761 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20762 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20763 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20764 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20765
20766 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20767 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20768 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20769 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20770 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20771
20772 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20773 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20774 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20775 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20776 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20777 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20778 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20779 target libraries.
20780
20781 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20782 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20783 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20784 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20785 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20786 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20787 programs.
20788
20789 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20790 @cindex remote connection commands
20791 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20792 local Unix domain socket, or
20793 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20794 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20795 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20796 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20797 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20798 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20799
20800 @table @code
20801
20802 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20803 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20804 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20805 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20806 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20807
20808 @smallexample
20809 target remote /dev/ttyb
20810 @end smallexample
20811
20812 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20813 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20814 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20815 @code{target} command.
20816
20817 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20818 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20819 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20820 @cindex Unix domain socket
20821 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20822 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20823
20824 @smallexample
20825 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20826 @end smallexample
20827
20828 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20829 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20830 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20831 of connection.
20832 The above command is identical to the command:
20833
20834 @smallexample
20835 target remote unix::/tmp/gdb-socket1
20836 @end smallexample
20837 @noindent
20838
20839 See below for the explanation of this syntax.
20840
20841 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20842 Unix domain sockets.
20843
20844 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20845 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20846 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20847 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20848 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20849 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20850 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20851 @itemx target remote @code{unix::@var{local-socket}}
20852 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20853 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20854 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20855 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20856 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20857 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20858 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20859 @itemx target extended-remote @code{unix::@var{local-socket}}
20860 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20861 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}
20862 or using the Unix domain socket @var{local-socket} on the local machine.
20863 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20864 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20865 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20866 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20867 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20868 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20869
20870 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20871 @code{manyfarms}:
20872
20873 @smallexample
20874 target remote manyfarms:2828
20875 @end smallexample
20876
20877 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20878 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20879 square bracket syntax:
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 @noindent
20886 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20887
20888 @smallexample
20889 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20890 @end smallexample
20891
20892 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20893 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20894 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20895 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20896 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20897 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20898
20899 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20900 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20901 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20902 port 1234 on your local machine:
20903
20904 @smallexample
20905 target remote :1234
20906 @end smallexample
20907 @noindent
20908
20909 Note that the colon is still required here.
20910 Alternatively you can use a Unix domain socket:
20911
20912 @smallexample
20913 target remote unix::/tmp/gdb-socket1
20914 @end smallexample
20915 @noindent
20916
20917 This has the advantage that it'll not fail if the port number is already
20918 in use.
20919
20920
20921 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20922 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20923 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20924 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20925 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20926 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20927 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20928 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20929 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20930 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20931 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20932 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20933 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20940 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20941 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20942 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20943
20944 @item target remote | @var{command}
20945 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20946 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20947 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20948 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20949 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20950 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20951 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20952 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20953 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20954
20955 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20956 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20957 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20958
20959 @end table
20960
20961 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20962 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20963 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20964 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20965 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20966 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20967 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20968
20969 @smallexample
20970 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20971 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20975 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20976 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20977 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20978
20979 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20980 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20981
20982 @table @code
20983 @kindex detach (remote)
20984 @item detach
20985 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20986 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20987 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20988 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20989 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20990 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20991 still connected to the target.
20992
20993 @kindex disconnect
20994 @item disconnect
20995 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20996 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20997 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20998 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20999 another target.
21000
21001 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21002 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21003 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21004 @kindex monitor
21005 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21006 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21007 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21008 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21009 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21010 and implement.
21011 @end table
21012
21013 @node File Transfer
21014 @section Sending files to a remote system
21015 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21016 @cindex file transfer
21017 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21018
21019 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21020 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21021 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21022 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21023 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21024 the only way to upload or download files.
21025
21026 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21027
21028 @table @code
21029 @kindex remote put
21030 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21031 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21032 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21033
21034 @kindex remote get
21035 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21036 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21037 on the host system.
21038
21039 @kindex remote delete
21040 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21041 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21042
21043 @end table
21044
21045 @node Server
21046 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21047
21048 @kindex gdbserver
21049 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21050 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21051 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21052 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21053 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21054
21055 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21056 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21057 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21058 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21059 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21060 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21061 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21062 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21063 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21064 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21065 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21066 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21067 choice for debugging.
21068
21069 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21070 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21071 protocol.
21072
21073 @quotation
21074 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21075 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21076 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21077 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21078 @code{gdbserver}.
21079 @end quotation
21080
21081 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21082 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21083 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21084 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21085
21086 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21087 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21088 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21089 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21090 system does all the symbol handling.
21091
21092 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21093 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21094 syntax is:
21095
21096 @smallexample
21097 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21098 @end smallexample
21099
21100 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21101 with it.
21102
21103 @var{comm} may take several forms:
21104
21105 @table @code
21106 @item @var{device}
21107 A serial line device.
21108
21109 @item -
21110 @itemx stdio
21111 To use the stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21112
21113 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21114 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21115 @file{/dev/com1}:
21116
21117 @smallexample
21118 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21119 @end smallexample
21120
21121 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21122 with ssh:
21123
21124 @smallexample
21125 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21126 @end smallexample
21127
21128 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21129 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21130 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21131 You could elide it if you want to.
21132
21133 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21134 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21135 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21136 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21137
21138 @item @var{host}:@var{port}
21139 @itemx tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}
21140 @itemx tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}
21141 To use a @acronym{TCP} @acronym{IPv4} socket connection on port number @var{port}.
21142
21143 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21144
21145 @smallexample
21146 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21147 @end smallexample
21148
21149 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21150 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21151 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21152 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21153 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21154 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21155 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21156 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21157 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21158 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21159 @code{target remote} command.
21160
21161
21162 @item tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}
21163 To use a @acronym{TCP} @acronym{IPv6} socket connection on port number @var{port}.
21164
21165 @item unix:@var{host}:@var{local-socket}
21166 To use a Unix domain socket. This will create a socket with the file
21167 system entry @var{local-socket} and listen on that. For example:
21168
21169 @smallexample
21170 target> gdbserver unix:localhost:/tmp/gdb-socket0 emacs foo.txt
21171 @end smallexample
21172
21173 @var{host} must either be the empty string or the literal string @code{localhost}.
21174 @end table
21175
21176
21177 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21178 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21179 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21180 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21181
21182 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21183 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21184
21185 @smallexample
21186 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21190 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21191
21192 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21193 @value{GDBN} attach command
21194 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21195
21196 @pindex pidof
21197 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21198 @code{pidof} utility:
21199
21200 @smallexample
21201 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21202 @end smallexample
21203
21204 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21205 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21206 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21207
21208 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21209
21210 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21211 port.
21212
21213 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21214 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21215 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21216 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21217 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21218 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21219 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21220 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21221
21222 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21223 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21224 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21225
21226 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21227 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21228 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21229 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21230 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21231 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21232 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21233 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21234 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21235 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21236 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21237 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21238
21239 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21240 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21241
21242 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21243 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21244 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21245 program. For more information,
21246 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21247
21248 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21249 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21250 status information about the debugging process.
21251 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21252 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21253 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21254 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21255
21256 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21257 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21258 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21259 Possible options are:
21260
21261 @table @code
21262 @item none
21263 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21264 @item all
21265 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21266 @item timestamps
21267 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21268 @end table
21269
21270 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21271 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21272
21273 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21274 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21275 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21276 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21277 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21278
21279 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21280 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21281 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21282 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21283
21284 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21285 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21286 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21287 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21288
21289 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21290 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21291 environment:
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21298 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21299
21300 @smallexample
21301 $ gdbserver --selftest
21302 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21303 @end smallexample
21304
21305 These tests are disabled in release.
21306 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21307
21308 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21309 @itemize
21310
21311 @item
21312 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21313
21314 @item
21315 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21316 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21317 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21318 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21319 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21320 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21321
21322 @item
21323 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21324 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21325 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21326 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21327 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21328 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21329 program is already on the target.
21330
21331 @end itemize
21332
21333 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21334 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21335 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21336
21337 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21338 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21339 Here are the available commands.
21340
21341 @table @code
21342 @item monitor help
21343 List the available monitor commands.
21344
21345 @item monitor set debug 0
21346 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21347 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21348
21349 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21350 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21351 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21352 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21353
21354 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21355 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21356 Possible options are:
21357
21358 @table @code
21359 @item none
21360 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21361 @item all
21362 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21363 @item timestamps
21364 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21365 @end table
21366
21367 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21368 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21369
21370 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21371 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21372 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21373 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21374 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21375 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21376
21377 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21378 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21379
21380 @item monitor exit
21381 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21382 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21383 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21384 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21385 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21386
21387 @end table
21388
21389 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21390 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21391
21392 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21393 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21394
21395 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21396 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21397 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21398 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21399 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21400 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21401 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21402 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21403 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21404 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21405 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21406 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21407
21408 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21409
21410 @table @code
21411 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21412
21413 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21414 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21415 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21416
21417 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21418
21419 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21420 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21421 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21422 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21423 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21424 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21425
21426 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21427
21428 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21429 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21430 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21431 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21432 command for that. For example:
21433
21434 @smallexample
21435 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21436 @end smallexample
21437
21438 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21439 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21440 @end table
21441
21442 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21443 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21444 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21445 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21446 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21447 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21448 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21449 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21450 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21451 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21452
21453 @smallexample
21454 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21455 @end smallexample
21456
21457 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21458
21459 @smallexample
21460 $ gdb myprogram
21461 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21462 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21463 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21464 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21465 @end smallexample
21466
21467 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21468 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21469 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21470 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21471 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21472 tracing.
21473
21474 @node Remote Configuration
21475 @section Remote Configuration
21476
21477 @kindex set remote
21478 @kindex show remote
21479 This section documents the configuration options available when
21480 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21481 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21482 system-call-allowed}.
21483
21484 @table @code
21485 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21486 @cindex address size for remote targets
21487 @cindex bits in remote address
21488 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21489 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21490 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21491 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21492
21493 @item show remoteaddresssize
21494 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21495
21496 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21497 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21498 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21499 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21500 remote targets.
21501
21502 @item show serial baud
21503 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21504
21505 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21506 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21507 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21508
21509 @item show serial parity
21510 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21511
21512 @item set remotebreak
21513 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21514 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21515 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21516 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21517 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21518 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21519 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21520 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21521
21522 @item show remotebreak
21523 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21524 interrupt the remote program.
21525
21526 @item set remoteflow on
21527 @itemx set remoteflow off
21528 @kindex set remoteflow
21529 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21530 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21531
21532 @item show remoteflow
21533 @kindex show remoteflow
21534 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21535
21536 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21537 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21538 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21539 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21540 @code{ascii}.
21541
21542 @item show remotelogbase
21543 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21544 protocol.
21545
21546 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21547 @cindex record serial communications on file
21548 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21549 default is not to record at all.
21550
21551 @item show remotelogfile.
21552 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21553 serial communications.
21554
21555 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21556 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21557 @cindex remote timeout
21558 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21559 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21560
21561 @item show remotetimeout
21562 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21563 responses.
21564
21565 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21566 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21567 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21568 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21569 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21570 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21571 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21572 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21573 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21574 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21575
21576 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21577 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21578 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21579 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21580
21581 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21582 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21583 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21584 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21585 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21586 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21587 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21588 length.
21589
21590 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21591 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21592 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21593
21594 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21595 @itemx show remote exec-file
21596 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21597 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21598 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21599 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21600 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21601 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21602
21603 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21604 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21605 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21606 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21607 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21608 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21609 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21610 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21611 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21612 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21613
21614 @item show interrupt-sequence
21615 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21616 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21617 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21618 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21619
21620 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21621 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21622 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21623 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21624 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21625 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21626
21627 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21628 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21629 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21630
21631 @kindex set tcp
21632 @kindex show tcp
21633 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21634 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21635 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21636 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21637 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21638 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21639 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21640 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21641 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21642
21643 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21644 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21645
21646 @item show tcp auto-retry
21647 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21648
21649 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21650 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21651 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21652 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21653 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21654 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21655 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21656 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21657 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21658 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21659 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21660
21661 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21662 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21663 @end table
21664
21665 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21666 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21667 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21668 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21669 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21670 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21671 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21672 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21673 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21674
21675 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21676 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21677 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21678 @value{GDBN} developers.
21679
21680 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21681 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21682 are:
21683
21684 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21685 @item Command Name
21686 @tab Remote Packet
21687 @tab Related Features
21688
21689 @item @code{fetch-register}
21690 @tab @code{p}
21691 @tab @code{info registers}
21692
21693 @item @code{set-register}
21694 @tab @code{P}
21695 @tab @code{set}
21696
21697 @item @code{binary-download}
21698 @tab @code{X}
21699 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21700
21701 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21702 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21703 @tab @code{info auxv}
21704
21705 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21706 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21707 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21708
21709 @item @code{attach}
21710 @tab @code{vAttach}
21711 @tab @code{attach}
21712
21713 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21714 @tab @code{vCont}
21715 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21716
21717 @item @code{run}
21718 @tab @code{vRun}
21719 @tab @code{run}
21720
21721 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21722 @tab @code{Z0}
21723 @tab @code{break}
21724
21725 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21726 @tab @code{Z1}
21727 @tab @code{hbreak}
21728
21729 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21730 @tab @code{Z2}
21731 @tab @code{watch}
21732
21733 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21734 @tab @code{Z3}
21735 @tab @code{rwatch}
21736
21737 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21738 @tab @code{Z4}
21739 @tab @code{awatch}
21740
21741 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21742 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21743 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21744
21745 @item @code{target-features}
21746 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21747 @tab @code{set architecture}
21748
21749 @item @code{library-info}
21750 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21751 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21752
21753 @item @code{memory-map}
21754 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21755 @tab @code{info mem}
21756
21757 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21758 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21759 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21760
21761 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21762 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21763 @tab @code{info spu}
21764
21765 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21766 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21767 @tab @code{info spu}
21768
21769 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21770 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21771 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21772
21773 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21774 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21775 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21776
21777 @item @code{threads}
21778 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21779 @tab @code{info threads}
21780
21781 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21782 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21783 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21784
21785 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21786 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21787 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21788
21789 @item @code{search-memory}
21790 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21791 @tab @code{find}
21792
21793 @item @code{supported-packets}
21794 @tab @code{qSupported}
21795 @tab Remote communications parameters
21796
21797 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21798 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21799 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21800
21801 @item @code{pass-signals}
21802 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21803 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21804
21805 @item @code{program-signals}
21806 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21807 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21808
21809 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21810 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21811 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21812
21813 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21814 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21815 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21816
21817 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21818 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21819 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21820
21821 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21822 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21823 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21824
21825 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21826 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21827 @tab @code{remote delete}
21828
21829 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21830 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21831 @tab Host I/O
21832
21833 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21834 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21835 @tab Host I/O
21836
21837 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21838 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21839 @tab Host I/O
21840
21841 @item @code{noack-packet}
21842 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21843 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21844
21845 @item @code{osdata}
21846 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21847 @tab @code{info os}
21848
21849 @item @code{query-attached}
21850 @tab @code{qAttached}
21851 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21852
21853 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21854 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21855 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21856
21857 @item @code{trace-status}
21858 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21859 @tab @code{tstatus}
21860
21861 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21862 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21863 @tab Traceframe info
21864
21865 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21866 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21867 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21868
21869 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21870 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21871 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21872
21873 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21874 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21875 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21876
21877 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21878 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21879 @tab @code{set environment}
21880
21881 @item @code{environment-unset}
21882 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21883 @tab @code{unset environment}
21884
21885 @item @code{environment-reset}
21886 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21887 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21888
21889 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21890 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21891 @tab @code{set cwd}
21892
21893 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21894 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21895 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21896
21897 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21898 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21899 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21900
21901 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21902 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21903 @tab @code{break}
21904
21905 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21906 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21907 @tab @code{hbreak}
21908
21909 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21910 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21911 @tab @code{fork}
21912
21913 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21914 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21915 @tab @code{vfork}
21916
21917 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21918 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21919 @tab @code{exec}
21920
21921 @item @code{thread-events}
21922 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21923 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21924
21925 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21926 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21927 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21928
21929 @end multitable
21930
21931 @node Remote Stub
21932 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21933
21934 @cindex debugging stub, example
21935 @cindex remote stub, example
21936 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21937 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21938 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21939 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21940 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21941 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21942 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21943 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21944
21945 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21946 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21947 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21948 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21949 program, you need:
21950
21951 @enumerate
21952 @item
21953 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21954 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21955 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21956
21957 @item
21958 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21959 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21960
21961 @item
21962 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21963 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21964 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21965 documentation.
21966 @end enumerate
21967
21968 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21969 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21970 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21971
21972 @table @emph
21973 @item On the host,
21974 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21975 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21976 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21977
21978 @item On the target,
21979 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21980 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21981 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21982
21983 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21984 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21985 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21986 @end table
21987
21988 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21989 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21990 @sc{sparc} boards.
21991
21992 @cindex remote serial stub list
21993 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21994
21995 @table @code
21996
21997 @item i386-stub.c
21998 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21999 @cindex Intel
22000 @cindex i386
22001 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22002
22003 @item m68k-stub.c
22004 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22005 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22006 @cindex m680x0
22007 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22008
22009 @item sh-stub.c
22010 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22011 @cindex Renesas
22012 @cindex SH
22013 For Renesas SH architectures.
22014
22015 @item sparc-stub.c
22016 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22017 @cindex Sparc
22018 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22019
22020 @item sparcl-stub.c
22021 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22022 @cindex Fujitsu
22023 @cindex SparcLite
22024 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22025
22026 @end table
22027
22028 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22029 recently added stubs.
22030
22031 @menu
22032 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22033 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22034 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22035 @end menu
22036
22037 @node Stub Contents
22038 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22039
22040 @cindex remote serial stub
22041 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22042 subroutines:
22043
22044 @table @code
22045 @item set_debug_traps
22046 @findex set_debug_traps
22047 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22048 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22049 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22050 program's startup code.
22051
22052 @item handle_exception
22053 @findex handle_exception
22054 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22055 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22056 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22057 run when a trap is triggered.
22058
22059 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22060 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22061 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22062 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22063 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22064 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22065 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22066 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22067 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22068 machine.
22069
22070 @item breakpoint
22071 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22072 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22073 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22074 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22075 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22076 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22077 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22078 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22079 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22080 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22081 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22082
22083 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22084 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22085 start of your debugging session.
22086 @end table
22087
22088 @node Bootstrapping
22089 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22090
22091 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22092 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22093 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22094 debugging target machine.
22095
22096 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22097 serial port.
22098
22099 @table @code
22100 @item int getDebugChar()
22101 @findex getDebugChar
22102 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22103 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22104 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22105
22106 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22107 @findex putDebugChar
22108 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22109 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22110 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22111 @end table
22112
22113 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22114 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22115 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22116 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22117 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22118 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22119 remote system to stop.
22120
22121 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22122 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22123 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22124 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22125
22126 Other routines you need to supply are:
22127
22128 @table @code
22129 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22130 @findex exceptionHandler
22131 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22132 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22133 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22134 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22135 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22136 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22137 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22138 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22139 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22140 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22141 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22142 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22143 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22144
22145 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22146 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22147 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22148 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22149 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22150
22151 @item void flush_i_cache()
22152 @findex flush_i_cache
22153 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22154 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22155 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22156
22157 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22158 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22159 @end table
22160
22161 @noindent
22162 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22163
22164 @table @code
22165 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22166 @findex memset
22167 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22168 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22169 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22170 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22171 @end table
22172
22173 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22174 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22175 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22176 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22177
22178
22179 @node Debug Session
22180 @subsection Putting it All Together
22181
22182 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22183 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22184 steps.
22185
22186 @enumerate
22187 @item
22188 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22189 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22190 @display
22191 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22192 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22193 @end display
22194
22195 @item
22196 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22197 procedure is called:
22198
22199 @smallexample
22200 set_debug_traps();
22201 breakpoint();
22202 @end smallexample
22203
22204 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22205 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22206 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22207 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22208 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22209 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22210 progress.
22211
22212 @item
22213 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22214 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22215
22216 @smallexample
22217 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22218 @end smallexample
22219
22220 @noindent
22221 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22222 function in your program, that function is called when
22223 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22224 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22225 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22226
22227 @item
22228 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22229 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22230
22231 @item
22232 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22233 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22234
22235 @item
22236 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22237 @c document that. FIXME.
22238 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22239 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22240
22241 @item
22242 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22243 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22244
22245 @end enumerate
22246
22247 @node Configurations
22248 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22249
22250 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22251 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22252 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22253
22254 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22255 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22256 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22257 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22258 are quite different from each other.
22259
22260 @menu
22261 * Native::
22262 * Embedded OS::
22263 * Embedded Processors::
22264 * Architectures::
22265 @end menu
22266
22267 @node Native
22268 @section Native
22269
22270 This section describes details specific to particular native
22271 configurations.
22272
22273 @menu
22274 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22275 * Process Information:: Process information
22276 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22277 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22278 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22279 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22280 @end menu
22281
22282 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22283 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22284
22285 @cindex libkvm
22286 @cindex kernel memory image
22287 @cindex kernel crash dump
22288
22289 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22290 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22291 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22292 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22293 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22294 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22295 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22296 @code{kvm} target:
22297
22298 @smallexample
22299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22300 @end smallexample
22301
22302 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22303 argument:
22304
22305 @smallexample
22306 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22307 @end smallexample
22308
22309 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22310 available:
22311
22312 @table @code
22313 @kindex kvm
22314 @item kvm pcb
22315 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22316
22317 @item kvm proc
22318 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22319 modern FreeBSD systems.
22320 @end table
22321
22322 @node Process Information
22323 @subsection Process Information
22324 @cindex /proc
22325 @cindex examine process image
22326 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22327
22328 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22329 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22330 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22331 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22332 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22333 any process running on your system.
22334
22335 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22336 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22337 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22338 systems.
22339
22340 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22341 information.
22342
22343 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22344 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22345 information available from a live process. Process information is
22346 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22347 systems.
22348
22349 @table @code
22350 @kindex info proc
22351 @cindex process ID
22352 @item info proc
22353 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22354 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22355 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22356 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22357 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22358 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22359 executable file's absolute file name.
22360
22361 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22362 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22363 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22364 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22365 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22366 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22367
22368 @item info proc cmdline
22369 @cindex info proc cmdline
22370 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22371 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22372
22373 @item info proc cwd
22374 @cindex info proc cwd
22375 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22376 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22377
22378 @item info proc exe
22379 @cindex info proc exe
22380 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22381 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22382
22383 @item info proc files
22384 @cindex info proc files
22385 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22386 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22387 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22388 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22389 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22390 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22391 FreeBSD.
22392
22393 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22394 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22395
22396 @smallexample
22397 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22398 process 22136
22399 Open files:
22400
22401 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22402 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22403 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22404 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22405 root dir - r-------- /
22406 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22407 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22408 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22409 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22410 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22411 @end smallexample
22412
22413 @item info proc mappings
22414 @cindex memory address space mappings
22415 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22416 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22417 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22418 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22419 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22420
22421 @item info proc stat
22422 @itemx info proc status
22423 @cindex process detailed status information
22424 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22425 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22426 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22427 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22428 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22429
22430 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22431 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22432
22433 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22434 proc status}.
22435
22436 @item info proc all
22437 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22438 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22439
22440 @ignore
22441 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22442 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22443 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22444 @kindex info proc times
22445 @item info proc times
22446 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22447 its children.
22448
22449 @kindex info proc id
22450 @item info proc id
22451 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22452 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22453 @end ignore
22454
22455 @item set procfs-trace
22456 @kindex set procfs-trace
22457 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22458 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22459
22460 @item show procfs-trace
22461 @kindex show procfs-trace
22462 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22463
22464 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22465 @kindex set procfs-file
22466 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22467 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22468 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22469 standard output.
22470
22471 @item show procfs-file
22472 @kindex show procfs-file
22473 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22474
22475 @item proc-trace-entry
22476 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22477 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22478 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22479 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22480 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22481 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22482 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22483 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22484 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22485
22486 @item info pidlist
22487 @kindex info pidlist
22488 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22489 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22490 processes and all the threads within each process.
22491
22492 @item info meminfo
22493 @kindex info meminfo
22494 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22495 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22496 @end table
22497
22498 @node DJGPP Native
22499 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22500 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22501 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22502 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22503
22504 @cindex DPMI
22505 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22506 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22507 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22508 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22509
22510 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22511 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22512 subsection describes those commands.
22513
22514 @table @code
22515 @kindex info dos
22516 @item info dos
22517 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22518 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22519
22520 @kindex sysinfo
22521 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22522 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22523 @item info dos sysinfo
22524 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22525 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22526 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22527
22528 @cindex GDT
22529 @cindex LDT
22530 @cindex IDT
22531 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22532 @cindex descriptor tables display
22533 @item info dos gdt
22534 @itemx info dos ldt
22535 @itemx info dos idt
22536 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22537 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22538 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22539 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22540 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22541 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22542 rights.
22543
22544 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22545 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22546 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22547 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22548 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22549
22550 @cindex garbled pointers
22551 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22552 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22553 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22554 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22555 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22556 debugged program's data segment:
22557
22558 @smallexample
22559 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22560 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22561 @end smallexample
22562
22563 @noindent
22564 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22565 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22566
22567 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22568 @item info dos pde
22569 @itemx info dos pte
22570 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22571 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22572 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22573 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22574 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22575 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22576 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22577 that is currently in use.
22578
22579 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22580 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22581 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22582 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22583 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22584 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22585 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22586
22587 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22588 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22589 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22590 controller.
22591
22592 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22593
22594 @cindex physical address from linear address
22595 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22596 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22597 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22598 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22599 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22600 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22601 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22602
22603 @smallexample
22604 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22605 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22606 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22607 @end smallexample
22608
22609 @noindent
22610 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22611 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22612 attributes of that page.
22613
22614 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22615 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22616 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22617 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22618 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22619 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22620
22621 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22622 transfer buffer:
22623
22624 @smallexample
22625 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22626 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22627 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22628 @end smallexample
22629
22630 @noindent
22631 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22632 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22633 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22634 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22635 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22636
22637 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22638 @end table
22639
22640 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22641 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22642 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22643 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22644
22645 @table @code
22646 @kindex set com1base
22647 @kindex set com1irq
22648 @kindex set com2base
22649 @kindex set com2irq
22650 @kindex set com3base
22651 @kindex set com3irq
22652 @kindex set com4base
22653 @kindex set com4irq
22654 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22655 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22656 port.
22657
22658 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22659 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22660 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22661
22662 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22663 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22664 other 3 COM ports.
22665
22666 @kindex show com1base
22667 @kindex show com1irq
22668 @kindex show com2base
22669 @kindex show com2irq
22670 @kindex show com3base
22671 @kindex show com3irq
22672 @kindex show com4base
22673 @kindex show com4irq
22674 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22675 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22676 lines used by the COM ports.
22677
22678 @item info serial
22679 @kindex info serial
22680 @cindex DOS serial port status
22681 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22682 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22683 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22684 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22685 @end table
22686
22687
22688 @node Cygwin Native
22689 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22690 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22691 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22692 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22693
22694 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22695 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22696
22697 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22698 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22699 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22700 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22701 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22702 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22703 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22704 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22705
22706 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22707 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22708 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22709
22710 @table @code
22711 @kindex info w32
22712 @item info w32
22713 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22714 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22715
22716 @item info w32 selector
22717 This command displays information returned by
22718 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22719 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22720 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22721 Without argument, this command displays information
22722 about the six segment registers.
22723
22724 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22725 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22726 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22727 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22728
22729 @kindex signal-event
22730 @item signal-event @var{id}
22731 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22732 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22733
22734 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22735 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22736 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22737 (for x86_64 versions):
22738
22739 @itemize @minus
22740 @item
22741 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22742 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22743 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22744
22745 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22746 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22747 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22748 to attach.
22749
22750 @item
22751 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22752 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22753 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22754 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22755 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22756 @end itemize
22757
22758 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22759 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22760 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22761 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22762 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22763 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22764 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22765 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22766 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22767 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22768 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22769
22770 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22771 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22772 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22773 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22774
22775 @kindex set new-console
22776 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22777 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22778 be started in a new console on next start.
22779 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22780 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22781
22782 @kindex show new-console
22783 @item show new-console
22784 Displays whether a new console is used
22785 when the debuggee is started.
22786
22787 @kindex set new-group
22788 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22789 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22790 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22791 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22792 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22793
22794 @kindex show new-group
22795 @item show new-group
22796 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22797
22798 @kindex set debugevents
22799 @item set debugevents
22800 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22801 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22802 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22803 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22804 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22805
22806 @kindex set debugexec
22807 @item set debugexec
22808 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22809 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22810
22811 @kindex set debugexceptions
22812 @item set debugexceptions
22813 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22814 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22815
22816 @kindex set debugmemory
22817 @item set debugmemory
22818 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22819 and writes by the debugger.
22820
22821 @kindex set shell
22822 @item set shell
22823 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22824 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22825
22826 @kindex show shell
22827 @item show shell
22828 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22829
22830 @end table
22831
22832 @menu
22833 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22834 @end menu
22835
22836 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22837 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22838 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22839 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22840
22841 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22842 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22843 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22844 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22845 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22846 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22847 ``minimal symbols''.
22848
22849 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22850 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22851 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22852 program run once to completion.
22853
22854 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22855
22856 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22857 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22858 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22859 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22860 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22861 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22862 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22863 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22864 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22865
22866 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22867 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22868 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22869 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22870 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22871 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22872
22873 @smallexample
22874 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22875 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22876
22877 Non-debugging symbols:
22878 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22879 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22880 @end smallexample
22881
22882 @smallexample
22883 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22884 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22885
22886 Non-debugging symbols:
22887 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22888 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22889 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22890 [etc...]
22891 @end smallexample
22892
22893 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22894
22895 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22896 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22897 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22898 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22899 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22900 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22901 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22902
22903 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22904 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22905 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22906 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22907 problem:
22908
22909 @smallexample
22910 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22911 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22912 @end smallexample
22913
22914 @smallexample
22915 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22916 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22917 @end smallexample
22918
22919 And two possible solutions:
22920
22921 @smallexample
22922 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22923 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22924 @end smallexample
22925
22926 @smallexample
22927 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22928 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22929 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22930 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22931 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22932 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22933 @end smallexample
22934
22935 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22936 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22937 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22938 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22939 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22940
22941 @smallexample
22942 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22943 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22944 @end smallexample
22945
22946 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22947 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22948 safe.
22949
22950 @node Hurd Native
22951 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22952 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22953
22954 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22955 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22956
22957 @table @code
22958 @item set signals
22959 @itemx set sigs
22960 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22961 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22962 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22963 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22964 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22965 @code{signals}.
22966
22967 @item show signals
22968 @itemx show sigs
22969 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22970 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22971 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22972
22973 @item set signal-thread
22974 @itemx set sigthread
22975 @kindex set signal-thread
22976 @kindex set sigthread
22977 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22978 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22979 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22980 signal-thread}.
22981
22982 @item show signal-thread
22983 @itemx show sigthread
22984 @kindex show signal-thread
22985 @kindex show sigthread
22986 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22987 delivered a signal.
22988
22989 @item set stopped
22990 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22991 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22992 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22993 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22994
22995 @item show stopped
22996 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22997 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22998 stopped.
22999
23000 @item set exceptions
23001 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23002 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23003 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23004 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23005 trapping on.
23006
23007 @item show exceptions
23008 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23009 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23010
23011 @item set task pause
23012 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23013 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23014 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23015 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23016 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23017 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23018 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23019 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23020 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23021
23022 @item show task pause
23023 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23024 Show the current state of task suspension.
23025
23026 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23027 @cindex task suspend count
23028 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23029 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23030 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23031
23032 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23033 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23034
23035 @item set task exception-port
23036 @itemx set task excp
23037 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23038 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23039 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23040 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23041
23042 @item set noninvasive
23043 @cindex noninvasive task options
23044 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23045 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23046 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23047 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23048
23049 @item info send-rights
23050 @itemx info receive-rights
23051 @itemx info port-rights
23052 @itemx info port-sets
23053 @itemx info dead-names
23054 @itemx info ports
23055 @itemx info psets
23056 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23057 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23058 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23059 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23060 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23061 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23062 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23063 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23064 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23065
23066 @item set thread pause
23067 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23068 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23069 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23070 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23071 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23072 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23073 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23074 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23075 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23076 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23077 only the current thread.
23078
23079 @item show thread pause
23080 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23081 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23082
23083 @item set thread run
23084 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23085
23086 @item show thread run
23087 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23088
23089 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23090 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23091 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23092 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23093 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23094 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23095 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23096
23097 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23098 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23099 detaching.
23100
23101 @item set thread exception-port
23102 @itemx set thread excp
23103 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23104 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23105 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23106
23107 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23108 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23109 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23110 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23111
23112 @item set thread default
23113 @itemx show thread default
23114 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23115 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23116 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23117 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23118 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23119 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23120 the non-default commands.
23121 @end table
23122
23123 @node Darwin
23124 @subsection Darwin
23125 @cindex Darwin
23126
23127 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23128
23129 @table @code
23130 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23131 @kindex set debug darwin
23132 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23133 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23134
23135 @item show debug darwin
23136 @kindex show debug darwin
23137 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23138
23139 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23140 @kindex set debug mach-o
23141 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23142 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23143 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23144 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23145 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23146 usage.
23147
23148 @item show debug mach-o
23149 @kindex show debug mach-o
23150 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23151
23152 @item set mach-exceptions on
23153 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23154 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23155 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23156 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23157 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23158 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23159
23160 @item show mach-exceptions
23161 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23162 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23163 @end table
23164
23165
23166 @node Embedded OS
23167 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23168
23169 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23170 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23171 architectures.
23172
23173 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23174 various real-time operating systems.
23175
23176 @node Embedded Processors
23177 @section Embedded Processors
23178
23179 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23180 configurations.
23181
23182 @cindex send command to simulator
23183 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23184 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23185
23186 @table @code
23187 @item sim @var{command}
23188 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23189 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23190 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23191 acceptable commands.
23192 @end table
23193
23194
23195 @menu
23196 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23197 * ARM:: ARM
23198 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23199 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23200 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23201 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23202 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23203 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23204 * CRIS:: CRIS
23205 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23206 @end menu
23207
23208 @node ARC
23209 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23210 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23211 @cindex ARC specific commands
23212 @cindex ARC600
23213 @cindex ARC700
23214 @cindex ARC EM
23215 @cindex ARC HS
23216
23217 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23218
23219 @table @code
23220 @item set debug arc
23221 @kindex set debug arc
23222 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23223 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23224
23225 @item show debug arc
23226 @kindex show debug arc
23227 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23228
23229 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23230 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23231 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23232
23233 @end table
23234
23235 @node ARM
23236 @subsection ARM
23237
23238 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23239
23240 @table @code
23241 @item set arm disassembler
23242 @kindex set arm
23243 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23244 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23245
23246 @item show arm disassembler
23247 @kindex show arm
23248 Show the current disassembly style.
23249
23250 @item set arm apcs32
23251 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23252 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23253
23254 @item show arm apcs32
23255 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23256
23257 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23258 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23259 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23260
23261 @table @code
23262 @item auto
23263 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23264 @item softfpa
23265 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23266 processors.
23267 @item fpa
23268 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23269 @item softvfp
23270 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23271 @item vfp
23272 VFP co-processor.
23273 @end table
23274
23275 @item show arm fpu
23276 Show the current type of the FPU.
23277
23278 @item set arm abi
23279 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23280
23281 @item show arm abi
23282 Show the currently used ABI.
23283
23284 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23285 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23286 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23287 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23288 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23289 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23290 register).
23291
23292 @item show arm fallback-mode
23293 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23294
23295 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23296 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23297 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23298 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23299 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23300
23301 @item show arm force-mode
23302 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23303
23304 @item set debug arm
23305 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23306 target support subsystem.
23307
23308 @item show debug arm
23309 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23310 @end table
23311
23312 @table @code
23313 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23314 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23315
23316 @table @code
23317 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23318 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23319 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23320 The default value is @code{all}.
23321
23322 @table @code
23323 @item none
23324 @item demon
23325 @item angel
23326 @item redboot
23327 @item all
23328 @end table
23329 @end table
23330 @end table
23331
23332 @node M68K
23333 @subsection M68k
23334
23335 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23336
23337 @node MicroBlaze
23338 @subsection MicroBlaze
23339 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23340 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23341
23342 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23343 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23344 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23345 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23346 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23347 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23348 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23349 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23350 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23351 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23352 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23353
23354 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23355
23356 @table @code
23357 @item target remote :1234
23358 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23359 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23360
23361 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23362 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23363 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23364
23365 @item load
23366 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23367
23368 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23369 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23370
23371 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23372 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23373 @end table
23374
23375 @node MIPS Embedded
23376 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23377
23378 @noindent
23379 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23380
23381 @table @code
23382 @item set mipsfpu double
23383 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23384 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23385 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23386 @itemx show mipsfpu
23387 @kindex set mipsfpu
23388 @kindex show mipsfpu
23389 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23390 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23391 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23392 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23393 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23394 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23395 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23396 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23397 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23398 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23399 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23400 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23401 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23402
23403 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23404 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23405 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23406
23407 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23408 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23409 @end table
23410
23411 @node OpenRISC 1000
23412 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23413 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23414
23415 @noindent
23416 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23417 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23418 FPGA's.
23419
23420 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23421 a target:
23422
23423 @table @code
23424
23425 @kindex target sim
23426 @item target sim
23427
23428 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23429 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23430 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23431 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23432
23433 Example: @code{target sim}
23434
23435 @item set debug or1k
23436 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23437 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23438
23439 @item show debug or1k
23440 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23441 @end table
23442
23443 @node PowerPC Embedded
23444 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23445
23446 @cindex DVC register
23447 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23448 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23449
23450 @smallexample
23451 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23452 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23453 @end smallexample
23454
23455 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23456 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23457 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23458 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23459 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23460 or newer.
23461
23462 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23463 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23464 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23465 watching variables of scalar types.
23466
23467 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23468 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23469
23470 @smallexample
23471 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23472 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23473 @end smallexample
23474
23475 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23476 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23477
23478 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23479 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23480 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23481 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23482 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23483 use the @code{break-range} command.
23484
23485 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23486
23487 @table @code
23488 @kindex break-range
23489 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23490 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23491 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23492 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23493 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23494 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23495 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23496 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23497 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23498
23499 @kindex set powerpc
23500 @item set powerpc soft-float
23501 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23502 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23503 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23504 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23505
23506 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23507 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23508 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23509 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23510 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23511 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23512 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23513 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23514
23515 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23516 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23517 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23518 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23519 address of its first byte.
23520
23521 @end table
23522
23523 @node AVR
23524 @subsection Atmel AVR
23525 @cindex AVR
23526
23527 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23528 following AVR-specific commands:
23529
23530 @table @code
23531 @item info io_registers
23532 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23533 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23534 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23535 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23536 @end table
23537
23538 @node CRIS
23539 @subsection CRIS
23540 @cindex CRIS
23541
23542 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23543 following CRIS-specific commands:
23544
23545 @table @code
23546 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23547 @cindex CRIS version
23548 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23549 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23550 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23551
23552 @item show cris-version
23553 Show the current CRIS version.
23554
23555 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23556 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23557 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23558 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23559 @code{R59}.
23560
23561 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23562 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23563
23564 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23565 @cindex CRIS mode
23566 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23567 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23568 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23569
23570 @item show cris-mode
23571 Show the current CRIS mode.
23572 @end table
23573
23574 @node Super-H
23575 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23576 @cindex Super-H
23577
23578 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23579 commands:
23580
23581 @table @code
23582 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23583 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23584 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23585 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23586 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23587 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23588 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23589 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23590 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23591 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23592 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23593 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23594
23595 @item show sh calling-convention
23596 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23597 Show the current calling convention setting.
23598
23599 @end table
23600
23601
23602 @node Architectures
23603 @section Architectures
23604
23605 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23606 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23607
23608 @menu
23609 * AArch64::
23610 * i386::
23611 * Alpha::
23612 * MIPS::
23613 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23614 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23615 * PowerPC::
23616 * Nios II::
23617 * Sparc64::
23618 * S12Z::
23619 @end menu
23620
23621 @node AArch64
23622 @subsection AArch64
23623 @cindex AArch64 support
23624
23625 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23626 following special commands:
23627
23628 @table @code
23629 @item set debug aarch64
23630 @kindex set debug aarch64
23631 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23632 messages are to be displayed.
23633
23634 @item show debug aarch64
23635 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23636
23637 @end table
23638
23639 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23640 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23641
23642 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23643 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23644 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23645 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23646 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23647 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23648
23649 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23650 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23651 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23652 target process.
23653
23654
23655 @node i386
23656 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23657
23658 @table @code
23659 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23660 @kindex set struct-convention
23661 @cindex struct return convention
23662 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23663 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23664 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23665 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23666 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23667 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23668 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23669 be returned in a register.
23670
23671 @item show struct-convention
23672 @kindex show struct-convention
23673 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23674 from functions.
23675 @end table
23676
23677
23678 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23679 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23680
23681 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23682 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23683 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23684 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23685 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23686 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23687 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23688
23689 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23690 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23691 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23692 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23693 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23694 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23695
23696 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23697 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23698 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23699
23700 @smallexample
23701 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23702 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23703 @end smallexample
23704
23705 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23706 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23707 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23708 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23709 the pointer.
23710
23711 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23712 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23713 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23714 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23715 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23716
23717 @table @code
23718 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23719 @kindex show mpx bound
23720 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23721
23722 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23723 @kindex set mpx bound
23724 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23725 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23726 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23727 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23728 @end table
23729
23730 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23731 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23732 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23733 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23734
23735 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23736 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23737 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23738 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23739 function.
23740
23741 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23742 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23743 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23744 continuing the execution. For example:
23745
23746 @smallexample
23747 $ break *upper
23748 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23749 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23750 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23751 $ print $bnd0
23752 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23753 @end smallexample
23754
23755 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23756 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23757 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23758
23759 @node Alpha
23760 @subsection Alpha
23761
23762 See the following section.
23763
23764 @node MIPS
23765 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23766
23767 @cindex stack on Alpha
23768 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23769 @cindex Alpha stack
23770 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23771 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23772 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23773 find the beginning of a function.
23774
23775 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23776 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23777 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23778 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23779 commands:
23780
23781 @table @code
23782 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23783 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23784 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23785 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23786 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23787 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23788 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23789 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23790
23791 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23792 Display the current limit.
23793 @end table
23794
23795 @noindent
23796 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23797 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23798
23799 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23800 programs:
23801
23802 @table @code
23803 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23804 @kindex set mips abi
23805 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23806 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23807 values of @var{arg} are:
23808
23809 @table @samp
23810 @item auto
23811 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23812 default).
23813 @item o32
23814 @item o64
23815 @item n32
23816 @item n64
23817 @item eabi32
23818 @item eabi64
23819 @end table
23820
23821 @item show mips abi
23822 @kindex show mips abi
23823 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23824
23825 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23826 @kindex set mips compression
23827 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23828 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23829 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23830 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23831 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23832 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23833 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23834 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23835 provided by the executable.
23836
23837 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23838 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23839 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23840 identified as such.
23841
23842 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23843 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23844 implicitly from an executable.
23845
23846 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23847 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23848 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23849 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23850 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23851
23852 @item show mips compression
23853 @kindex show mips compression
23854 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23855 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23856
23857 @item set mipsfpu
23858 @itemx show mipsfpu
23859 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23860
23861 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23862 @kindex set mips mask-address
23863 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23864 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23865 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23866 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23867 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23868
23869 @item show mips mask-address
23870 @kindex show mips mask-address
23871 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23872 not.
23873
23874 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23875 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23876 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23877 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23878 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23879 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23880
23881 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23882 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23883 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23884
23885 @item set debug mips
23886 @kindex set debug mips
23887 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23888 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23889
23890 @item show debug mips
23891 @kindex show debug mips
23892 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23893 @end table
23894
23895
23896 @node HPPA
23897 @subsection HPPA
23898 @cindex HPPA support
23899
23900 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23901 following special commands:
23902
23903 @table @code
23904 @item set debug hppa
23905 @kindex set debug hppa
23906 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23907 messages are to be displayed.
23908
23909 @item show debug hppa
23910 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23911
23912 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23913 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23914 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23915 given @var{address}.
23916
23917 @end table
23918
23919
23920 @node SPU
23921 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23922 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23923 @cindex SPU
23924
23925 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23926 it provides the following special commands:
23927
23928 @table @code
23929 @item info spu event
23930 @kindex info spu
23931 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23932 and pending event status.
23933
23934 @item info spu signal
23935 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23936 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23937 notification channels.
23938
23939 @item info spu mailbox
23940 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23941 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23942 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23943
23944 @item info spu dma
23945 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23946 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23947 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23948
23949 @item info spu proxydma
23950 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23951 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23952 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23953
23954 @end table
23955
23956 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23957 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23958 special commands:
23959
23960 @table @code
23961 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23962 @kindex set spu
23963 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23964 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23965 function. The default is @code{off}.
23966
23967 @item show spu stop-on-load
23968 @kindex show spu
23969 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23970
23971 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23972 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23973 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23974 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23975 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23976 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23977
23978 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23979 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23980
23981 @end table
23982
23983 @node PowerPC
23984 @subsection PowerPC
23985 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23986
23987 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23988 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23989 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23990 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23991 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23992
23993 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23994 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23995 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23996
23997 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23998 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23999
24000 @node Nios II
24001 @subsection Nios II
24002 @cindex Nios II architecture
24003
24004 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24005 it provides the following special commands:
24006
24007 @table @code
24008
24009 @item set debug nios2
24010 @kindex set debug nios2
24011 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24012 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24013
24014 @item show debug nios2
24015 @kindex show debug nios2
24016 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24017 @end table
24018
24019 @node Sparc64
24020 @subsection Sparc64
24021 @cindex Sparc64 support
24022 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24023 @subsubsection ADI Support
24024
24025 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24026 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24027 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24028 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24029 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24030 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24031 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24032 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24033 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24034 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24035 signal.
24036
24037 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24038 ADI-enabled.
24039
24040 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24041 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24042
24043
24044 @table @code
24045 @kindex adi examine
24046 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24047
24048 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24049 cacheline.
24050
24051 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24052 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24053 block size, to display.
24054
24055 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24056 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24057
24058 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24059
24060 @smallexample
24061 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24062 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24063 @end smallexample
24064
24065 @kindex adi assign
24066 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24067
24068 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24069 to an address.
24070
24071 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24072 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24073 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24074
24075 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24076 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24077
24078 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24079
24080 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24081 variable "shmaddr":
24082
24083 @smallexample
24084 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24085 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24086 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24087 @end smallexample
24088
24089 @end table
24090
24091 @node S12Z
24092 @subsection S12Z
24093 @cindex S12Z support
24094
24095 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24096 it provides the following special command:
24097
24098 @table @code
24099 @item maint info bdccsr
24100 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24101 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24102 BDCCSR register.
24103 @end table
24104
24105
24106 @node Controlling GDB
24107 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24108
24109 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24110 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24111 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24112 described here.
24113
24114 @menu
24115 * Prompt:: Prompt
24116 * Editing:: Command editing
24117 * Command History:: Command history
24118 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24119 * Numbers:: Numbers
24120 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24121 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24122 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24123 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24124 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24125 @end menu
24126
24127 @node Prompt
24128 @section Prompt
24129
24130 @cindex prompt
24131
24132 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24133 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24134 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24135 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24136 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24137 which one you are talking to.
24138
24139 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24140 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24141 or a prompt that does not.
24142
24143 @table @code
24144 @kindex set prompt
24145 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24146 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24147
24148 @kindex show prompt
24149 @item show prompt
24150 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24151 @end table
24152
24153 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24154 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24155 are:
24156
24157 @table @code
24158 @kindex set extended-prompt
24159 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24160 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24161 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24162 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24163 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24164 is displayed.
24165
24166 For example:
24167
24168 @smallexample
24169 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24170 @end smallexample
24171
24172 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24173 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24174
24175 @kindex show extended-prompt
24176 @item show extended-prompt
24177 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24178 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24179 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24180 @end table
24181
24182 @node Editing
24183 @section Command Editing
24184 @cindex readline
24185 @cindex command line editing
24186
24187 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24188 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24189 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24190 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24191 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24192 debugging sessions.
24193
24194 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24195 command @code{set}.
24196
24197 @table @code
24198 @kindex set editing
24199 @cindex editing
24200 @item set editing
24201 @itemx set editing on
24202 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24203
24204 @item set editing off
24205 Disable command line editing.
24206
24207 @kindex show editing
24208 @item show editing
24209 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24210 @end table
24211
24212 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24213 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24214 @end ifset
24215 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24216 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24217 @end ifclear
24218 for more details about the Readline
24219 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24220 encouraged to read that chapter.
24221
24222 @node Command History
24223 @section Command History
24224 @cindex command history
24225
24226 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24227 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24228 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24229 history facility.
24230
24231 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24232 package, to provide the history facility.
24233 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24234 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24235 @end ifset
24236 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24237 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24238 @end ifclear
24239 for the detailed description of the History library.
24240
24241 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24242 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24243 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24244 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24245 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24246 pressed on a line by itself.
24247
24248 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24249 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24250 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24251 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24252
24253 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24254 history.
24255
24256 @table @code
24257 @cindex history substitution
24258 @cindex history file
24259 @kindex set history filename
24260 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24261 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24262 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24263 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24264 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24265 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24266 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24267 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24268 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24269 is not set.
24270
24271 @cindex save command history
24272 @kindex set history save
24273 @item set history save
24274 @itemx set history save on
24275 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24276 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24277
24278 @item set history save off
24279 Stop recording command history in a file.
24280
24281 @cindex history size
24282 @kindex set history size
24283 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24284 @item set history size @var{size}
24285 @itemx set history size unlimited
24286 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24287 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24288 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24289 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24290 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24291 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24292
24293 @cindex remove duplicate history
24294 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24295 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24296 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24297 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24298 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24299 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24300 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24301 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24302 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24303
24304 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24305 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24306
24307 @end table
24308
24309 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24310 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24311 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24312 @end ifset
24313 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24314 @xref{Event Designators},
24315 @end ifclear
24316 for more details.
24317
24318 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24319 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24320 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24321 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24322 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24323 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24324 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24325 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24326
24327 The commands to control history expansion are:
24328
24329 @table @code
24330 @item set history expansion on
24331 @itemx set history expansion
24332 @kindex set history expansion
24333 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24334
24335 @item set history expansion off
24336 Disable history expansion.
24337
24338 @c @group
24339 @kindex show history
24340 @item show history
24341 @itemx show history filename
24342 @itemx show history save
24343 @itemx show history size
24344 @itemx show history expansion
24345 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24346 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24347 @c @end group
24348 @end table
24349
24350 @table @code
24351 @kindex show commands
24352 @cindex show last commands
24353 @cindex display command history
24354 @item show commands
24355 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24356
24357 @item show commands @var{n}
24358 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24359
24360 @item show commands +
24361 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24362 @end table
24363
24364 @node Screen Size
24365 @section Screen Size
24366 @cindex size of screen
24367 @cindex screen size
24368 @cindex pagination
24369 @cindex page size
24370 @cindex pauses in output
24371
24372 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24373 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24374 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24375 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24376 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24377 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24378 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24379 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24380 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24381 following line.
24382
24383 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24384 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24385 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24386 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24387 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24388 width} commands:
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @kindex set height
24392 @kindex set width
24393 @kindex show width
24394 @kindex show height
24395 @item set height @var{lpp}
24396 @itemx set height unlimited
24397 @itemx show height
24398 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24399 @itemx set width unlimited
24400 @itemx show width
24401 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24402 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24403 commands display the current settings.
24404
24405 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24406 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24407 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24408 buffer.
24409
24410 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24411 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24412
24413 @item set pagination on
24414 @itemx set pagination off
24415 @kindex set pagination
24416 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24417 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24418 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24419 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24420
24421 @item show pagination
24422 @kindex show pagination
24423 Show the current pagination mode.
24424 @end table
24425
24426 @node Numbers
24427 @section Numbers
24428 @cindex number representation
24429 @cindex entering numbers
24430
24431 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24432 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24433 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24434 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24435 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24436 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24437 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24438 both input and output with the commands described below.
24439
24440 @table @code
24441 @kindex set input-radix
24442 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24443 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24444 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24445 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24446 example, any of
24447
24448 @smallexample
24449 set input-radix 012
24450 set input-radix 10.
24451 set input-radix 0xa
24452 @end smallexample
24453
24454 @noindent
24455 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24456 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24457 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24458 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24459 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24460 change the radix.
24461
24462 @kindex set output-radix
24463 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24464 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24465 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24466 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24467
24468 @kindex show input-radix
24469 @item show input-radix
24470 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24471
24472 @kindex show output-radix
24473 @item show output-radix
24474 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24475
24476 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24477 @itemx show radix
24478 @kindex set radix
24479 @kindex show radix
24480 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24481 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24482 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24483 default value of 10.
24484
24485 @end table
24486
24487 @node ABI
24488 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24489
24490 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24491 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24492 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24493 current ABI.
24494
24495 @cindex OS ABI
24496 @kindex set osabi
24497 @kindex show osabi
24498 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24499
24500 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24501 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24502 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24503 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24504 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24505 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24506 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24507 platform provides.
24508
24509 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24510 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24511 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24512 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24513
24514 @table @code
24515 @item show osabi
24516 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24517
24518 @item set osabi
24519 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24520
24521 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24522 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24523 @end table
24524
24525 @cindex float promotion
24526
24527 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24528 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24529 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24530 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24531 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24532 @code{double} and then passed.
24533
24534 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24535 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24536 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24537
24538 @table @code
24539 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24540 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24541 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24542 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24543 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24544
24545 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24546 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24547 functions.
24548
24549 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24550 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24551 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24552 @end table
24553
24554 @kindex set cp-abi
24555 @kindex show cp-abi
24556 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24557 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24558 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24559 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24560 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24561 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24562 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24563 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24564 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24565 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24566 ``auto''.
24567
24568 @table @code
24569 @item show cp-abi
24570 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24571
24572 @item set cp-abi
24573 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24574
24575 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24576 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24577 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24578 @end table
24579
24580 @node Auto-loading
24581 @section Automatically loading associated files
24582 @cindex auto-loading
24583
24584 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24585 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24586 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24587 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24588 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24589 sources).
24590
24591 @menu
24592 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24593 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24594
24595 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24596 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24597 @end menu
24598
24599 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24600 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24601 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24602
24603 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24604 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24605 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24606
24607 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24608 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24609
24610 @table @code
24611 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24612 @kindex set auto-load off
24613 @item set auto-load off
24614 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24615 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24616 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24617 @smallexample
24618 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24619 @end smallexample
24620
24621 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24622 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24623 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24624 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24625 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24626 @code{set auto-load no}.
24627
24628 @anchor{show auto-load}
24629 @kindex show auto-load
24630 @item show auto-load
24631 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24632 or disabled.
24633
24634 @smallexample
24635 (gdb) show auto-load
24636 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24637 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24638 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24639 is on.
24640 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24641 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24642 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24643 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24644 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24645 @end smallexample
24646
24647 @anchor{info auto-load}
24648 @kindex info auto-load
24649 @item info auto-load
24650 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24651 not.
24652
24653 @smallexample
24654 (gdb) info auto-load
24655 gdb-scripts:
24656 Loaded Script
24657 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24658 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24659 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24660 loaded.
24661 python-scripts:
24662 Loaded Script
24663 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24664 @end smallexample
24665 @end table
24666
24667 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24668
24669 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24670 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24671 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24672 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24673 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24674 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24675 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24676 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24677 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24678 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24679 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24680 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24681 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24682 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24683 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24684 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24685 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24686 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24687 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24688 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24689 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24690 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24691 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24692 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24693 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24694 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24695 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24696 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24697 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24698 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24699 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24700 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24701 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24702 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24703 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24704 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24705 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24706 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24707 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24708 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24709 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24710 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24711 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24712 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24713 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24714 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24715 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24716 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24717 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24718 @end multitable
24719
24720 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24721 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24722 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24723
24724 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24725 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24726 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24727
24728 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24729 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24730
24731 @table @code
24732 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24733 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24734 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24735 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24736 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24737
24738 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24739 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24740 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24741 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24742 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24743
24744 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24745 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24746 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24747 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24748 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24749 @end table
24750
24751 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24752 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24753 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24754
24755 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24756
24757 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24758 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24759
24760 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24761 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24762 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24763 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24764 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24765 library.
24766
24767 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24768 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24769
24770 @table @code
24771 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24772 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24773 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24774 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24775
24776 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24777 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24778 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24779 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24780 enabled or disabled.
24781
24782 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24783 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24784 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24785 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24786 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24787 @end table
24788
24789 @node Auto-loading safe path
24790 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24791 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24792
24793 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24794 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24795 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24796 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24797 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24798
24799 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24800 get loaded:
24801
24802 @smallexample
24803 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24804 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24805 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24806 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24807 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24808 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24809 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24810 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24811 @end smallexample
24812
24813 @noindent
24814 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24815 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24816
24817 @smallexample
24818 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24819 @end smallexample
24820
24821 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24822
24823 @table @code
24824 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24825 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24826 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24827 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24828 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24829 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24830 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24831 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24832 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24833 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24834
24835 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24836 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24837 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24838
24839 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24840 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24841 @item show auto-load safe-path
24842 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24843 scripts.
24844
24845 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24846 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24847 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24848 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24849 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24850 by the host platform path separator in use.
24851 @end table
24852
24853 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24854 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24855 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24856 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24857 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24858
24859 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24860 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24861 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24862 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24863 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24864 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24865 init file in the current directory
24866 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24867
24868 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24869 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24870
24871 @table @asis
24872 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24873 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24874 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24875 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24876
24877 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24878 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24879 @value{GDBN} session.
24880
24881 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24882 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24883 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24884 from trusted sources.
24885
24886 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24887 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24888 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24889 trusted sources.
24890 @end table
24891
24892 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24893 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24894
24895 @table @asis
24896 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24897 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24898
24899 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24900 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24901 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24902 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24903 @end table
24904
24905 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24906 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24907 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24908 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24909 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24910 recommended to be entered.
24911
24912 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24913 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24914 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24915
24916 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24917 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24918 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24919 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24920 be printed.
24921
24922 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24923 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24924 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24925
24926 @smallexample
24927 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24928 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24929 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24930 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24931 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24932 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24933 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24934 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24935 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24936 @end smallexample
24937
24938 @table @code
24939 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24940 @kindex set debug auto-load
24941 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24942 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24943
24944 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24945 @kindex show debug auto-load
24946 @item show debug auto-load
24947 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24948 on or off.
24949 @end table
24950
24951 @node Messages/Warnings
24952 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24953
24954 @cindex verbose operation
24955 @cindex optional warnings
24956 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24957 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24958 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24959 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24960
24961 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24962 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24963 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24964
24965 @table @code
24966 @kindex set verbose
24967 @item set verbose on
24968 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24969
24970 @item set verbose off
24971 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24972
24973 @kindex show verbose
24974 @item show verbose
24975 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24976 @end table
24977
24978 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24979 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24980 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24981 Symbol Files}).
24982
24983 @table @code
24984
24985 @kindex set complaints
24986 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24987 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24988 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24989 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24990 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24991
24992 @kindex show complaints
24993 @item show complaints
24994 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24995
24996 @end table
24997
24998 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24999 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25000 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25001 you try to run a program which is already running:
25002
25003 @smallexample
25004 (@value{GDBP}) run
25005 The program being debugged has been started already.
25006 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25010 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25011
25012 @table @code
25013
25014 @kindex set confirm
25015 @cindex flinching
25016 @cindex confirmation
25017 @cindex stupid questions
25018 @item set confirm off
25019 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25020 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25021 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25022
25023 @item set confirm on
25024 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25025
25026 @kindex show confirm
25027 @item show confirm
25028 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25029
25030 @end table
25031
25032 @cindex command tracing
25033 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25034 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25035 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25036 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25037
25038 @table @code
25039 @kindex set trace-commands
25040 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25041 @item set trace-commands on
25042 Enable command tracing.
25043 @item set trace-commands off
25044 Disable command tracing.
25045 @item show trace-commands
25046 Display the current state of command tracing.
25047 @end table
25048
25049 @node Debugging Output
25050 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25051 @cindex optional debugging messages
25052
25053 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25054 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25055 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25056 section documents those commands.
25057
25058 @table @code
25059 @kindex set exec-done-display
25060 @item set exec-done-display
25061 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25062 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25063 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25064 @kindex show exec-done-display
25065 @item show exec-done-display
25066 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25067 notification.
25068 @kindex set debug
25069 @cindex ARM AArch64
25070 @item set debug aarch64
25071 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25072 The default is off.
25073 @kindex show debug
25074 @item show debug aarch64
25075 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25076 ARM AArch64.
25077 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25078 @cindex architecture debugging info
25079 @item set debug arch
25080 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25081 @item show debug arch
25082 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25083 @item set debug aix-solib
25084 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25085 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25086 support module. The default is off.
25087 @item show debug aix-thread
25088 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25089 @item set debug aix-thread
25090 @cindex AIX threads
25091 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25092 module.
25093 @item show debug aix-thread
25094 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25095 @item set debug check-physname
25096 @cindex physname
25097 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25098 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25099 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25100 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25101 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25102 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25103 @item show debug check-physname
25104 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25105 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25106 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25107 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25108 exported symbols. The default is off.
25109 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25110 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25111 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25112 @item set debug dwarf-die
25113 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25114 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25115 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25116 A value of zero turns off the display.
25117 @item show debug dwarf-die
25118 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25119 @item set debug dwarf-line
25120 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25121 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25122 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25123 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25124 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25125 @item show debug dwarf-line
25126 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25127 @item set debug dwarf-read
25128 @cindex DWARF Reading
25129 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25130 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25131 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25132 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25133 @item show debug dwarf-read
25134 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25135 @item set debug displaced
25136 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25137 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25138 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25139 @item show debug displaced
25140 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25141 related to displaced stepping.
25142 @item set debug event
25143 @cindex event debugging info
25144 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25145 default is off.
25146 @item show debug event
25147 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25148 info.
25149 @item set debug expression
25150 @cindex expression debugging info
25151 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25152 expression parsing. The default is off.
25153 @item show debug expression
25154 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25155 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25156 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25157 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25158 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25159 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25160 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25161 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25162 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25163 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25164 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25165 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25166 @item set debug frame
25167 @cindex frame debugging info
25168 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25169 default is off.
25170 @item show debug frame
25171 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25172 info.
25173 @item set debug gnu-nat
25174 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25175 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25176 @item show debug gnu-nat
25177 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25178 @item set debug infrun
25179 @cindex inferior debugging info
25180 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25181 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25182 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25183 @item show debug infrun
25184 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25185 @item set debug jit
25186 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25187 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25188 @item show debug jit
25189 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25190 @item set debug lin-lwp
25191 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25192 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25193 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25194 @item show debug lin-lwp
25195 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25196 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25197 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25198 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25199 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25200 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25201 @item set debug mach-o
25202 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25203 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25204 processing. The default is off.
25205 @item show debug mach-o
25206 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25207 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25208 @item set debug notification
25209 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25210 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25211 The default is off.
25212 @item show debug notification
25213 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25214 @item set debug observer
25215 @cindex observer debugging info
25216 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25217 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25218 @item show debug observer
25219 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25220 @item set debug overload
25221 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25222 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25223 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25224 is off.
25225 @item show debug overload
25226 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25227 debugging info.
25228 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25229 @cindex debug expression parser
25230 @item set debug parser
25231 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25232 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25233 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25234 details. The default is off.
25235 @item show debug parser
25236 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25237 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25238 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25239 @cindex debug remote protocol
25240 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25241 @cindex display remote packets
25242 @item set debug remote
25243 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25244 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25245 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25246 @item show debug remote
25247 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25248
25249 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25250 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25251 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25252 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25253
25254 @item set debug serial
25255 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25256 default is off.
25257 @item show debug serial
25258 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25259 info.
25260 @item set debug solib-frv
25261 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25262 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25263 @item show debug solib-frv
25264 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25265 messages.
25266 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25267 @cindex symbol lookup
25268 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25269 The default is 0 (off).
25270 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25271 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25272 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25273 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25274 @item set debug symfile
25275 @cindex symbol file functions
25276 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25277 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25278 @item show debug symfile
25279 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25280 @item set debug symtab-create
25281 @cindex symbol table creation
25282 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25283 The default is 0 (off).
25284 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25285 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25286 @item show debug symtab-create
25287 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25288 @item set debug target
25289 @cindex target debugging info
25290 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25291 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25292 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25293 value of large memory transfers.
25294 @item show debug target
25295 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25296 info.
25297 @item set debug timestamp
25298 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25299 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25300 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25301 message.
25302 @item show debug timestamp
25303 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25304 debugging info.
25305 @item set debug varobj
25306 @cindex variable object debugging info
25307 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25308 info. The default is off.
25309 @item show debug varobj
25310 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25311 debugging info.
25312 @item set debug xml
25313 @cindex XML parser debugging
25314 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25315 @item show debug xml
25316 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25317 @end table
25318
25319 @node Other Misc Settings
25320 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25321 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25322
25323 @table @code
25324 @kindex set interactive-mode
25325 @item set interactive-mode
25326 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25327 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25328 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25329 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25330 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25331 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25332 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25333 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25334
25335 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25336 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25337 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25338 inside a cygwin window.
25339
25340 @kindex show interactive-mode
25341 @item show interactive-mode
25342 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25343 @end table
25344
25345 @node Extending GDB
25346 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25347 @cindex extending GDB
25348
25349 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25350 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25351 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25352 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25353 being debugged.
25354
25355 @menu
25356 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25357 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25358 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25359 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25360 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25361 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25362 @end menu
25363
25364 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25365 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25366 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25367 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25368 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25369 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25370
25371 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25372 setting:
25373
25374 @table @code
25375 @kindex set script-extension
25376 @kindex show script-extension
25377 @item set script-extension off
25378 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25379
25380 @item set script-extension soft
25381 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25382 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25383 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25384 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25385
25386 @item set script-extension strict
25387 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25388 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25389 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25390
25391 @item show script-extension
25392 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25393
25394 @end table
25395
25396 @node Sequences
25397 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25398
25399 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25400 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25401 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25402 files.
25403
25404 @menu
25405 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25406 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25407 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25408 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25409 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25410 @end menu
25411
25412 @node Define
25413 @subsection User-defined Commands
25414
25415 @cindex user-defined command
25416 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25417 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25418 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25419 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25420 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25421 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25422
25423 @smallexample
25424 define adder
25425 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25426 end
25427 @end smallexample
25428
25429 @noindent
25430 To execute the command use:
25431
25432 @smallexample
25433 adder 1 2 3
25434 @end smallexample
25435
25436 @noindent
25437 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25438 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25439 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25440 functions calls.
25441
25442 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25443 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25444 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25445 been passed.
25446
25447 @smallexample
25448 define adder
25449 if $argc == 2
25450 print $arg0 + $arg1
25451 end
25452 if $argc == 3
25453 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25454 end
25455 end
25456 @end smallexample
25457
25458 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25459 to process a variable number of arguments:
25460
25461 @smallexample
25462 define adder
25463 set $i = 0
25464 set $sum = 0
25465 while $i < $argc
25466 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25467 set $i = $i + 1
25468 end
25469 print $sum
25470 end
25471 @end smallexample
25472
25473 @table @code
25474
25475 @kindex define
25476 @item define @var{commandname}
25477 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25478 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25479 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25480 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25481 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25482 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25483
25484 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25485 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25486 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25487
25488 @kindex document
25489 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25490 @item document @var{commandname}
25491 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25492 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25493 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25494 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25495 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25496 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25497
25498 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25499 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25500 does not change the documentation.
25501
25502 @kindex dont-repeat
25503 @cindex don't repeat command
25504 @item dont-repeat
25505 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25506 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25507 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25508
25509 @kindex help user-defined
25510 @item help user-defined
25511 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25512 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25513 included (if any).
25514
25515 @kindex show user
25516 @item show user
25517 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25518 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25519 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25520 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25521 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25522
25523 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25524 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25525 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25526 @item show max-user-call-depth
25527 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25528 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25529 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25530 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25531 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25532 @end table
25533
25534 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25535 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25536
25537 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25538 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25539 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25540
25541 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25542 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25543 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25544 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25545
25546 @node Hooks
25547 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25548 @cindex command hooks
25549 @cindex hooks, for commands
25550 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25551
25552 @kindex hook
25553 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25554 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25555 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25556 before that command.
25557
25558 @cindex hooks, post-command
25559 @kindex hookpost
25560 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25561 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25562 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25563 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25564 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25565
25566 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25567 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25568
25569 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25570 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25571
25572 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25573 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25574 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25575 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25576 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25577
25578 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25579 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25580 you could define:
25581
25582 @smallexample
25583 define hook-stop
25584 handle SIGALRM nopass
25585 end
25586
25587 define hook-run
25588 handle SIGALRM pass
25589 end
25590
25591 define hook-continue
25592 handle SIGALRM pass
25593 end
25594 @end smallexample
25595
25596 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25597 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25598 you could define:
25599
25600 @smallexample
25601 define hook-echo
25602 echo <<<---
25603 end
25604
25605 define hookpost-echo
25606 echo --->>>\n
25607 end
25608
25609 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25610 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25611 (@value{GDBP})
25612
25613 @end smallexample
25614
25615 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25616 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25617 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25618 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25619 @c or not?
25620 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25621 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25622 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25623
25624 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25625 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25626 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25627
25628 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25629 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25630
25631 @node Command Files
25632 @subsection Command Files
25633
25634 @cindex command files
25635 @cindex scripting commands
25636 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25637 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25638 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25639 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25640 terminal.
25641
25642 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25643 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25644 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25645 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25646 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25647
25648 @table @code
25649 @kindex source
25650 @cindex execute commands from a file
25651 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25652 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25653 @end table
25654
25655 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25656 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25657 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25658 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25659 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25660
25661 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25662 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25663 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25664 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25665 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25666 is not relevant to scripts.
25667
25668 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25669 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25670 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25671 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25672 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25673 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25674 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25675 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25676 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25677 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25678 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25679 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25680 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25681 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25682
25683 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25684 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25685 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25686
25687 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25688 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25689 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25690 when called from command files.
25691
25692 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25693 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25694 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25695 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25696 the next command.
25697
25698 @smallexample
25699 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25700 @end smallexample
25701
25702 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25703 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25704 would be directed to @file{log}.
25705
25706 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25707 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25708 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25709 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25710 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25711 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25712 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25713 conditionally, etc.
25714
25715 @table @code
25716 @kindex if
25717 @kindex else
25718 @item if
25719 @itemx else
25720 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25721 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25722 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25723 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25724 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25725 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25726 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25727
25728 @kindex while
25729 @item while
25730 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25731 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25732 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25733 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25734 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25735 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25736
25737 @kindex loop_break
25738 @item loop_break
25739 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25740 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25741 line.
25742
25743 @kindex loop_continue
25744 @item loop_continue
25745 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25746 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25747 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25748 the controlling expression.
25749
25750 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25751 @item end
25752 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25753 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25754 @end table
25755
25756
25757 @node Output
25758 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25759
25760 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25761 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25762 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25763 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25764 want.
25765
25766 @table @code
25767 @kindex echo
25768 @item echo @var{text}
25769 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25770 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25771 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25772 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25773 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25774 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25775 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25776 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25777 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25778 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25779 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25780
25781 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25782 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25783
25784 @smallexample
25785 echo This is some text\n\
25786 which is continued\n\
25787 onto several lines.\n
25788 @end smallexample
25789
25790 produces the same output as
25791
25792 @smallexample
25793 echo This is some text\n
25794 echo which is continued\n
25795 echo onto several lines.\n
25796 @end smallexample
25797
25798 @kindex output
25799 @item output @var{expression}
25800 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25801 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25802 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25803 on expressions.
25804
25805 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25806 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25807 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25808 Formats}, for more information.
25809
25810 @kindex printf
25811 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25812 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25813 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25814 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25815 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25816 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25817 executing the code below:
25818
25819 @smallexample
25820 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25821 @end smallexample
25822
25823 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25824 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25825 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25826 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25827 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25828 printed.
25829
25830 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25831
25832 @smallexample
25833 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25834 @end smallexample
25835
25836 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25837 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25838 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25839
25840 @itemize @bullet
25841 @item
25842 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25843
25844 @item
25845 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25846 width.
25847
25848 @item
25849 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25850 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25851
25852 @item
25853 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25854 supported.
25855
25856 @item
25857 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25858
25859 @item
25860 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25861 @end itemize
25862
25863 @noindent
25864 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25865 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25866 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25867 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25868
25869 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25870 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25871 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25872 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25873 supported.
25874
25875 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25876 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25877 together with a floating point specifier.
25878 letters:
25879
25880 @itemize @bullet
25881 @item
25882 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25883
25884 @item
25885 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25886
25887 @item
25888 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25889 @end itemize
25890
25891 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25892 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25893 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25894
25895 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25896 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25897
25898 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25899 @smallexample
25900 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25901 @end smallexample
25902
25903 @anchor{eval}
25904 @kindex eval
25905 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25906 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25907 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25908
25909 @end table
25910
25911 @node Auto-loading sequences
25912 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25913 @cindex native script auto-loading
25914
25915 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25916 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25917 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25918 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25919
25920 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25921 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25922
25923 @table @code
25924 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25925 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25926 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25927 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25928
25929 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25930 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25931 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25932 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25933 disabled.
25934
25935 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25936 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25937 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25938 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25939 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25940 auto-loaded.
25941 @end table
25942
25943 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25944 matching names are printed.
25945
25946 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25947 @include python.texi
25948
25949 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25950 @include guile.texi
25951
25952 @node Auto-loading extensions
25953 @section Auto-loading extensions
25954 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25955
25956 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25957 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25958 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25959 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25960 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25961
25962 @menu
25963 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25964 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25965 * Which flavor to choose?::
25966 @end menu
25967
25968 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25969 debugging commands and features.
25970
25971 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25972 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25973 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25974 for more information.
25975 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25976 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25977
25978 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25979 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25980
25981 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25982 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25983 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25984 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25985 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25986
25987 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25988 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25989 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25990 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25991
25992 @table @code
25993 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25994 GDB's own command language
25995 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25996 Python
25997 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25998 Guile
25999 @end table
26000
26001 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26002 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26003 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26004 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26005 script in the specified extension language.
26006
26007 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26008 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26009
26010 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26011 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26012
26013 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26014 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26015 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26016 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26017 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26018 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26019
26020 @table @code
26021 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26022 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26023 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26024 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26025 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26026 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26027
26028 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26029 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26030
26031 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26032 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26033 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26034 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26035
26036 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26037 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26038 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26039 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26040 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26041 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26042 platform.
26043
26044 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26045 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26046 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26047
26048 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26049 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26050 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26051 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26052
26053 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26054 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26055 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26056 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26057 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26058 @end table
26059
26060 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26061 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26062 @var{objfile} is opened.
26063 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26064 is evaluated more than once.
26065
26066 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26067 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26068 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26069
26070 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26071 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26072 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26073 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26074 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26075 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26076 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26077
26078 The following entries are supported:
26079
26080 @table @code
26081 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26082 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26083 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26084 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26085 @end table
26086
26087 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26088
26089 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26090 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26091 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26092 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26093 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26094
26095 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26096 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26097
26098 @example
26099 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26100 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26101 asm("\
26102 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26103 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26104 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26105 .popsection \n\
26106 ");
26107 @end example
26108
26109 @noindent
26110 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26111 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26112
26113 @example
26114 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26115 @end example
26116
26117 The script name may include directories if desired.
26118
26119 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26120 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26121
26122 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26123 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26124 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26125 will remove duplicates.
26126
26127 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26128
26129 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26130 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26131 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26132 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26133 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26134 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26135 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26136 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26137 on its name.
26138
26139 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26140 testsuite.
26141
26142 @example
26143 #include "symcat.h"
26144 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26145 asm(
26146 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26147 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26148 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26149 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26150 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26151 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26152 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26153 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26154 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26155 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26156 ".byte 0\n"
26157 ".popsection\n"
26158 );
26159 @end example
26160
26161 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26162 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26163 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26164 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26165
26166 @node Which flavor to choose?
26167 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26168
26169 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26170 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26171
26172 @noindent
26173 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26174
26175 @itemize @bullet
26176 @item
26177 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26178
26179 @item
26180 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26181
26182 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26183 in the source search path.
26184 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26185 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26186
26187 @item
26188 Doesn't require source code additions.
26189 @end itemize
26190
26191 @noindent
26192 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26193
26194 @itemize @bullet
26195 @item
26196 Works with static linking.
26197
26198 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26199 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26200 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26201 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26202 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26203
26204 @item
26205 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26206
26207 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26208 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26209
26210 @item
26211 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26212
26213 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26214 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26215 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26216 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26217 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26218 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26219 @end itemize
26220
26221 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26222 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26223
26224 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26225 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26226 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26227
26228 @subsection Python comes first
26229
26230 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26231 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26232 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26233 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26234 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26235 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26236 pretty-printed form of a value).
26237 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26238 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26239 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26240
26241 @node Aliases
26242 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26243 @cindex aliases for commands
26244
26245 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26246 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26247 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26248 that involves less typing.
26249
26250 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26251 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26252 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26253
26254 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26255 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26256 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26257
26258 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26259
26260 @table @code
26261
26262 @kindex alias
26263 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26264
26265 @end table
26266
26267 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26268 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26269 underscores.
26270
26271 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26272 that is being aliased.
26273
26274 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26275 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26276 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26277
26278 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26279 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26280
26281 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26282 of a command so that there is less to type.
26283 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26284 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26285 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26286 The following will accomplish this.
26287
26288 @smallexample
26289 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26290 @end smallexample
26291
26292 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26293 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26294 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26295 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26296
26297 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26298 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26299 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26300 of a command.
26301
26302 @smallexample
26303 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26304 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26305 (gdb) set p elms 20
26306 (gdb) show p elms
26307 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26308 @end smallexample
26309
26310 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26311 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26312 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26313
26314 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26315 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26316
26317 @smallexample
26318 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26319 @end smallexample
26320
26321 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26322 alias for a more complex command.
26323 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26324
26325 @smallexample
26326 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26327 (gdb) spe 20
26328 @end smallexample
26329
26330 @node Interpreters
26331 @chapter Command Interpreters
26332 @cindex command interpreters
26333
26334 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26335 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26336 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26337
26338 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26339 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26340 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26341 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26342
26343 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26344 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26345 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26346 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26347
26348 @table @code
26349 @item console
26350 @cindex console interpreter
26351 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26352 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26353 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26354
26355 @item mi
26356 @cindex mi interpreter
26357 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26358 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26359 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26360 Interface}.
26361
26362 @item mi2
26363 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26364 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26365
26366 @item mi1
26367 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26368 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26369
26370 @end table
26371
26372 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26373
26374 @kindex interpreter-exec
26375 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26376 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26377 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26378
26379 @smallexample
26380 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26381 @end smallexample
26382
26383 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26384 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26385
26386 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26387 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26388 permanently.
26389
26390 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26391
26392 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26393 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26394 device (usually a tty).
26395
26396 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26397 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26398 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26399 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26400 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26401 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26402 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26403 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26404 the separate MI interpreter.
26405
26406 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26407 @code{new-ui} command:
26408
26409 @kindex new-ui
26410 @cindex new user interface
26411 @smallexample
26412 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26413 @end smallexample
26414
26415 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26416 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26417 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26418 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26419 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26420 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26421
26422 @smallexample
26423 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26424 @end smallexample
26425
26426 @noindent
26427 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26428
26429 @node TUI
26430 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26431 @cindex TUI
26432 @cindex Text User Interface
26433
26434 @menu
26435 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26436 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26437 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26438 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26439 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26440 @end menu
26441
26442 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26443 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26444 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26445 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26446 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26447 is available.
26448
26449 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26450 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26451 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26452 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26453 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26454 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26455
26456 @node TUI Overview
26457 @section TUI Overview
26458
26459 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26460
26461 @table @emph
26462 @item command
26463 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26464 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26465 managed using readline.
26466
26467 @item source
26468 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26469 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26470
26471 @item assembly
26472 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26473
26474 @item register
26475 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26476 when their values change.
26477 @end table
26478
26479 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26480 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26481 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26482 indicates the breakpoint type:
26483
26484 @table @code
26485 @item B
26486 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26487
26488 @item b
26489 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26490
26491 @item H
26492 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26493
26494 @item h
26495 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26496 @end table
26497
26498 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26499
26500 @table @code
26501 @item +
26502 Breakpoint is enabled.
26503
26504 @item -
26505 Breakpoint is disabled.
26506 @end table
26507
26508 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26509 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26510 changes.
26511
26512 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26513 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26514 layouts:
26515
26516 @itemize @bullet
26517 @item
26518 source only,
26519
26520 @item
26521 assembly only,
26522
26523 @item
26524 source and assembly,
26525
26526 @item
26527 source and registers, or
26528
26529 @item
26530 assembly and registers.
26531 @end itemize
26532
26533 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26534
26535 @table @emph
26536 @item target
26537 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26538 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26539
26540 @item process
26541 Gives the current process or thread number.
26542 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26543
26544 @item function
26545 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26546 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26547 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26548 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26549
26550 @item line
26551 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26552 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26553
26554 @item pc
26555 Indicates the current program counter address.
26556 @end table
26557
26558 @node TUI Keys
26559 @section TUI Key Bindings
26560 @cindex TUI key bindings
26561
26562 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26563 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26564 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26565 @end ifset
26566 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26567 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26568 @end ifclear
26569 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26570 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26571
26572 @table @kbd
26573 @kindex C-x C-a
26574 @item C-x C-a
26575 @kindex C-x a
26576 @itemx C-x a
26577 @kindex C-x A
26578 @itemx C-x A
26579 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26580 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26581 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26582 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26583 The screen is then refreshed.
26584
26585 @kindex C-x 1
26586 @item C-x 1
26587 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26588 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26589 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26590
26591 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26592
26593 @kindex C-x 2
26594 @item C-x 2
26595 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26596 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26597 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26598 previous layout and the new one.
26599
26600 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26601
26602 @kindex C-x o
26603 @item C-x o
26604 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26605 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26606 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26607
26608 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26609
26610 @kindex C-x s
26611 @item C-x s
26612 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26613 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26614 @end table
26615
26616 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26617
26618 @table @asis
26619 @kindex PgUp
26620 @item @key{PgUp}
26621 Scroll the active window one page up.
26622
26623 @kindex PgDn
26624 @item @key{PgDn}
26625 Scroll the active window one page down.
26626
26627 @kindex Up
26628 @item @key{Up}
26629 Scroll the active window one line up.
26630
26631 @kindex Down
26632 @item @key{Down}
26633 Scroll the active window one line down.
26634
26635 @kindex Left
26636 @item @key{Left}
26637 Scroll the active window one column left.
26638
26639 @kindex Right
26640 @item @key{Right}
26641 Scroll the active window one column right.
26642
26643 @kindex C-L
26644 @item @kbd{C-L}
26645 Refresh the screen.
26646 @end table
26647
26648 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26649 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26650 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26651 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26652 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26653
26654 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26655 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26656 @cindex TUI single key mode
26657
26658 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26659 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26660 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26661
26662 @table @kbd
26663 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26664 @item c
26665 continue
26666
26667 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26668 @item d
26669 down
26670
26671 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26672 @item f
26673 finish
26674
26675 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26676 @item n
26677 next
26678
26679 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26680 @item o
26681 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26682
26683 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26684 @item q
26685 exit the SingleKey mode.
26686
26687 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26688 @item r
26689 run
26690
26691 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26692 @item s
26693 step
26694
26695 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26696 @item i
26697 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26698
26699 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26700 @item u
26701 up
26702
26703 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26704 @item v
26705 info locals
26706
26707 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26708 @item w
26709 where
26710 @end table
26711
26712 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26713 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26714 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26715 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26716 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26717 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26718
26719
26720 @node TUI Commands
26721 @section TUI-specific Commands
26722 @cindex TUI commands
26723
26724 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26725 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26726 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26727 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26728
26729 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26730 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26731 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26732 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26733 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26734
26735 @table @code
26736 @item tui enable
26737 @kindex tui enable
26738 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26739 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26740 otherwise a default layout is used.
26741
26742 @item tui disable
26743 @kindex tui disable
26744 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26745
26746 @item info win
26747 @kindex info win
26748 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26749
26750 @item layout @var{name}
26751 @kindex layout
26752 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26753 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26754 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26755
26756 @table @code
26757 @item next
26758 Display the next layout.
26759
26760 @item prev
26761 Display the previous layout.
26762
26763 @item src
26764 Display the source and command windows.
26765
26766 @item asm
26767 Display the assembly and command windows.
26768
26769 @item split
26770 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26771
26772 @item regs
26773 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26774 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26775 register, assembler, and command windows.
26776 @end table
26777
26778 @item focus @var{name}
26779 @kindex focus
26780 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26781 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26782
26783 @table @code
26784 @item next
26785 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26786
26787 @item prev
26788 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26789
26790 @item src
26791 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26792
26793 @item asm
26794 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26795
26796 @item regs
26797 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26798
26799 @item cmd
26800 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26801 @end table
26802
26803 @item refresh
26804 @kindex refresh
26805 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26806
26807 @item tui reg @var{group}
26808 @kindex tui reg
26809 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26810 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26811 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26812 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26813 following groups are available on most targets:
26814 @table @code
26815 @item next
26816 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26817 through all of the available register groups.
26818
26819 @item prev
26820 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26821 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26822 @var{next}.
26823
26824 @item general
26825 Display the general registers.
26826 @item float
26827 Display the floating point registers.
26828 @item system
26829 Display the system registers.
26830 @item vector
26831 Display the vector registers.
26832 @item all
26833 Display all registers.
26834 @end table
26835
26836 @item update
26837 @kindex update
26838 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26839
26840 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26841 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26842 @kindex winheight
26843 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26844 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26845 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26846 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26847 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26848 @end table
26849
26850 @node TUI Configuration
26851 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26852 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26853
26854 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26855
26856 @table @code
26857 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26858 @kindex set tui border-kind
26859 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26860 The possible values are the following:
26861 @table @code
26862 @item space
26863 Use a space character to draw the border.
26864
26865 @item ascii
26866 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26867
26868 @item acs
26869 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26870 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26871 @end table
26872
26873 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26874 @kindex set tui border-mode
26875 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26876 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26877 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26878 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26879 @table @code
26880 @item normal
26881 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26882
26883 @item standout
26884 Use standout mode.
26885
26886 @item reverse
26887 Use reverse video mode.
26888
26889 @item half
26890 Use half bright mode.
26891
26892 @item half-standout
26893 Use half bright and standout mode.
26894
26895 @item bold
26896 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26897
26898 @item bold-standout
26899 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26900 @end table
26901
26902 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
26903 @kindex set tui tab-width
26904 @kindex tabset
26905 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26906 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26907 assembly windows.
26908 @end table
26909
26910 @node Emacs
26911 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26912
26913 @cindex Emacs
26914 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26915 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26916 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26917 @value{GDBN}.
26918
26919 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26920 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26921 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26922 created Emacs buffer.
26923 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26924
26925 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26926 things:
26927
26928 @itemize @bullet
26929 @item
26930 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26931 the GUD buffer.
26932
26933 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26934 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26935
26936 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26937 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26938 in this way.
26939
26940 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26941 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26942 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26943 stop.
26944
26945 @item
26946 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26947
26948 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26949 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26950 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26951 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26952 and the source.
26953
26954 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26955 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26956 @end itemize
26957
26958 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26959 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26960 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26961 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26962
26963 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26964 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26965 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26966 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26967 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26968 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26969 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26970 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26971 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26972
26973 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26974 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26975 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26976 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26977
26978 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26979 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26980 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26981 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26982 one you want.
26983
26984 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26985 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26986
26987 @table @kbd
26988 @item C-h m
26989 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26990
26991 @item C-c C-s
26992 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26993 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26994
26995 @item C-c C-n
26996 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26997 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26998 to show the current file and location.
26999
27000 @item C-c C-i
27001 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27002 display window accordingly.
27003
27004 @item C-c C-f
27005 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27006 @code{finish} command.
27007
27008 @item C-c C-r
27009 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27010 command.
27011
27012 @item C-c <
27013 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27014 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27015 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27016
27017 @item C-c >
27018 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27019 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27020 @end table
27021
27022 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27023 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27024
27025 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27026 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27027 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27028 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27029 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27030 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27031 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27032
27033 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27034 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27035 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27036 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27037 frame.
27038
27039 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27040 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27041 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27042 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27043 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27044 to correspond properly with the code.
27045
27046 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27047 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27048 Emacs Manual}).
27049
27050 @node GDB/MI
27051 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27052
27053 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27054
27055 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27056 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27057 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27058 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27059 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27060 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27061
27062 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27063 in the form of a reference manual.
27064
27065 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27066 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27067 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27068
27069 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27070
27071 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27072 This chapter uses the following notation:
27073
27074 @itemize @bullet
27075 @item
27076 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27077
27078 @item
27079 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27080 it may or may not be given.
27081
27082 @item
27083 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27084 may repeat zero or more times.
27085
27086 @item
27087 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27088 may repeat one or more times.
27089
27090 @item
27091 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27092 @end itemize
27093
27094 @ignore
27095 @heading Dependencies
27096 @end ignore
27097
27098 @menu
27099 * GDB/MI General Design::
27100 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27101 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27102 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27103 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27104 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27105 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27106 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27107 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27108 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27109 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27110 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27111 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27112 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27113 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27114 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27115 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27116 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27117 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27118 @ignore
27119 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27120 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27121 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27122 @end ignore
27123 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27124 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27125 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27126 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27127 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27128 @end menu
27129
27130 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27131 @node GDB/MI General Design
27132 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27133 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27134
27135 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27136 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27137 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27138 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27139 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27140 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27141 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27142 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27143 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27144 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27145
27146 The important examples of notifications are:
27147 @itemize @bullet
27148
27149 @item
27150 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27151 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27152 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27153 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27154 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27155 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27156 command itself was successfully executed.
27157
27158 @item
27159 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27160 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27161 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27162 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27163 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27164 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27165
27166 @item
27167 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27168 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27169 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27170 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27171 orthogonal frontend design.
27172
27173 @end itemize
27174
27175 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27176 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27177 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27178 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27179 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27180 the user interface.
27181
27182
27183 @menu
27184 * Context management::
27185 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27186 * Thread groups::
27187 @end menu
27188
27189 @node Context management
27190 @subsection Context management
27191
27192 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27193
27194 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27195 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27196 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27197 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27198 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27199 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27200 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27201 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27202 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27203
27204 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27205 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27206 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27207 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27208 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27209 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27210 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27211 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27212 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27213 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27214 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27215
27216 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27217 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27218 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27219 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27220 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27221 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27222 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27223 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27224 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27225 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27226
27227 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27228 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27229 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27230 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27231 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27232 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27233 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27234 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27235 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27236 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27237 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27238 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27239 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27240 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27241 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27242 @samp{--frame} options.
27243
27244 @subsubsection Language
27245
27246 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27247 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27248 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27249 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27250 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27251 For instance:
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27255 ^done,value="4"
27256 (gdb)
27257 @end smallexample
27258
27259 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27260 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27261 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27262
27263 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27264 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27265
27266 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27267 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27268 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27269 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27270 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27271 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27272 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27273 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27274 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27275
27276 @table @code
27277 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27278 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27279 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27280
27281 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27282 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27283 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27284
27285 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27286 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27287 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27288 MI commands even while the target is running.
27289
27290 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27291 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27292 @end table
27293
27294 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27295 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27296 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27297 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27298 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27299 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27300
27301 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27302 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27303 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27304 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27305 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27306 are running.
27307
27308 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27309 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27310 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27311 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27312 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27313 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27314 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27315 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27316 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27317 @samp{--thread} option).
27318
27319 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27320 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27321 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27322 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27323
27324 @node Thread groups
27325 @subsection Thread groups
27326 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27327 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27328 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27329 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27330 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27331
27332 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27333 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27334 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27335 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27336 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27337 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27338 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27339 into processes.
27340
27341 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27342 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27343 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27344 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27345 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27346 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27347 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27348 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27349 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27350 the members of specific thread group.
27351
27352 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27353 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27354 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27355 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27356 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27357 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27358 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27359 after attaching to that thread group.
27360
27361 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27362 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27363 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27364 such thread groups.
27365
27366 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27367 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27368 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27369
27370 @menu
27371 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27372 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27373 @end menu
27374
27375 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27376 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27377
27378 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27379 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27380 @table @code
27381 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27382 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27383
27384 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27385 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27386 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27387
27388 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27389 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27390 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27391
27392 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27393 "any sequence of digits"
27394
27395 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27396 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27397
27398 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27399 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27400
27401 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27402 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27403
27404 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27405 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27406 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27407
27408 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27409 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27410
27411 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27412 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27413 @end table
27414
27415 @noindent
27416 Notes:
27417
27418 @itemize @bullet
27419 @item
27420 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27421 output is described below.
27422
27423 @item
27424 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27425 finishes.
27426
27427 @item
27428 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27429 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27430 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27431 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27432 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27433 @end itemize
27434
27435 Pragmatics:
27436
27437 @itemize @bullet
27438 @item
27439 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27440
27441 @item
27442 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27443 @end itemize
27444
27445 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27446 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27447
27448 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27449 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27450 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27451 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27452 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27453 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27454
27455 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27456 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27457 @var{token}.
27458
27459 @table @code
27460 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27461 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27462
27463 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27464 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27465
27466 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27467 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27468
27469 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27470 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27471
27472 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27473 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27474
27475 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27476 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27477
27478 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27479 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27480
27481 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27482 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27483
27484 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27485 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27486
27487 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27488 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27489 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27490
27491 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27492 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27493
27494 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27495 @code{ @var{string} }
27496
27497 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27498 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27499
27500 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27501 @code{@var{c-string}}
27502
27503 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27504 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27505
27506 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27507 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27508 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27509
27510 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27511 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27512
27513 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27514 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27515
27516 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27517 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27518
27519 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27520 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27521
27522 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27523 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27524
27525 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27526 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27527 @end table
27528
27529 @noindent
27530 Notes:
27531
27532 @itemize @bullet
27533 @item
27534 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27535
27536 @item
27537 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27538 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27539 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27540 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27541 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27542 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27543 prior command.
27544
27545 @item
27546 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27547 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27548 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27549 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27550
27551 @item
27552 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27553 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27554 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27555 @samp{*}.
27556
27557 @item
27558 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27559 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27560 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27561 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27562
27563 @item
27564 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27565 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27566 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27567 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27568
27569 @item
27570 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27571 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27572 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27573
27574 @item
27575 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27576 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27577 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27578 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27579
27580 @item
27581 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27582 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27583 @var{values}.
27584
27585
27586 @end itemize
27587
27588 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27589 details about the various output records.
27590
27591 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27592 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27593 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27594
27595 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27596 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27597
27598 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27599 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27600 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27601 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27602 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27603 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27604
27605 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27606 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27607 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27608
27609 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27610 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27611 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27612 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27613
27614 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27615 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27616
27617 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27618 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27619 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27620 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27621 might change.
27622
27623 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27624 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27625 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27626 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27627
27628 @itemize @bullet
27629 @item
27630 New MI commands may be added.
27631
27632 @item
27633 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27634
27635 @item
27636 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27637 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27638
27639 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27640 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27641
27642 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27643 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27644 @end itemize
27645
27646 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27647 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27648 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27649 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27650 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27651
27652 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27653 @c version?
27654
27655 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27656 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27657 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27658 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27659 @cindex mailing lists
27660
27661 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27662 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27663 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27664
27665 @menu
27666 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27667 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27668 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27669 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27670 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27671 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27672 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27673 @end menu
27674
27675 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27676 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27677
27678 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27679 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27680 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27681 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27682
27683 @table @code
27684 @findex ^done
27685 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27686 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27687 values.
27688
27689 @item "^running"
27690 @findex ^running
27691 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27692 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27693 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27694 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27695 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27696 which threads are resumed.
27697
27698 @item "^connected"
27699 @findex ^connected
27700 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27701
27702 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27703 @findex ^error
27704 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27705 the corresponding error message.
27706
27707 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27708 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27709 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27710
27711 @table @samp
27712 @item "undefined-command"
27713 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27714 @end table
27715
27716 @item "^exit"
27717 @findex ^exit
27718 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27719
27720 @end table
27721
27722 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27723 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27724
27725 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27726 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27727 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27728 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27729 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27730
27731 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27732 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27733 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27734 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27735 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27736
27737 @table @code
27738 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27739 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27740 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27741
27742 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27743 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27744 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27745 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27746
27747 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27748 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27749 internals.
27750 @end table
27751
27752 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27753 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27754
27755 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27756 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27757 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27758 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27759 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27760 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27761
27762 The following is the list of possible async records:
27763
27764 @table @code
27765
27766 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27767 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27768 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27769 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27770 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27771 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27772 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27773 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27774 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27775 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27776 it run freely.
27777
27778 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27779 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27780 following values:
27781
27782 @table @code
27783 @item breakpoint-hit
27784 A breakpoint was reached.
27785 @item watchpoint-trigger
27786 A watchpoint was triggered.
27787 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27788 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27789 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27790 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27791 @item function-finished
27792 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27793 @item location-reached
27794 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27795 @item watchpoint-scope
27796 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27797 @item end-stepping-range
27798 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27799 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27800 @item exited-signalled
27801 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27802 @item exited
27803 The inferior exited.
27804 @item exited-normally
27805 The inferior exited normally.
27806 @item signal-received
27807 A signal was received by the inferior.
27808 @item solib-event
27809 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27810 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27811 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27812 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27813 @item fork
27814 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27815 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27816 @item vfork
27817 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27818 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27819 @item syscall-entry
27820 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27821 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27822 @item syscall-return
27823 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27824 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27825 @item exec
27826 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27827 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27828 @end table
27829
27830 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27831 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27832 Depending on whether all-stop
27833 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27834 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27835 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27836 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27837 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27838 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27839 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27840 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27841 if such information is not available.
27842
27843 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27844 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27845 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27846 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27847 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27848 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27849 cannot be used in any way.
27850
27851 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27852 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27853 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27854 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27855 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27856 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27857
27858 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27859 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27860 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27861 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27862 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27863 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27864
27865 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27866 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27867 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27868 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27869 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27870
27871 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27872 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27873 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27874 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27875 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27876 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27877 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27878 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27879 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27880
27881 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27882 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27883
27884 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27885 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27886 that thread.
27887
27888 @item =library-loaded,...
27889 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27890 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27891 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27892 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27893 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27894 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27895 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27896 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27897 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27898 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27899 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27900 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27901 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27902 to this library.
27903
27904 @item =library-unloaded,...
27905 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27906 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27907 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27908 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27909 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27910 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27911 thread groups.
27912
27913 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27914 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27915 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27916 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27917 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27918
27919 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27920 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27921 initial value @var{initial}.
27922
27923 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27924 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27925 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27926 trace state variables are deleted.
27927
27928 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27929 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27930 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27931 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27932 value of trace state variable is known.
27933
27934 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27935 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27936 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27937 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27938 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27939 user.
27940
27941 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27942 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27943 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27944
27945 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27946 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27947
27948 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27949 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27950 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27951 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27952 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27953
27954 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27955 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27956 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27957 for existing method and format values.
27958
27959 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27960 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27961 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27962 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27963 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27964 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27965
27966 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27967 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27968 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27969 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27970 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27971 executable code.
27972 @end table
27973
27974 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27975 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27976
27977 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27978 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27979 following fields:
27980
27981 @table @code
27982 @item number
27983 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27984 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27985 @samp{1.2}.
27986
27987 @item type
27988 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27989 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27990
27991 @item catch-type
27992 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27993 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27994
27995 @item disp
27996 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27997 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27998 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27999
28000 @item enabled
28001 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28002 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28003 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28004
28005 @item addr
28006 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28007 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28008 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28009 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28010 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28011
28012 @item func
28013 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28014 If not known, this field is not present.
28015
28016 @item filename
28017 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28018 If not known, this field is not present.
28019
28020 @item fullname
28021 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28022 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28023
28024 @item line
28025 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28026 If not known, this field is not present.
28027
28028 @item at
28029 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28030 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28031 by a symbol name.
28032
28033 @item pending
28034 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28035 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28036
28037 @item evaluated-by
28038 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28039 @samp{target}.
28040
28041 @item thread
28042 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28043 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28044
28045 @item task
28046 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28047 field will hold the task identifier.
28048
28049 @item cond
28050 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28051
28052 @item ignore
28053 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28054
28055 @item enable
28056 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28057
28058 @item traceframe-usage
28059 FIXME.
28060
28061 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28062 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28063
28064 @item mask
28065 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28066
28067 @item pass
28068 A tracepoint's pass count.
28069
28070 @item original-location
28071 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28072 This field is optional.
28073
28074 @item times
28075 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28076
28077 @item installed
28078 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28079 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28080 is not.
28081
28082 @item what
28083 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28084
28085 @end table
28086
28087 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28088 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28089
28090 @smallexample
28091 -> -break-insert main
28092 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28093 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28094 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28095 times="0"@}
28096 <- (gdb)
28097 @end smallexample
28098
28099 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28100 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28101
28102 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28103 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28104 fields:
28105
28106 @table @code
28107 @item level
28108 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28109 zero. This field is always present.
28110
28111 @item func
28112 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28113 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28114
28115 @item addr
28116 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28117
28118 @item file
28119 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28120 address. This field may be absent.
28121
28122 @item line
28123 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28124 may be absent.
28125
28126 @item from
28127 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28128 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28129
28130 @end table
28131
28132 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28133 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28134
28135 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28136 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28137 stated otherwise.
28138
28139 @table @code
28140 @item id
28141 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28142
28143 @item target-id
28144 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28145
28146 @item details
28147 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28148 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28149 frontend. This field is optional.
28150
28151 @item name
28152 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28153 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28154 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28155 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28156 field is omitted.
28157
28158 @item state
28159 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28160 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28161
28162 @item frame
28163 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28164 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28165 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28166
28167 @item core
28168 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28169 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28170 @end table
28171
28172 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28173 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28174
28175 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28176 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28177 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28178 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28179 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28180 the @code{exception-message} field.
28181
28182 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28183 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28184 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28185 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28186
28187 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28188 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28189 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28190 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28191
28192 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28193 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28194
28195 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28196
28197 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28198 information of the breakpoint.
28199
28200 @smallexample
28201 -> -break-insert main
28202 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28203 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28204 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28205 times="0"@}
28206 <- (gdb)
28207 @end smallexample
28208
28209 @subheading Program Execution
28210
28211 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28212 reason that execution stopped.
28213
28214 @smallexample
28215 -> -exec-run
28216 <- ^running
28217 <- (gdb)
28218 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28219 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28220 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28221 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28222 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28223 <- (gdb)
28224 -> -exec-continue
28225 <- ^running
28226 <- (gdb)
28227 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28228 <- (gdb)
28229 @end smallexample
28230
28231 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28232
28233 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 -> (gdb)
28237 <- -gdb-exit
28238 <- ^exit
28239 @end smallexample
28240
28241 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28242 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28243 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28244 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28245 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28246 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28247
28248 @subheading A Bad Command
28249
28250 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28251
28252 @smallexample
28253 -> -rubbish
28254 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28255 <- (gdb)
28256 @end smallexample
28257
28258
28259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28260 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28262
28263 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28264 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28265
28266 @subheading Motivation
28267
28268 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28269
28270 @subheading Introduction
28271
28272 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28273
28274 @subheading Commands
28275
28276 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28277
28278 @subsubheading Synopsis
28279
28280 @smallexample
28281 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28282 @end smallexample
28283
28284 @subsubheading Result
28285
28286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28287
28288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28289
28290 @subsubheading Example
28291
28292 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28293 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28294
28295
28296 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28297 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28298 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28299
28300 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28301 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28302 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28303 breakpoints.
28304
28305 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28306 @findex -break-after
28307
28308 @subsubheading Synopsis
28309
28310 @smallexample
28311 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28312 @end smallexample
28313
28314 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28315 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28316 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28317 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28318
28319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28320
28321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28322
28323 @subsubheading Example
28324
28325 @smallexample
28326 (gdb)
28327 -break-insert main
28328 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28329 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28330 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28331 times="0"@}
28332 (gdb)
28333 -break-after 1 3
28334 ~
28335 ^done
28336 (gdb)
28337 -break-list
28338 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28339 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28340 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28341 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28342 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28343 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28344 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28345 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28346 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28347 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28348 (gdb)
28349 @end smallexample
28350
28351 @ignore
28352 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28353 @findex -break-catch
28354 @end ignore
28355
28356 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28357 @findex -break-commands
28358
28359 @subsubheading Synopsis
28360
28361 @smallexample
28362 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28363 @end smallexample
28364
28365 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28366 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28367 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28368 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28369 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28370 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28371
28372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28373
28374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28375
28376 @subsubheading Example
28377
28378 @smallexample
28379 (gdb)
28380 -break-insert main
28381 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28382 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28383 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28384 times="0"@}
28385 (gdb)
28386 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28387 ^done
28388 (gdb)
28389 @end smallexample
28390
28391 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28392 @findex -break-condition
28393
28394 @subsubheading Synopsis
28395
28396 @smallexample
28397 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28398 @end smallexample
28399
28400 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28401 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28402 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28403 command below).
28404
28405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28406
28407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28408
28409 @subsubheading Example
28410
28411 @smallexample
28412 (gdb)
28413 -break-condition 1 1
28414 ^done
28415 (gdb)
28416 -break-list
28417 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28418 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28419 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28420 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28421 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28422 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28423 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28424 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28425 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28426 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28427 (gdb)
28428 @end smallexample
28429
28430 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28431 @findex -break-delete
28432
28433 @subsubheading Synopsis
28434
28435 @smallexample
28436 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28437 @end smallexample
28438
28439 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28440 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28441
28442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28443
28444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28445
28446 @subsubheading Example
28447
28448 @smallexample
28449 (gdb)
28450 -break-delete 1
28451 ^done
28452 (gdb)
28453 -break-list
28454 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28455 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28456 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28457 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28458 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28459 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28460 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28461 body=[]@}
28462 (gdb)
28463 @end smallexample
28464
28465 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28466 @findex -break-disable
28467
28468 @subsubheading Synopsis
28469
28470 @smallexample
28471 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28475 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28476
28477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28478
28479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28480
28481 @subsubheading Example
28482
28483 @smallexample
28484 (gdb)
28485 -break-disable 2
28486 ^done
28487 (gdb)
28488 -break-list
28489 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28490 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28491 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28492 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28493 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28494 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28495 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28496 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28497 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28498 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28499 (gdb)
28500 @end smallexample
28501
28502 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28503 @findex -break-enable
28504
28505 @subsubheading Synopsis
28506
28507 @smallexample
28508 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28512
28513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28514
28515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28516
28517 @subsubheading Example
28518
28519 @smallexample
28520 (gdb)
28521 -break-enable 2
28522 ^done
28523 (gdb)
28524 -break-list
28525 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28526 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28527 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28528 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28529 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28530 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28531 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28532 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28533 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28534 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28535 (gdb)
28536 @end smallexample
28537
28538 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28539 @findex -break-info
28540
28541 @subsubheading Synopsis
28542
28543 @smallexample
28544 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28545 @end smallexample
28546
28547 @c REDUNDANT???
28548 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28549
28550 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28551 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28552 table.
28553
28554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28555
28556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28557
28558 @subsubheading Example
28559 N.A.
28560
28561 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28562 @findex -break-insert
28563 @anchor{-break-insert}
28564
28565 @subsubheading Synopsis
28566
28567 @smallexample
28568 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28569 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28570 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28571 @end smallexample
28572
28573 @noindent
28574 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28575
28576 @table @var
28577 @item linespec location
28578 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28579
28580 @item explicit location
28581 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28582 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28583 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28584
28585 @table @samp
28586 @item --source @var{filename}
28587 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28588 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28589
28590 @item --function @var{function}
28591 The name of a function or method.
28592
28593 @item --label @var{label}
28594 The name of a label.
28595
28596 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28597 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28598 @end table
28599
28600 @item address location
28601 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28602 @end table
28603
28604 @noindent
28605 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28606
28607 @table @samp
28608 @item -t
28609 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28610 @item -h
28611 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28612 @item -f
28613 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28614 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28615 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28616 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28617 cannot be parsed.
28618 @item -d
28619 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28620 @item -a
28621 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28622 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28623 @item -c @var{condition}
28624 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28625 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28626 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28627 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28628 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28629 @var{thread-id}.
28630 @end table
28631
28632 @subsubheading Result
28633
28634 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28635 resulting breakpoint.
28636
28637 Note: this format is open to change.
28638 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28639
28640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28641
28642 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28643 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28644
28645 @subsubheading Example
28646
28647 @smallexample
28648 (gdb)
28649 -break-insert main
28650 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28651 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28652 times="0"@}
28653 (gdb)
28654 -break-insert -t foo
28655 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28656 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28657 times="0"@}
28658 (gdb)
28659 -break-list
28660 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28661 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28662 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28663 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28664 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28665 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28666 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28667 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28668 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28669 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28670 times="0"@},
28671 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28672 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28673 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28674 times="0"@}]@}
28675 (gdb)
28676 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28677 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28678 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28679 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28680 @c times="0"@}
28681 @c (gdb)
28682 @end smallexample
28683
28684 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28685 @findex -dprintf-insert
28686
28687 @subsubheading Synopsis
28688
28689 @smallexample
28690 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28691 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28692 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28693 [ @var{argument} ]
28694 @end smallexample
28695
28696 @noindent
28697 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28698 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28699
28700 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28701
28702 @table @samp
28703 @item -t
28704 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28705 @item -f
28706 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28707 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28708 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28709 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28710 cannot be parsed.
28711 @item -d
28712 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28713 @item -c @var{condition}
28714 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28715 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28716 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28717 to @var{ignore-count}.
28718 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28719 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28720 @var{thread-id}.
28721 @end table
28722
28723 @subsubheading Result
28724
28725 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28726 resulting breakpoint.
28727
28728 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28729
28730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28731
28732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28733
28734 @subsubheading Example
28735
28736 @smallexample
28737 (gdb)
28738 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28739 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28740 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28741 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28742 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28743 original-location="foo"@}
28744 (gdb)
28745 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28746 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28747 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28748 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28749 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28750 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28751 (gdb)
28752 @end smallexample
28753
28754 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28755 @findex -break-list
28756
28757 @subsubheading Synopsis
28758
28759 @smallexample
28760 -break-list
28761 @end smallexample
28762
28763 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28764
28765 @table @samp
28766 @item Number
28767 number of the breakpoint
28768 @item Type
28769 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28770 @item Disposition
28771 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28772 or @samp{nokeep}
28773 @item Enabled
28774 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28775 @item Address
28776 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28777 @item What
28778 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28779 name, line number
28780 @item Thread-groups
28781 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28782 @item Times
28783 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28784 @end table
28785
28786 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28787 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28788
28789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28790
28791 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28792
28793 @subsubheading Example
28794
28795 @smallexample
28796 (gdb)
28797 -break-list
28798 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28799 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28800 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28801 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28802 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28803 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28804 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28805 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28806 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28807 times="0"@},
28808 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28809 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28810 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28811 (gdb)
28812 @end smallexample
28813
28814 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28815
28816 @smallexample
28817 (gdb)
28818 -break-list
28819 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28820 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28821 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28822 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28823 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28824 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28825 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28826 body=[]@}
28827 (gdb)
28828 @end smallexample
28829
28830 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28831 @findex -break-passcount
28832
28833 @subsubheading Synopsis
28834
28835 @smallexample
28836 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28837 @end smallexample
28838
28839 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28840 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28841 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28842 command @samp{passcount}.
28843
28844 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28845 @findex -break-watch
28846
28847 @subsubheading Synopsis
28848
28849 @smallexample
28850 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28851 @end smallexample
28852
28853 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28854 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28855 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28856 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28857 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28858 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28859 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28860 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28861
28862 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28863 breakpoints inserted.
28864
28865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28866
28867 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28868 @samp{rwatch}.
28869
28870 @subsubheading Example
28871
28872 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28873
28874 @smallexample
28875 (gdb)
28876 -break-watch x
28877 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28878 (gdb)
28879 -exec-continue
28880 ^running
28881 (gdb)
28882 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28883 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28884 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28886 (gdb)
28887 @end smallexample
28888
28889 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28890 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28891 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28892
28893 @smallexample
28894 (gdb)
28895 -break-watch C
28896 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28897 (gdb)
28898 -exec-continue
28899 ^running
28900 (gdb)
28901 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28902 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28903 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28904 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28905 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28906 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28907 (gdb)
28908 -exec-continue
28909 ^running
28910 (gdb)
28911 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28912 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28913 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28914 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28915 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28916 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28917 (gdb)
28918 @end smallexample
28919
28920 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28921 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28922 deleted.
28923
28924 @smallexample
28925 (gdb)
28926 -break-watch C
28927 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28928 (gdb)
28929 -break-list
28930 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28931 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28932 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28933 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28934 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28935 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28936 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28937 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28938 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28939 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28940 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28941 times="1"@},
28942 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28943 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28944 (gdb)
28945 -exec-continue
28946 ^running
28947 (gdb)
28948 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28949 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28950 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28951 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28952 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28953 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28954 (gdb)
28955 -break-list
28956 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28957 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28958 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28959 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28960 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28961 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28962 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28963 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28964 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28965 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28966 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28967 times="1"@},
28968 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28969 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28970 (gdb)
28971 -exec-continue
28972 ^running
28973 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28974 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28975 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28978 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28979 (gdb)
28980 -break-list
28981 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28982 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28983 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28984 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28985 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28986 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28987 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28988 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28989 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28990 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28991 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28992 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28993 (gdb)
28994 @end smallexample
28995
28996
28997 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28998 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28999 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29000
29001 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29002 catchpoints.
29003
29004 @menu
29005 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29006 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29007 @end menu
29008
29009 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29010 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29011
29012 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29013 @findex -catch-load
29014
29015 @subsubheading Synopsis
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29019 @end smallexample
29020
29021 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29022 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29023 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29024 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29025 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29026
29027
29028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29029
29030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29031
29032 @subsubheading Example
29033
29034 @smallexample
29035 -catch-load -t foo.so
29036 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29037 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29038 (gdb)
29039 @end smallexample
29040
29041
29042 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29043 @findex -catch-unload
29044
29045 @subsubheading Synopsis
29046
29047 @smallexample
29048 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29049 @end smallexample
29050
29051 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29052 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29053 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29054 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29055 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29056
29057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29058
29059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29060
29061 @subsubheading Example
29062
29063 @smallexample
29064 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29065 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29066 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29067 (gdb)
29068 @end smallexample
29069
29070 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29071 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29072
29073 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29074 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29075
29076 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29077 @findex -catch-assert
29078
29079 @subsubheading Synopsis
29080
29081 @smallexample
29082 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29083 @end smallexample
29084
29085 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29086
29087 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29088
29089 @table @samp
29090 @item -c @var{condition}
29091 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29092 @item -d
29093 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29094 @item -t
29095 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29096 @end table
29097
29098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29099
29100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29101
29102 @subsubheading Example
29103
29104 @smallexample
29105 -catch-assert
29106 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29107 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29108 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29109 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29110 (gdb)
29111 @end smallexample
29112
29113 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29114 @findex -catch-exception
29115
29116 @subsubheading Synopsis
29117
29118 @smallexample
29119 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29120 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29121 @end smallexample
29122
29123 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29124 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29125 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29126 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29127 catchpoints.
29128
29129 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29130
29131 @table @samp
29132 @item -c @var{condition}
29133 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29134 @item -d
29135 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29136 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29137 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29138 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29139 @item -t
29140 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29141 @item -u
29142 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29143 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29144 @end table
29145
29146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29147
29148 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29149 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29150
29151 @subsubheading Example
29152
29153 @smallexample
29154 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29155 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29156 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29157 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29158 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29159 (gdb)
29160 @end smallexample
29161
29162 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29163 @findex -catch-handlers
29164
29165 @subsubheading Synopsis
29166
29167 @smallexample
29168 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29169 [ -t ]
29170 @end smallexample
29171
29172 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29173 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29174 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29175 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29176 catchpoints.
29177
29178 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29179
29180 @table @samp
29181 @item -c @var{condition}
29182 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29183 @item -d
29184 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29185 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29186 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29187 @item -t
29188 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29189 @end table
29190
29191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29192
29193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29194
29195 @subsubheading Example
29196
29197 @smallexample
29198 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29199 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29200 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29201 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29202 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29203 (gdb)
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29207 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29208 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29209
29210 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29211 @findex -exec-arguments
29212
29213
29214 @subsubheading Synopsis
29215
29216 @smallexample
29217 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29218 @end smallexample
29219
29220 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29221 @samp{-exec-run}.
29222
29223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29224
29225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29226
29227 @subsubheading Example
29228
29229 @smallexample
29230 (gdb)
29231 -exec-arguments -v word
29232 ^done
29233 (gdb)
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236
29237 @ignore
29238 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29239 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29240
29241 @subsubheading Synopsis
29242
29243 @smallexample
29244 -exec-show-arguments
29245 @end smallexample
29246
29247 Print the arguments of the program.
29248
29249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29250
29251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29252
29253 @subsubheading Example
29254 N.A.
29255 @end ignore
29256
29257
29258 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29259 @findex -environment-cd
29260
29261 @subsubheading Synopsis
29262
29263 @smallexample
29264 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29265 @end smallexample
29266
29267 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29268
29269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29270
29271 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29272
29273 @subsubheading Example
29274
29275 @smallexample
29276 (gdb)
29277 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29278 ^done
29279 (gdb)
29280 @end smallexample
29281
29282
29283 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29284 @findex -environment-directory
29285
29286 @subsubheading Synopsis
29287
29288 @smallexample
29289 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29290 @end smallexample
29291
29292 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29293 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29294 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29295 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29296 occurs as normal.
29297 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29298 multiple directories in a single command
29299 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29300 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29301 If blanks are needed as
29302 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29303 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29304 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29305 character must not be used
29306 in any directory name.
29307 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29308
29309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29310
29311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29312
29313 @subsubheading Example
29314
29315 @smallexample
29316 (gdb)
29317 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29318 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29319 (gdb)
29320 -environment-directory ""
29321 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29322 (gdb)
29323 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29324 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29325 (gdb)
29326 -environment-directory -r
29327 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29328 (gdb)
29329 @end smallexample
29330
29331
29332 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29333 @findex -environment-path
29334
29335 @subsubheading Synopsis
29336
29337 @smallexample
29338 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29339 @end smallexample
29340
29341 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29342 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29343 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29344 supplied in addition to the
29345 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29346 occurs as normal.
29347 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29348 multiple directories in a single command
29349 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29350 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29351 If blanks are needed as
29352 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29353 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29354 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29355 character must not be used
29356 in any directory name.
29357 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29358
29359
29360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29361
29362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29363
29364 @subsubheading Example
29365
29366 @smallexample
29367 (gdb)
29368 -environment-path
29369 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29370 (gdb)
29371 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29372 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29373 (gdb)
29374 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29375 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29376 (gdb)
29377 @end smallexample
29378
29379
29380 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29381 @findex -environment-pwd
29382
29383 @subsubheading Synopsis
29384
29385 @smallexample
29386 -environment-pwd
29387 @end smallexample
29388
29389 Show the current working directory.
29390
29391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29392
29393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29394
29395 @subsubheading Example
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 (gdb)
29399 -environment-pwd
29400 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29401 (gdb)
29402 @end smallexample
29403
29404 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29405 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29406 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29407
29408
29409 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29410 @findex -thread-info
29411
29412 @subsubheading Synopsis
29413
29414 @smallexample
29415 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29416 @end smallexample
29417
29418 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29419 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29420 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29421 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29422 current thread.
29423
29424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29425
29426 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29427 about all threads.
29428
29429 @subsubheading Result
29430
29431 The result contains the following attributes:
29432
29433 @table @samp
29434 @item threads
29435 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29436 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29437
29438 @item current-thread-id
29439 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29440 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29441 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29442 the command.
29443
29444 @end table
29445
29446 @subsubheading Example
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 -thread-info
29450 ^done,threads=[
29451 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29452 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29453 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29454 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29455 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29456 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29457 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29458 state="running"@}],
29459 current-thread-id="1"
29460 (gdb)
29461 @end smallexample
29462
29463 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29464 @findex -thread-list-ids
29465
29466 @subsubheading Synopsis
29467
29468 @smallexample
29469 -thread-list-ids
29470 @end smallexample
29471
29472 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29473 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29474 threads.
29475
29476 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29477 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29478
29479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29480
29481 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29482
29483 @subsubheading Example
29484
29485 @smallexample
29486 (gdb)
29487 -thread-list-ids
29488 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29489 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29490 (gdb)
29491 @end smallexample
29492
29493
29494 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29495 @findex -thread-select
29496
29497 @subsubheading Synopsis
29498
29499 @smallexample
29500 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29501 @end smallexample
29502
29503 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29504 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29505 topmost frame for that thread.
29506
29507 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29508 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29509
29510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29511
29512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29513
29514 @subsubheading Example
29515
29516 @smallexample
29517 (gdb)
29518 -exec-next
29519 ^running
29520 (gdb)
29521 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29522 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29523 (gdb)
29524 -thread-list-ids
29525 ^done,
29526 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29527 number-of-threads="3"
29528 (gdb)
29529 -thread-select 3
29530 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29531 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29532 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29533 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29534 (gdb)
29535 @end smallexample
29536
29537 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29538 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29539 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29540
29541 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29542 @findex -ada-task-info
29543
29544 @subsubheading Synopsis
29545
29546 @smallexample
29547 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29548 @end smallexample
29549
29550 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29551 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29552
29553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29554
29555 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29556 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29557
29558 @subsubheading Result
29559
29560 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29561 defined for each Ada task:
29562
29563 @table @samp
29564 @item current
29565 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29566
29567 @item id
29568 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29569
29570 @item task-id
29571 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29572
29573 @item thread-id
29574 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29575 task.
29576
29577 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29578 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29579 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29580
29581 @item parent-id
29582 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29583 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29584
29585 @item priority
29586 The base priority of the task.
29587
29588 @item state
29589 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29590 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29591
29592 @item name
29593 The name of the task.
29594
29595 @end table
29596
29597 @subsubheading Example
29598
29599 @smallexample
29600 -ada-task-info
29601 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29602 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29603 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29604 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29605 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29606 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29607 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29608 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29609 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29610 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29611 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29612 (gdb)
29613 @end smallexample
29614
29615 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29616 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29617 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29618
29619 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29620 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29621 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29622 other cases.
29623
29624 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29625 @findex -exec-continue
29626
29627 @subsubheading Synopsis
29628
29629 @smallexample
29630 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29631 @end smallexample
29632
29633 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29634 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29635 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29636 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29637 @itemize @bullet
29638 @item
29639 breakpoints or watchpoints
29640 @item
29641 signals or exceptions
29642 @item
29643 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29644 @item
29645 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29646 @end itemize
29647 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29648 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29649 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29650 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29651 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29652 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29653
29654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29655
29656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29657
29658 @subsubheading Example
29659
29660 @smallexample
29661 -exec-continue
29662 ^running
29663 (gdb)
29664 @@Hello world
29665 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29666 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29667 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29668 (gdb)
29669 @end smallexample
29670
29671
29672 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29673 @findex -exec-finish
29674
29675 @subsubheading Synopsis
29676
29677 @smallexample
29678 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29679 @end smallexample
29680
29681 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29682 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29683 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29684 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29685 function was called.
29686
29687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29688
29689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29690
29691 @subsubheading Example
29692
29693 Function returning @code{void}.
29694
29695 @smallexample
29696 -exec-finish
29697 ^running
29698 (gdb)
29699 @@hello from foo
29700 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29701 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29702 (gdb)
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29706 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29707 value itself.
29708
29709 @smallexample
29710 -exec-finish
29711 ^running
29712 (gdb)
29713 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29714 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29715 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29716 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29717 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29718 (gdb)
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721
29722 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29723 @findex -exec-interrupt
29724
29725 @subsubheading Synopsis
29726
29727 @smallexample
29728 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29729 @end smallexample
29730
29731 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29732 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29733 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29734 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29735 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29736
29737 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29738 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29739 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29740 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29741
29742 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29743 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29744 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29745 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29746
29747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29748
29749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29750
29751 @subsubheading Example
29752
29753 @smallexample
29754 (gdb)
29755 111-exec-continue
29756 111^running
29757
29758 (gdb)
29759 222-exec-interrupt
29760 222^done
29761 (gdb)
29762 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29763 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29764 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29765 (gdb)
29766
29767 (gdb)
29768 -exec-interrupt
29769 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29770 (gdb)
29771 @end smallexample
29772
29773 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29774 @findex -exec-jump
29775
29776 @subsubheading Synopsis
29777
29778 @smallexample
29779 -exec-jump @var{location}
29780 @end smallexample
29781
29782 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29783 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29784 different forms of @var{location}.
29785
29786 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29787
29788 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29789
29790 @subsubheading Example
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29794 *running,thread-id="all"
29795 ^running
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798
29799 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29800 @findex -exec-next
29801
29802 @subsubheading Synopsis
29803
29804 @smallexample
29805 -exec-next [--reverse]
29806 @end smallexample
29807
29808 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29809 of the next source line is reached.
29810
29811 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29812 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29813 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29814 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29815 source line where the function was called.
29816
29817
29818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29819
29820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29821
29822 @subsubheading Example
29823
29824 @smallexample
29825 -exec-next
29826 ^running
29827 (gdb)
29828 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29829 (gdb)
29830 @end smallexample
29831
29832
29833 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29834 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29835
29836 @subsubheading Synopsis
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29840 @end smallexample
29841
29842 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29843 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29844 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29845 printed as well.
29846
29847 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29848 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29849 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29850 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29851 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29852
29853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29854
29855 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29856
29857 @subsubheading Example
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 (gdb)
29861 -exec-next-instruction
29862 ^running
29863
29864 (gdb)
29865 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29866 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29867 (gdb)
29868 @end smallexample
29869
29870
29871 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29872 @findex -exec-return
29873
29874 @subsubheading Synopsis
29875
29876 @smallexample
29877 -exec-return
29878 @end smallexample
29879
29880 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29881 Displays the new current frame.
29882
29883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29884
29885 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29886
29887 @subsubheading Example
29888
29889 @smallexample
29890 (gdb)
29891 200-break-insert callee4
29892 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29893 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29894 (gdb)
29895 000-exec-run
29896 000^running
29897 (gdb)
29898 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29899 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29900 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29901 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29902 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29903 (gdb)
29904 205-break-delete
29905 205^done
29906 (gdb)
29907 111-exec-return
29908 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29909 args=[@{name="strarg",
29910 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29911 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29912 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29913 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29914 (gdb)
29915 @end smallexample
29916
29917
29918 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29919 @findex -exec-run
29920
29921 @subsubheading Synopsis
29922
29923 @smallexample
29924 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29925 @end smallexample
29926
29927 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29928 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29929 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29930 the program has exited exceptionally.
29931
29932 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29933 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29934 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29935 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29936 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29937
29938 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29939 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29940 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29941 (@pxref{Starting}).
29942
29943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29944
29945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29946
29947 @subsubheading Examples
29948
29949 @smallexample
29950 (gdb)
29951 -break-insert main
29952 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29953 (gdb)
29954 -exec-run
29955 ^running
29956 (gdb)
29957 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29958 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29959 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29960 (gdb)
29961 @end smallexample
29962
29963 @noindent
29964 Program exited normally:
29965
29966 @smallexample
29967 (gdb)
29968 -exec-run
29969 ^running
29970 (gdb)
29971 x = 55
29972 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29973 (gdb)
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976 @noindent
29977 Program exited exceptionally:
29978
29979 @smallexample
29980 (gdb)
29981 -exec-run
29982 ^running
29983 (gdb)
29984 x = 55
29985 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29986 (gdb)
29987 @end smallexample
29988
29989 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29990 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29991
29992 @smallexample
29993 (gdb)
29994 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29995 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29996 @end smallexample
29997
29998
29999 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30000
30001
30002 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30003 @findex -exec-step
30004
30005 @subsubheading Synopsis
30006
30007 @smallexample
30008 -exec-step [--reverse]
30009 @end smallexample
30010
30011 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30012 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30013 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30014 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30015 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30016 previously executed source line.
30017
30018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30019
30020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30021
30022 @subsubheading Example
30023
30024 Stepping into a function:
30025
30026 @smallexample
30027 -exec-step
30028 ^running
30029 (gdb)
30030 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30031 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30032 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30033 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30034 (gdb)
30035 @end smallexample
30036
30037 Regular stepping:
30038
30039 @smallexample
30040 -exec-step
30041 ^running
30042 (gdb)
30043 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30044 (gdb)
30045 @end smallexample
30046
30047
30048 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30049 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30050
30051 @subsubheading Synopsis
30052
30053 @smallexample
30054 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30055 @end smallexample
30056
30057 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30058 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30059 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30060 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30061 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30062 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30063 as well.
30064
30065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30066
30067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30068
30069 @subsubheading Example
30070
30071 @smallexample
30072 (gdb)
30073 -exec-step-instruction
30074 ^running
30075
30076 (gdb)
30077 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30078 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30079 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30080 (gdb)
30081 -exec-step-instruction
30082 ^running
30083
30084 (gdb)
30085 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30086 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30087 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30088 (gdb)
30089 @end smallexample
30090
30091
30092 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30093 @findex -exec-until
30094
30095 @subsubheading Synopsis
30096
30097 @smallexample
30098 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30099 @end smallexample
30100
30101 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30102 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30103 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30104 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30105
30106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30107
30108 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30109
30110 @subsubheading Example
30111
30112 @smallexample
30113 (gdb)
30114 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30115 ^running
30116 (gdb)
30117 x = 55
30118 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30119 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30120 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30121 (gdb)
30122 @end smallexample
30123
30124 @ignore
30125 @subheading -file-clear
30126 Is this going away????
30127 @end ignore
30128
30129 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30130 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30131 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30132
30133 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30134 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30135
30136 @smallexample
30137 -enable-frame-filters
30138 @end smallexample
30139
30140 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30141 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30142 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30143 request that this functionality be enabled.
30144
30145 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30146
30147 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30148 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30149
30150 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30151 @findex -stack-info-frame
30152
30153 @subsubheading Synopsis
30154
30155 @smallexample
30156 -stack-info-frame
30157 @end smallexample
30158
30159 Get info on the selected frame.
30160
30161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30162
30163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30164 (without arguments).
30165
30166 @subsubheading Example
30167
30168 @smallexample
30169 (gdb)
30170 -stack-info-frame
30171 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30172 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30173 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30174 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30175 (gdb)
30176 @end smallexample
30177
30178 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30179 @findex -stack-info-depth
30180
30181 @subsubheading Synopsis
30182
30183 @smallexample
30184 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30185 @end smallexample
30186
30187 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30188 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30189
30190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30191
30192 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30193
30194 @subsubheading Example
30195
30196 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30197
30198 @smallexample
30199 (gdb)
30200 -stack-info-depth
30201 ^done,depth="12"
30202 (gdb)
30203 -stack-info-depth 4
30204 ^done,depth="4"
30205 (gdb)
30206 -stack-info-depth 12
30207 ^done,depth="12"
30208 (gdb)
30209 -stack-info-depth 11
30210 ^done,depth="11"
30211 (gdb)
30212 -stack-info-depth 13
30213 ^done,depth="12"
30214 (gdb)
30215 @end smallexample
30216
30217 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30218 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30219 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30220
30221 @subsubheading Synopsis
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30225 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30226 @end smallexample
30227
30228 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30229 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30230 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30231 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30232 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30233 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30234 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30235 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30236
30237 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30238 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30239 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30240 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30241 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30242 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30243
30244 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30245 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30246 are still displayed, however.
30247
30248 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30249 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30250
30251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30252
30253 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30254 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30255 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30256
30257 @subsubheading Example
30258
30259 @smallexample
30260 (gdb)
30261 -stack-list-frames
30262 ^done,
30263 stack=[
30264 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30265 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30266 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30267 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30268 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30269 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30270 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30271 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30272 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30273 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30274 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30275 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30276 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30279 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30280 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30281 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30282 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30283 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30284 (gdb)
30285 -stack-list-arguments 0
30286 ^done,
30287 stack-args=[
30288 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30289 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30290 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30291 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30292 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30293 (gdb)
30294 -stack-list-arguments 1
30295 ^done,
30296 stack-args=[
30297 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30298 frame=@{level="1",
30299 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30300 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30301 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30302 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30303 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30304 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30305 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30306 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30307 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30308 (gdb)
30309 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30310 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30311 (gdb)
30312 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30313 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30314 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30315 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30316 (gdb)
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30320
30321
30322 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30323 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30324 @findex -stack-list-frames
30325
30326 @subsubheading Synopsis
30327
30328 @smallexample
30329 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30330 @end smallexample
30331
30332 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30333 following info:
30334
30335 @table @samp
30336 @item @var{level}
30337 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30338 @item @var{addr}
30339 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30340 @item @var{func}
30341 Function name.
30342 @item @var{file}
30343 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30344 @item @var{fullname}
30345 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30346 @item @var{line}
30347 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30348 @item @var{from}
30349 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30350 if the frame's function is not known.
30351 @item @var{arch}
30352 Frame's architecture.
30353 @end table
30354
30355 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30356 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30357 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30358 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30359 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30360 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30361 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30362 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30363 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30364
30365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30366
30367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30368
30369 @subsubheading Example
30370
30371 Full stack backtrace:
30372
30373 @smallexample
30374 (gdb)
30375 -stack-list-frames
30376 ^done,stack=
30377 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30378 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30379 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30380 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30381 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30382 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30383 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30384 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30385 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30386 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30388 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30389 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30390 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30391 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30392 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30393 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30394 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30395 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30396 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30397 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30398 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30400 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30401 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30402 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30403 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30404 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30405 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30406 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30407 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30408 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30409 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30410 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30411 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30412 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30413 (gdb)
30414 @end smallexample
30415
30416 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 (gdb)
30420 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30421 ^done,stack=
30422 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30423 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30424 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30425 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30426 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30427 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30428 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30429 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30430 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30431 (gdb)
30432 @end smallexample
30433
30434 Show a single frame:
30435
30436 @smallexample
30437 (gdb)
30438 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30439 ^done,stack=
30440 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30442 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30443 (gdb)
30444 @end smallexample
30445
30446
30447 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30448 @findex -stack-list-locals
30449 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30450
30451 @subsubheading Synopsis
30452
30453 @smallexample
30454 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30455 @end smallexample
30456
30457 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30458 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30459 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30460 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30461 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30462 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30463 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30464 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30465 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30466 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30467
30468 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30469 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30470 variables are still displayed, however.
30471
30472 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30473 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30474
30475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30476
30477 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30478
30479 @subsubheading Example
30480
30481 @smallexample
30482 (gdb)
30483 -stack-list-locals 0
30484 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30485 (gdb)
30486 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30487 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30488 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30489 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30490 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30491 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30492 (gdb)
30493 @end smallexample
30494
30495 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30496 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30497 @findex -stack-list-variables
30498
30499 @subsubheading Synopsis
30500
30501 @smallexample
30502 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30503 @end smallexample
30504
30505 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30506 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30507 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30508 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30509 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30510 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30511 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30512
30513 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30514 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30515 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30516
30517 @subsubheading Example
30518
30519 @smallexample
30520 (gdb)
30521 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30522 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30523 (gdb)
30524 @end smallexample
30525
30526
30527 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30528 @findex -stack-select-frame
30529
30530 @subsubheading Synopsis
30531
30532 @smallexample
30533 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30534 @end smallexample
30535
30536 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30537 the stack.
30538
30539 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30540 option to every command.
30541
30542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30543
30544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30545 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30546
30547 @subsubheading Example
30548
30549 @smallexample
30550 (gdb)
30551 -stack-select-frame 2
30552 ^done
30553 (gdb)
30554 @end smallexample
30555
30556 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30557 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30558 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30559
30560 @ignore
30561
30562 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30563
30564 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30565 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30566 used by @code{Insight}.
30567
30568 The two main reasons for that are:
30569
30570 @enumerate 1
30571 @item
30572 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30573
30574 @item
30575 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30576 now).
30577 @end enumerate
30578
30579 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30580 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30581 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30582 hints about their use.
30583
30584 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30585 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30586 least, the following operations:
30587
30588 @itemize @bullet
30589 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30590 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30591 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30592 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30593 @end itemize
30594
30595 @end ignore
30596
30597 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30598
30599 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30600
30601 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30602 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30603 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30604 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30605 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30606 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30607 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30608 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30609 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30610 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30611 object, or to change display format.
30612
30613 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30614 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30615 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30616 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30617 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30618 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30619 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30620 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30621 child will be created.
30622
30623 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30624 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30625 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30626 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30627 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30628
30629 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30630 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30631 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30632 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30633 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30634 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30635 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30636 variables that frontend has created.
30637
30638 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30639 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30640 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30641 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30642 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30643 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30644 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30645 implicitly updated.
30646
30647 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30648 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30649 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30650 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30651 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30652 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30653 frame. Consider this example:
30654
30655 @smallexample
30656 void do_work(...)
30657 @{
30658 struct work_state state;
30659
30660 if (...)
30661 do_work(...);
30662 @}
30663 @end smallexample
30664
30665 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30666 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30667 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30668 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30669 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30670
30671 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30672 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30673 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30674 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30675 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30676 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30677
30678 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30679 access this functionality:
30680
30681 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30682 @item @strong{Operation}
30683 @tab @strong{Description}
30684
30685 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30686 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30687 @item @code{-var-create}
30688 @tab create a variable object
30689 @item @code{-var-delete}
30690 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30691 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30692 @tab set the display format of this variable
30693 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30694 @tab show the display format of this variable
30695 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30696 @tab tells how many children this object has
30697 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30698 @tab return a list of the object's children
30699 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30700 @tab show the type of this variable object
30701 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30702 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30703 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30704 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30705 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30706 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30707 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30708 @tab get the value of this variable
30709 @item @code{-var-assign}
30710 @tab set the value of this variable
30711 @item @code{-var-update}
30712 @tab update the variable and its children
30713 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30714 @tab set frozeness attribute
30715 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30716 @tab set range of children to display on update
30717 @end multitable
30718
30719 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30720 how it can be used.
30721
30722 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30723
30724 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30725 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30726
30727 @smallexample
30728 -enable-pretty-printing
30729 @end smallexample
30730
30731 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30732 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30733 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30734 request that this functionality be enabled.
30735
30736 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30737
30738 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30739 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30740
30741 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30742 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30743
30744 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30745 @findex -var-create
30746
30747 @subsubheading Synopsis
30748
30749 @smallexample
30750 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30751 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30752 @end smallexample
30753
30754 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30755 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30756 register.
30757
30758 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30759 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30760 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30761 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30762 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30763
30764 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30765 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30766 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30767 object must be created.
30768
30769 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30770 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30771
30772 @itemize @bullet
30773 @item
30774 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30775
30776 @item
30777 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30778
30779 @item
30780 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30781 @end itemize
30782
30783 @cindex dynamic varobj
30784 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30785 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30786 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30787 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30788 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30789 compatibility for existing clients.
30790
30791 @subsubheading Result
30792
30793 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30794 are:
30795
30796 @table @samp
30797 @item name
30798 The name of the varobj.
30799
30800 @item numchild
30801 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30802 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30803 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30804
30805 @item value
30806 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30807 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30808 will not be interesting.
30809
30810 @item type
30811 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30812 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30813 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30814 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30815 @emph{declared} one.
30816
30817 @item thread-id
30818 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30819 thread's global identifier.
30820
30821 @item has_more
30822 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30823 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30824
30825 @item dynamic
30826 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30827 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30828 then this attribute will not be present.
30829
30830 @item displayhint
30831 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30832 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30833 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30834 @end table
30835
30836 Typical output will look like this:
30837
30838 @smallexample
30839 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30840 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30841 @end smallexample
30842
30843
30844 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30845 @findex -var-delete
30846
30847 @subsubheading Synopsis
30848
30849 @smallexample
30850 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30851 @end smallexample
30852
30853 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30854 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30855
30856 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30857
30858
30859 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30860 @findex -var-set-format
30861
30862 @subsubheading Synopsis
30863
30864 @smallexample
30865 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30866 @end smallexample
30867
30868 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30869 @var{format-spec}.
30870
30871 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30872 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30873
30874 @smallexample
30875 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30876 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30877 @end smallexample
30878
30879 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30880 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30881 for pointers, etc.).
30882
30883 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30884 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30885 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30886 zero-hexadecimal format.
30887
30888 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30889 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30890
30891 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30892 @findex -var-show-format
30893
30894 @subsubheading Synopsis
30895
30896 @smallexample
30897 -var-show-format @var{name}
30898 @end smallexample
30899
30900 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30901
30902 @smallexample
30903 @var{format} @expansion{}
30904 @var{format-spec}
30905 @end smallexample
30906
30907
30908 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30909 @findex -var-info-num-children
30910
30911 @subsubheading Synopsis
30912
30913 @smallexample
30914 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30915 @end smallexample
30916
30917 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30918
30919 @smallexample
30920 numchild=@var{n}
30921 @end smallexample
30922
30923 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30924 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30925 be available.
30926
30927
30928 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30929 @findex -var-list-children
30930
30931 @subsubheading Synopsis
30932
30933 @smallexample
30934 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30935 @end smallexample
30936 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30937
30938 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30939 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30940 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30941 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30942 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30943 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30944 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30945 and unions.
30946
30947 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30948 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30949 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30950 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30951 reported.
30952
30953 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30954 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30955 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30956 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30957 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30958 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30959 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30960 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30961 the visible items.
30962
30963 For each child the following results are returned:
30964
30965 @table @var
30966
30967 @item name
30968 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30969
30970 @item exp
30971 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30972 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30973
30974 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30975 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30976
30977 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30978 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30979 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30980 type and value are not present.
30981
30982 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30983 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30984 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30985
30986 @item numchild
30987 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30988 0.
30989
30990 @item type
30991 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30992 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30993 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30994 @emph{declared} one.
30995
30996 @item value
30997 If values were requested, this is the value.
30998
30999 @item thread-id
31000 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31001 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31002
31003 @item frozen
31004 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31005
31006 @item displayhint
31007 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31008 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31009 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31010
31011 @item dynamic
31012 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31013 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31014 then this attribute will not be present.
31015
31016 @end table
31017
31018 The result may have its own attributes:
31019
31020 @table @samp
31021 @item displayhint
31022 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31023 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31024 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31025
31026 @item has_more
31027 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31028 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31029 @end table
31030
31031 @subsubheading Example
31032
31033 @smallexample
31034 (gdb)
31035 -var-list-children n
31036 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31037 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31038 (gdb)
31039 -var-list-children --all-values n
31040 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31041 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31042 @end smallexample
31043
31044
31045 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31046 @findex -var-info-type
31047
31048 @subsubheading Synopsis
31049
31050 @smallexample
31051 -var-info-type @var{name}
31052 @end smallexample
31053
31054 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31055 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31056 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31057
31058 @smallexample
31059 type=@var{typename}
31060 @end smallexample
31061
31062
31063 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31064 @findex -var-info-expression
31065
31066 @subsubheading Synopsis
31067
31068 @smallexample
31069 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31070 @end smallexample
31071
31072 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31073 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31074 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31075
31076 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31077 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31078
31079 @smallexample
31080 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31081 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31082 @end smallexample
31083
31084 @noindent
31085 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31086 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31087
31088 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31089 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31090 is of limited use.
31091
31092 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31093 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31094
31095 @subsubheading Synopsis
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31102 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31103 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31104 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31105 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31106 watchpoint from a variable object.
31107
31108 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31109 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31110
31111 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31112 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31113 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31114 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31115 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31116 @smallexample
31117 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31118 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31119 @end smallexample
31120
31121 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31122 @findex -var-show-attributes
31123
31124 @subsubheading Synopsis
31125
31126 @smallexample
31127 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31128 @end smallexample
31129
31130 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 @noindent
31137 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31138
31139 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31140 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31141
31142 @subsubheading Synopsis
31143
31144 @smallexample
31145 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31146 @end smallexample
31147
31148 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31149 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31150 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31151 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31152 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31153 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31154 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31155
31156 @smallexample
31157 value=@var{value}
31158 @end smallexample
31159
31160 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31161 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31162
31163 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31164 @findex -var-assign
31165
31166 @subsubheading Synopsis
31167
31168 @smallexample
31169 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31173 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31174 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31175 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31176
31177 @subsubheading Example
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 (gdb)
31181 -var-assign var1 3
31182 ^done,value="3"
31183 (gdb)
31184 -var-update *
31185 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31186 (gdb)
31187 @end smallexample
31188
31189 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31190 @findex -var-update
31191
31192 @subsubheading Synopsis
31193
31194 @smallexample
31195 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31196 @end smallexample
31197
31198 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31199 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31200 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31201 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31202 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31203 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31204 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31205 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31206 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31207 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31208 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31209 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31210 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31211
31212 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31213 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31214 diagnostic.
31215
31216 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31217 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31218
31219 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31220 @samp{changelist}.
31221
31222 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31223
31224 @table @samp
31225 @item name
31226 The name of the varobj.
31227
31228 @item value
31229 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31230 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31231
31232 @item in_scope
31233 @anchor{-var-update}
31234 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31235
31236 @table @code
31237 @item "true"
31238 The variable object's current value is valid.
31239
31240 @item "false"
31241 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31242 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31243 scope.
31244
31245 @item "invalid"
31246 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31247 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31248 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31249 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31250 objects.
31251 @end table
31252
31253 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31254 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31255
31256 @item type_changed
31257 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31258 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31259 be @samp{false}.
31260
31261 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31262 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31263 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31264 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31265 unset.
31266
31267 @item new_type
31268 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31269 hold the new type.
31270
31271 @item new_num_children
31272 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31273 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31274
31275 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31276 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31277 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31278 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31279 children which may be available.
31280
31281 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31282 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31283 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31284 only happen at the end of the update range).
31285
31286 @item displayhint
31287 The display hint, if any.
31288
31289 @item has_more
31290 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31291 available outside the varobj's update range.
31292
31293 @item dynamic
31294 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31295 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31296 then this attribute will not be present.
31297
31298 @item new_children
31299 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31300 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31301 be listed in this attribute.
31302 @end table
31303
31304 @subsubheading Example
31305
31306 @smallexample
31307 (gdb)
31308 -var-assign var1 3
31309 ^done,value="3"
31310 (gdb)
31311 -var-update --all-values var1
31312 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31313 type_changed="false"@}]
31314 (gdb)
31315 @end smallexample
31316
31317 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31318 @findex -var-set-frozen
31319 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31320
31321 @subsubheading Synopsis
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31328 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31329 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31330 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31331 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31332 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31333 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31334 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31335 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31336 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31337 @code{-var-update} does.
31338
31339 @subsubheading Example
31340
31341 @smallexample
31342 (gdb)
31343 -var-set-frozen V 1
31344 ^done
31345 (gdb)
31346 @end smallexample
31347
31348 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31349 @findex -var-set-update-range
31350 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31351
31352 @subsubheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31359 @code{-var-update}.
31360
31361 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31362 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31363 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31364 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31365
31366 @subsubheading Example
31367
31368 @smallexample
31369 (gdb)
31370 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31371 ^done
31372 @end smallexample
31373
31374 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31375 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31376 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31377
31378 @subsubheading Synopsis
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31382 @end smallexample
31383
31384 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31385
31386 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31387 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31388
31389 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31390 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31391 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31392 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31393 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31394 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31395 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31396
31397 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31398 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31399 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31400 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31401
31402 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31403 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31404 can be used to check this.
31405
31406 @subsubheading Example
31407
31408 Resetting the visualizer:
31409
31410 @smallexample
31411 (gdb)
31412 -var-set-visualizer V None
31413 ^done
31414 @end smallexample
31415
31416 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31417
31418 @smallexample
31419 (gdb)
31420 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31421 ^done
31422 @end smallexample
31423
31424 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31425 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31426
31427 @smallexample
31428 (gdb)
31429 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31430 ^done
31431 @end smallexample
31432
31433 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31434 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31435 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31436
31437 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31438 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31439 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31440 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31441
31442 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31443 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31444
31445 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31446 @c @subheading -data-assign
31447 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31448 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31449 @c set variable
31450 @c @subsubheading Example
31451 @c N.A.
31452
31453 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31454 @findex -data-disassemble
31455
31456 @subsubheading Synopsis
31457
31458 @smallexample
31459 -data-disassemble
31460 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31461 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31462 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31463 -- @var{mode}
31464 @end smallexample
31465
31466 @noindent
31467 Where:
31468
31469 @table @samp
31470 @item @var{start-addr}
31471 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31472 @item @var{end-addr}
31473 is the end address
31474 @item @var{addr}
31475 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31476 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31477 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31478 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31479 @item @var{filename}
31480 is the name of the file to disassemble
31481 @item @var{linenum}
31482 is the line number to disassemble around
31483 @item @var{lines}
31484 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31485 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31486 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31487 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31488 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31489 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31490 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31491 are displayed.
31492 @item @var{mode}
31493 is one of:
31494 @itemize @bullet
31495 @item 0 disassembly only
31496 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31497 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31498 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31499 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31500 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31501 @end itemize
31502
31503 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31504 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31505 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31506 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31507 @end table
31508
31509 @subsubheading Result
31510
31511 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31512 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31513 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31514
31515 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31516 following fields:
31517
31518 @table @code
31519 @item address
31520 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31521
31522 @item func-name
31523 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31524
31525 @item offset
31526 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31527
31528 @item inst
31529 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31530
31531 @item opcodes
31532 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31533 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31534
31535 @end table
31536
31537 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31538 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31539
31540 @table @code
31541 @item line
31542 The line number within @samp{file}.
31543
31544 @item file
31545 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31546 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31547 used.
31548
31549 @item fullname
31550 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31551 using the source file search path
31552 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31553 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31554
31555 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31556 present in the debug information.
31557
31558 @item line_asm_insn
31559 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31560 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31561 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31562 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31563 @samp{opcodes}.
31564
31565 @end table
31566
31567 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31568 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31569 adjust its format.
31570
31571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31572
31573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31574
31575 @subsubheading Example
31576
31577 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31578
31579 @smallexample
31580 (gdb)
31581 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31582 ^done,
31583 asm_insns=[
31584 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31585 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31586 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31587 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31588 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31589 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31590 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31591 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31592 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31593 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31594 (gdb)
31595 @end smallexample
31596
31597 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31598 @code{main}.
31599
31600 @smallexample
31601 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31602 ^done,asm_insns=[
31603 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31604 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31605 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31606 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31607 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31608 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31609 [@dots{}]
31610 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31611 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31612 (gdb)
31613 @end smallexample
31614
31615 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31616
31617 @smallexample
31618 (gdb)
31619 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31620 ^done,asm_insns=[
31621 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31622 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31623 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31624 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31625 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31626 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31627 (gdb)
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31631
31632 @smallexample
31633 (gdb)
31634 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31635 ^done,asm_insns=[
31636 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31637 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31638 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31639 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31640 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31641 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31642 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31643 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31644 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31645 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31646 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31647 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31648 (gdb)
31649 @end smallexample
31650
31651
31652 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31653 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31654
31655 @subsubheading Synopsis
31656
31657 @smallexample
31658 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31659 @end smallexample
31660
31661 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31662 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31663 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31664
31665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31666
31667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31668 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31669 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31670
31671 @subsubheading Example
31672
31673 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31674 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31675 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31676 output.
31677
31678 @smallexample
31679 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31680 211^done,value="1"
31681 (gdb)
31682 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31683 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31684 (gdb)
31685 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31686 411^done,value="4"
31687 (gdb)
31688 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31689 511^done,value="4"
31690 (gdb)
31691 @end smallexample
31692
31693
31694 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31695 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31696
31697 @subsubheading Synopsis
31698
31699 @smallexample
31700 -data-list-changed-registers
31701 @end smallexample
31702
31703 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31704
31705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31706
31707 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31708 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31709
31710 @subsubheading Example
31711
31712 On a PPC MBX board:
31713
31714 @smallexample
31715 (gdb)
31716 -exec-continue
31717 ^running
31718
31719 (gdb)
31720 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31721 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31722 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31723 (gdb)
31724 -data-list-changed-registers
31725 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31726 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31727 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31728 (gdb)
31729 @end smallexample
31730
31731
31732 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31733 @findex -data-list-register-names
31734
31735 @subsubheading Synopsis
31736
31737 @smallexample
31738 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31739 @end smallexample
31740
31741 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31742 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31743 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31744 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31745 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31746 include empty register names.
31747
31748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31749
31750 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31751 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31752 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31753
31754 @subsubheading Example
31755
31756 For the PPC MBX board:
31757 @smallexample
31758 (gdb)
31759 -data-list-register-names
31760 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31761 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31762 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31763 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31764 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31765 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31766 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31767 (gdb)
31768 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31769 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31770 (gdb)
31771 @end smallexample
31772
31773 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31774 @findex -data-list-register-values
31775
31776 @subsubheading Synopsis
31777
31778 @smallexample
31779 -data-list-register-values
31780 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31781 @end smallexample
31782
31783 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31784 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31785 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31786 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31787 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31788 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31789
31790 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31791
31792 @table @code
31793 @item x
31794 Hexadecimal
31795 @item o
31796 Octal
31797 @item t
31798 Binary
31799 @item d
31800 Decimal
31801 @item r
31802 Raw
31803 @item N
31804 Natural
31805 @end table
31806
31807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31808
31809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31810 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31811
31812 @subsubheading Example
31813
31814 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31815 don't appear in the actual output):
31816
31817 @smallexample
31818 (gdb)
31819 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31820 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31821 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31822 (gdb)
31823 -data-list-register-values x
31824 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31825 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31826 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31827 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31828 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31829 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31830 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31831 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31832 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31833 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31834 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31835 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31836 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31837 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31838 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31839 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31840 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31841 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31842 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31843 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31844 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31845 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31846 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31847 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31848 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31849 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31850 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31851 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31852 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31853 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31854 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31855 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31856 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31857 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31858 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31859 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31860 (gdb)
31861 @end smallexample
31862
31863
31864 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31865 @findex -data-read-memory
31866
31867 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31868
31869 @subsubheading Synopsis
31870
31871 @smallexample
31872 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31873 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31874 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31875 @end smallexample
31876
31877 @noindent
31878 where:
31879
31880 @table @samp
31881 @item @var{address}
31882 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31883 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31884 quoted using the C convention.
31885
31886 @item @var{word-format}
31887 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31888 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31889 ,Output Formats}).
31890
31891 @item @var{word-size}
31892 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31893
31894 @item @var{nr-rows}
31895 The number of rows in the output table.
31896
31897 @item @var{nr-cols}
31898 The number of columns in the output table.
31899
31900 @item @var{aschar}
31901 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31902 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31903 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31904 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31905
31906 @item @var{byte-offset}
31907 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31908 @end table
31909
31910 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31911 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31912 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31913 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31914 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31915 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31916 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31917 @samp{addr}.
31918
31919 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31920 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31921 @samp{prev-page}.
31922
31923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31924
31925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31926 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31927
31928 @subsubheading Example
31929
31930 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31931 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31932 word. Display each word in hex.
31933
31934 @smallexample
31935 (gdb)
31936 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31937 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31938 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31939 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31940 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31941 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31942 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31943 (gdb)
31944 @end smallexample
31945
31946 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31947 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31948
31949 @smallexample
31950 (gdb)
31951 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31952 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31953 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31954 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31955 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31956 (gdb)
31957 @end smallexample
31958
31959 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31960 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31961 used as the non-printable character.
31962
31963 @smallexample
31964 (gdb)
31965 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31966 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31967 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31968 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31969 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31970 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31971 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31972 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31973 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31974 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31975 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31976 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31977 (gdb)
31978 @end smallexample
31979
31980 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31981 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31982
31983 @subsubheading Synopsis
31984
31985 @smallexample
31986 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31987 @var{address} @var{count}
31988 @end smallexample
31989
31990 @noindent
31991 where:
31992
31993 @table @samp
31994 @item @var{address}
31995 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31996 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31997 quoted using the C convention.
31998
31999 @item @var{count}
32000 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32001 literal.
32002
32003 @item @var{offset}
32004 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32005 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32006 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32007 arithmetics itself.
32008
32009 @end table
32010
32011 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32012 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32013 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32014 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32015 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32016 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32017
32018 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32019 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32020 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32021 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32022 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32023 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32024 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32025 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32026
32027 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32028 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32029 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32030 and has the following fields:
32031
32032 @table @code
32033 @item begin
32034 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32035
32036 @item end
32037 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32038
32039 @item offset
32040 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32041 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32042
32043 @item contents
32044 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32045
32046 @end table
32047
32048
32049
32050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32051
32052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32053
32054 @subsubheading Example
32055
32056 @smallexample
32057 (gdb)
32058 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32059 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32060 end="0xbffff15e",
32061 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32062 (gdb)
32063 @end smallexample
32064
32065
32066 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32067 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32068
32069 @subsubheading Synopsis
32070
32071 @smallexample
32072 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32073 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32074 @end smallexample
32075
32076 @noindent
32077 where:
32078
32079 @table @samp
32080 @item @var{address}
32081 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32082 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32083 be quoted using the C convention.
32084
32085 @item @var{contents}
32086 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32087 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32088
32089 @item @var{count}
32090 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32091 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32092 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32093 @var{count} memory units.
32094
32095 @end table
32096
32097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32098
32099 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32100
32101 @subsubheading Example
32102
32103 @smallexample
32104 (gdb)
32105 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32106 ^done
32107 (gdb)
32108 @end smallexample
32109
32110 @smallexample
32111 (gdb)
32112 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32113 ^done
32114 (gdb)
32115 @end smallexample
32116
32117 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32118 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32119 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32120
32121 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32122 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32123
32124 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32125 @findex -trace-find
32126
32127 @subsubheading Synopsis
32128
32129 @smallexample
32130 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32131 @end smallexample
32132
32133 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32134 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32135 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32136
32137 @table @samp
32138
32139 @item none
32140 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32141
32142 @item frame-number
32143 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32144 that index.
32145
32146 @item tracepoint-number
32147 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32148 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32149
32150 @item pc
32151 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32152 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32153 address.
32154
32155 @item pc-inside-range
32156 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32157 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32158 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32159
32160 @item pc-outside-range
32161 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32162 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32163 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32164
32165 @item line
32166 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32167 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32168 the specified location.
32169
32170 @end table
32171
32172 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32173 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32174
32175 @table @samp
32176 @item found
32177 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32178 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32179
32180 @item traceframe
32181 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32182 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32183
32184 @item tracepoint
32185 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32186 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32187
32188 @item frame
32189 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32190 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32191 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32192
32193 @end table
32194
32195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32196
32197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32198
32199 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32200 @findex -trace-define-variable
32201
32202 @subsubheading Synopsis
32203
32204 @smallexample
32205 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32206 @end smallexample
32207
32208 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32209 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32210 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32211 with the @samp{$} character.
32212
32213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32214
32215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32216
32217 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32218 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32219
32220 @subsubheading Synopsis
32221
32222 @smallexample
32223 -trace-frame-collected
32224 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32225 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32226 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32227 [--memory-contents]
32228 @end smallexample
32229
32230 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32231 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32232 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32233 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32234 See the output description table below for more details.
32235
32236 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32237 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32238 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32239 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32240 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32241
32242 For instance, if the actions were
32243 @smallexample
32244 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32245 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32246 @end smallexample
32247
32248 @noindent
32249 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32250 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32251 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32252 objects would be computed expressions.
32253
32254 An example output would be:
32255
32256 @smallexample
32257 (gdb)
32258 -trace-frame-collected
32259 ^done,
32260 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32261 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32262 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32263 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32264 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32265 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32266 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32267 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32268 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32269 ...
32270 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32271 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32272 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32273 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32274 (gdb)
32275 @end smallexample
32276
32277 Where:
32278
32279 @table @code
32280 @item explicit-variables
32281 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32282 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32283 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32284 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32285 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32286 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32287 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32288 arrays, structures and unions.
32289
32290 @item computed-expressions
32291 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32292 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32293 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32294 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32295
32296 @item registers
32297 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32298 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32299 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32300 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32301 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32302
32303 @item tvars
32304 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32305 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32306 current value are returned.
32307
32308 @item memory
32309 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32310 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32311 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32312
32313 @table @code
32314 @item address
32315 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32316
32317 @item length
32318 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32319
32320 @item contents
32321 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32322 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32323
32324 @end table
32325
32326 @end table
32327
32328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32329
32330 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32331
32332 @subsubheading Example
32333
32334 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32335 @findex -trace-list-variables
32336
32337 @subsubheading Synopsis
32338
32339 @smallexample
32340 -trace-list-variables
32341 @end smallexample
32342
32343 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32344 table has the following fields:
32345
32346 @table @samp
32347 @item name
32348 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32349
32350 @item initial
32351 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32352 field is always present.
32353
32354 @item current
32355 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32356 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32357 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32358 presently running.
32359
32360 @end table
32361
32362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32363
32364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32365
32366 @subsubheading Example
32367
32368 @smallexample
32369 (gdb)
32370 -trace-list-variables
32371 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32372 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32373 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32374 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32375 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32376 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32377 (gdb)
32378 @end smallexample
32379
32380 @subheading -trace-save
32381 @findex -trace-save
32382
32383 @subsubheading Synopsis
32384
32385 @smallexample
32386 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32387 @end smallexample
32388
32389 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32390 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32391 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32392 to perform the save.
32393
32394 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32395 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32396 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32397
32398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32399
32400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32401
32402
32403 @subheading -trace-start
32404 @findex -trace-start
32405
32406 @subsubheading Synopsis
32407
32408 @smallexample
32409 -trace-start
32410 @end smallexample
32411
32412 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32413 have any fields.
32414
32415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32416
32417 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32418
32419 @subheading -trace-status
32420 @findex -trace-status
32421
32422 @subsubheading Synopsis
32423
32424 @smallexample
32425 -trace-status
32426 @end smallexample
32427
32428 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32429 the following fields:
32430
32431 @table @samp
32432
32433 @item supported
32434 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32435 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32436 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32437 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32438 started. This field is always present.
32439
32440 @item running
32441 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32442 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32443 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32444
32445 @item stop-reason
32446 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32447 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32448 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32449 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32450 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32451 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32452 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32453 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32454 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32455
32456 @item stopping-tracepoint
32457 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32458 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32459 @samp{passcount}.
32460
32461 @item frames
32462 @itemx frames-created
32463 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32464 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32465 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32466 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32467
32468 @item buffer-size
32469 @itemx buffer-free
32470 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32471 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32472
32473 @item circular
32474 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32475 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32476 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32477 and may fill up.
32478
32479 @item disconnected
32480 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32481 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32482 that the trace run will stop.
32483
32484 @item trace-file
32485 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32486 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32487
32488 @end table
32489
32490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32491
32492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32493
32494 @subheading -trace-stop
32495 @findex -trace-stop
32496
32497 @subsubheading Synopsis
32498
32499 @smallexample
32500 -trace-stop
32501 @end smallexample
32502
32503 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32504 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32505 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32506
32507 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32508
32509 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32510
32511
32512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32513 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32515
32516
32517 @ignore
32518 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32519 @findex -symbol-info-address
32520
32521 @subsubheading Synopsis
32522
32523 @smallexample
32524 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32525 @end smallexample
32526
32527 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32528
32529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32530
32531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32532
32533 @subsubheading Example
32534 N.A.
32535
32536
32537 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32538 @findex -symbol-info-file
32539
32540 @subsubheading Synopsis
32541
32542 @smallexample
32543 -symbol-info-file
32544 @end smallexample
32545
32546 Show the file for the symbol.
32547
32548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32549
32550 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32551 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32552
32553 @subsubheading Example
32554 N.A.
32555
32556
32557 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32558 @findex -symbol-info-function
32559
32560 @subsubheading Synopsis
32561
32562 @smallexample
32563 -symbol-info-function
32564 @end smallexample
32565
32566 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32567
32568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32569
32570 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32571
32572 @subsubheading Example
32573 N.A.
32574
32575
32576 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32577 @findex -symbol-info-line
32578
32579 @subsubheading Synopsis
32580
32581 @smallexample
32582 -symbol-info-line
32583 @end smallexample
32584
32585 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32586
32587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32588
32589 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32590 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32591
32592 @subsubheading Example
32593 N.A.
32594
32595
32596 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32597 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32598
32599 @subsubheading Synopsis
32600
32601 @smallexample
32602 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32603 @end smallexample
32604
32605 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32606
32607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32608
32609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32610
32611 @subsubheading Example
32612 N.A.
32613
32614
32615 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32616 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32617
32618 @subsubheading Synopsis
32619
32620 @smallexample
32621 -symbol-list-functions
32622 @end smallexample
32623
32624 List the functions in the executable.
32625
32626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32627
32628 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32629 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32630
32631 @subsubheading Example
32632 N.A.
32633 @end ignore
32634
32635
32636 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32637 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32638
32639 @subsubheading Synopsis
32640
32641 @smallexample
32642 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32643 @end smallexample
32644
32645 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32646 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32647 ascending PC order.
32648
32649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32650
32651 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32652
32653 @subsubheading Example
32654 @smallexample
32655 (gdb)
32656 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32657 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32658 (gdb)
32659 @end smallexample
32660
32661
32662 @ignore
32663 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32664 @findex -symbol-list-types
32665
32666 @subsubheading Synopsis
32667
32668 @smallexample
32669 -symbol-list-types
32670 @end smallexample
32671
32672 List all the type names.
32673
32674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32675
32676 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32677 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32678
32679 @subsubheading Example
32680 N.A.
32681
32682
32683 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32684 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32685
32686 @subsubheading Synopsis
32687
32688 @smallexample
32689 -symbol-list-variables
32690 @end smallexample
32691
32692 List all the global and static variable names.
32693
32694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32695
32696 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32697
32698 @subsubheading Example
32699 N.A.
32700
32701
32702 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32703 @findex -symbol-locate
32704
32705 @subsubheading Synopsis
32706
32707 @smallexample
32708 -symbol-locate
32709 @end smallexample
32710
32711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32712
32713 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32714
32715 @subsubheading Example
32716 N.A.
32717
32718
32719 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32720 @findex -symbol-type
32721
32722 @subsubheading Synopsis
32723
32724 @smallexample
32725 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32726 @end smallexample
32727
32728 Show type of @var{variable}.
32729
32730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32731
32732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32733 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32734
32735 @subsubheading Example
32736 N.A.
32737 @end ignore
32738
32739
32740 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32741 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32742 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32743
32744 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32745 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32746
32747 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32748 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32749
32750 @subsubheading Synopsis
32751
32752 @smallexample
32753 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32754 @end smallexample
32755
32756 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32757 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32758 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32759 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32760 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32761 notification.
32762
32763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32764
32765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32766
32767 @subsubheading Example
32768
32769 @smallexample
32770 (gdb)
32771 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32772 ^done
32773 (gdb)
32774 @end smallexample
32775
32776
32777 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32778 @findex -file-exec-file
32779
32780 @subsubheading Synopsis
32781
32782 @smallexample
32783 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32784 @end smallexample
32785
32786 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32787 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32788 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32789 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32790 notification.
32791
32792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32793
32794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32795
32796 @subsubheading Example
32797
32798 @smallexample
32799 (gdb)
32800 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32801 ^done
32802 (gdb)
32803 @end smallexample
32804
32805
32806 @ignore
32807 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32808 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32809
32810 @subsubheading Synopsis
32811
32812 @smallexample
32813 -file-list-exec-sections
32814 @end smallexample
32815
32816 List the sections of the current executable file.
32817
32818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32819
32820 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32821 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32822 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32823
32824 @subsubheading Example
32825 N.A.
32826 @end ignore
32827
32828
32829 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32830 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32831
32832 @subsubheading Synopsis
32833
32834 @smallexample
32835 -file-list-exec-source-file
32836 @end smallexample
32837
32838 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32839 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32840 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32841 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32842
32843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32844
32845 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32846
32847 @subsubheading Example
32848
32849 @smallexample
32850 (gdb)
32851 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32852 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32853 (gdb)
32854 @end smallexample
32855
32856
32857 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32858 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32859
32860 @subsubheading Synopsis
32861
32862 @smallexample
32863 -file-list-exec-source-files
32864 @end smallexample
32865
32866 List the source files for the current executable.
32867
32868 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32869 name) of a source file.
32870
32871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32872
32873 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32874 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32875
32876 @subsubheading Example
32877 @smallexample
32878 (gdb)
32879 -file-list-exec-source-files
32880 ^done,files=[
32881 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32882 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32883 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32884 (gdb)
32885 @end smallexample
32886
32887 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32888 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32889
32890 @subsubheading Synopsis
32891
32892 @smallexample
32893 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32894 @end smallexample
32895
32896 List the shared libraries in the program.
32897 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32898 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32899
32900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32901
32902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32903 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32904 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32905 library. Each range has the following fields:
32906
32907 @table @samp
32908 @item from
32909 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32910 @item to
32911 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32912 @end table
32913
32914 @subsubheading Example
32915 @smallexample
32916 (gdb)
32917 -file-list-exec-source-files
32918 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32919 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32920 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32921 (gdb)
32922 @end smallexample
32923
32924
32925 @ignore
32926 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32927 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32928
32929 @subsubheading Synopsis
32930
32931 @smallexample
32932 -file-list-symbol-files
32933 @end smallexample
32934
32935 List symbol files.
32936
32937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32938
32939 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32940
32941 @subsubheading Example
32942 N.A.
32943 @end ignore
32944
32945
32946 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32947 @findex -file-symbol-file
32948
32949 @subsubheading Synopsis
32950
32951 @smallexample
32952 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32953 @end smallexample
32954
32955 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32956 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32957 produced, except for a completion notification.
32958
32959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32960
32961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32962
32963 @subsubheading Example
32964
32965 @smallexample
32966 (gdb)
32967 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32968 ^done
32969 (gdb)
32970 @end smallexample
32971
32972 @ignore
32973 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32974 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32975 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32976
32977 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32978
32979 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32980
32981 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32982
32983 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32984
32985 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32986
32987 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32988
32989 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32990
32991 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32992
32993 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32994 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32995 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32996
32997 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32998
32999 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33000
33001 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33002
33003 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33004 @end ignore
33005
33006
33007 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33008 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33009 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33010
33011
33012 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33013 @findex -target-attach
33014
33015 @subsubheading Synopsis
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33019 @end smallexample
33020
33021 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33022 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33023 group, the id previously returned by
33024 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33025
33026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33027
33028 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33029
33030 @subsubheading Example
33031 @smallexample
33032 (gdb)
33033 -target-attach 34
33034 =thread-created,id="1"
33035 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33036 ^done
33037 (gdb)
33038 @end smallexample
33039
33040 @ignore
33041 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33042 @findex -target-compare-sections
33043
33044 @subsubheading Synopsis
33045
33046 @smallexample
33047 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33048 @end smallexample
33049
33050 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33051 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33052
33053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33054
33055 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33056
33057 @subsubheading Example
33058 N.A.
33059 @end ignore
33060
33061
33062 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33063 @findex -target-detach
33064
33065 @subsubheading Synopsis
33066
33067 @smallexample
33068 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33069 @end smallexample
33070
33071 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33072 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33073 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33074
33075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33076
33077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33078
33079 @subsubheading Example
33080
33081 @smallexample
33082 (gdb)
33083 -target-detach
33084 ^done
33085 (gdb)
33086 @end smallexample
33087
33088
33089 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33090 @findex -target-disconnect
33091
33092 @subsubheading Synopsis
33093
33094 @smallexample
33095 -target-disconnect
33096 @end smallexample
33097
33098 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33099 generally not resumed.
33100
33101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33102
33103 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33104
33105 @subsubheading Example
33106
33107 @smallexample
33108 (gdb)
33109 -target-disconnect
33110 ^done
33111 (gdb)
33112 @end smallexample
33113
33114
33115 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33116 @findex -target-download
33117
33118 @subsubheading Synopsis
33119
33120 @smallexample
33121 -target-download
33122 @end smallexample
33123
33124 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33125 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33126
33127 @table @samp
33128 @item section
33129 The name of the section.
33130 @item section-sent
33131 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33132 @item section-size
33133 The size of the section.
33134 @item total-sent
33135 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33136 @item total-size
33137 The size of the overall executable to download.
33138 @end table
33139
33140 @noindent
33141 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33142 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33143
33144 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33145 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33146
33147 @table @samp
33148 @item section
33149 The name of the section.
33150 @item section-size
33151 The size of the section.
33152 @item total-size
33153 The size of the overall executable to download.
33154 @end table
33155
33156 @noindent
33157 At the end, a summary is printed.
33158
33159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33160
33161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33162
33163 @subsubheading Example
33164
33165 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33166 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33167
33168 @smallexample
33169 (gdb)
33170 -target-download
33171 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33172 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33173 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33174 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33175 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33176 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33177 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33178 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33179 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33180 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33181 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33182 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33183 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33184 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33185 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33186 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33187 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33188 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33189 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33190 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33191 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33192 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33193 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33194 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33195 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33196 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33197 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33198 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33199 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33200 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33201 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33202 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33203 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33204 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33205 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33206 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33207 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33208 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33209 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33210 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33211 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33212 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33213 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33214 write-rate="429"
33215 (gdb)
33216 @end smallexample
33217
33218
33219 @ignore
33220 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33221 @findex -target-exec-status
33222
33223 @subsubheading Synopsis
33224
33225 @smallexample
33226 -target-exec-status
33227 @end smallexample
33228
33229 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33230 not, for instance).
33231
33232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33233
33234 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33235
33236 @subsubheading Example
33237 N.A.
33238
33239
33240 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33241 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33242
33243 @subsubheading Synopsis
33244
33245 @smallexample
33246 -target-list-available-targets
33247 @end smallexample
33248
33249 List the possible targets to connect to.
33250
33251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33252
33253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33254
33255 @subsubheading Example
33256 N.A.
33257
33258
33259 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33260 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33261
33262 @subsubheading Synopsis
33263
33264 @smallexample
33265 -target-list-current-targets
33266 @end smallexample
33267
33268 Describe the current target.
33269
33270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33271
33272 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33273 other things).
33274
33275 @subsubheading Example
33276 N.A.
33277
33278
33279 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33280 @findex -target-list-parameters
33281
33282 @subsubheading Synopsis
33283
33284 @smallexample
33285 -target-list-parameters
33286 @end smallexample
33287
33288 @c ????
33289 @end ignore
33290
33291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33292
33293 No equivalent.
33294
33295 @subsubheading Example
33296 N.A.
33297
33298 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33299 @findex -target-flash-erase
33300
33301 @subsubheading Synopsis
33302
33303 @smallexample
33304 -target-flash-erase
33305 @end smallexample
33306
33307 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33308
33309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33310
33311 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33312 addresses and memory region sizes.
33313
33314 @smallexample
33315 (gdb)
33316 -target-flash-erase
33317 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33318 (gdb)
33319 @end smallexample
33320
33321 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33322 @findex -target-select
33323
33324 @subsubheading Synopsis
33325
33326 @smallexample
33327 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33328 @end smallexample
33329
33330 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33331
33332 @table @samp
33333 @item @var{type}
33334 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33335 @item @var{parameters}
33336 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33337 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33338 @end table
33339
33340 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33341 which the target program is, in the following form:
33342
33343 @smallexample
33344 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33345 args=[@var{arg list}]
33346 @end smallexample
33347
33348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33349
33350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33351
33352 @subsubheading Example
33353
33354 @smallexample
33355 (gdb)
33356 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33357 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33358 (gdb)
33359 @end smallexample
33360
33361 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33362 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33363 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33364
33365
33366 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33367 @findex -target-file-put
33368
33369 @subsubheading Synopsis
33370
33371 @smallexample
33372 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33373 @end smallexample
33374
33375 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33376 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33377
33378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33379
33380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33381
33382 @subsubheading Example
33383
33384 @smallexample
33385 (gdb)
33386 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33387 ^done
33388 (gdb)
33389 @end smallexample
33390
33391
33392 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33393 @findex -target-file-get
33394
33395 @subsubheading Synopsis
33396
33397 @smallexample
33398 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33399 @end smallexample
33400
33401 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33402 on the host system.
33403
33404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33405
33406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33407
33408 @subsubheading Example
33409
33410 @smallexample
33411 (gdb)
33412 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33413 ^done
33414 (gdb)
33415 @end smallexample
33416
33417
33418 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33419 @findex -target-file-delete
33420
33421 @subsubheading Synopsis
33422
33423 @smallexample
33424 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33425 @end smallexample
33426
33427 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33428
33429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33430
33431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33432
33433 @subsubheading Example
33434
33435 @smallexample
33436 (gdb)
33437 -target-file-delete remotefile
33438 ^done
33439 (gdb)
33440 @end smallexample
33441
33442
33443 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33444 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33445 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33446
33447 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33448 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33449
33450 @subsubheading Synopsis
33451
33452 @smallexample
33453 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33454 @end smallexample
33455
33456 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33457 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33458 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33459
33460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33461
33462 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33463
33464 @subsubheading Result
33465
33466 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33467 defined for each exception:
33468
33469 @table @samp
33470 @item name
33471 The name of the exception.
33472
33473 @item address
33474 The address of the exception.
33475
33476 @end table
33477
33478 @subsubheading Example
33479
33480 @smallexample
33481 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33482 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33483 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33484 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33485 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33486 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33487 @end smallexample
33488
33489 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33490
33491 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33492 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33493 Catchpoint Commands}.
33494
33495
33496 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33497 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33498 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33499
33500 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33501 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33502 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33503 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33504
33505 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33506 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33507 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33508
33509 @subsubheading Synopsis
33510
33511 @smallexample
33512 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33513 @end smallexample
33514
33515 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33516
33517 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33518 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33519 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33520 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33521 dash.
33522
33523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33524
33525 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33526
33527 @subsubheading Result
33528
33529 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33530
33531 @table @samp
33532 @item exists
33533 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33534 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33535
33536 @end table
33537
33538 @subsubheading Example
33539
33540 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33541
33542 @smallexample
33543 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33544 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33545 @end smallexample
33546
33547 @noindent
33548 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33549 to the debugger:
33550
33551 @smallexample
33552 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33553 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33554 @end smallexample
33555
33556 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33557 @findex -list-features
33558 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33559
33560 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33561 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33562 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33563 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33564 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33565 startup.
33566
33567 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33568 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33569 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33570 is given below.
33571
33572 Example output:
33573
33574 @smallexample
33575 (gdb) -list-features
33576 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33577 @end smallexample
33578
33579 The current list of features is:
33580
33581 @ftable @samp
33582 @item frozen-varobjs
33583 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33584 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33585 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33586 @item pending-breakpoints
33587 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33588 command.
33589 @item python
33590 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33591 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33592 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33593 @item thread-info
33594 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33595 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33596 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33597 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33598 @item breakpoint-notifications
33599 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33600 CLI will be announced via async records.
33601 @item ada-task-info
33602 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33603 @item language-option
33604 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33605 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33606 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33607 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33608 @item undefined-command-error-code
33609 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33610 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33611 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33612 @item exec-run-start-option
33613 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33614 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33615 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33616 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33617 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33618 @end ftable
33619
33620 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33621 @findex -list-target-features
33622
33623 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33624 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33625 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33626 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33627 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33628 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33629 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33630 Example output:
33631
33632 @smallexample
33633 (gdb) -list-target-features
33634 ^done,result=["async"]
33635 @end smallexample
33636
33637 The current list of features is:
33638
33639 @table @samp
33640 @item async
33641 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33642 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33643 while the target is running.
33644
33645 @item reverse
33646 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33647 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33648
33649 @end table
33650
33651 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33652 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33653 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33654
33655 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33656
33657 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33658 @findex -gdb-exit
33659
33660 @subsubheading Synopsis
33661
33662 @smallexample
33663 -gdb-exit
33664 @end smallexample
33665
33666 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33667
33668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33669
33670 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33671
33672 @subsubheading Example
33673
33674 @smallexample
33675 (gdb)
33676 -gdb-exit
33677 ^exit
33678 @end smallexample
33679
33680
33681 @ignore
33682 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33683 @findex -exec-abort
33684
33685 @subsubheading Synopsis
33686
33687 @smallexample
33688 -exec-abort
33689 @end smallexample
33690
33691 Kill the inferior running program.
33692
33693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33694
33695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33696
33697 @subsubheading Example
33698 N.A.
33699 @end ignore
33700
33701
33702 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33703 @findex -gdb-set
33704
33705 @subsubheading Synopsis
33706
33707 @smallexample
33708 -gdb-set
33709 @end smallexample
33710
33711 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33712 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33713
33714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33715
33716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33717
33718 @subsubheading Example
33719
33720 @smallexample
33721 (gdb)
33722 -gdb-set $foo=3
33723 ^done
33724 (gdb)
33725 @end smallexample
33726
33727
33728 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33729 @findex -gdb-show
33730
33731 @subsubheading Synopsis
33732
33733 @smallexample
33734 -gdb-show
33735 @end smallexample
33736
33737 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33738
33739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33740
33741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33742
33743 @subsubheading Example
33744
33745 @smallexample
33746 (gdb)
33747 -gdb-show annotate
33748 ^done,value="0"
33749 (gdb)
33750 @end smallexample
33751
33752 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33753
33754
33755 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33756 @findex -gdb-version
33757
33758 @subsubheading Synopsis
33759
33760 @smallexample
33761 -gdb-version
33762 @end smallexample
33763
33764 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33765
33766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33767
33768 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33769 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33770
33771 @subsubheading Example
33772
33773 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33774 @c box in TeX.
33775 @smallexample
33776 (gdb)
33777 -gdb-version
33778 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33779 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33780 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33781 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33782 ~ certain conditions.
33783 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33784 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33785 ~ details.
33786 ~This GDB was configured as
33787 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33788 ^done
33789 (gdb)
33790 @end smallexample
33791
33792 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33793 @findex -list-thread-groups
33794
33795 @subheading Synopsis
33796
33797 @smallexample
33798 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33799 @end smallexample
33800
33801 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33802 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33803 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33804 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33805 top-level thread groups.
33806
33807 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33808 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33809 available on the target.
33810
33811 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33812 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33813 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33814 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33815 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33816 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33817 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33818 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33819
33820 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33821 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33822 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33823 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33824 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33825 @samp{threads} field.
33826
33827 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33828 the following caveats:
33829
33830 @itemize @bullet
33831 @item
33832 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33833 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33834 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33835
33836 @item
33837 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33838 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33839 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33840 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33841 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33842 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33843
33844 @end itemize
33845
33846 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33847 have the following fields:
33848
33849 @table @code
33850 @item id
33851 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33852 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33853 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33854
33855 @item type
33856 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33857 valid type.
33858
33859 @item pid
33860 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33861 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33862
33863 @item exit-code
33864 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33865 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33866 only if the process is not running.
33867
33868 @item num_children
33869 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33870 absent for an available thread group.
33871
33872 @item threads
33873 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33874 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33875 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33876
33877 @item cores
33878 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33879 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33880 such information is not available.
33881
33882 @item executable
33883 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33884 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33885 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33886
33887 @end table
33888
33889 @subheading Example
33890
33891 @smallexample
33892 @value{GDBP}
33893 -list-thread-groups
33894 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33895 -list-thread-groups 17
33896 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33897 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33898 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33899 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33900 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33901 -list-thread-groups --available
33902 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33903 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33904 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33905 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33906 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33907 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33908 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33909 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33910 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33911 @end smallexample
33912
33913 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33914 @findex -info-os
33915
33916 @subsubheading Synopsis
33917
33918 @smallexample
33919 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33920 @end smallexample
33921
33922 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33923 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33924 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33925 of data of that type.
33926
33927 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33928 system.
33929
33930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33931
33932 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33933
33934 @subsubheading Example
33935
33936 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33937 like this:
33938
33939 @smallexample
33940 @value{GDBP}
33941 -info-os
33942 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33943 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33944 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33945 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33946 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33947 col2="CPUs"@},
33948 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33949 col2="File descriptors"@},
33950 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33951 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33952 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33953 col2="Message queues"@},
33954 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33955 col2="Processes"@},
33956 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33957 col2="Process groups"@},
33958 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33959 col2="Semaphores"@},
33960 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33961 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33962 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33963 col2="Sockets"@},
33964 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33965 col2="Threads"@}]
33966 @value{GDBP}
33967 -info-os processes
33968 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33969 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33970 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33971 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33973 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33974 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33975 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33976 ...
33977 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33978 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33979 (gdb)
33980 @end smallexample
33981
33982 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33983 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33984 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33985 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33986 @code{info os} omits it.)
33987
33988 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33989 @findex -add-inferior
33990
33991 @subheading Synopsis
33992
33993 @smallexample
33994 -add-inferior
33995 @end smallexample
33996
33997 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33998 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33999 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34000 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34001 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34002 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34003
34004 @subheading Example
34005
34006 @smallexample
34007 @value{GDBP}
34008 -add-inferior
34009 ^done,inferior="i3"
34010 @end smallexample
34011
34012 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34013 @findex -interpreter-exec
34014
34015 @subheading Synopsis
34016
34017 @smallexample
34018 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34019 @end smallexample
34020 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34021
34022 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34023
34024 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34025
34026 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34027
34028 @subheading Example
34029
34030 @smallexample
34031 (gdb)
34032 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34033 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34034 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34035 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34036 ^done
34037 (gdb)
34038 @end smallexample
34039
34040 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34041 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34042
34043 @subheading Synopsis
34044
34045 @smallexample
34046 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34047 @end smallexample
34048
34049 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34050
34051 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34052
34053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34054
34055 @subheading Example
34056
34057 @smallexample
34058 (gdb)
34059 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34060 ^done
34061 (gdb)
34062 @end smallexample
34063
34064 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34065 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34066
34067 @subheading Synopsis
34068
34069 @smallexample
34070 -inferior-tty-show
34071 @end smallexample
34072
34073 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34074
34075 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34076
34077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34078
34079 @subheading Example
34080
34081 @smallexample
34082 (gdb)
34083 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34084 ^done
34085 (gdb)
34086 -inferior-tty-show
34087 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34088 (gdb)
34089 @end smallexample
34090
34091 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34092 @findex -enable-timings
34093
34094 @subheading Synopsis
34095
34096 @smallexample
34097 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34098 @end smallexample
34099
34100 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34101 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34102 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34103 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34104
34105 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34106
34107 No equivalent.
34108
34109 @subheading Example
34110
34111 @smallexample
34112 (gdb)
34113 -enable-timings
34114 ^done
34115 (gdb)
34116 -break-insert main
34117 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34118 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34119 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34120 times="0"@},
34121 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34122 (gdb)
34123 -enable-timings no
34124 ^done
34125 (gdb)
34126 -exec-run
34127 ^running
34128 (gdb)
34129 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34130 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34131 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34132 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34133 (gdb)
34134 @end smallexample
34135
34136 @node Annotations
34137 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34138
34139 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34140 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34141 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34142 relatively high level.
34143
34144 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34145 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34146
34147 @ignore
34148 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34149 @end ignore
34150
34151 @menu
34152 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34153 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34154 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34155 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34156 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34157 * Annotations for Running::
34158 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34159 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34160 @end menu
34161
34162 @node Annotations Overview
34163 @section What is an Annotation?
34164 @cindex annotations
34165
34166 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34167 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34168 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34169 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34170 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34171 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34172 cannot contain newline characters.
34173
34174 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34175 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34176 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34177 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34178 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34179 means those three characters as output.
34180
34181 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34182 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34183 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34184 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34185 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34186 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34187 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34188 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34189 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34190
34191 @table @code
34192 @kindex set annotate
34193 @item set annotate @var{level}
34194 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34195 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34196
34197 @item show annotate
34198 @kindex show annotate
34199 Show the current annotation level.
34200 @end table
34201
34202 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34203
34204 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34205
34206 @smallexample
34207 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34208 GNU gdb 6.0
34209 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34210 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34211 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34212 under certain conditions.
34213 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34214 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34215 for details.
34216 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34217
34218 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34219 (@value{GDBP})
34220 ^Z^Zprompt
34221 @kbd{quit}
34222
34223 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34224 $
34225 @end smallexample
34226
34227 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34228 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34229 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34230 output from @value{GDBN}.
34231
34232 @node Server Prefix
34233 @section The Server Prefix
34234 @cindex server prefix
34235
34236 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34237 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34238 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34239 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34240 a transparent manner.
34241
34242 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34243 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34244 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34245 @code{print} command.
34246
34247 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34248 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34249
34250 @node Prompting
34251 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34252
34253 @cindex annotations for prompts
34254 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34255 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34256 over, etc.
34257
34258 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34259 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34260 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34261 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34262 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34263 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34264 features the following annotations:
34265
34266 @smallexample
34267 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34268 ^Z^Zprompt
34269 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34270 @end smallexample
34271
34272 The input types are
34273
34274 @table @code
34275 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34276 @findex prompt annotation
34277 @findex post-prompt annotation
34278 @item prompt
34279 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34280
34281 @findex pre-commands annotation
34282 @findex commands annotation
34283 @findex post-commands annotation
34284 @item commands
34285 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34286 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34287
34288 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34289 @findex overload-choice annotation
34290 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34291 @item overload-choice
34292 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34293
34294 @findex pre-query annotation
34295 @findex query annotation
34296 @findex post-query annotation
34297 @item query
34298 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34299
34300 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34301 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34302 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34303 @item prompt-for-continue
34304 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34305 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34306 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34307 presence of annotations.
34308 @end table
34309
34310 @node Errors
34311 @section Errors
34312 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34313
34314 @findex quit annotation
34315 @smallexample
34316 ^Z^Zquit
34317 @end smallexample
34318
34319 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34320
34321 @findex error annotation
34322 @smallexample
34323 ^Z^Zerror
34324 @end smallexample
34325
34326 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34327
34328 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34329 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34330 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34331 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34332 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34333 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34334 to the top level.
34335
34336 @findex error-begin annotation
34337 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34338
34339 @smallexample
34340 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34341 @end smallexample
34342
34343 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34344 message.
34345
34346 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34347 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34348 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34349
34350 @node Invalidation
34351 @section Invalidation Notices
34352
34353 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34354 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34355 changed.
34356
34357 @table @code
34358 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34359 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34360
34361 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34362 have changed.
34363
34364 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34365 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34366
34367 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34368 deleted a breakpoint.
34369 @end table
34370
34371 @node Annotations for Running
34372 @section Running the Program
34373 @cindex annotations for running programs
34374
34375 @findex starting annotation
34376 @findex stopping annotation
34377 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34378 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34379
34380 @smallexample
34381 ^Z^Zstarting
34382 @end smallexample
34383
34384 is output. When the program stops,
34385
34386 @smallexample
34387 ^Z^Zstopped
34388 @end smallexample
34389
34390 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34391 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34392
34393 @table @code
34394 @findex exited annotation
34395 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34396 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34397 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34398
34399 @findex signalled annotation
34400 @findex signal-name annotation
34401 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34402 @findex signal-string annotation
34403 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34404 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34405 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34406 annotation continues:
34407
34408 @smallexample
34409 @var{intro-text}
34410 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34411 @var{name}
34412 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34413 @var{middle-text}
34414 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34415 @var{string}
34416 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34417 @var{end-text}
34418 @end smallexample
34419
34420 @noindent
34421 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34422 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34423 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34424 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34425 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34426
34427 @findex signal annotation
34428 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34429 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34430 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34431 terminated with it.
34432
34433 @findex breakpoint annotation
34434 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34435 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34436
34437 @findex watchpoint annotation
34438 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34439 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34440 @end table
34441
34442 @node Source Annotations
34443 @section Displaying Source
34444 @cindex annotations for source display
34445
34446 @findex source annotation
34447 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34448
34449 @smallexample
34450 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34451 @end smallexample
34452
34453 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34454 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34455 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34456 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34457 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34458 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34459 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34460 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34461 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34462 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34463 depend on the language).
34464
34465 @node JIT Interface
34466 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34467 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34468 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34469
34470 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34471 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34472 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34473 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34474
34475 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34476 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34477 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34478 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34479 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34480 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34481
34482 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34483 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34484 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34485 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34486 LLVM JIT.
34487
34488 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34489 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34490 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34491 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34492 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34493 out about additional code.
34494
34495 @menu
34496 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34497 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34498 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34499 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34500 @end menu
34501
34502 @node Declarations
34503 @section JIT Declarations
34504
34505 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34506 implement the interface:
34507
34508 @smallexample
34509 typedef enum
34510 @{
34511 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34512 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34513 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34514 @} jit_actions_t;
34515
34516 struct jit_code_entry
34517 @{
34518 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34519 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34520 const char *symfile_addr;
34521 uint64_t symfile_size;
34522 @};
34523
34524 struct jit_descriptor
34525 @{
34526 uint32_t version;
34527 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34528 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34529 uint32_t action_flag;
34530 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34531 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34532 @};
34533
34534 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34535 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34536
34537 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34538 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34539 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34540 @end smallexample
34541
34542 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34543 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34544 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34545
34546 @node Registering Code
34547 @section Registering Code
34548
34549 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34550
34551 @itemize @bullet
34552 @item
34553 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34554 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34555
34556 @item
34557 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34558 file.
34559
34560 @item
34561 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34562
34563 @item
34564 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34565
34566 @item
34567 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34568 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34569 @end itemize
34570
34571 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34572 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34573 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34574 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34575
34576 @node Unregistering Code
34577 @section Unregistering Code
34578
34579 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34580
34581 @itemize @bullet
34582 @item
34583 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34584
34585 @item
34586 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34587
34588 @item
34589 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34590 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34591 @end itemize
34592
34593 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34594 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34595
34596 @node Custom Debug Info
34597 @section Custom Debug Info
34598 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34599 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34600
34601 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34602 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34603 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34604 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34605 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34606 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34607 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34608 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34609 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34610
34611 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34612 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34613 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34614 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34615 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34616 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34617 compiler.
34618
34619 @menu
34620 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34621 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34622 @end menu
34623
34624 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34625 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34626 @kindex jit-reader-load
34627 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34628
34629 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34630 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34631
34632 @table @code
34633 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34634 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34635 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34636 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34637 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34638 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34639 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34640
34641 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34642 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34643 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34644 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34645 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34646
34647 @item jit-reader-unload
34648 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34649
34650 @end table
34651
34652 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34653 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34654 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34655
34656 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34657 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34658
34659 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34660 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34661 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34662 the system include directory.
34663
34664 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34665 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34666 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34667
34668 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34669 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34670
34671 @findex gdb_init_reader
34672 @smallexample
34673 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34674 @end smallexample
34675
34676 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34677
34678 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34679 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34680 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34681 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34682 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34683 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34684
34685 @smallexample
34686 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34687 @{
34688 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34689 int reader_version;
34690
34691 /* For use by the reader. */
34692 void *priv_data;
34693
34694 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34695 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34696 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34697 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34698 @};
34699 @end smallexample
34700
34701 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34702 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34703
34704 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34705 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34706 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34707 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34708 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34709 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34710 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34711 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34712 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34713 target's address space.
34714
34715 @node In-Process Agent
34716 @chapter In-Process Agent
34717 @cindex debugging agent
34718 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34719 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34720 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34721 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34722 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34723 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34724 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34725 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34726 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34727 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34728 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34729 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34730 behavior without interrupting it.
34731
34732 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34733 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34734 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34735 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34736 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34737 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34738 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34739 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34740 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34741
34742 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34743 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34744 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34745 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34746
34747 @anchor{Control Agent}
34748 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34749 debugging with the following commands:
34750
34751 @table @code
34752 @kindex set agent on
34753 @item set agent on
34754 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34755 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34756 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34757 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34758 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34759 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34760
34761 @kindex set agent off
34762 @item set agent off
34763 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34764 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34765
34766 @kindex show agent
34767 @item show agent
34768 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34769 the in-process agent.
34770 @end table
34771
34772 @menu
34773 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34774 @end menu
34775
34776 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34777 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34778 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34779
34780 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34781 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34782 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34783 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34784 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34785 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34786 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34787 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34788 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34789
34790 @menu
34791 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34792 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34793 @end menu
34794
34795 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34796 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34797 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34798
34799 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34800 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34801
34802 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34803 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34804 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34805 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34806
34807 @enumerate
34808 @item
34809 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34810 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34811 @item
34812 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34813 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34814 the other one.
34815 @end enumerate
34816
34817 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34818
34819 @enumerate
34820 @item
34821 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34822 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34823 @anchor{agent expression object}
34824 @item
34825 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34826 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34827 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34828 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34829 @item
34830 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34831 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34832
34833 @end enumerate
34834
34835 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34836 object:
34837
34838 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34839 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34840 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34841 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34842 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34843 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34844 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34845 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34846 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34847 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34848 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34849 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34850 memory address for collecting.
34851 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34852 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34853 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34854 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34855 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34856 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34857 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34858 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34859 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34860 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34861 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34862 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34863 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34864 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34865 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34866 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34867 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34868 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34869 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34870 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34871 @ref{agent expression object}
34872 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34873 @ref{agent expression object}
34874 @item actions @tab variable
34875 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34876 @end multitable
34877
34878 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34879 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34880 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34881
34882 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34883 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34884
34885 @table @samp
34886
34887 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34888 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34889 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34890 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34891 in IPA finally.
34892
34893 Replies:
34894 @table @samp
34895 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34896 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34897 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34898 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34899 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34900 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34901 @item E @var{NN}
34902 for an error
34903
34904 @end table
34905
34906 @item close
34907 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34908 is about to kill inferiors.
34909
34910 @item qTfSTM
34911 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34912 @item qTsSTM
34913 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34914 @item qTSTMat
34915 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34916 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34917 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34918
34919 Replies:
34920 @table @samp
34921 @item E @var{NN}
34922 for an error
34923 @end table
34924 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34925 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34926 @end table
34927
34928 @node GDB Bugs
34929 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34930 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34931 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34932
34933 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34934
34935 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34936 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34937 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34938 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34939
34940 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34941 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34942
34943 @menu
34944 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34945 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34946 @end menu
34947
34948 @node Bug Criteria
34949 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34950 @cindex bug criteria
34951
34952 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34953
34954 @itemize @bullet
34955 @cindex fatal signal
34956 @cindex debugger crash
34957 @cindex crash of debugger
34958 @item
34959 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34960 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34961
34962 @cindex error on valid input
34963 @item
34964 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34965 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34966 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34967
34968 @cindex invalid input
34969 @item
34970 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34971 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34972 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34973 for traditional practice''.
34974
34975 @item
34976 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34977 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34978 @end itemize
34979
34980 @node Bug Reporting
34981 @section How to Report Bugs
34982 @cindex bug reports
34983 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34984
34985 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34986 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34987 contact that organization first.
34988
34989 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34990 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34991 distribution.
34992 @c should add a web page ref...
34993
34994 @ifset BUGURL
34995 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34996 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34997 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34998 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34999 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35000 be used.
35001
35002 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35003 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35004 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35005 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35006
35007 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35008 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35009 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35010 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35011 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35012 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35013 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35014 bug reports to the mailing list.
35015 @end ifset
35016 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35017 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35018 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35019 @end ifclear
35020 @end ifset
35021
35022 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35023 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35024 fact or leave it out, state it!
35025
35026 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35027 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35028 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35029 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35030 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35031 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35032 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35033 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35034 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35035
35036 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35037 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35038 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35039 self-contained.
35040
35041 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35042 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35043 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35044 bugs properly.
35045
35046 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35047
35048 @itemize @bullet
35049 @item
35050 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35051 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35052 version}.
35053
35054 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35055 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35056
35057 @item
35058 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35059 version number.
35060
35061 @item
35062 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35063 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35064 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35065 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35066
35067 @item
35068 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35069 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35070
35071 @item
35072 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35073 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35074 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35075 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35076 those compilers.
35077
35078 @item
35079 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35080 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35081 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35082 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35083
35084 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35085 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35086
35087 @item
35088 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35089 reproduce the bug.
35090
35091 @item
35092 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35093 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35094
35095 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35096 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35097 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35098 a chance to make a mistake.
35099
35100 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35101 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35102 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35103 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35104 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35105 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35106 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35107 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35108
35109 @pindex script
35110 @cindex recording a session script
35111 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35112 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35113 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35114 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35115
35116 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35117 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35118
35119 @item
35120 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35121 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35122 it by context, not by line number.
35123
35124 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35125 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35126
35127 @end itemize
35128
35129 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35130
35131 @itemize @bullet
35132 @item
35133 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35134
35135 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35136 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35137 changes will not affect it.
35138
35139 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35140 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35141 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35142 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35143
35144 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35145 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35146 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35147 less time, and so on.
35148
35149 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35150 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35151
35152 @item
35153 A patch for the bug.
35154
35155 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35156 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35157 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35158 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35159
35160 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35161 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35162 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35163 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35164
35165 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35166 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35167 help us to understand.
35168
35169 @item
35170 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35171
35172 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35173 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35174 @end itemize
35175
35176 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35177 @c and consists of the two following files:
35178 @c rluser.texi
35179 @c hsuser.texi
35180 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35181 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35182 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35183 @include rluser.texi
35184 @include hsuser.texi
35185 @end ifclear
35186
35187 @node In Memoriam
35188 @appendix In Memoriam
35189
35190 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35191 contributors:
35192
35193 @table @code
35194 @item Fred Fish
35195 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35196 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35197 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35198
35199 @item Michael Snyder
35200 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35201 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35202 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35203 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35204 @end table
35205
35206 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35207 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35208
35209 @node Formatting Documentation
35210 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35211
35212 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35213 @cindex reference card
35214 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35215 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35216 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35217 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35218 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35219 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35220
35221 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35222 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35223
35224 @smallexample
35225 make refcard.dvi
35226 @end smallexample
35227
35228 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35229 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35230 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35231 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35232 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35233
35234 @cindex documentation
35235
35236 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35237 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35238 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35239 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35240 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35241 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35242
35243 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35244 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35245 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35246 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35247 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35248 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35249 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35250 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35251
35252 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35253 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35254 @code{makeinfo}.
35255
35256 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35257 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35258 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35259
35260 @smallexample
35261 cd gdb
35262 make gdb.info
35263 @end smallexample
35264
35265 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35266 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35267 Texinfo definitions file.
35268
35269 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35270 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35271 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35272 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35273 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35274 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35275 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35276
35277 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35278 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35279 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35280 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35281 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35282 directory.
35283
35284 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35285 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35286 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35287 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35288
35289 @smallexample
35290 make gdb.dvi
35291 @end smallexample
35292
35293 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35294
35295 @node Installing GDB
35296 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35297 @cindex installation
35298
35299 @menu
35300 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35301 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35302 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35303 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35304 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35305 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35306 @end menu
35307
35308 @node Requirements
35309 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35310 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35311
35312 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35313 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35314
35315 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35316 @table @asis
35317 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35318 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35319 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35320
35321 @item GNU make
35322 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35323 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35324 @end table
35325
35326 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35327 @table @asis
35328 @item Expat
35329 @anchor{Expat}
35330 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35331 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35332 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35333 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35334 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35335 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35336
35337 Expat is used for:
35338
35339 @itemize @bullet
35340 @item
35341 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35342 @item
35343 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35344 @item
35345 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35346 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35347 @item
35348 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35349 @item
35350 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35351 @item
35352 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35353 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35354 @end itemize
35355
35356 @item Guile
35357 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35358 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35359 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35360 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35361 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35362 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35363
35364 @item iconv
35365 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35366 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35367 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35368 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35369
35370 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35371 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35372 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35373 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35374 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35375
35376 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35377 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35378 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35379 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35380 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35381
35382 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35383 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35384 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35385 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35386 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35387 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35388 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35389 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35390 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35391
35392 @item lzma
35393 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35394 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35395 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35396 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35397 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35398 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35399 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35400
35401 @item MPFR
35402 @anchor{MPFR}
35403 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35404 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35405 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35406 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35407 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35408 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35409 option to specify its location.
35410
35411 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35412 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35413 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35414 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35415
35416 @item Python
35417 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35418 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35419 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35420 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35421 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35422 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35423 installation of Python.
35424
35425 @item zlib
35426 @cindex compressed debug sections
35427 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35428 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35429 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35430 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35431 information in such binaries.
35432
35433 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35434 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35435 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35436 @end table
35437
35438 @node Running Configure
35439 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35440 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35441 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35442 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35443 build the @code{gdb} program.
35444 @iftex
35445 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35446 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35447 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35448 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35449 @end iftex
35450
35451 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35452 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35453 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35454
35455 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35456 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35457
35458 @table @code
35459 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35460 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35461
35462 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35463 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35464
35465 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35466 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35467
35468 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35469 @sc{gnu} include files
35470
35471 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35472 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35473
35474 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35475 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35476
35477 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35478 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35479 @end table
35480
35481 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35482
35483 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35484 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35485 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35486
35487 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35488 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35489 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35490 argument.
35491
35492 For example:
35493
35494 @smallexample
35495 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35496 ./configure
35497 make
35498 @end smallexample
35499
35500 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35501 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35502 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35503 directories.
35504
35505 @need 750
35506 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35507 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35508 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35509
35510 @smallexample
35511 sh configure
35512 @end smallexample
35513
35514 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35515 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35516 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35517 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35518 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35519 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35520 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35521 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35522 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35523
35524 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35525 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35526 install it with @code{make install}.
35527
35528 @node Separate Objdir
35529 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35530
35531 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35532 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35533 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35534 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35535 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35536 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35537 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35538 program specified there.
35539
35540 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35541 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35542 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35543 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35544 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35545 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35546
35547 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35548 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35549
35550 @smallexample
35551 @group
35552 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35553 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35554 cd ../gdb-sun4
35555 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35556 make
35557 @end group
35558 @end smallexample
35559
35560 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35561 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35562 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35563 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35564 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35565 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35566
35567 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35568 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35569 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35570 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35571 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35572
35573 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35574 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35575 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35576 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35577 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35578 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35579
35580 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35581 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35582 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35583
35584 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35585 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35586 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35587 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35588 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35589
35590 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35591 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35592 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35593 with each other.
35594
35595 @node Config Names
35596 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35597
35598 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35599 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35600 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35601 of information in the following pattern:
35602
35603 @smallexample
35604 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35605 @end smallexample
35606
35607 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35608 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35609 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35610
35611 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35612 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35613 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35614 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35615 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35616 abbreviations---for example:
35617
35618 @smallexample
35619 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35620 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35621 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35622 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35623 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35624 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35625 % sh config.sub sun4
35626 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35627 % sh config.sub sun3
35628 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35629 % sh config.sub i986v
35630 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35631 @end smallexample
35632
35633 @noindent
35634 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35635 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35636
35637 @node Configure Options
35638 @section @file{configure} Options
35639
35640 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35641 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35642 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35643 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35644 explanation of @file{configure}.
35645
35646 @smallexample
35647 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35648 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35649 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35650 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35651 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35652 @end smallexample
35653
35654 @noindent
35655 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35656 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35657 @samp{--}.
35658
35659 @table @code
35660 @item --help
35661 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35662
35663 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35664 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35665 @file{@var{dir}}.
35666
35667 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35668 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35669 @file{@var{dir}}.
35670
35671 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35672 @need 2000
35673 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35674 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35675 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35676 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35677 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35678 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35679 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35680 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35681 @var{dirname}.
35682
35683 @item --target=@var{target}
35684 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35685 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35686 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35687
35688 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35689 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35690 @end table
35691
35692 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35693 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35694 options not described here.
35695
35696 @table @code
35697 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35698 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35699 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35700 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35701 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35702
35703 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35704 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35705 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35706 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35707 @code{--datadir}).
35708
35709 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35710 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35711 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35712 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35713 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35714 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35715 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35716 after it is built.
35717
35718 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35719 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35720
35721 @item --disable-gdbmi
35722 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35723 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35724
35725 @item --enable-tui
35726 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35727 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35728 supported).
35729
35730 @item --with-curses
35731 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35732 terminal operations.
35733
35734 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35735 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35736 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35737 details.
35738
35739 @item --with-system-readline
35740 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35741 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35742
35743 @item --with-system-zlib
35744 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35745 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35746
35747 @item --with-expat
35748 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35749 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35750 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35751 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35752 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35753 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35754 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35755 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35756
35757 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35758
35759 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35760 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35761 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35762 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35763 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35764
35765 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35766 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35767
35768 @item --with-lzma
35769 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35770 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35771 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35772 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35773 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35774 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35775
35776 @item --with-mpfr
35777 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35778 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35779 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35780 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35781 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35782 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35783 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35784 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35785 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35786
35787 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35788 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35789 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35790 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35791 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35792 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35793 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35794 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35795 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35796 Python is installed.
35797
35798 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35799 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35800 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35801 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35802 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35803 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35804 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35805 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35806 compile and link against Guile.
35807
35808 @item --without-included-regex
35809 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35810 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35811 the GNU C library.
35812
35813 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35814 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35815 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35816 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35817 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35818 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35819 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35820 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35821
35822 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35823 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35824 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35825 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35826 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35827 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35828
35829 @item --enable-build-warnings
35830 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35831 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
35832 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
35833 compiler you are using.
35834
35835 @item --enable-werror
35836 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
35837 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
35838 outputs any warning messages.
35839
35840 @item --enable-ubsan
35841 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
35842 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
35843 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
35844 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
35845 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
35846 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
35847 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
35848 @end table
35849
35850 @node System-wide configuration
35851 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35852 @cindex system-wide init file
35853
35854 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35855 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35856 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35857
35858 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35859
35860 @table @code
35861 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35862 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35863 @var{file}.
35864 @end table
35865
35866 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35867 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35868
35869 @itemize @bullet
35870 @item
35871 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35872 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35873 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35874 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35875 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35876 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35877
35878 @item
35879 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35880 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35881 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35882 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35883 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35884 @end itemize
35885
35886 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35887 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35888 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35889 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35890 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35891 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35892 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35893 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35894 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35895 reread.
35896
35897 @menu
35898 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35899 @end menu
35900
35901 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35902 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35903 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35904
35905 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35906 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35907 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35908 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35909 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35910 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35911
35912 The following scripts are currently available:
35913 @itemize @bullet
35914
35915 @item @file{elinos.py}
35916 @pindex elinos.py
35917 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35918 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35919 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35920 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35921 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35922 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35923
35924 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35925 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35926 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35927 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35928 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35929 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35930
35931 @end itemize
35932
35933 @node Maintenance Commands
35934 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35935 @cindex maintenance commands
35936 @cindex internal commands
35937
35938 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35939 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35940 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35941 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35942 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35943
35944 @table @code
35945 @kindex maint agent
35946 @kindex maint agent-eval
35947 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35948 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35949 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35950 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35951 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35952 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35953 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35954 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35955 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35956 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35957 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35958 addition and return the sum.
35959 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35960 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35961
35962 @kindex maint agent-printf
35963 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35964 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35965 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35966 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35967 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35968
35969 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35970 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35971 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35972 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35973 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35974 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35975 is shown:
35976
35977 @table @code
35978 @item breakpoint
35979 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35980
35981 @item watchpoint
35982 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35983
35984 @item longjmp
35985 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35986 @code{longjmp} calls.
35987
35988 @item longjmp resume
35989 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35990
35991 @item until
35992 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35993
35994 @item finish
35995 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35996
35997 @item shlib events
35998 Shared library events.
35999
36000 @end table
36001
36002 @kindex maint info btrace
36003 @item maint info btrace
36004 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36005
36006 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36007 @item maint btrace packet-history
36008 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36009 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36010 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36011 recording format.
36012
36013 @table @code
36014 @item bts
36015 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36016 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36017
36018 @table @asis
36019 @item Block number
36020 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36021 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36022 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36023 @end table
36024
36025 @item pt
36026 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36027 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36028 information is printed:
36029
36030 @table @asis
36031 @item Packet number
36032 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36033 @item Trace offset
36034 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36035 @item Packet opcode and payload
36036 @end table
36037 @end table
36038
36039 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36040 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36041 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36042 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36043 needed.
36044
36045 @kindex maint btrace clear
36046 @item maint btrace clear
36047 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36048 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36049
36050 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36051 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36052 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36053 buffer.
36054
36055 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36056 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36057 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36058 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36059 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36060 packet history.
36061
36062 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36063 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36064 @cindex displaced stepping support
36065 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36066 @item set displaced-stepping
36067 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36068 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36069 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36070 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36071 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36072 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36073
36074 @table @code
36075 @item set displaced-stepping on
36076 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36077 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36078
36079 @item set displaced-stepping off
36080 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36081 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36082
36083 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36084 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36085 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36086 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36087 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36088 @end table
36089
36090 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36091 @item maint check-psymtabs
36092 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36093 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36094
36095 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36096 @item maint check-symtabs
36097 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36098
36099 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36100 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36101 Expand symbol tables.
36102 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36103 names matching @var{regexp}.
36104
36105 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36106 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36107 @cindex demangler crashes
36108 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36109 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36110 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36111 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36112 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36113 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36114 option to terminate the current session.
36115
36116 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36117 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36118 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36119
36120 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36121 @item maint cplus namespace
36122 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36123
36124 @kindex maint deprecate
36125 @kindex maint undeprecate
36126 @cindex deprecated commands
36127 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36128 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36129 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36130 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36131 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36132 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36133 the replacement as part of the warning.
36134
36135 @kindex maint dump-me
36136 @item maint dump-me
36137 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36138 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36139 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36140 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36141
36142 @kindex maint internal-error
36143 @kindex maint internal-warning
36144 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36145 @cindex demangler crashes
36146 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36147 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36148 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36149
36150 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36151 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36152 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36153 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36154 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36155 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36156 @value{GDBN} session.
36157
36158 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36159 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36160
36161 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36162
36163 @smallexample
36164 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36165 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36166 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36167 debugging may prove unreliable.
36168 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36169 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36170 (@value{GDBP})
36171 @end smallexample
36172
36173 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36174 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36175 @cindex demangler crashes
36176
36177 @kindex maint set internal-error
36178 @kindex maint show internal-error
36179 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36180 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36181 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36182 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36183 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36184 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36185 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36186 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36187 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36188 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36189 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36190 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36191 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36192 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36193 described in the table below.
36194
36195 @table @samp
36196 @item quit
36197 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36198 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36199
36200 @item corefile
36201 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36202 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36203 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36204 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36205 disabled.
36206 @end table
36207
36208 @kindex maint packet
36209 @item maint packet @var{text}
36210 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36211 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36212 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36213 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36214 checksum.
36215
36216 @kindex maint print architecture
36217 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36218 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36219 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36220
36221 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36222 @item maint print c-tdesc
36223 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36224 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36225 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36226 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36227 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36228 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36229 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36230 modify XML target descriptions.
36231
36232 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36233 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36234 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36235 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36236
36237 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36238 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36239 @item maint check libthread-db
36240 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36241 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36242 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36243 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36244 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36245 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36246
36247 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36248 @item maint print dummy-frames
36249 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36250
36251 @smallexample
36252 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36253 @dots{}
36254 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36255 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36256 58 return (a + b);
36257 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36258 @dots{}
36259 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36260 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36261 (@value{GDBP})
36262 @end smallexample
36263
36264 Takes an optional file parameter.
36265
36266 @kindex maint print registers
36267 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36268 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36269 @kindex maint print register-groups
36270 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36271 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36272 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36273 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36274 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36275 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36276 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36277
36278 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36279 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36280 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36281 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36282 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36283 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36284 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36285 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36286
36287 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36288 write the information.
36289
36290 @kindex maint print reggroups
36291 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36292 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36293 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36294 information.
36295
36296 The register groups info looks like this:
36297
36298 @smallexample
36299 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36300 Group Type
36301 general user
36302 float user
36303 all user
36304 vector user
36305 system user
36306 save internal
36307 restore internal
36308 @end smallexample
36309
36310 @kindex flushregs
36311 @item flushregs
36312 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36313
36314 @kindex maint print objfiles
36315 @cindex info for known object files
36316 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36317 Print a dump of all known object files.
36318 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36319 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36320 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36321
36322 @kindex maint print user-registers
36323 @cindex user registers
36324 @item maint print user-registers
36325 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36326 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36327 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36328 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36329 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36330 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36331 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36332
36333 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36334 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36335 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36336 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36337 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36338 matching @var{regexp}.
36339 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36340 and the full path if known.
36341 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36342
36343 @kindex maint print statistics
36344 @cindex bcache statistics
36345 @item maint print statistics
36346 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36347 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36348 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36349 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36350 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36351 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36352 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36353 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36354 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36355 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36356 lengths.
36357
36358 @kindex maint print target-stack
36359 @cindex target stack description
36360 @item maint print target-stack
36361 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36362 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36363 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36364 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36365 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36366 address.
36367
36368 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36369 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36370
36371 @kindex maint print type
36372 @cindex type chain of a data type
36373 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36374 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36375 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36376 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36377 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36378 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36379
36380 @kindex maint selftest
36381 @cindex self tests
36382 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36383 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36384 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36385 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36386 name will by ran.
36387
36388 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36389 @cindex self tests
36390 @item maint info selftests
36391 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36392
36393 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36394 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36395 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36396 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36397 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36398 information.
36399
36400 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36401 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36402 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36403 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36404 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36405 always see the disassembly form.
36406
36407 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36408
36409 @smallexample
36410 (gdb) info addr argc
36411 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36412 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36413 @end smallexample
36414
36415 For more information on these expressions, see
36416 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36417
36418 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36419 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36420 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36421 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36422 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36423
36424 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36425 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36426 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36427 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36428 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36429 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36430 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36431 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36432 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36433
36434 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36435 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36436 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36437 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36438 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36439
36440 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36441 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36442 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36443 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36444 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36445 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36446
36447 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36448 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36449 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36450
36451 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36452 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36453 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36454 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36455
36456 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36457 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36458 @kindex maint set profile
36459 @kindex maint show profile
36460 @cindex profiling GDB
36461 @item maint set profile
36462 @itemx maint show profile
36463 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36464
36465 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36466 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36467 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36468 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36469 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36470 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36471 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36472
36473 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36474 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36475
36476 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36477 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36478 @cindex hardware debug registers
36479 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36480 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36481 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36482 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36483 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36484 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36485 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36486
36487 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36488 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36489 @item maint set show-all-tib
36490 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36491 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36492 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36493 command.
36494
36495 @kindex maint set target-async
36496 @kindex maint show target-async
36497 @item maint set target-async
36498 @itemx maint show target-async
36499 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36500 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36501 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36502 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36503
36504 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36505 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36506 @item maint set target-non-stop
36507 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36508
36509 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36510 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36511 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36512 if supported by the target.
36513
36514 @table @code
36515 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36516 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36517 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36518
36519 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36520 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36521 does not indicate support.
36522
36523 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36524 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36525 target supports it.
36526 @end table
36527
36528 @kindex maint set per-command
36529 @kindex maint show per-command
36530 @item maint set per-command
36531 @itemx maint show per-command
36532 @cindex resources used by commands
36533
36534 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36535 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36536
36537 @table @code
36538 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36539 @itemx maint show per-command space
36540 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36541 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36542 took, following the command's own output.
36543 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36544 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36545
36546 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36547 @itemx maint show per-command time
36548 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36549 for each command.
36550 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36551 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36552 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36553 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36554 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36555 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36556 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36557 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36558 spent by the program been debugged.
36559 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36560 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36561
36562 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36563 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36564 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36565 for each command.
36566 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36567
36568 @enumerate a
36569 @item
36570 number of symbol tables
36571 @item
36572 number of primary symbol tables
36573 @item
36574 number of blocks in the blockvector
36575 @end enumerate
36576 @end table
36577
36578 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36579 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36580 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36581 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36582 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36583 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36584 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36585 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36586 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36587 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36588
36589 @kindex maint space
36590 @cindex memory used by commands
36591 @item maint space @var{value}
36592 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36593 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36594
36595 @kindex maint time
36596 @cindex time of command execution
36597 @item maint time @var{value}
36598 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36599 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36600
36601 @kindex maint translate-address
36602 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36603 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36604 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36605 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36606 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36607 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36608 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36609
36610 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36611 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36612 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36613
36614 @end table
36615
36616 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36617 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36618
36619 @table @code
36620 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36621 @kindex set watchdog
36622 @cindex watchdog timer
36623 @cindex timeout for commands
36624 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36625 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36626 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36627
36628 @item show watchdog
36629 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36630 @end table
36631
36632 @node Remote Protocol
36633 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36634
36635 @menu
36636 * Overview::
36637 * Packets::
36638 * Stop Reply Packets::
36639 * General Query Packets::
36640 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36641 * Tracepoint Packets::
36642 * Host I/O Packets::
36643 * Interrupts::
36644 * Notification Packets::
36645 * Remote Non-Stop::
36646 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36647 * Examples::
36648 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36649 * Library List Format::
36650 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36651 * Memory Map Format::
36652 * Thread List Format::
36653 * Traceframe Info Format::
36654 * Branch Trace Format::
36655 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36656 @end menu
36657
36658 @node Overview
36659 @section Overview
36660
36661 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36662 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36663 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36664 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36665
36666 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36667 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36668
36669 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36670 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36671 @cindex remote serial protocol
36672 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36673 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36674 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36675 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36676 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36677
36678 @smallexample
36679 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36680 @end smallexample
36681 @noindent
36682
36683 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36684 @noindent
36685 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36686 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36687 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36688
36689 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36690 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36691
36692 @smallexample
36693 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36694 @end smallexample
36695
36696 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36697 @noindent
36698 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36699 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36700 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36701
36702 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36703 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36704 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36705 retransmission):
36706
36707 @smallexample
36708 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36709 <- @code{+}
36710 @end smallexample
36711 @noindent
36712
36713 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36714 once a connection is established.
36715 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36716
36717 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36718 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36719 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36720 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36721 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36722 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36723 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36724
36725 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36726 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36727 exceptions).
36728
36729 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36730 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36731 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36732 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36733
36734 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36735 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36736 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36737
36738 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36739 @anchor{Binary Data}
36740 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36741 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36742 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36743 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36744 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36745 binary data.
36746
36747 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36748 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36749 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36750 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36751 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36752 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36753 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36754 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36755 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36756 (described next).
36757
36758 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36759 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36760 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36761 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36762 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36763 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36764 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36765 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36766 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36767 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36768 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36769 3}} more times.
36770
36771 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36772 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36773 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36774 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36775 @samp{0*"00}.
36776
36777 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36778 error number. That number is not well defined.
36779
36780 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36781 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36782 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36783 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36784 on that response.
36785
36786 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36787 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36788 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36789 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36790 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36791 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36792
36793 @node Packets
36794 @section Packets
36795
36796 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36797 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36798 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36799 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36800
36801 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36802 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36803 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36804 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36805 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36806 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36807 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36808 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36809 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36810 @var{baz}.
36811
36812 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36813 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36814 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36815 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36816 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36817 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36818 pick any thread.
36819
36820 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36821 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36822 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36823 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36824 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36825 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36826 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36827 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36828 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36829 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36830 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36831 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36832 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36833
36834 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36835 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36836 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36837 more information.
36838
36839 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36840 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36841
36842 Here are the packet descriptions.
36843
36844 @table @samp
36845
36846 @item !
36847 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36848 @anchor{extended mode}
36849 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36850 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36851 debugged.
36852
36853 Reply:
36854 @table @samp
36855 @item OK
36856 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36857 @end table
36858
36859 @item ?
36860 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36861 @anchor{? packet}
36862 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36863 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36864 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36865
36866 Reply:
36867 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36868
36869 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36870 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36871 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36872 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36873 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36874
36875 Reply:
36876 @table @samp
36877 @item OK
36878 The arguments were set.
36879 @item E @var{NN}
36880 An error occurred.
36881 @end table
36882
36883 @item b @var{baud}
36884 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36885 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36886 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36887
36888 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36889 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36890 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36891
36892 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36893 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36894 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36895 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36896 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36897
36898 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36899 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36900 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36901 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36902
36903 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36904 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36905
36906 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36907 @anchor{bc}
36908 @item bc
36909 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36910 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36911
36912 Reply:
36913 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36914
36915 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36916 @anchor{bs}
36917 @item bs
36918 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36919 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36920
36921 Reply:
36922 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36923
36924 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36925 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36926 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36927 is omitted, resume at current address.
36928
36929 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36930 packet}.
36931
36932 Reply:
36933 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36934
36935 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36936 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36937 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36938 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36939
36940 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36941 packet}.
36942
36943 Reply:
36944 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36945
36946 @item d
36947 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36948 Toggle debug flag.
36949
36950 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36951 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36952
36953 @item D
36954 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36955 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36956 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36957 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36958 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36959
36960 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36961 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36962 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36963 big-endian hex string.
36964
36965 Reply:
36966 @table @samp
36967 @item OK
36968 for success
36969 @item E @var{NN}
36970 for an error
36971 @end table
36972
36973 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36974 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36975 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36976 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36977 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36978
36979 @item g
36980 @anchor{read registers packet}
36981 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36982 Read general registers.
36983
36984 Reply:
36985 @table @samp
36986 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36987 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36988 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36989 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36990 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36991 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36992
36993 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36994 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36995 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36996 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36997 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36998 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36999 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37000 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37001
37002 @smallexample
37003 -> @code{g}
37004 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37005 @end smallexample
37006
37007 @item E @var{NN}
37008 for an error.
37009 @end table
37010
37011 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37012 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37013 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37014 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37015
37016 Reply:
37017 @table @samp
37018 @item OK
37019 for success
37020 @item E @var{NN}
37021 for an error
37022 @end table
37023
37024 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37025 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37026 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37027 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37028 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37029 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37030 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37031 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37032 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37033
37034 Reply:
37035 @table @samp
37036 @item OK
37037 for success
37038 @item E @var{NN}
37039 for an error
37040 @end table
37041
37042 @c FIXME: JTC:
37043 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37044 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37045 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37046 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37047 @c described. For example:
37048 @c
37049 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37050 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37051 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37052 @c
37053 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37054 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37055 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37056
37057 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37058 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37059 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37060 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37061 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37062 step starting at that address.
37063
37064 @item I
37065 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37066 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37067 step packet}.
37068
37069 @item k
37070 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37071 Kill request.
37072
37073 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37074
37075 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37076 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37077
37078 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37079
37080 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37081 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37082 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37083
37084 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37085 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37086 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37087
37088 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37089 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37090 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37091 (@pxref{? packet}).
37092
37093 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37094 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37095 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37096 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37097 any particular boundary.
37098
37099 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37100 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37101 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37102 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37103 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37104 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37105 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37106 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37107
37108 Reply:
37109 @table @samp
37110 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37111 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37112 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37113 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37114 @item E @var{NN}
37115 @var{NN} is errno
37116 @end table
37117
37118 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37119 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37120 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37121 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37122 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37123
37124 Reply:
37125 @table @samp
37126 @item OK
37127 for success
37128 @item E @var{NN}
37129 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37130 written).
37131 @end table
37132
37133 @item p @var{n}
37134 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37135 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37136 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37137 register value is encoded.
37138
37139 Reply:
37140 @table @samp
37141 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37142 the register's value
37143 @item E @var{NN}
37144 for an error
37145 @item @w{}
37146 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37147 @end table
37148
37149 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37150 @anchor{write register packet}
37151 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37152 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37153 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37154 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37155
37156 Reply:
37157 @table @samp
37158 @item OK
37159 for success
37160 @item E @var{NN}
37161 for an error
37162 @end table
37163
37164 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37165 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37166 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37167 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37168 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37169 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37170
37171 @item r
37172 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37173 Reset the entire system.
37174
37175 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37176
37177 @item R @var{XX}
37178 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37179 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37180 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37181
37182 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37183
37184 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37185 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37186 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37187 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37188
37189 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37190 packet}.
37191
37192 Reply:
37193 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37194
37195 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37196 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37197 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37198 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37199 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37200
37201 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37202 packet}.
37203
37204 Reply:
37205 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37206
37207 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37208 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37209 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37210 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37211 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37212
37213 @item T @var{thread-id}
37214 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37215 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37216
37217 Reply:
37218 @table @samp
37219 @item OK
37220 thread is still alive
37221 @item E @var{NN}
37222 thread is dead
37223 @end table
37224
37225 @item v
37226 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37227 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37228
37229 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37230 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37231 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37232 The process ID is a
37233 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37234 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37235 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37236
37237 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37238 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37239 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37240 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37241 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37242 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37243 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37244 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37245
37246 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37247
37248 Reply:
37249 @table @samp
37250 @item E @var{nn}
37251 for an error
37252 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37253 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37254 @item OK
37255 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37256 @end table
37257
37258 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37259 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37260 @anchor{vCont packet}
37261 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37262
37263 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37264 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37265 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37266 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37267 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37268 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37269 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37270 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37271 error.
37272
37273 Currently supported actions are:
37274
37275 @table @samp
37276 @item c
37277 Continue.
37278 @item C @var{sig}
37279 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37280 @item s
37281 Step.
37282 @item S @var{sig}
37283 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37284 @item t
37285 Stop.
37286 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37287 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37288 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37289 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37290 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37291 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37292
37293 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37294 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37295 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37296 jumps to @var{start}).
37297
37298 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37299 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37300 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37301
37302 @end table
37303
37304 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37305 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37306 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37307
37308 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37309 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37310 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37311 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37312 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37313 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37314 as an implementation detail.
37315
37316 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37317 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37318 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37319 stopped.
37320
37321 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37322 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37323 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37324
37325 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37326 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37327
37328 Reply:
37329 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37330
37331 @item vCont?
37332 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37333 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37334
37335 Reply:
37336 @table @samp
37337 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37338 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37339 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37340 @item @w{}
37341 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37342 @end table
37343
37344 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37345 @item vCtrlC
37346 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37347 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37348 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37349 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37350 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37351 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37352 variant.
37353
37354 Reply:
37355 @table @samp
37356 @item E @var{nn}
37357 for an error
37358 @item OK
37359 for success
37360 @end table
37361
37362 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37363 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37364 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37365 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37366
37367 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37368 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37369 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37370 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37371 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37372 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37373 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37374 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37375 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37376 packet is received.
37377
37378 Reply:
37379 @table @samp
37380 @item OK
37381 for success
37382 @item E @var{NN}
37383 for an error
37384 @end table
37385
37386 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37387 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37388 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37389 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37390 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37391 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37392 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37393 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37394 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37395 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37396 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37397 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37398
37399
37400 Reply:
37401 @table @samp
37402 @item OK
37403 for success
37404 @item E.memtype
37405 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37406 @item E @var{NN}
37407 for an error
37408 @end table
37409
37410 @item vFlashDone
37411 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37412 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37413 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37414 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37415 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37416 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37417 request is completed.
37418
37419 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37420 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37421 @anchor{vKill packet}
37422 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37423 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37424 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37425 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37426
37427 Reply:
37428 @table @samp
37429 @item E @var{nn}
37430 for an error
37431 @item OK
37432 for success
37433 @end table
37434
37435 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37436 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37437 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37438 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37439 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37440
37441 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37442 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37443 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37444 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37445 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37446 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37447
37448 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37449 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37450 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37451 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37452 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37453 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37454 state.
37455
37456 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37457
37458 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37459
37460 Reply:
37461 @table @samp
37462 @item E @var{nn}
37463 for an error
37464 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37465 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37466 @end table
37467
37468 @item vStopped
37469 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37470 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37471
37472 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37473 @anchor{X packet}
37474 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37475 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37476 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37477 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37478 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37479
37480 Reply:
37481 @table @samp
37482 @item OK
37483 for success
37484 @item E @var{NN}
37485 for an error
37486 @end table
37487
37488 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37489 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37490 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37491 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37492 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37493 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37494 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37495
37496 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37497 separately.
37498
37499 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37500 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37501 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37502 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37503 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37504 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37505
37506 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37507 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37508 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37509 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37510 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37511 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37512
37513 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37514 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37515 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37516 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37517 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37518 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37519 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37520 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37521 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37522 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37523 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37524 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37525 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37526
37527 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37528 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37529
37530 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37531 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37532
37533 @table @samp
37534
37535 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37536 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37537 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37538
37539 @end table
37540
37541 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37542 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37543 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37544 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37545 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37546 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37547 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37548
37549 @table @samp
37550
37551 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37552 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37553 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37554
37555 @end table
37556
37557 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37558 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37559 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37560 target, is not defined.}
37561
37562 Reply:
37563 @table @samp
37564 @item OK
37565 success
37566 @item @w{}
37567 not supported
37568 @item E @var{NN}
37569 for an error
37570 @end table
37571
37572 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37573 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37574 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37575 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37576 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37577 address @var{addr}.
37578
37579 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37580 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37581 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37582 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37583
37584 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37585 movement.}
37586
37587 Reply:
37588 @table @samp
37589 @item OK
37590 success
37591 @item @w{}
37592 not supported
37593 @item E @var{NN}
37594 for an error
37595 @end table
37596
37597 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37598 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37599 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37600 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37601 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37602 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37603
37604 Reply:
37605 @table @samp
37606 @item OK
37607 success
37608 @item @w{}
37609 not supported
37610 @item E @var{NN}
37611 for an error
37612 @end table
37613
37614 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37615 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37616 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37617 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37618 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37619 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37620
37621 Reply:
37622 @table @samp
37623 @item OK
37624 success
37625 @item @w{}
37626 not supported
37627 @item E @var{NN}
37628 for an error
37629 @end table
37630
37631 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37632 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37633 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37634 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37635 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37636 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37637
37638 Reply:
37639 @table @samp
37640 @item OK
37641 success
37642 @item @w{}
37643 not supported
37644 @item E @var{NN}
37645 for an error
37646 @end table
37647
37648 @end table
37649
37650 @node Stop Reply Packets
37651 @section Stop Reply Packets
37652 @cindex stop reply packets
37653
37654 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37655 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37656 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37657 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37658 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37659 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37660 @value{GDBN} source code.
37661
37662 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37663 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37664 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37665
37666 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37667 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37668 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37669 components.
37670
37671 @table @samp
37672
37673 @item S @var{AA}
37674 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37675 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37676 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37677
37678 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37679 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37680 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37681 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37682 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37683 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37684 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37685 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37686
37687 @itemize @bullet
37688 @item
37689 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37690 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37691 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37692 two-digit hex number.
37693
37694 @item
37695 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37696 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37697
37698 @item
37699 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37700 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37701
37702 @item
37703 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37704 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37705 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37706 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37707
37708 @item
37709 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37710 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37711 future.
37712 @end itemize
37713
37714 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37715
37716 @table @samp
37717 @item watch
37718 @itemx rwatch
37719 @itemx awatch
37720 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37721 hex.
37722
37723 @item syscall_entry
37724 @itemx syscall_return
37725 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37726 syscall number, in hex.
37727
37728 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37729 @item library
37730 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37731 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37732 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37733
37734 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37735 @item replaylog
37736 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37737 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37738 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37739 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37740 for more information.
37741
37742 @item swbreak
37743 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37744 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37745 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37746 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37747 part must be left empty.
37748
37749 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37750 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37751 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37752 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37753 address.
37754
37755 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37756 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37757 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37758 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37759 indicating support.
37760
37761 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37762
37763 @item hwbreak
37764 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37765 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37766
37767 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37768 apply.
37769
37770 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37771 @item fork
37772 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37773 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37774 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37775 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37776 fork events.
37777
37778 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37779 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37780 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37781 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37782 indicating support.
37783
37784 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37785 @item vfork
37786 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37787 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37788 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37789 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37790 vfork events.
37791
37792 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37793 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37794 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37795 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37796 indicating support.
37797
37798 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37799 @item vforkdone
37800 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37801 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37802 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37803 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37804 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37805
37806 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37807 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37808 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37809 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37810 indicating support.
37811
37812 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37813 @item exec
37814 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37815 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37816 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37817
37818 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37819 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37820 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37821 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37822 indicating support.
37823
37824 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37825 @anchor{thread create event}
37826 @item create
37827 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37828 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37829 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37830 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37831 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37832 @var{r} part is ignored.
37833
37834 @end table
37835
37836 @item W @var{AA}
37837 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37838 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37839 applicable to certain targets.
37840
37841 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37842 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37843 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37844 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37845 hex strings.
37846
37847 @item X @var{AA}
37848 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37849 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37850
37851 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37852 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37853 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37854 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37855 hex strings.
37856
37857 @anchor{thread exit event}
37858 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37859 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37860
37861 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37862 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37863 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37864 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37865
37866 @item N
37867 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37868 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37869 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37870 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37871 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37872 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37873 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37874 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37875 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37876 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37877 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37878 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37879 support.
37880
37881 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37882 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37883 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37884 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37885 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37886
37887 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37888 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37889 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37890 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37891 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37892 system calls.
37893
37894 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37895 this very system call.
37896
37897 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37898 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37899 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37900 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37901 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37902 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37903
37904 @end table
37905
37906 @node General Query Packets
37907 @section General Query Packets
37908 @cindex remote query requests
37909
37910 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37911 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37912 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37913 sending information to and from the stub.
37914
37915 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37916 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37917 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37918 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37919 conventions:
37920
37921 @itemize @bullet
37922 @item
37923 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37924 @item
37925 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37926 letter.
37927 @item
37928 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37929 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37930 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37931 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37932 @end itemize
37933
37934 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37935 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37936 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37937 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37938 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37939 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37940 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37941 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37942 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37943 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37944 packet.}.
37945
37946 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37947 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37948 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37949 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37950 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37951
37952 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37953
37954 @table @samp
37955
37956 @item QAgent:1
37957 @itemx QAgent:0
37958 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37959 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37960
37961 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37962 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37963 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37964 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37965 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37966 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37967 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37968 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37969 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37970 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37971 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37972
37973 @item qC
37974 @cindex current thread, remote request
37975 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37976 Return the current thread ID.
37977
37978 Reply:
37979 @table @samp
37980 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37981 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37982 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37983 @item @r{(anything else)}
37984 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37985 @end table
37986
37987 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37988 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37989 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37990 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37991 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37992 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37993 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37994 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37995
37996 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37997 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37998 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37999 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38000 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38001 detect trailing zeros.
38002
38003 Reply:
38004 @table @samp
38005 @item E @var{NN}
38006 An error (such as memory fault)
38007 @item C @var{crc32}
38008 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38009 @end table
38010
38011 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38012 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38013 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38014 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38015 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38016 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38017 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38018 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38019 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38020 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38021 randomization.
38022
38023 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38024
38025 Reply:
38026 @table @samp
38027 @item OK
38028 The request succeeded.
38029
38030 @item E @var{nn}
38031 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38032
38033 @item @w{}
38034 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38035 by the stub.
38036 @end table
38037
38038 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38039 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38040 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38041 address space randomization.
38042
38043 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38044 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38045 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38046 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38047 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38048 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38049 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38050 inferior using a shell or not.
38051
38052 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38053 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38054 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38055 values are considered an error.
38056
38057 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38058 mode}).
38059
38060 Reply:
38061 @table @samp
38062 @item OK
38063 The request succeeded.
38064
38065 @item E @var{nn}
38066 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38067 @end table
38068
38069 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38070 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38071 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38072 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38073
38074 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38075 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38076
38077 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38078 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38079 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38080 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38081 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38082 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38083 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38084 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38085 environment}).
38086
38087 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38088 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38089 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38090 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38091 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38092 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38093 not be present.
38094
38095 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38096 mode}).
38097
38098 Reply:
38099 @table @samp
38100 @item OK
38101 The request succeeded.
38102 @end table
38103
38104 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38105 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38106 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38107 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38108 inferior.
38109
38110 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38111 @pxref{set environment}.
38112
38113 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38114 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38115 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38116 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38117 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38118 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38119 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38120 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38121
38122 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38123 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38124
38125 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38126 mode}).
38127
38128 Reply:
38129 @table @samp
38130 @item OK
38131 The request succeeded.
38132 @end table
38133
38134 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38135 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38136 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38137 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38138 inferior.
38139
38140 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38141 @pxref{unset environment}.
38142
38143 @item QEnvironmentReset
38144 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38145 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38146 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38147 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38148 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38149 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38150 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38151 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38152 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38153 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38154 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38155
38156 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38157 mode}).
38158
38159 Reply:
38160 @table @samp
38161 @item OK
38162 The request succeeded.
38163 @end table
38164
38165 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38166 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38167 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38168 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38169 inferior.
38170
38171 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38172 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38173 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38174 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38175 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38176 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38177
38178 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38179 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38180 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38181 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38182 directory to its original, empty value.
38183
38184 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38185 mode}).
38186
38187 Reply:
38188 @table @samp
38189 @item OK
38190 The request succeeded.
38191 @end table
38192
38193 @item qfThreadInfo
38194 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38195 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38196 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38197 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38198 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38199 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38200 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38201 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38202 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38203 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38204
38205 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38206
38207 Reply:
38208 @table @samp
38209 @item m @var{thread-id}
38210 A single thread ID
38211 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38212 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38213 @item l
38214 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38215 @end table
38216
38217 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38218 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38219 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38220 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38221 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38222 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38223 fields.
38224
38225 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38226 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38227 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38228 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38229 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38230
38231 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38232 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38233 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38234 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38235 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38236
38237 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38238 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38239
38240 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38241 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38242 information associated with the variable.)
38243
38244 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38245 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38246 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38247 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38248 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38249 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38250
38251 Reply:
38252 @table @samp
38253 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38254 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38255 local storage requested.
38256
38257 @item E @var{nn}
38258 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38259
38260 @item @w{}
38261 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38262 @end table
38263
38264 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38265 @cindex get thread information block address
38266 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38267 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38268
38269 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38270
38271 Reply:
38272 @table @samp
38273 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38274 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38275 thread information block.
38276
38277 @item E @var{nn}
38278 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38279 address could not be retrieved.
38280
38281 @item @w{}
38282 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38283 @end table
38284
38285 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38286 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38287 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38288 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38289 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38290 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38291 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38292
38293 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38294
38295 Reply:
38296 @table @samp
38297 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38298 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38299 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38300 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38301 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38302 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38303 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38304 @end table
38305
38306 @item qOffsets
38307 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38308 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38309 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38310 image.
38311
38312 Reply:
38313 @table @samp
38314 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38315 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38316 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38317 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38318 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38319 segments by the supplied offsets.
38320
38321 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38322 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38323 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38324
38325 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38326 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38327 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38328 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38329 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38330 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38331 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38332 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38333 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38334 @end table
38335
38336 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38337 @cindex thread information, remote request
38338 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38339 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38340 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38341 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38342
38343 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38344 (see below).
38345
38346 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38347
38348 @item QNonStop:1
38349 @itemx QNonStop:0
38350 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38351 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38352 @anchor{QNonStop}
38353 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38354 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38355
38356 Reply:
38357 @table @samp
38358 @item OK
38359 The request succeeded.
38360
38361 @item E @var{nn}
38362 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38363
38364 @item @w{}
38365 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38366 the stub.
38367 @end table
38368
38369 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38370 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38371 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38372 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38373
38374 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38375 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38376 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38377 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38378 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38379 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38380 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38381
38382 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38383 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38384 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38385
38386 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38387 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38388 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38389 report the requested syscalls.
38390
38391 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38392 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38393
38394 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38395 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38396 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38397 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38398
38399 Reply:
38400 @table @samp
38401 @item OK
38402 The request succeeded.
38403
38404 @item E @var{nn}
38405 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38406
38407 @item @w{}
38408 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38409 the stub.
38410 @end table
38411
38412 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38413 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38414 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38415 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38416
38417 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38418 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38419 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38420 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38421 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38422 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38423 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38424 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38425 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38426 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38427 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38428 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38429 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38430
38431 Reply:
38432 @table @samp
38433 @item OK
38434 The request succeeded.
38435
38436 @item E @var{nn}
38437 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38438
38439 @item @w{}
38440 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38441 the stub.
38442 @end table
38443
38444 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38445 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38446 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38447 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38448
38449 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38450 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38451 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38452 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38453 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38454 Others should be silently discarded.
38455
38456 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38457 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38458 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38459 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38460 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38461 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38462 signals.
38463
38464 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38465 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38466
38467 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38468 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38469 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38470 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38471 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38472
38473 Reply:
38474 @table @samp
38475 @item OK
38476 The request succeeded.
38477
38478 @item E @var{nn}
38479 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38480
38481 @item @w{}
38482 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38483 by the stub.
38484 @end table
38485
38486 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38487 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38488 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38489 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38490
38491 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38492 @item QThreadEvents:1
38493 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38494 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38495 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38496
38497 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38498 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38499 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38500 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38501 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38502 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38503 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38504 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38505 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38506 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38507
38508 Reply:
38509 @table @samp
38510 @item OK
38511 The request succeeded.
38512
38513 @item E @var{nn}
38514 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38515
38516 @item @w{}
38517 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38518 the stub.
38519 @end table
38520
38521 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38522 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38523
38524 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38525 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38526 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38527 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38528 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38529 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38530 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38531 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38532 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38533
38534 Reply:
38535 @table @samp
38536 @item OK
38537 A command response with no output.
38538 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38539 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38540 @item E @var{NN}
38541 Indicate a badly formed request.
38542 @item @w{}
38543 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38544 @end table
38545
38546 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38547 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38548 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38549 packets.)
38550
38551 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38552 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38553 @ifnotinfo
38554 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38555 @end ifnotinfo
38556 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38557 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38558 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38559 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38560 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38561
38562 Reply:
38563 @table @samp
38564 @item 0
38565 The pattern was not found.
38566 @item 1,address
38567 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38568 @item E @var{NN}
38569 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38570 @item @w{}
38571 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38572 @end table
38573
38574 @item QStartNoAckMode
38575 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38576 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38577 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38578 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38579
38580 Reply:
38581 @table @samp
38582 @item OK
38583 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38584 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38585 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38586 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38587 @item @w{}
38588 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38589 @end table
38590
38591 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38592 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38593 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38594 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38595 @anchor{qSupported}
38596 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38597 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38598 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38599 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38600 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38601 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38602 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38603 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38604 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38605 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38606 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38607 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38608 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38609 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38610
38611 Reply:
38612 @table @samp
38613 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38614 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38615 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38616 possible forms).
38617 @item @w{}
38618 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38619 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38620 @end table
38621
38622 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38623 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38624 are:
38625
38626 @table @samp
38627 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38628 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38629 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38630 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38631 @item @var{name}+
38632 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38633 need an associated value.
38634 @item @var{name}-
38635 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38636 @item @var{name}?
38637 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38638 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38639 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38640 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38641 @end table
38642
38643 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38644 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38645 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38646 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38647 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38648
38649 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38650 are defined:
38651
38652 @table @samp
38653 @item multiprocess
38654 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38655 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38656 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38657 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38658 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38659
38660 @item xmlRegisters
38661 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38662 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38663 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38664 description.
38665
38666 @item qRelocInsn
38667 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38668 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38669 instruction reply packet}).
38670
38671 @item swbreak
38672 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38673 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38674
38675 @item hwbreak
38676 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38677 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38678
38679 @item fork-events
38680 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38681 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38682 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38683 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38684
38685 @item vfork-events
38686 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38687 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38688 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38689 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38690
38691 @item exec-events
38692 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38693 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38694 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38695 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38696
38697 @item vContSupported
38698 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38699 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38700 @end table
38701
38702 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38703 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38704 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38705 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38706 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38707 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38708 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38709 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38710 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38711 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38712 all the features it supports.
38713
38714 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38715 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38716
38717 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38718 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38719 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38720 form response.
38721
38722 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38723 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38724 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38725 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38726
38727 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38728 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38729 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38730 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38731 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38732
38733 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38734
38735 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38736 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38737 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38738 @item Feature Name
38739 @tab Value Required
38740 @tab Default
38741 @tab Probe Allowed
38742
38743 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38744 @tab Yes
38745 @tab @samp{-}
38746 @tab No
38747
38748 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38749 @tab No
38750 @tab @samp{-}
38751 @tab Yes
38752
38753 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38754 @tab No
38755 @tab @samp{-}
38756 @tab Yes
38757
38758 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38759 @tab No
38760 @tab @samp{-}
38761 @tab Yes
38762
38763 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38764 @tab No
38765 @tab @samp{-}
38766 @tab Yes
38767
38768 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38769 @tab No
38770 @tab @samp{-}
38771 @tab Yes
38772
38773 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38774 @tab No
38775 @tab @samp{-}
38776 @tab Yes
38777
38778 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38779 @tab No
38780 @tab @samp{-}
38781 @tab Yes
38782
38783 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38784 @tab No
38785 @tab @samp{-}
38786 @tab No
38787
38788 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38789 @tab No
38790 @tab @samp{-}
38791 @tab Yes
38792
38793 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38794 @tab No
38795 @tab @samp{-}
38796 @tab Yes
38797
38798 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38799 @tab No
38800 @tab @samp{-}
38801 @tab Yes
38802
38803 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38804 @tab No
38805 @tab @samp{-}
38806 @tab Yes
38807
38808 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38809 @tab No
38810 @tab @samp{-}
38811 @tab Yes
38812
38813 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38814 @tab No
38815 @tab @samp{-}
38816 @tab Yes
38817
38818 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38819 @tab No
38820 @tab @samp{-}
38821 @tab Yes
38822
38823 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38824 @tab No
38825 @tab @samp{-}
38826 @tab Yes
38827
38828 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38829 @tab No
38830 @tab @samp{-}
38831 @tab Yes
38832
38833 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38834 @tab No
38835 @tab @samp{-}
38836 @tab Yes
38837
38838 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38839 @tab Yes
38840 @tab @samp{-}
38841 @tab Yes
38842
38843 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38844 @tab Yes
38845 @tab @samp{-}
38846 @tab Yes
38847
38848 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38849 @tab Yes
38850 @tab @samp{-}
38851 @tab Yes
38852
38853 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38854 @tab Yes
38855 @tab @samp{-}
38856 @tab Yes
38857
38858 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38859 @tab Yes
38860 @tab @samp{-}
38861 @tab Yes
38862
38863 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38864 @tab No
38865 @tab @samp{-}
38866 @tab Yes
38867
38868 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38869 @tab No
38870 @tab @samp{-}
38871 @tab Yes
38872
38873 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38874 @tab No
38875 @tab @samp{-}
38876 @tab Yes
38877
38878 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38879 @tab No
38880 @tab @samp{-}
38881 @tab Yes
38882
38883 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38884 @tab No
38885 @tab @samp{-}
38886 @tab No
38887
38888 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38889 @tab No
38890 @tab @samp{-}
38891 @tab No
38892
38893 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38894 @tab No
38895 @tab @samp{-}
38896 @tab No
38897
38898 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38899 @tab No
38900 @tab @samp{-}
38901 @tab No
38902
38903 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38904 @tab No
38905 @tab @samp{-}
38906 @tab No
38907
38908 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38909 @tab No
38910 @tab @samp{-}
38911 @tab No
38912
38913 @item @samp{QAgent}
38914 @tab No
38915 @tab @samp{-}
38916 @tab No
38917
38918 @item @samp{QAllow}
38919 @tab No
38920 @tab @samp{-}
38921 @tab No
38922
38923 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38924 @tab No
38925 @tab @samp{-}
38926 @tab No
38927
38928 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38929 @tab No
38930 @tab @samp{-}
38931 @tab No
38932
38933 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38934 @tab No
38935 @tab @samp{-}
38936 @tab No
38937
38938 @item @samp{tracenz}
38939 @tab No
38940 @tab @samp{-}
38941 @tab No
38942
38943 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38944 @tab No
38945 @tab @samp{-}
38946 @tab No
38947
38948 @item @samp{swbreak}
38949 @tab No
38950 @tab @samp{-}
38951 @tab No
38952
38953 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38954 @tab No
38955 @tab @samp{-}
38956 @tab No
38957
38958 @item @samp{fork-events}
38959 @tab No
38960 @tab @samp{-}
38961 @tab No
38962
38963 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38964 @tab No
38965 @tab @samp{-}
38966 @tab No
38967
38968 @item @samp{exec-events}
38969 @tab No
38970 @tab @samp{-}
38971 @tab No
38972
38973 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38974 @tab No
38975 @tab @samp{-}
38976 @tab No
38977
38978 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38979 @tab No
38980 @tab @samp{-}
38981 @tab No
38982
38983 @end multitable
38984
38985 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38986
38987 @table @samp
38988 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38989 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38990 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38991 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38992 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38993 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38994 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38995 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38996 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38997 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38998
38999 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39000 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39001 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39002
39003 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39004 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39005 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39006
39007 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39008 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39009 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39010
39011 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39012 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39013 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39014
39015 @item qXfer:features:read
39016 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39017 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39018
39019 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39020 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39021 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39022
39023 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39024 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39025 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39026
39027 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39028 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39029 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39030 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39031
39032 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39033 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39034 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39035
39036 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39037 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39038 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39039
39040 @item qXfer:spu:read
39041 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39042 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39043
39044 @item qXfer:spu:write
39045 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39046 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39047
39048 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39049 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39050 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39051
39052 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39053 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39054 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39055
39056 @item qXfer:threads:read
39057 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39058 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39059
39060 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39061 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39062 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39063
39064 @item qXfer:uib:read
39065 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39066 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39067
39068 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39069 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39070 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39071
39072 @item QNonStop
39073 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39074 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39075
39076 @item QCatchSyscalls
39077 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39078 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39079
39080 @item QPassSignals
39081 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39082 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39083
39084 @item QStartNoAckMode
39085 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39086 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39087
39088 @item multiprocess
39089 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39090 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39091 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39092 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39093 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39094 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39095 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39096 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39097 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39098 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39099 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39100
39101 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39102 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39103 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39104
39105 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39106 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39107 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39108 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39109
39110 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39111 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39112 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39113
39114 @item ReverseContinue
39115 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39116 (@pxref{bc}).
39117
39118 @item ReverseStep
39119 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39120 (@pxref{bs}).
39121
39122 @item TracepointSource
39123 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39124 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39125
39126 @item QAgent
39127 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39128
39129 @item QAllow
39130 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39131
39132 @item QDisableRandomization
39133 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39134
39135 @item StaticTracepoint
39136 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39137 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39138
39139 @item InstallInTrace
39140 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39141 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39142
39143 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39144 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39145 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39146 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39147
39148 @item QTBuffer:size
39149 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39150 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39151
39152 @item tracenz
39153 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39154 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39155 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39156
39157 @item BreakpointCommands
39158 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39159 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39160 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39161
39162 @item Qbtrace:off
39163 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39164
39165 @item Qbtrace:bts
39166 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39167
39168 @item Qbtrace:pt
39169 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39170
39171 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39172 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39173
39174 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39175 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39176
39177 @item swbreak
39178 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39179 breakpoints.
39180
39181 @item hwbreak
39182 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39183 breakpoints.
39184
39185 @item fork-events
39186 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39187
39188 @item vfork-events
39189 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39190 and vforkdone events.
39191
39192 @item exec-events
39193 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39194
39195 @item vContSupported
39196 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39197 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39198
39199 @item QThreadEvents
39200 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39201
39202 @item no-resumed
39203 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39204
39205 @end table
39206
39207 @item qSymbol::
39208 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39209 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39210 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39211 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39212
39213 Reply:
39214 @table @samp
39215 @item OK
39216 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39217 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39218 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39219 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39220 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39221 below.
39222 @end table
39223
39224 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39225 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39226
39227 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39228 target has previously requested.
39229
39230 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39231 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39232 will be empty.
39233
39234 Reply:
39235 @table @samp
39236 @item OK
39237 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39238 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39239 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39240 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39241 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39242 @end table
39243
39244 @item qTBuffer
39245 @itemx QTBuffer
39246 @itemx QTDisconnected
39247 @itemx QTDP
39248 @itemx QTDPsrc
39249 @itemx QTDV
39250 @itemx qTfP
39251 @itemx qTfV
39252 @itemx QTFrame
39253 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39254
39255 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39256
39257 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39258 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39259 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39260 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39261 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39262 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39263 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39264 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39265 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39266 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39267 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39268
39269 Reply:
39270 @table @samp
39271 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39272 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39273 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39274 the thread's attributes.
39275 @end table
39276
39277 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39278 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39279 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39280 packets.)
39281
39282 @item QTNotes
39283 @itemx qTP
39284 @itemx QTSave
39285 @itemx qTsP
39286 @itemx qTsV
39287 @itemx QTStart
39288 @itemx QTStop
39289 @itemx QTEnable
39290 @itemx QTDisable
39291 @itemx QTinit
39292 @itemx QTro
39293 @itemx qTStatus
39294 @itemx qTV
39295 @itemx qTfSTM
39296 @itemx qTsSTM
39297 @itemx qTSTMat
39298 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39299
39300 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39301 @cindex read special object, remote request
39302 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39303 @anchor{qXfer read}
39304 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39305 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39306 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39307 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39308 additional details about what data to access.
39309
39310 Reply:
39311 @table @samp
39312 @item m @var{data}
39313 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39314 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39315 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39316 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39317 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39318 request.
39319
39320 @item l @var{data}
39321 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39322 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39323 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39324
39325 @item l
39326 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39327 There is no more data to be read.
39328
39329 @item E00
39330 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39331
39332 @item E @var{nn}
39333 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39334 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39335
39336 @item @w{}
39337 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39338 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39339 @end table
39340
39341 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39342 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39343 formats, listed above.
39344
39345 @table @samp
39346 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39347 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39348 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39349 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39350
39351 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39352 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39353
39354 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39355 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39356
39357 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39358 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39359 packet may have one of the following values:
39360
39361 @table @code
39362 @item all
39363 Returns all available branch trace.
39364
39365 @item new
39366 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39367 the last read request.
39368
39369 @item delta
39370 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39371 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39372 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39373 used to stitch traces together.
39374
39375 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39376 @end table
39377
39378 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39379 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39380
39381 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39382 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39383
39384 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39385 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39386
39387 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39388 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39389
39390 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39391 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39392 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39393 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39394 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39395 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39396 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39397
39398 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39399 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39400
39401 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39402 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39403 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39404 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39405 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39406
39407 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39408 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39409
39410 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39411 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39412 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39413 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39414 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39415
39416 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39417 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39418 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39419
39420 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39421 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39422
39423 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39424 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39425 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39426 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39427 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39428 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39429 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39430 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39431
39432 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39433 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39434
39435 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39436 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39437
39438 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39439 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39440 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39441 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39442
39443 @table @code
39444 @item start=@var{address}
39445 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39446 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39447 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39448 chosen as the starting point.
39449
39450 @item prev=@var{address}
39451 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39452 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39453 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39454 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39455 exists prior to the starting point.
39456
39457 @end table
39458
39459 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39460 ignored.
39461
39462 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39463 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39464 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39465 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39466 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39467
39468 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39469 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39470
39471 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39472 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39473
39474 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39475 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39476 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39477 Action Lists}.
39478
39479 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39480 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39481 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39482
39483 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39484 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39485 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39486 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39487 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39488
39489 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39490 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39491 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39492
39493 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39494 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39495 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39496 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39497 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39498 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39499 in that context to be accessed.
39500
39501 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39502 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39503 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39504
39505 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39506 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39507 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39508 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39509 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39510
39511 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39512 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39513
39514 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39515 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39516
39517 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39518 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39519 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39520
39521 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39522 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39523
39524 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39525 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39526
39527 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39528 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39529
39530 This packet is not probed by default.
39531
39532 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39533 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39534 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39535 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39536 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39537
39538 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39539 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39540
39541 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39542 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39543 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39544 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39545
39546 @end table
39547
39548 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39549 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39550 @anchor{qXfer write}
39551 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39552 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39553 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39554 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39555 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39556 to access.
39557
39558 Reply:
39559 @table @samp
39560 @item @var{nn}
39561 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39562 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39563
39564 @item E00
39565 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39566
39567 @item E @var{nn}
39568 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39569 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39570
39571 @item @w{}
39572 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39573 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39574 @end table
39575
39576 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39577 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39578 formats, listed above.
39579
39580 @table @samp
39581 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39582 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39583 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39584 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39585 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39586
39587 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39588 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39589 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39590
39591 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39592 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39593 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39594 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39595 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39596 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39597 in that context to be accessed.
39598
39599 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39600 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39601 @end table
39602
39603 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39604 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39605 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39606 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39607 must respond with an empty packet.
39608
39609 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39610 @cindex query attached, remote request
39611 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39612 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39613 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39614 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39615 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39616 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39617 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39618
39619 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39620 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39621 the @code{quit} command.
39622
39623 Reply:
39624 @table @samp
39625 @item 1
39626 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39627 @item 0
39628 The remote server created a new process.
39629 @item E @var{NN}
39630 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39631 @end table
39632
39633 @item Qbtrace:bts
39634 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39635
39636 Reply:
39637 @table @samp
39638 @item OK
39639 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39640 @item E.errtext
39641 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39642 @end table
39643
39644 @item Qbtrace:pt
39645 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39646
39647 Reply:
39648 @table @samp
39649 @item OK
39650 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39651 @item E.errtext
39652 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39653 @end table
39654
39655 @item Qbtrace:off
39656 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39657
39658 Reply:
39659 @table @samp
39660 @item OK
39661 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39662 @item E.errtext
39663 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39664 @end table
39665
39666 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39667 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39668 btrace recording method in bts format.
39669
39670 Reply:
39671 @table @samp
39672 @item OK
39673 The ring buffer size has been set.
39674 @item E.errtext
39675 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39676 @end table
39677
39678 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39679 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39680 btrace recording method in pt format.
39681
39682 Reply:
39683 @table @samp
39684 @item OK
39685 The ring buffer size has been set.
39686 @item E.errtext
39687 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39688 @end table
39689
39690 @end table
39691
39692 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39693 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39694
39695 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39696 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39697 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39698
39699 @menu
39700 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39701 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39702 @end menu
39703
39704 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39705 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39706
39707 @menu
39708 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39709 @end menu
39710
39711 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39712 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39713 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39714
39715 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39716
39717 @table @r
39718
39719 @item 2
39720 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39721
39722 @item 3
39723 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39724
39725 @item 4
39726 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39727
39728 @end table
39729
39730 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39731 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39732
39733 @menu
39734 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39735 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39736 @end menu
39737
39738 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39739 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39740 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39741
39742 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39743 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39744 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39745 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39746 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39747 most-significant -- least-significant.
39748
39749 @table @r
39750
39751 @item MIPS32
39752 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39753 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39754 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39755
39756 @item MIPS64
39757 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39758 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39759 as @code{MIPS32}.
39760
39761 @end table
39762
39763 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39764 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39765 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39766
39767 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39768
39769 @table @r
39770
39771 @item 2
39772 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39773
39774 @item 3
39775 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39776
39777 @item 4
39778 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39779
39780 @item 5
39781 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39782
39783 @end table
39784
39785 @node Tracepoint Packets
39786 @section Tracepoint Packets
39787 @cindex tracepoint packets
39788 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39789
39790 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39791 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39792
39793 @table @samp
39794
39795 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39796 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39797 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39798 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39799 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39800 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39801 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39802 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39803 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39804 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39805 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39806 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39807 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39808 actions.
39809
39810 Replies:
39811 @table @samp
39812 @item OK
39813 The packet was understood and carried out.
39814 @item qRelocInsn
39815 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39816 @item @w{}
39817 The packet was not recognized.
39818 @end table
39819
39820 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39821 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39822 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39823 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39824 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39825 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39826 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39827
39828 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39829 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39830 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39831 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39832 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39833 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39834 tracepoint actions.
39835
39836 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39837 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39838 following forms:
39839
39840 @table @samp
39841
39842 @item R @var{mask}
39843 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39844 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39845 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39846 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39847 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39848
39849 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39850 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39851 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39852 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39853 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39854 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39855 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39856
39857 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39858 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39859 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39860 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39861 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39862 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39863 packet).
39864
39865 @end table
39866
39867 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39868 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39869 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39870 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39871 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39872 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39873 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39874 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39875
39876 Replies:
39877 @table @samp
39878 @item OK
39879 The packet was understood and carried out.
39880 @item qRelocInsn
39881 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39882 @item @w{}
39883 The packet was not recognized.
39884 @end table
39885
39886 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39887 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39888 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39889 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39890 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39891 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39892 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39893 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39894
39895 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39896 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39897 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39898 fit in a single packet.
39899 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39900 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39901
39902 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39903 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39904 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39905 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39906
39907 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39908 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39909 query packets.
39910
39911 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39912 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39913 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39914 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39915 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39916 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39917 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39918 be found.
39919
39920 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39921 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39922 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39923 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39924 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39925 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39926 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39927 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39928 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39929 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39930 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39931 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39932 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39933 variable.
39934
39935 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39936 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39937 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39938 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39939 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39940
39941 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39942 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39943 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39944 one of the following forms:
39945
39946 @table @samp
39947 @item F @var{f}
39948 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39949 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39950 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39951
39952 @item T @var{t}
39953 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39954 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39955
39956 @end table
39957
39958 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39959 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39960 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39961 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39962
39963 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39964 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39965 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39966 is a hexadecimal number.
39967
39968 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39969 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39970 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39971 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39972 numbers.
39973
39974 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39975 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39976 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39977
39978 @item qTMinFTPILen
39979 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39980 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39981 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39982 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39983 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39984 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39985 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39986 arrange for that.
39987
39988 Replies:
39989
39990 @table @samp
39991 @item 0
39992 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39993 @item @var{length}
39994 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39995 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39996 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39997 regardless of size.
39998 @item E
39999 An error has occurred.
40000 @item @w{}
40001 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40002 @end table
40003
40004 @item QTStart
40005 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40006 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40007 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40008 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40009 instruction reply packet}).
40010
40011 @item QTStop
40012 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40013 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40014
40015 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40016 @anchor{QTEnable}
40017 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40018 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40019 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40020 of data from it will resume.
40021
40022 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40023 @anchor{QTDisable}
40024 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40025 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40026 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40027 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40028
40029 @item QTinit
40030 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40031 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40032
40033 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40034 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40035 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40036 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40037 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40038
40039 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40040 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40041 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40042 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40043
40044 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40045 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40046 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40047 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40048 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40049 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40050
40051 @item qTStatus
40052 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40053 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40054
40055 The reply has the form:
40056
40057 @table @samp
40058
40059 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40060 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40061 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40062 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40063
40064 @end table
40065
40066 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40067 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40068
40069 @table @samp
40070
40071 @item tnotrun:0
40072 No trace has been run yet.
40073
40074 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40075 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40076 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40077 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40078 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40079
40080 @item tfull:0
40081 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40082
40083 @item tdisconnected:0
40084 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40085
40086 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40087 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40088
40089 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40090 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40091 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40092 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40093 is hex encoded.
40094
40095 @item tunknown:0
40096 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40097
40098 @end table
40099
40100 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40101 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40102 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40103 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40104 trace.
40105
40106 @table @samp
40107
40108 @item tframes:@var{n}
40109 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40110
40111 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40112 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40113 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40114
40115 @item tsize:@var{n}
40116 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40117
40118 @item tfree:@var{n}
40119 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40120
40121 @item circular:@var{n}
40122 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40123 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40124 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40125 and may fill up.
40126
40127 @item disconn:@var{n}
40128 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40129 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40130 that the trace run will stop.
40131
40132 @end table
40133
40134 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40135 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40136 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40137 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40138 address @var{addr}.
40139
40140 Replies:
40141 @table @samp
40142 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40143 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40144 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40145 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40146 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40147
40148 @end table
40149
40150 @item qTV:@var{var}
40151 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40152 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40153 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40154
40155 Replies:
40156 @table @samp
40157 @item V@var{value}
40158 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40159 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40160 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40161 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40162 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40163 program is running.
40164
40165 @item U
40166 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40167 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40168 was not collected.
40169 @end table
40170
40171 @item qTfP
40172 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40173 @itemx qTsP
40174 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40175 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40176 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40177 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40178 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40179 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40180
40181 @item qTfV
40182 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40183 @itemx qTsV
40184 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40185 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40186 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40187 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40188 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40189 trace state variables.
40190
40191 @item qTfSTM
40192 @itemx qTsSTM
40193 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40194 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40195 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40196 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40197 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40198 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40199 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40200 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40201
40202 Reply:
40203 @table @samp
40204 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40205 A single marker
40206 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40207 a comma-separated list of markers
40208 @item l
40209 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40210 @item E @var{nn}
40211 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40212 @item @w{}
40213 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40214 stub.
40215 @end table
40216
40217 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40218 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40219
40220 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40221 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40222 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40223 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40224 @dfn{last}).
40225
40226 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40227 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40228 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40229 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40230 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40231 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40232 tracepoint markers.
40233
40234 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40235 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40236 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40237 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40238 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40239 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40240
40241 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40242 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40243 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40244 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40245 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40246 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40247 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40248 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40249 available.
40250
40251 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40252 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40253 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40254
40255 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40256 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40257 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40258 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40259 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40260 use whatever size it prefers.
40261
40262 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40263 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40264 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40265 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40266 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40267
40268 @end table
40269
40270 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40271 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40272 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40273 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40274 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40275 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40276 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40277 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40278 it had executed in the original location.
40279
40280 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40281 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40282 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40283 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40284 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40285 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40286 format of the request is:
40287
40288 @table @samp
40289 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40290
40291 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40292 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40293 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40294 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40295 memory starting at @var{to}.
40296 @end table
40297
40298 Replies:
40299 @table @samp
40300 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40301 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40302 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40303 @item E @var{NN}
40304 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40305 relocating the instruction.
40306 @end table
40307
40308 @node Host I/O Packets
40309 @section Host I/O Packets
40310 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40311 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40312
40313 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40314 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40315 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40316 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40317 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40318 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40319 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40320 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40321 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40322 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40323
40324 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40325 its arguments. They have this format:
40326
40327 @table @samp
40328
40329 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40330 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40331 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40332 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40333 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40334 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40335 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40336 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40337 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40338
40339 @end table
40340
40341 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40342
40343 @table @samp
40344
40345 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40346 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40347 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40348 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40349 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40350 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40351 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40352 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40353 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40354 @var{attachment}.
40355
40356 @item @w{}
40357 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40358
40359 @end table
40360
40361 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40362
40363 @table @samp
40364 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40365 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40366 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40367 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40368 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40369 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40370 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40371
40372 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40373 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40374 -1 if an error occurs.
40375
40376 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40377 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40378 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40379 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40380 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40381 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40382 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40383 @var{count} was zero.
40384
40385 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40386 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40387 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40388 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40389 some characters were escaped.
40390
40391 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40392 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40393 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40394 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40395 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40396 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40397 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40398 error occurred.
40399
40400 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40401 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40402 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40403 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40404 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40405 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40406
40407 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40408 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40409 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40410
40411 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40412 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40413 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40414
40415 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40416 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40417 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40418 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40419 some characters were escaped.
40420
40421 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40422 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40423 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40424 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40425 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40426 inferior(s).
40427
40428 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40429 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40430 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40431 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40432 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40433 operation.
40434
40435 @end table
40436
40437 @node Interrupts
40438 @section Interrupts
40439 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40440 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40441
40442 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40443 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40444 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40445 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40446
40447 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40448 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40449 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40450 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40451 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40452
40453 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40454 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40455 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40456 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40457 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40458 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40459 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40460 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40461
40462 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40463 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40464 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40465
40466 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40467 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40468 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40469 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40470 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40471 @code{0x03}.
40472
40473 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40474 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40475 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40476 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40477 currently-executing threads and processes.
40478 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40479 running program, it should send one of the stop
40480 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40481 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40482 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40483 Interrupts received while the
40484 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40485 it is resumed next time.
40486
40487 @node Notification Packets
40488 @section Notification Packets
40489 @cindex notification packets
40490 @cindex packets, notification
40491
40492 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40493 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40494 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40495 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40496 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40497 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40498 is not a problem.
40499
40500 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40501 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40502 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40503 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40504 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40505 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40506 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40507
40508 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40509 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40510
40511 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40512 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40513 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40514 not they understand it.
40515
40516 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40517 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40518 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40519 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40520 recipients.
40521
40522 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40523 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40524 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40525 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40526 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40527
40528 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40529 @table @samp
40530 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40531 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40532 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40533 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40534 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40535 @item @var{ack}
40536 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40537 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40538 @end table
40539
40540 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40541 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40542
40543 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40544 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40545 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40546 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40547 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40548 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40549 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40550 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40551 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40552 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40553
40554 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40555 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40556 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40557 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40558 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40559 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40560
40561 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40562 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40563 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40564 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40565 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40566
40567 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40568 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40569 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40570 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40571 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40572 normally.
40573
40574 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40575 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40576 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40577 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40578 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40579 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40580 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40581 the process shall be repeated.
40582
40583 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40584 following example:
40585 @smallexample
40586 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40587 @code{...}
40588 -> @code{vStopped}
40589 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40590 -> @code{vStopped}
40591 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40592 -> @code{vStopped}
40593 <- @code{OK}
40594 @end smallexample
40595
40596 The following notifications are defined:
40597 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40598
40599 @item Notification
40600 @tab Ack
40601 @tab Event
40602 @tab Description
40603
40604 @item Stop
40605 @tab vStopped
40606 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40607 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40608 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40609 @value{GDBN}.
40610 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40611
40612 @end multitable
40613
40614 @node Remote Non-Stop
40615 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40616
40617 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40618 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40619 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40620 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40621
40622 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40623 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40624 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40625 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40626 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40627 probe the target state after a mode change.
40628
40629 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40630 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40631 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40632 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40633 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40634 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40635 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40636 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40637 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40638 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40639 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40640
40641 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40642 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40643 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40644 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40645 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40646 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40647 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40648 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40649 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40650 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40651 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40652 @samp{OK}.
40653
40654 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40655 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40656 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40657 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40658 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40659 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40660 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40661 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40662 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40663 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40664 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40665 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40666 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40667
40668 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40669 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40670
40671 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40672 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40673 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40674 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40675 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40676 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40677 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40678
40679 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40680 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40681 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40682 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40683 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40684
40685 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40686 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40687 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40688 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40689
40690 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40691 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40692 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40693 @pxref{qSupported}.
40694 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40695 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40696 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40697 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40698 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40699 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40700 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40701
40702 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40703 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40704 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40705 connection.
40706 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40707 new connection is established,
40708 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40709 for the current connection, once disabled.
40710
40711 @node Examples
40712 @section Examples
40713
40714 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40715 does not get any direct output:
40716
40717 @smallexample
40718 -> @code{R00}
40719 <- @code{+}
40720 @emph{target restarts}
40721 -> @code{?}
40722 <- @code{+}
40723 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40724 -> @code{+}
40725 @end smallexample
40726
40727 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40728
40729 @smallexample
40730 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40731 <- @code{+}
40732 -> @code{s}
40733 <- @code{+}
40734 @emph{time passes}
40735 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40736 -> @code{+}
40737 -> @code{g}
40738 <- @code{+}
40739 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40740 -> @code{+}
40741 @end smallexample
40742
40743 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40744 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40745 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40746
40747 @menu
40748 * File-I/O Overview::
40749 * Protocol Basics::
40750 * The F Request Packet::
40751 * The F Reply Packet::
40752 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40753 * Console I/O::
40754 * List of Supported Calls::
40755 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40756 * Constants::
40757 * File-I/O Examples::
40758 @end menu
40759
40760 @node File-I/O Overview
40761 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40762 @cindex file-i/o overview
40763
40764 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40765 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40766 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40767 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40768 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40769 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40770
40771 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40772 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40773 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40774 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40775 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40776
40777 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40778 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40779 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40780 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40781 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40782 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40783 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40784
40785 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40786 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40787 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40788 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40789 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40790
40791 @smallexample
40792 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40793 <- target requests 'system call X'
40794 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40795 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40796 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40797 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40798 @end smallexample
40799
40800 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40801 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40802 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40803 system are not supported by this protocol.
40804
40805 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40806
40807 @node Protocol Basics
40808 @subsection Protocol Basics
40809 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40810
40811 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40812 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40813 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40814 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40815 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40816 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40817 to call the appropriate host system call:
40818
40819 @itemize @bullet
40820 @item
40821 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40822
40823 @item
40824 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40825 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40826 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40827 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40828
40829 @end itemize
40830
40831 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40832
40833 @itemize @bullet
40834 @item
40835 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40836 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40837 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40838 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40839 packet.
40840
40841 @item
40842 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40843 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40844
40845 @item
40846 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40847
40848 @item
40849 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40850
40851 @item
40852 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40853 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40854 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40855 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40856 packet.
40857
40858 @end itemize
40859
40860 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40861 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40862
40863 @itemize @bullet
40864 @item
40865 Return value.
40866
40867 @item
40868 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40869
40870 @item
40871 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40872
40873 @end itemize
40874
40875 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40876 the latest continue or step action.
40877
40878 @node The F Request Packet
40879 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40880 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40881 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40882
40883 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40884
40885 @table @samp
40886 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40887
40888 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40889 This is just the name of the function.
40890
40891 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40892 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40893 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40894 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40895 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40896 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40897 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40898
40899 @end table
40900
40901
40902
40903 @node The F Reply Packet
40904 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40905 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40906 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40907
40908 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40909
40910 @table @samp
40911
40912 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40913
40914 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40915
40916 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40917 representation.
40918 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40919
40920 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40921 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40922 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40923
40924 @smallexample
40925 F0,0,C
40926 @end smallexample
40927
40928 @noindent
40929 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40930
40931 @smallexample
40932 F-1,4,C
40933 @end smallexample
40934
40935 @noindent
40936 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40937
40938 @end table
40939
40940
40941 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40942 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40943 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40944
40945 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40946 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40947 the target should behave as if it had
40948 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40949 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40950 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40951 packet.
40952
40953 It's important for the target to know in which
40954 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40955
40956 @itemize @bullet
40957 @item
40958 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40959
40960 @item
40961 The system call on the host has been finished.
40962
40963 @end itemize
40964
40965 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40966 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40967 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40968 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40969 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40970 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40971
40972 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40973 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40974 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40975 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40976 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40977 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40978 or the full action has been completed.
40979
40980 @node Console I/O
40981 @subsection Console I/O
40982 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40983
40984 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40985 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40986 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40987 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40988 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40989 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40990 conditions is met:
40991
40992 @itemize @bullet
40993 @item
40994 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40995 @code{read}
40996 system call is treated as finished.
40997
40998 @item
40999 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41000 newline.
41001
41002 @item
41003 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41004 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41005
41006 @end itemize
41007
41008 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41009 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41010 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41011 is stopped at the user's request.
41012
41013
41014 @node List of Supported Calls
41015 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41016 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41017
41018 @menu
41019 * open::
41020 * close::
41021 * read::
41022 * write::
41023 * lseek::
41024 * rename::
41025 * unlink::
41026 * stat/fstat::
41027 * gettimeofday::
41028 * isatty::
41029 * system::
41030 @end menu
41031
41032 @node open
41033 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41034 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41035
41036 @table @asis
41037 @item Synopsis:
41038 @smallexample
41039 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41040 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41041 @end smallexample
41042
41043 @item Request:
41044 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41045
41046 @noindent
41047 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41048
41049 @table @code
41050 @item O_CREAT
41051 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41052 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41053 are concerned.
41054
41055 @item O_EXCL
41056 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41057 an error and open() fails.
41058
41059 @item O_TRUNC
41060 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41061 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41062 truncated to zero length.
41063
41064 @item O_APPEND
41065 The file is opened in append mode.
41066
41067 @item O_RDONLY
41068 The file is opened for reading only.
41069
41070 @item O_WRONLY
41071 The file is opened for writing only.
41072
41073 @item O_RDWR
41074 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41075 @end table
41076
41077 @noindent
41078 Other bits are silently ignored.
41079
41080
41081 @noindent
41082 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41083
41084 @table @code
41085 @item S_IRUSR
41086 User has read permission.
41087
41088 @item S_IWUSR
41089 User has write permission.
41090
41091 @item S_IRGRP
41092 Group has read permission.
41093
41094 @item S_IWGRP
41095 Group has write permission.
41096
41097 @item S_IROTH
41098 Others have read permission.
41099
41100 @item S_IWOTH
41101 Others have write permission.
41102 @end table
41103
41104 @noindent
41105 Other bits are silently ignored.
41106
41107
41108 @item Return value:
41109 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41110 occurred.
41111
41112 @item Errors:
41113
41114 @table @code
41115 @item EEXIST
41116 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41117
41118 @item EISDIR
41119 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41120
41121 @item EACCES
41122 The requested access is not allowed.
41123
41124 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41125 @var{pathname} was too long.
41126
41127 @item ENOENT
41128 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41129
41130 @item ENODEV
41131 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41132
41133 @item EROFS
41134 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41135 write access was requested.
41136
41137 @item EFAULT
41138 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41139
41140 @item ENOSPC
41141 No space on device to create the file.
41142
41143 @item EMFILE
41144 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41145
41146 @item ENFILE
41147 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41148 has been reached.
41149
41150 @item EINTR
41151 The call was interrupted by the user.
41152 @end table
41153
41154 @end table
41155
41156 @node close
41157 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41158 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41159
41160 @table @asis
41161 @item Synopsis:
41162 @smallexample
41163 int close(int fd);
41164 @end smallexample
41165
41166 @item Request:
41167 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41168
41169 @item Return value:
41170 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41171
41172 @item Errors:
41173
41174 @table @code
41175 @item EBADF
41176 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41177
41178 @item EINTR
41179 The call was interrupted by the user.
41180 @end table
41181
41182 @end table
41183
41184 @node read
41185 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41186 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41187
41188 @table @asis
41189 @item Synopsis:
41190 @smallexample
41191 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41192 @end smallexample
41193
41194 @item Request:
41195 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41196
41197 @item Return value:
41198 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41199 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41200 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41201
41202 @item Errors:
41203
41204 @table @code
41205 @item EBADF
41206 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41207 reading.
41208
41209 @item EFAULT
41210 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41211
41212 @item EINTR
41213 The call was interrupted by the user.
41214 @end table
41215
41216 @end table
41217
41218 @node write
41219 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41220 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41221
41222 @table @asis
41223 @item Synopsis:
41224 @smallexample
41225 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41226 @end smallexample
41227
41228 @item Request:
41229 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41230
41231 @item Return value:
41232 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41233 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41234 is returned.
41235
41236 @item Errors:
41237
41238 @table @code
41239 @item EBADF
41240 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41241 writing.
41242
41243 @item EFAULT
41244 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41245
41246 @item EFBIG
41247 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41248 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41249
41250 @item ENOSPC
41251 No space on device to write the data.
41252
41253 @item EINTR
41254 The call was interrupted by the user.
41255 @end table
41256
41257 @end table
41258
41259 @node lseek
41260 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41261 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41262
41263 @table @asis
41264 @item Synopsis:
41265 @smallexample
41266 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41267 @end smallexample
41268
41269 @item Request:
41270 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41271
41272 @var{flag} is one of:
41273
41274 @table @code
41275 @item SEEK_SET
41276 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41277
41278 @item SEEK_CUR
41279 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41280 bytes.
41281
41282 @item SEEK_END
41283 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41284 bytes.
41285 @end table
41286
41287 @item Return value:
41288 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41289 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41290 value of -1 is returned.
41291
41292 @item Errors:
41293
41294 @table @code
41295 @item EBADF
41296 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41297
41298 @item ESPIPE
41299 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41300
41301 @item EINVAL
41302 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41303
41304 @item EINTR
41305 The call was interrupted by the user.
41306 @end table
41307
41308 @end table
41309
41310 @node rename
41311 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41312 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41313
41314 @table @asis
41315 @item Synopsis:
41316 @smallexample
41317 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41318 @end smallexample
41319
41320 @item Request:
41321 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41322
41323 @item Return value:
41324 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41325
41326 @item Errors:
41327
41328 @table @code
41329 @item EISDIR
41330 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41331 directory.
41332
41333 @item EEXIST
41334 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41335
41336 @item EBUSY
41337 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41338 process.
41339
41340 @item EINVAL
41341 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41342 of itself.
41343
41344 @item ENOTDIR
41345 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41346 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41347 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41348
41349 @item EFAULT
41350 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41351
41352 @item EACCES
41353 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41354
41355 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41356
41357 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41358
41359 @item ENOENT
41360 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41361
41362 @item EROFS
41363 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41364
41365 @item ENOSPC
41366 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41367 directory entry.
41368
41369 @item EINTR
41370 The call was interrupted by the user.
41371 @end table
41372
41373 @end table
41374
41375 @node unlink
41376 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41377 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41378
41379 @table @asis
41380 @item Synopsis:
41381 @smallexample
41382 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41383 @end smallexample
41384
41385 @item Request:
41386 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41387
41388 @item Return value:
41389 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41390
41391 @item Errors:
41392
41393 @table @code
41394 @item EACCES
41395 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41396
41397 @item EPERM
41398 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41399
41400 @item EBUSY
41401 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41402 being used by another process.
41403
41404 @item EFAULT
41405 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41406
41407 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41408 @var{pathname} was too long.
41409
41410 @item ENOENT
41411 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41412
41413 @item ENOTDIR
41414 A component of the path is not a directory.
41415
41416 @item EROFS
41417 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41418
41419 @item EINTR
41420 The call was interrupted by the user.
41421 @end table
41422
41423 @end table
41424
41425 @node stat/fstat
41426 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41427 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41428 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41429
41430 @table @asis
41431 @item Synopsis:
41432 @smallexample
41433 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41434 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41435 @end smallexample
41436
41437 @item Request:
41438 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41439 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41440
41441 @item Return value:
41442 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41443
41444 @item Errors:
41445
41446 @table @code
41447 @item EBADF
41448 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41449
41450 @item ENOENT
41451 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41452 path is an empty string.
41453
41454 @item ENOTDIR
41455 A component of the path is not a directory.
41456
41457 @item EFAULT
41458 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41459
41460 @item EACCES
41461 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41462
41463 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41464 @var{pathname} was too long.
41465
41466 @item EINTR
41467 The call was interrupted by the user.
41468 @end table
41469
41470 @end table
41471
41472 @node gettimeofday
41473 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41474 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41475
41476 @table @asis
41477 @item Synopsis:
41478 @smallexample
41479 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41480 @end smallexample
41481
41482 @item Request:
41483 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41484
41485 @item Return value:
41486 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41487
41488 @item Errors:
41489
41490 @table @code
41491 @item EINVAL
41492 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41493
41494 @item EFAULT
41495 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41496 @end table
41497
41498 @end table
41499
41500 @node isatty
41501 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41502 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41503
41504 @table @asis
41505 @item Synopsis:
41506 @smallexample
41507 int isatty(int fd);
41508 @end smallexample
41509
41510 @item Request:
41511 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41512
41513 @item Return value:
41514 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41515
41516 @item Errors:
41517
41518 @table @code
41519 @item EINTR
41520 The call was interrupted by the user.
41521 @end table
41522
41523 @end table
41524
41525 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41526 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41527 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41528 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41529 needed.
41530
41531
41532 @node system
41533 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41534 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41535
41536 @table @asis
41537 @item Synopsis:
41538 @smallexample
41539 int system(const char *command);
41540 @end smallexample
41541
41542 @item Request:
41543 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41544
41545 @item Return value:
41546 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41547 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41548 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41549 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41550 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41551 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41552 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41553
41554 @item Errors:
41555
41556 @table @code
41557 @item EINTR
41558 The call was interrupted by the user.
41559 @end table
41560
41561 @end table
41562
41563 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41564 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41565 the host is simplified before it's returned
41566 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41567 is discarded, and the return value consists
41568 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41569
41570 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41571 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41572 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41573
41574 @table @code
41575 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41576 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41577 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41578 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41579
41580 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41581 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41582 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41583 protocol.
41584 @end table
41585
41586 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41587 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41588 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41589
41590 @menu
41591 * Integral Datatypes::
41592 * Pointer Values::
41593 * Memory Transfer::
41594 * struct stat::
41595 * struct timeval::
41596 @end menu
41597
41598 @node Integral Datatypes
41599 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41600 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41601
41602 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41603 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41604 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41605
41606 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41607 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41608
41609 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41610
41611 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41612 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41613
41614 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41615
41616 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41617 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41618 byte order.
41619
41620 @node Pointer Values
41621 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41622 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41623
41624 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41625 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41626 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41627 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41628
41629 @smallexample
41630 @code{1aaf/12}
41631 @end smallexample
41632
41633 @noindent
41634 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41635 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41636 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41637 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41638
41639 @smallexample
41640 @code{123456/d}
41641 @end smallexample
41642
41643 @node Memory Transfer
41644 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41645 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41646
41647 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41648 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41649 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41650 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41651 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41652 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41653 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41654
41655
41656 @node struct stat
41657 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41658 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41659
41660 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41661 is defined as follows:
41662
41663 @smallexample
41664 struct stat @{
41665 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41666 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41667 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41668 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41669 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41670 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41671 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41672 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41673 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41674 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41675 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41676 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41677 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41678 @};
41679 @end smallexample
41680
41681 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41682 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41683 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41684
41685 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41686 range of values.
41687
41688 @table @code
41689
41690 @item st_dev
41691 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41692
41693 @item st_ino
41694 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41695
41696 @item st_mode
41697 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41698 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41699
41700 @item st_uid
41701 @itemx st_gid
41702 @itemx st_rdev
41703 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41704
41705 @item st_atime
41706 @itemx st_mtime
41707 @itemx st_ctime
41708 These values have a host and file system dependent
41709 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41710 support exact timing values.
41711 @end table
41712
41713 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41714 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41715 continuing.
41716
41717 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41718 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41719 get truncated on the target.
41720
41721 @node struct timeval
41722 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41723 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41724
41725 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41726 is defined as follows:
41727
41728 @smallexample
41729 struct timeval @{
41730 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41731 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41732 @};
41733 @end smallexample
41734
41735 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41736 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41737 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41738
41739 @node Constants
41740 @subsection Constants
41741 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41742
41743 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41744 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41745 values before and after the call as needed.
41746
41747 @menu
41748 * Open Flags::
41749 * mode_t Values::
41750 * Errno Values::
41751 * Lseek Flags::
41752 * Limits::
41753 @end menu
41754
41755 @node Open Flags
41756 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41757 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41758
41759 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41760
41761 @smallexample
41762 O_RDONLY 0x0
41763 O_WRONLY 0x1
41764 O_RDWR 0x2
41765 O_APPEND 0x8
41766 O_CREAT 0x200
41767 O_TRUNC 0x400
41768 O_EXCL 0x800
41769 @end smallexample
41770
41771 @node mode_t Values
41772 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41773 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41774
41775 All values are given in octal representation.
41776
41777 @smallexample
41778 S_IFREG 0100000
41779 S_IFDIR 040000
41780 S_IRUSR 0400
41781 S_IWUSR 0200
41782 S_IXUSR 0100
41783 S_IRGRP 040
41784 S_IWGRP 020
41785 S_IXGRP 010
41786 S_IROTH 04
41787 S_IWOTH 02
41788 S_IXOTH 01
41789 @end smallexample
41790
41791 @node Errno Values
41792 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41793 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41794
41795 All values are given in decimal representation.
41796
41797 @smallexample
41798 EPERM 1
41799 ENOENT 2
41800 EINTR 4
41801 EBADF 9
41802 EACCES 13
41803 EFAULT 14
41804 EBUSY 16
41805 EEXIST 17
41806 ENODEV 19
41807 ENOTDIR 20
41808 EISDIR 21
41809 EINVAL 22
41810 ENFILE 23
41811 EMFILE 24
41812 EFBIG 27
41813 ENOSPC 28
41814 ESPIPE 29
41815 EROFS 30
41816 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41817 EUNKNOWN 9999
41818 @end smallexample
41819
41820 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41821 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41822
41823 @node Lseek Flags
41824 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41825 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41826
41827 @smallexample
41828 SEEK_SET 0
41829 SEEK_CUR 1
41830 SEEK_END 2
41831 @end smallexample
41832
41833 @node Limits
41834 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41835 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41836
41837 All values are given in decimal representation.
41838
41839 @smallexample
41840 INT_MIN -2147483648
41841 INT_MAX 2147483647
41842 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41843 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41844 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41845 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41846 @end smallexample
41847
41848 @node File-I/O Examples
41849 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41850 @cindex file-i/o examples
41851
41852 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41853 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41854
41855 @smallexample
41856 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41857 @emph{request memory read from target}
41858 -> @code{m1234,6}
41859 <- XXXXXX
41860 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41861 -> @code{F6}
41862 @end smallexample
41863
41864 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41865 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41866
41867 @smallexample
41868 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41869 @emph{request memory write to target}
41870 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41871 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41872 -> @code{F6}
41873 @end smallexample
41874
41875 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41876 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41877
41878 @smallexample
41879 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41880 -> @code{F-1,9}
41881 @end smallexample
41882
41883 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41884 host is called:
41885
41886 @smallexample
41887 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41888 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41889 <- @code{T02}
41890 @end smallexample
41891
41892 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41893 host is called:
41894
41895 @smallexample
41896 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41897 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41898 <- @code{T02}
41899 @end smallexample
41900
41901 @node Library List Format
41902 @section Library List Format
41903 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41904
41905 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41906 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41907 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41908 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41909 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41910 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41911 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41912 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41913 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41914 are loaded.
41915
41916 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41917 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41918 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41919 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41920
41921 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41922 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41923 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41924 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41925 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41926 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41927
41928 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41929 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41930
41931 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41932 offset, looks like this:
41933
41934 @smallexample
41935 <library-list>
41936 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41937 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41938 </library>
41939 </library-list>
41940 @end smallexample
41941
41942 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41943 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41944
41945 @smallexample
41946 <library-list>
41947 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41948 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41949 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41950 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41951 </library>
41952 </library-list>
41953 @end smallexample
41954
41955 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41956
41957 @smallexample
41958 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41959 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41960 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41961 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41962 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41963 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41964 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41965 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41966 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41967 @end smallexample
41968
41969 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41970 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41971 section for each library.
41972
41973 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41974 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41975 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41976
41977 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41978 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41979 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41980 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41981
41982 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41983 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41984 target, the following parameters are reported:
41985
41986 @itemize @minus
41987 @item
41988 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41989 @code{struct link_map}.
41990 @item
41991 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41992 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41993 @item
41994 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41995 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41996 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41997 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41998 @item
41999 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42000 @end itemize
42001
42002 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42003 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42004 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42005
42006 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42007 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42008
42009 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42010 looks like this:
42011
42012 @smallexample
42013 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42014 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42015 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42016 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42017 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42018 </library-list-svr>
42019 @end smallexample
42020
42021 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42022
42023 @smallexample
42024 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42025 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42026 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42027 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42028 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42029 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42030 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42031 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42032 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42033 @end smallexample
42034
42035 @node Memory Map Format
42036 @section Memory Map Format
42037 @cindex memory map format
42038
42039 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42040 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42041 memory map.
42042
42043 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42044 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42045 lists memory regions.
42046
42047 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42048 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42049
42050 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42051
42052 @smallexample
42053 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42054 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42055 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42056 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42057 <memory-map>
42058 region...
42059 </memory-map>
42060 @end smallexample
42061
42062 Each region can be either:
42063
42064 @itemize
42065
42066 @item
42067 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42068 bytes from there:
42069
42070 @smallexample
42071 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42072 @end smallexample
42073
42074
42075 @item
42076 A region of read-only memory:
42077
42078 @smallexample
42079 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42080 @end smallexample
42081
42082
42083 @item
42084 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42085 bytes in length:
42086
42087 @smallexample
42088 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42089 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42090 </memory>
42091 @end smallexample
42092
42093 @end itemize
42094
42095 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42096 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42097 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42098
42099 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42100
42101 @smallexample
42102 <!-- ................................................... -->
42103 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42104 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42105 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42106 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42107 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42108 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42109 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42110 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42111 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42112 and its type, or device. -->
42113 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42114 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42115 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42116 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42117 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42118 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42119 @end smallexample
42120
42121 @node Thread List Format
42122 @section Thread List Format
42123 @cindex thread list format
42124
42125 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42126 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42127 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42128 the following structure:
42129
42130 @smallexample
42131 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42132 <threads>
42133 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42134 ... description ...
42135 </thread>
42136 </threads>
42137 @end smallexample
42138
42139 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42140 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42141 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42142 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42143 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42144 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42145 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42146 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42147
42148
42149 @node Traceframe Info Format
42150 @section Traceframe Info Format
42151 @cindex traceframe info format
42152
42153 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42154 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42155 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42156 collected in a traceframe.
42157
42158 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42159 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42160
42161 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42162 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42163
42164 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42165
42166 @smallexample
42167 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42168 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42169 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42170 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42171 <traceframe-info>
42172 block...
42173 </traceframe-info>
42174 @end smallexample
42175
42176 Each traceframe block can be either:
42177
42178 @itemize
42179
42180 @item
42181 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42182 @var{length} bytes from there:
42183
42184 @smallexample
42185 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42186 @end smallexample
42187
42188 @item
42189 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42190 collected:
42191
42192 @smallexample
42193 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42194 @end smallexample
42195
42196 @end itemize
42197
42198 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42199
42200 @smallexample
42201 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42202 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42203
42204 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42205 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42206 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42207 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42208 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42209 @end smallexample
42210
42211 @node Branch Trace Format
42212 @section Branch Trace Format
42213 @cindex branch trace format
42214
42215 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42216 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42217 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42218 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42219
42220 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42221 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42222
42223 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42224 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42225
42226 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42227
42228 @smallexample
42229 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42230 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42231 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42232 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42233 <btrace>
42234 block...
42235 </btrace>
42236 @end smallexample
42237
42238 @itemize
42239
42240 @item
42241 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42242 and ending at @var{end}:
42243
42244 @smallexample
42245 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42246 @end smallexample
42247
42248 @end itemize
42249
42250 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42251
42252 @smallexample
42253 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42254 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42255
42256 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42257 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42258 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42259
42260 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42261
42262 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42263
42264 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42265 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42266 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42267 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42268 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42269
42270 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42271 @end smallexample
42272
42273 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42274 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42275 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42276
42277 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42278 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42279 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42280
42281 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42282 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42283
42284 @table @code
42285 @item bts
42286 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42287 @table @code
42288 @item size
42289 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42290 @end table
42291 @item pt
42292 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42293 PT}) format.
42294 @table @code
42295 @item size
42296 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42297 @end table
42298 @end table
42299
42300 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42301 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42302
42303 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42304
42305 @smallexample
42306 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42307 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42308
42309 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42310 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42311
42312 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42313 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42314 @end smallexample
42315
42316 @include agentexpr.texi
42317
42318 @node Target Descriptions
42319 @appendix Target Descriptions
42320 @cindex target descriptions
42321
42322 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42323 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42324 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42325 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42326 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42327 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42328 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42329
42330 @itemize @bullet
42331 @item
42332 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42333 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42334 @item
42335 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42336 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42337 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42338 @item
42339 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42340 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42341 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42342 @end itemize
42343
42344 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42345 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42346 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42347 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42348 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42349
42350 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42351 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42352
42353 @menu
42354 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42355 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42356 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42357 descriptions.
42358 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42359 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42360 @end menu
42361
42362 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42363 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42364
42365 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42366 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42367 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42368 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42369 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42370 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42371 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42372 Format}.
42373
42374 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42375 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42376 specify a file are:
42377
42378 @table @code
42379 @cindex set tdesc filename
42380 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42381 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42382
42383 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42384 @item unset tdesc filename
42385 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42386 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42387
42388 @cindex show tdesc filename
42389 @item show tdesc filename
42390 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42391 @end table
42392
42393
42394 @node Target Description Format
42395 @section Target Description Format
42396 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42397
42398 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42399 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42400 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42401 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42402 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42403 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42404 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42405
42406 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42407 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42408 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42409 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42410 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42411
42412 Here is a simple target description:
42413
42414 @smallexample
42415 <target version="1.0">
42416 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42417 </target>
42418 @end smallexample
42419
42420 @noindent
42421 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42422 the x86-64 architecture.
42423
42424 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42425 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42426 are explained further below.
42427
42428 @smallexample
42429 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42430 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42431 <target version="1.0">
42432 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42433 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42434 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42435 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42436 </target>
42437 @end smallexample
42438
42439 @noindent
42440 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42441 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42442 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42443 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42444 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42445 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42446 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42447 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42448 the version mismatch.
42449
42450 @subsection Inclusion
42451 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42452 @cindex XInclude
42453 @ifnotinfo
42454 @cindex <xi:include>
42455 @end ifnotinfo
42456
42457 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42458 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42459 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42460 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42461 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42462
42463 @smallexample
42464 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42465 @end smallexample
42466
42467 @noindent
42468 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42469 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42470 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42471 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42472 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42473 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42474 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42475 original description.
42476
42477 @subsection Architecture
42478 @cindex <architecture>
42479
42480 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42481
42482 @smallexample
42483 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42484 @end smallexample
42485
42486 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42487 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42488
42489 @subsection OS ABI
42490 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42491
42492 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42493 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42494
42495 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42496
42497 @smallexample
42498 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42499 @end smallexample
42500
42501 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42502 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42503
42504 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42505 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42506
42507 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42508 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42509
42510 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42511
42512 @smallexample
42513 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42514 @end smallexample
42515
42516 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42517 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42518
42519 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42520 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42521 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42522 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42523 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42524 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42525 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42526
42527 @smallexample
42528 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42529 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42530 @end smallexample
42531
42532 @subsection Features
42533 @cindex <feature>
42534
42535 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42536 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42537 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42538 has this form:
42539
42540 @smallexample
42541 <feature name="@var{name}">
42542 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42543 @var{reg}@dots{}
42544 </feature>
42545 @end smallexample
42546
42547 @noindent
42548 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42549 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42550 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42551 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42552
42553 @subsection Types
42554
42555 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42556 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42557 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42558 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42559 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42560 and enum types.
42561
42562 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42563 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42564 Types must be defined before they are used.
42565
42566 @cindex <vector>
42567 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42568 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42569 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42570 @var{count}:
42571
42572 @smallexample
42573 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42574 @end smallexample
42575
42576 @cindex <union>
42577 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42578 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42579 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42580 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42581
42582 @smallexample
42583 <union id="@var{id}">
42584 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42585 @dots{}
42586 </union>
42587 @end smallexample
42588
42589 @cindex <struct>
42590 @cindex <flags>
42591 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42592 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42593 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42594 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42595 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42596 specified.
42597
42598 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42599
42600 @smallexample
42601 <struct id="@var{id}">
42602 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42603 @dots{}
42604 </struct>
42605 @end smallexample
42606
42607 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42608 No implicit padding is added.
42609
42610 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42611
42612 @smallexample
42613 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42614 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42615 @dots{}
42616 </struct>
42617 @end smallexample
42618
42619 @smallexample
42620 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42621 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42622 @dots{}
42623 </flags>
42624 @end smallexample
42625
42626 The @var{name} value is required.
42627 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42628 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42629 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42630
42631 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42632 is optional.
42633 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42634 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42635
42636 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42637 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42638
42639 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42640
42641 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42642 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42643
42644 @itemize @bullet
42645 @item
42646 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42647 @item
42648 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42649 @end itemize
42650
42651 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42652 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42653
42654 @itemize @bullet
42655 @item
42656 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42657
42658 @smallexample
42659 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42660 $1 = 42
42661 @end smallexample
42662
42663 @end itemize
42664
42665 @subsection Registers
42666 @cindex <reg>
42667
42668 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42669
42670 @smallexample
42671 <reg name="@var{name}"
42672 bitsize="@var{size}"
42673 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42674 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42675 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42676 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42677 @end smallexample
42678
42679 @noindent
42680 The components are as follows:
42681
42682 @table @var
42683
42684 @item name
42685 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42686
42687 @item bitsize
42688 The register's size, in bits.
42689
42690 @item regnum
42691 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42692 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42693 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42694 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42695 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42696 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42697 in order of increasing register number.
42698
42699 @item save-restore
42700 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42701 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42702 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42703 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42704 ABI.
42705
42706 @item type
42707 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42708 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42709 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42710 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42711 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42712 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42713
42714 @item group
42715 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42716 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42717 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42718 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42719 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42720 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42721 @code{info registers}.
42722
42723 @end table
42724
42725 @node Predefined Target Types
42726 @section Predefined Target Types
42727 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42728
42729 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42730 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42731 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42732 types. The currently supported types are:
42733
42734 @table @code
42735
42736 @item bool
42737 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42738
42739 @item int8
42740 @itemx int16
42741 @itemx int24
42742 @itemx int32
42743 @itemx int64
42744 @itemx int128
42745 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42746
42747 @item uint8
42748 @itemx uint16
42749 @itemx uint24
42750 @itemx uint32
42751 @itemx uint64
42752 @itemx uint128
42753 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42754
42755 @item code_ptr
42756 @itemx data_ptr
42757 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42758 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42759 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42760 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42761 may be marked as data pointers.
42762
42763 @item ieee_single
42764 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42765
42766 @item ieee_double
42767 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42768
42769 @item arm_fpa_ext
42770 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42771
42772 @item i387_ext
42773 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42774
42775 @item i386_eflags
42776 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42777
42778 @item i386_mxcsr
42779 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42780
42781 @end table
42782
42783 @node Enum Target Types
42784 @section Enum Target Types
42785 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42786
42787 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42788 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42789
42790 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42791
42792 @smallexample
42793 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42794 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42795 @dots{}
42796 </enum>
42797 @end smallexample
42798
42799 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42800
42801 @smallexample
42802 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42803 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42804 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42805 </enum>
42806 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42807 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42808 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42809 </flags>
42810 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42811 @end smallexample
42812
42813 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42814 would be printed as:
42815
42816 @smallexample
42817 (gdb) info register flags
42818 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42819 @end smallexample
42820
42821 @node Standard Target Features
42822 @section Standard Target Features
42823 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42824
42825 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42826 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42827 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42828 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42829 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42830 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42831 can recognize them.
42832
42833 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42834 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42835 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42836 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42837 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42838 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42839 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42840 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42841
42842 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42843 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42844 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42845
42846 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42847 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42848 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42849 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42850
42851 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42852 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42853 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42854
42855 @menu
42856 * AArch64 Features::
42857 * ARC Features::
42858 * ARM Features::
42859 * i386 Features::
42860 * MicroBlaze Features::
42861 * MIPS Features::
42862 * M68K Features::
42863 * NDS32 Features::
42864 * Nios II Features::
42865 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42866 * PowerPC Features::
42867 * S/390 and System z Features::
42868 * Sparc Features::
42869 * TIC6x Features::
42870 @end menu
42871
42872
42873 @node AArch64 Features
42874 @subsection AArch64 Features
42875 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42876
42877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42878 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42879 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42880
42881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42882 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42883 and @samp{fpcr}.
42884
42885 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42886 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42887 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42888
42889 @node ARC Features
42890 @subsection ARC Features
42891 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42892
42893 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42894 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42895 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42896 that one of the core registers features is present.
42897 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42898
42899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42900 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42901 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42902 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42903 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42904 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42905 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42906
42907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42908 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42909 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42910 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42911 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42912 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42913
42914 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42915 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42916 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42917 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42918 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42919 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42920 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42921 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42922 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42923 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42924
42925 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42926 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42927
42928 @node ARM Features
42929 @subsection ARM Features
42930 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42931
42932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42933 ARM targets.
42934 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42935 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42936
42937 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42938 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42939 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42940 and @samp{xpsr}.
42941
42942 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42943 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42944
42945 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42946 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42947 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42948 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42949
42950 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42951 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42952 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42953 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42954 halves of the double-precision registers.
42955
42956 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42957 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42958 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42959 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42960 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42961 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42962
42963 @node i386 Features
42964 @subsection i386 Features
42965 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42966
42967 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42968 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42969
42970 @itemize @minus
42971 @item
42972 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42973 @item
42974 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42975 @item
42976 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42977 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42978 @item
42979 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42980 @item
42981 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42982 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42983 @end itemize
42984
42985 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42986
42987 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42988 describe registers:
42989
42990 @itemize @minus
42991 @item
42992 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42993 @item
42994 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42995 @item
42996 @samp{mxcsr}
42997 @end itemize
42998
42999 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43000 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43001 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43002
43003 @itemize @minus
43004 @item
43005 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43006 @item
43007 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43008 @end itemize
43009
43010 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43011 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43012
43013 @itemize @minus
43014 @item
43015 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43016 @item
43017 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43018 @end itemize
43019
43020 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43021 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43022
43023 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43024 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43025
43026 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43027 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43028 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43029
43030 @itemize @minus
43031 @item
43032 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43033 @end itemize
43034
43035 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43036
43037 @itemize @minus
43038 @item
43039 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43040 @end itemize
43041
43042 It should
43043 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43044
43045 @itemize @minus
43046 @item
43047 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43048 @item
43049 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43050 @end itemize
43051
43052 It should
43053 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43054
43055 @itemize @minus
43056 @item
43057 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43058 @end itemize
43059
43060 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43061 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43062 valid for i386 and amd64.
43063
43064 @node MicroBlaze Features
43065 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43066 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43067
43068 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43069 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43070 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43071 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43072 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43073
43074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43075 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43076
43077 @node MIPS Features
43078 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43079 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43080
43081 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43082 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43083 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43084 on the target.
43085
43086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43087 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43088 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43089
43090 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43091 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43092 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43093 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43094
43095 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43096 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43097 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43098 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43099
43100 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43101 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43102 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43103
43104 @node M68K Features
43105 @subsection M68K Features
43106 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43107
43108 @table @code
43109 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43110 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43111 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43112 One of those features must be always present.
43113 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43114 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43115 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43116 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43117
43118 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43119 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43120 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43121 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43122 @end table
43123
43124 @node NDS32 Features
43125 @subsection NDS32 Features
43126 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43127
43128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43129 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43130 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43131 and @samp{pc}.
43132
43133 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43134 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43135 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43136 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43137
43138 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43139 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43140 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43141 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43142 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43143 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43144 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43145
43146 @node Nios II Features
43147 @subsection Nios II Features
43148 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43149
43150 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43151 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43152 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43153 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43154 @samp{mpuacc}).
43155
43156 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43157 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43158 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43159
43160 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43161 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43162 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43163
43164 @node PowerPC Features
43165 @subsection PowerPC Features
43166 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43167
43168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43169 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43170 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43171 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43172
43173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43174 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43175
43176 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43177 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43178 and @samp{vrsave}.
43179
43180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43181 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43182 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
43183 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
43184 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
43185 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
43186
43187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43188 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43189 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43190 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43191 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43192 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43193 user.
43194
43195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43196 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43197
43198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43199 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43200
43201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43202 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43203
43204 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43205 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43206 64-bit wide.
43207
43208 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43209 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43210 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43211 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43212
43213 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43214 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43215 64-bit wide.
43216
43217 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43218 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43219 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43220 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43221 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43222 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43223 wide.
43224
43225 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43226 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43227 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43228 @samp{cfpscr}.
43229
43230 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43231 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43232 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43233 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43234 wide.
43235
43236 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43237 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43238 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43239 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43240 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43241 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43242 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43243 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43244 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43245
43246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43247 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43248
43249 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43250 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43251
43252 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43253 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43254
43255 @node S/390 and System z Features
43256 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43257 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43258 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43259
43260 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43261 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43262 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43263 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43264 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43265 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43266 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43267 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43268 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43269
43270 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43271 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43272 @samp{fpc}.
43273
43274 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43275 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43276
43277 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43278 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43279 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43280 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43281 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43282 32-bit wide.
43283
43284 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43285 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43286 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43287
43288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43289 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43290 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43291 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43292 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43293 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43294 @samp{v31}.
43295
43296 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43297 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43298 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43299
43300 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43301 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43302 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43303
43304 @node Sparc Features
43305 @subsection Sparc Features
43306 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43307 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43309 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43310
43311 @itemize @minus
43312 @item
43313 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43314 @item
43315 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43316 @item
43317 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43318 @item
43319 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43320 @end itemize
43321
43322 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43323
43324 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43325 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43326
43327 @itemize @minus
43328 @item
43329 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43330 @item
43331 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43332 @end itemize
43333
43334 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43335 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43336
43337 @itemize @minus
43338 @item
43339 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43340 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43341 @item
43342 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43343 for sparc64
43344 @end itemize
43345
43346 @node TIC6x Features
43347 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43348 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43349 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43350 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43351 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43352 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43353
43354 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43355 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43356 through @samp{B31}.
43357
43358 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43359 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43360
43361 @node Operating System Information
43362 @appendix Operating System Information
43363 @cindex operating system information
43364
43365 @menu
43366 * Process list::
43367 @end menu
43368
43369 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43370 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43371 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43372 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43373 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43374 on a different aspect of target.
43375
43376 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43377 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43378 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43379 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43380
43381 @node Process list
43382 @appendixsection Process list
43383 @cindex operating system information, process list
43384
43385 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43386 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43387 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43388 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43389
43390 An example document is:
43391
43392 @smallexample
43393 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43394 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43395 <osdata type="processes">
43396 <item>
43397 <column name="pid">1</column>
43398 <column name="user">root</column>
43399 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43400 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43401 </item>
43402 </osdata>
43403 @end smallexample
43404
43405 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43406 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43407 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43408 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43409 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43410 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43411 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43412
43413 @node Trace File Format
43414 @appendix Trace File Format
43415 @cindex trace file format
43416
43417 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43418 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43419
43420 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43421 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43422 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43423 in the future.
43424
43425 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43426 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43427 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43428 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43429 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43430 of this section.
43431
43432 @table @code
43433 @item R @var{size}
43434 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43435 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43436 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43437 a single trace file.
43438
43439 @item status @var{status}
43440 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43441 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43442 file.
43443
43444 @item tp @var{payload}
43445 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43446 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43447 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43448 reply packets.
43449
43450 @item tsv @var{payload}
43451 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43452 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43453 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43454 reply packets.
43455
43456 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43457 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43458 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43459 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43460 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43461 file. Includes are not allowed.
43462
43463 @end table
43464
43465 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43466 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43467 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43468 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43469 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43470 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43471 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43472 endianness.
43473
43474 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43475
43476 @table @code
43477 @item R @var{bytes}
43478 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43479 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43480 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43481
43482 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43483 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43484 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43485 @var{length} bytes.
43486
43487 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43488 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43489 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43490
43491 @end table
43492
43493 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43494 of blocks.
43495
43496 @node Index Section Format
43497 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43498 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43499 @cindex index section format
43500
43501 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43502 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43503 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43504 description.
43505
43506 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43507 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43508 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43509 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43510 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43511 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43512
43513 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43514
43515 @enumerate
43516 @item
43517 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43518 unless otherwise noted:
43519
43520 @enumerate
43521 @item
43522 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43523 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43524 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43525 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43526 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43527 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43528 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43529
43530 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43531 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43532 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43533 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43534
43535 @item
43536 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43537
43538 @item
43539 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43540 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43541 to the next offset.
43542
43543 @item
43544 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43545
43546 @item
43547 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43548
43549 @item
43550 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43551 @end enumerate
43552
43553 @item
43554 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43555 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43556 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43557 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43558 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43559 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43560 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43561 CU indices.
43562
43563 @item
43564 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43565 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43566 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43567 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43568
43569 @item
43570 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43571 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43572
43573 @enumerate
43574 @item
43575 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43576
43577 @item
43578 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43579 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43580
43581 @item
43582 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43583 @end enumerate
43584
43585 @item
43586 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43587 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43588
43589 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43590 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43591 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43592 constant pool.
43593
43594 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43595 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43596 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43597
43598 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43599 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43600 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43601 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43602 index version:
43603
43604 @table @asis
43605 @item Version 4
43606 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43607
43608 @item Versions 5 to 7
43609 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43610 @end table
43611
43612 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43613
43614 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43615 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43616 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43617 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43618 collision.
43619
43620 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43621 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43622 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43623 the code.
43624
43625 @item
43626 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43627 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43628 strings.
43629
43630 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43631 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43632 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43633 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43634 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43635 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43636
43637 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43638 @end enumerate
43639
43640 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43641 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43642 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43643
43644 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43645 (bit 0 = LSB):
43646
43647 @table @asis
43648
43649 @item Bits 0-23
43650 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43651 @item Bits 24-27
43652 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43653 @item Bits 28-30
43654 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43655
43656 @table @asis
43657 @item 0
43658 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43659 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43660 with previous versions of the index.
43661 @item 1
43662 The symbol is a type.
43663 @item 2
43664 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43665 @item 3
43666 The symbol is a function.
43667 @item 4
43668 Any other kind of symbol.
43669 @item 5,6,7
43670 These values are reserved.
43671 @end table
43672
43673 @item Bit 31
43674 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43675
43676 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43677 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43678 @value{GDBN} sources.
43679
43680 @end table
43681
43682 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43683 global/static attributes in the index.
43684
43685 @smallexample
43686 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43687 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43688 switch (die->tag)
43689 @{
43690 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43691 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43692 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43693 kind = TYPE;
43694 is_static = 1;
43695 break;
43696 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43697 kind = VARIABLE;
43698 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43699 break;
43700 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43701 kind = FUNCTION;
43702 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43703 break;
43704 case DW_TAG_constant:
43705 kind = VARIABLE;
43706 is_static = ! is_external;
43707 break;
43708 case DW_TAG_variable:
43709 kind = VARIABLE;
43710 is_static = ! is_external;
43711 break;
43712 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43713 kind = TYPE;
43714 is_static = 0;
43715 break;
43716 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43717 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43718 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43719 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43720 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43721 kind = TYPE;
43722 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43723 break;
43724 default:
43725 assert (0);
43726 @}
43727 @end smallexample
43728
43729 @node Man Pages
43730 @appendix Manual pages
43731 @cindex Man pages
43732
43733 @menu
43734 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43735 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43736 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43737 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43738 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43739 @end menu
43740
43741 @node gdb man
43742 @heading gdb man
43743
43744 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43745
43746 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43747 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43748 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43749 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43750 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43751 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43752 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43753 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43754 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43755 @c man end
43756
43757 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43758 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43759 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43760 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43761
43762 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43763 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43764
43765 @itemize @bullet
43766 @item
43767 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43768
43769 @item
43770 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43771
43772 @item
43773 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43774
43775 @item
43776 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43777 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43778 @end itemize
43779
43780 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43781 Modula-2.
43782
43783 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43784 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43785 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43786 by using the command @code{help}.
43787
43788 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43789 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43790 executable program as the argument:
43791
43792 @smallexample
43793 gdb program
43794 @end smallexample
43795
43796 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43797
43798 @smallexample
43799 gdb program core
43800 @end smallexample
43801
43802 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43803 to debug a running process:
43804
43805 @smallexample
43806 gdb program 1234
43807 gdb -p 1234
43808 @end smallexample
43809
43810 @noindent
43811 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43812 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43813 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43814
43815 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43816
43817 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43818 @table @env
43819 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43820 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43821
43822 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43823 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43824
43825 @item bt
43826 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43827
43828 @item print @var{expr}
43829 Display the value of an expression.
43830
43831 @item c
43832 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43833
43834 @item next
43835 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43836 function calls in the line.
43837
43838 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43839 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43840
43841 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43842 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43843
43844 @item step
43845 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43846 function calls in the line.
43847
43848 @item help [@var{name}]
43849 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43850 about using @value{GDBN}.
43851
43852 @item quit
43853 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43854 @end table
43855
43856 @ifset man
43857 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43858 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43859 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43860 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43861 @end ifset
43862 @c man end
43863
43864 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43865 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43866 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43867 encountered with no
43868 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43869 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43870 Many options have
43871 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43872 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43873 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43874 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43875 more usual convention.)
43876
43877 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43878 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43879 option is used.
43880
43881 @table @env
43882 @item -help
43883 @itemx -h
43884 List all options, with brief explanations.
43885
43886 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43887 @itemx -s @var{file}
43888 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43889
43890 @item -write
43891 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43892
43893 @item -exec=@var{file}
43894 @itemx -e @var{file}
43895 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43896 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43897 dump.
43898
43899 @item -se=@var{file}
43900 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43901 file.
43902
43903 @item -core=@var{file}
43904 @itemx -c @var{file}
43905 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43906
43907 @item -command=@var{file}
43908 @itemx -x @var{file}
43909 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43910
43911 @item -ex @var{command}
43912 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43913
43914 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43915 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43916 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43917
43918 @item -nh
43919 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43920
43921 @item -nx
43922 @itemx -n
43923 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43924
43925 @item -quiet
43926 @itemx -q
43927 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43928 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43929
43930 @item -batch
43931 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43932 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43933 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43934 commands in the command files.
43935
43936 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43937 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43938 more useful, the message
43939
43940 @smallexample
43941 Program exited normally.
43942 @end smallexample
43943
43944 @noindent
43945 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43946 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43947
43948 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43949 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43950 instead of the current directory.
43951
43952 @item -fullname
43953 @itemx -f
43954 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43955 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43956 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43957 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43958 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43959 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43960 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43961 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43962
43963 @item -b @var{bps}
43964 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43965 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43966
43967 @item -tty=@var{device}
43968 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43969 @end table
43970 @c man end
43971
43972 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43973 @ifset man
43974 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43975 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43976 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43977
43978 @smallexample
43979 info gdb
43980 @end smallexample
43981
43982 @noindent
43983 should give you access to the complete manual.
43984
43985 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43986 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43987 @end ifset
43988 @c man end
43989
43990 @node gdbserver man
43991 @heading gdbserver man
43992
43993 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43994 @format
43995 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43996 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43997
43998 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43999
44000 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44001 @c man end
44002 @end format
44003
44004 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44005 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44006 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44007
44008 @ifclear man
44009 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44010 @end ifclear
44011 @ifset man
44012 Usage (server (target) side):
44013 @end ifset
44014
44015 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44016 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44017 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44018 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44019
44020 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44021 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44022 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44023
44024 @smallexample
44025 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44026 @end smallexample
44027
44028 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44029
44030 @smallexample
44031 @ifset man
44032 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44033 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44034 @end ifset
44035 @ifclear man
44036 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44037 @end ifclear
44038 @end smallexample
44039
44040 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44041 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44042 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44043
44044 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44045
44046 @smallexample
44047 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44048 @end smallexample
44049
44050 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44051 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44052 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44053 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44054 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44055 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44056 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44057 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44058 print an error message and exit.
44059
44060 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44061 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44062
44063 @smallexample
44064 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44065 @end smallexample
44066
44067 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44068 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44069
44070 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44071 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44072 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44073 the program you want to debug.
44074
44075 @smallexample
44076 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44077 @end smallexample
44078
44079 @ifclear man
44080 @subheading Usage (host side)
44081 @end ifclear
44082 @ifset man
44083 Usage (host side):
44084 @end ifset
44085
44086 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44087 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44088 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44089 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44090 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44091 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44092 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44093 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44094 descriptor. For example:
44095
44096 @smallexample
44097 @ifset man
44098 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44099 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44100 @end ifset
44101 @ifclear man
44102 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44103 @end ifclear
44104 @end smallexample
44105
44106 @noindent
44107 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44108
44109 @smallexample
44110 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44111 @end smallexample
44112
44113 @noindent
44114 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44115 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44116 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44117 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44118 `Connection refused'.
44119
44120 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44121 described in
44122 @ifset man
44123 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44124 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44125 @end ifset
44126 @ifclear man
44127 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44128 @end ifclear
44129 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44130
44131 @smallexample
44132 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44133 @end smallexample
44134
44135 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44136 case.
44137 @c man end
44138
44139 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44140 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44141
44142 @itemize @bullet
44143
44144 @item
44145 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44146
44147 @smallexample
44148 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44149 @end smallexample
44150
44151 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44152 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44153 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44154 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44155 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44156 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44157 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44158
44159 @item
44160 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44161 program:
44162
44163 @smallexample
44164 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44165 @end smallexample
44166
44167 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44168 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44169 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44170 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44171
44172 @item
44173 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44174
44175 @smallexample
44176 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44177 @end smallexample
44178
44179 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44180 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44181 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44182 debug several processes in the same session.
44183 @end itemize
44184
44185 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44186
44187 @table @env
44188
44189 @item --help
44190 List all options, with brief explanations.
44191
44192 @item --version
44193 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44194
44195 @item --attach
44196 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44197
44198 @smallexample
44199 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44200 @end smallexample
44201
44202 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44203 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44204
44205 @item --multi
44206 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44207 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44208 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44209 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44210
44211 @smallexample
44212 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44213 @end smallexample
44214
44215 @item --debug
44216 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44217 process.
44218 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44219 the developers.
44220
44221 @item --remote-debug
44222 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44223 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44224 the developers.
44225
44226 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44227 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44228 of debugging output.
44229 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44230
44231 @item --wrapper
44232 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44233 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44234 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44235 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44236
44237 @item --once
44238 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44239 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44240 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44241 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44242
44243 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44244
44245 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44246 @c QDisableRandomization.
44247
44248 @end table
44249 @c man end
44250
44251 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44252 @ifset man
44253 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44254 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44255 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44256
44257 @smallexample
44258 info gdb
44259 @end smallexample
44260
44261 should give you access to the complete manual.
44262
44263 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44264 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44265 @end ifset
44266 @c man end
44267
44268 @node gcore man
44269 @heading gcore
44270
44271 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44272
44273 @format
44274 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44275 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44276 @c man end
44277 @end format
44278
44279 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44280 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44281 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44282 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44283 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44284 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44285 its job the program remains running without any change.
44286 @c man end
44287
44288 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44289 @table @env
44290 @item -a
44291 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44292 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44293 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44294 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44295 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44296
44297 @item -o @var{prefix}
44298 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44299 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44300 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44301 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44302 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44303 @end table
44304 @c man end
44305
44306 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44307 @ifset man
44308 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44309 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44310 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44311
44312 @smallexample
44313 info gdb
44314 @end smallexample
44315
44316 @noindent
44317 should give you access to the complete manual.
44318
44319 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44320 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44321 @end ifset
44322 @c man end
44323
44324 @node gdbinit man
44325 @heading gdbinit
44326
44327 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44328
44329 @format
44330 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44331 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44332 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44333 @end ifset
44334
44335 ~/.gdbinit
44336
44337 ./.gdbinit
44338 @c man end
44339 @end format
44340
44341 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44342 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44343 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44344 described in
44345 @ifset man
44346 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44347 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44348 @end ifset
44349 @ifclear man
44350 @ref{Sequences}.
44351 @end ifclear
44352
44353 Please read more in
44354 @ifset man
44355 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44356 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44357 @end ifset
44358 @ifclear man
44359 @ref{Startup}.
44360 @end ifclear
44361
44362 @table @env
44363 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44364 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44365 @end ifset
44366 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44367 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44368 @end ifclear
44369 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44370 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44371 See more in
44372 @ifset man
44373 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44374 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44375 @end ifset
44376 @ifclear man
44377 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44378 @end ifclear
44379
44380 @item ~/.gdbinit
44381 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44382 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44383
44384 @item ./.gdbinit
44385 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44386 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44387 See more in
44388 @ifset man
44389 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44390 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44391 @end ifset
44392 @ifclear man
44393 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44394 @end ifclear
44395 @end table
44396 @c man end
44397
44398 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44399 @ifset man
44400 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44401
44402 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44403 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44404 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44405
44406 @smallexample
44407 info gdb
44408 @end smallexample
44409
44410 should give you access to the complete manual.
44411
44412 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44413 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44414 @end ifset
44415 @c man end
44416
44417 @node gdb-add-index man
44418 @heading gdb-add-index
44419 @pindex gdb-add-index
44420 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44421
44422 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44423
44424 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44425 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44426 @c man end
44427
44428 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44429 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44430 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44431 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44432 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44433 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44434
44435 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44436 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44437 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44438 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44439 named @code{.debug_*}).
44440
44441 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44442 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44443 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44444 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44445
44446 See more in
44447 @ifset man
44448 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44449 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44450 @end ifset
44451 @ifclear man
44452 @ref{Index Files}.
44453 @end ifclear
44454 @c man end
44455
44456 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44457 @ifset man
44458 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44459 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44460 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44461
44462 @smallexample
44463 info gdb
44464 @end smallexample
44465
44466 should give you access to the complete manual.
44467
44468 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44469 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44470 @end ifset
44471 @c man end
44472
44473 @include gpl.texi
44474
44475 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44476 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44477 @include fdl.texi
44478
44479 @node Concept Index
44480 @unnumbered Concept Index
44481
44482 @printindex cp
44483
44484 @node Command and Variable Index
44485 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44486
44487 @printindex fn
44488
44489 @tex
44490 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44491 % meantime:
44492 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44493 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44494 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44495 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44496 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44497 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44498 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44499 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44500 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44501 \page\colophon
44502 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44503 @end tex
44504
44505 @bye
This page took 1.048933 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.